Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 452

ASX - ENGLISH - OGAE15E5

ASX
OWNER’S MANUAL

ASX - ENGLISH - OGAE15E5


Foreword Throughout this owner’s manual the words WARNING and CAUTION
appear.
Information for station service
E09200106344 E09300104149
Thank you for selecting an ASX as your new vehicle. These serve as reminders to be especially careful. Failure to follow instruc-
tions could result in personal injury or damage to your vehicle. 58 litres*1
2WD models
This owner’s manual will add to your understanding and full enjoyment of Petrol-powered vehicles 63 litres*2
the many fine features of this vehicle. WARNING Capacity
4WD models 60 litres
It contains information prepared to acquaint you with the proper way to oper-
ate and maintain your vehicle for the utmost in driving pleasure. indicates a strong possibility of severe personal injury or death if in- Diesel-powered vehicles 60 litres
structions are not followed. Petrol-powered vehicles
Fuel
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Europe B.V. reserves the right to make changes in Unleaded petrol octane number (EN228)
design and specifications and/or to make additions to or improvements in CAUTION 1600 models, 1800 models: 95 RON or higher
this product without obligation to install them on products previously manu- Fuel requirements 2000 models: 90 RON or higher
factured. means hazards or unsafe practices that could cause minor personal in- Diesel-powered vehicles
It is an absolute requirement for the driver to strictly observe all laws and jury or damage to your vehicle. Cetane number (EN590): 51 or higher
regulations concerning vehicles. You will see another important symbol: Refer to the “General information” section for the fuel selection.

This owner’s manual has been written in compliance with such laws and reg- NOTE: gives helpful information. Engine oil Refer to the “Maintenance” section for the selection of engine oil.
ulations, but some of the contents may become contradictory with later *: indicates optional equipment. Tyre inflation pressure Refer to the “Maintenance” section for the tyre inflation pressure.
amendment of the laws and regulations. It may differ according to the sales classification; refer *1: For vehicles with vehicle identification numbers that begin with “4”
to the sales catalogue.
*2: For vehicles with vehicle identification numbers that begin with “J”
Please leave this owner’s manual in this vehicle at time of resale. The next
owner will appreciate having access to the information contained in this Abbreviations used in this owner’s manual:
LHD: Left-Hand Drive
owner’s manual.
RHD: Right-Hand Drive CAUTION
Repairs to your vehicle: M/T: Manual Transmission l Diesel-powered vehicles are designed to use only diesel fuel that meets the EN 590 standard.
Vehicles in the warranty period: A/T: Automatic Transmission Use of any other type of diesel fuel can adversely affect the engine.
All warranty repairs must be carried out by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au- CVT: Continuously Variable Transmission
The symbol used on the vehicles:
thorized Service Point. NOTE
Vehicles outside the warranty period: : See owner’s manual l For the location of the vehicle identification number, refer to “Vehicle identification number” on page 11-02.
Where the vehicle is repaired is at the discretion of the owner.

© 2015 Mitsubishi Motors Corporation


OGAE15E5
BLO-15-000456
15
Table of contents
Overview 1
General information 2
Locking and unlocking 3
Seat and seat belts 4
Instruments and controls 5
Starting and driving 6
For pleasant driving 7
For emergencies 8
Vehicle care 9
Maintenance 10
Specifications 11
Alphabetical index 12
Declaration of Conformity 13

OGAE15E5
Instruments and controls

1 Instruments and controls


E00100108663

1. Combination headlamps and dipper switch p. 5-48


LHD Turn-signal lever p. 5-55
Front fog lamp switch* p. 5-56
Rear fog lamp switch p. 5-56
15 Headlamp washer switch* p. 5-62
16 2. Instruments p. 5-02
3. Shift paddles* p. 6-36
4. Windscreen wiper and washer switch p. 5-57
1 Rear window wiper and washer switch p. 5-61
2 5. Engine switch* p. 3-13
6. Cruise control switch* p. 6-54
13 3 7. Ignition switch* p. 6-12
14 8. Supplemental restraint system - driver’s knee airbag* p. 4-29
4 9. Supplemental restraint system - airbag (for driver’s seat) p. 4-24,
4-29
Horn switch p. 5-63
10. Tilt & Telescopic steering lever p. 6-08
11. Bluetooth® 2.0 interface* p. 7-48
5 12. Steering wheel audio remote control switches* p. 7-24
13. Sonar switch* p. 6-66
12 14. Active stability control (ASC) OFF switch* p. 6-52
6 15. Headlamp levelling switch* p. 5-54
16. Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) OFF switch* p. 6-22
11
7
10

9
8

1-02 Overview OGAE15E5


Instruments and controls

1
1. Instruments p. 5-02
RHD 2. Combination headlamps and dipper switch p. 5-48
Turn-signal lever p. 5-55
Front fog lamp switch* p. 5-56
4 Rear fog lamp switch p. 5-56
3
Headlamp washer switch* p. 5-62
3. Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) OFF switch* p. 6-22
4. Headlamp levelling switch* p. 5-54
2 5. Active stability control (ASC) OFF switch* p. 6-52
6. Sonar switch* p. 6-66
1 6 7. Cruise control switch* p. 6-54
5 8. Supplemental restraint system - airbag (for driver’s seat) p. 4-24,
16 4-29
15 Horn switch p. 5-63
9. Ignition switch* p. 6-12
10. Supplemental restraint system - driver’s knee airbag* p. 4-29
11. Bluetooth® 2.0 interface* p. 7-48
12. Steering wheel audio remote control switches* p. 7-24
14 13. Tilt & Telescopic steering lever p. 6-08
14. Engine switch* p. 3-13
15. Windscreen wiper and washer switch p. 5-57
13 Rear window wiper and washer switch p. 5-61
7
16. Shift paddles* p. 6-36
8

12
9
11
10

OGAE15E5 Overview 1-03


Instruments and controls

1
1. Audio system* p. 7-12
LHD MITSUBISHI Multi-Communication System*
DISPLAY AUDIO*
Refer to the separate owner’s manual
2. Centre ventilators p. 7-02
3. Key slot* p. 3-20
4. Side ventilators p. 7-02
5. Front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch p. 4-27
Glove box p. 7-78
6. Hazard warning flasher switch p. 5-55
7. Rear window demister switch p. 5-63
8. Accessory Socket* p. 7-74
Cigarette lighter* p. 7-73
9. Gearshift or selector lever p. 6-23, 6-26, 6-32
10. Parking brake lever p. 6-06
11. Cup holder p. 7-81
12. Drive mode selector* p. 6-39
13. Fuel tank filler door release lever p. 2-03
14. Ashtray* p. 7-72
15. Heated seat switch* p. 4-06
16. Bonnet release lever p. 10-03
17. Fuse box p. 10-20
18. Multi-information meter switch p. 5-05
19. Air conditioning* p. 7-03

1-04 Overview OGAE15E5


Instruments and controls

1
1. Audio System* p. 7-12
RHD MITSUBISHI Multi-Communication System*
DISPLAY AUDIO*
Refer to the separate owner’s manual
2. Multi-information meter switch p. 5-05
3. Bonnet release lever p. 10-03
4. Rear window demister switch p. 5-63
5. Accessory socket p. 7-74
6. Parking brake lever p. 6-06
7. Fuel tank filler door release lever p. 2-03
8. Cup holder p. 7-81
9. Drive mode selector* p. 6-39
10. Gearshift or selector lever, p. 6-23, 6-26
11. Air conditioning* p. 7-03
12. Front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch p. 4-27
Glove box p. 7-78
Fuse box p. 10-20
13. Side ventilators p. 7-02
14. Key slot* p. 3-20
15. Hazard warning flasher switch p. 5-55
16. Centre ventilators p. 7-02

OGAE15E5 Overview 1-05


Interior

1 Interior
E00100206253

1. Lock switch p. 3-40


LHD 2. Electric remote-controlled outside rear-view mirrors switch
p. 6-10
3. Central door lock switch p. 3-26
4. Electric window control switch p. 3-40
5. Sunshade illumination dimming control switch* p. 7-76
6. Inside rear-view mirror p. 6-08
7. Supplemental restraint system - side airbag (for front seats)*
p. 4-33
8. Front seat p. 4-03
Heated seat* p. 4-06
9. Heated seat switch* p. 4-06
10. Head restraints p. 4-07
11. Luggage room lamp p. 7-76
12. Luggage floor box* p. 7-81
13. Tether anchorages for child restraint system p. 4-22
14. Seat belts p. 4-09
Adjustable seat belt anchor p. 4-11
15. Supplemental restraint system - curtain airbag* p. 4-33

1-06 Overview OGAE15E5


Interior

1
1. Rear shelf panel p. 7-82
LHD 2. Assist grip p. 7-83
Coat hook p. 7-83
3. Room lamp (rear)* p. 7-75
3 4 4. Sun visors p. 7-71
Vanity mirror p. 7-71
2 Card holder p. 7-71
5 5. Map lamp & room lamp (front) p. 7-75
Sunshade switch* p. 3-41
Microphone (for Bluetooth® 2.0 interface)* p. 7-49
1 6. Supplemental restraint system - airbag (for front passenger’s seat)
p. 4-24, 4-29
7. Bottle holder p. 7-81
8. Armrest* p. 4-05
Auxiliary Audio connector (RCA)* p. 7-38
USB input terminal* p. 7-68
6 Accessory socket p. 7-74
9. Rear seat p. 4-06
10. Armrest* p. 4-06
Cup holder* p. 7-81

10 8

OGAE15E5 Overview 1-07


Interior

1
1. Supplemental restraint system - curtain airbag* p. 4-33
RHD 2. Seat belts p. 4-09
Adjustable seat belt anchor p. 4-11
3. Luggage room lamp p. 7-76
4. Luggage floor box* p. 7-81
5. Tether anchorages for child restraint system p. 4-22
6. Head restraints p. 4-07
7. Heated seat switch* p. 4-06
8. Front seat p. 4-03
Heated seat* p. 4-06
9. Supplemental restraint system - side airbag (for front seats)*
p. 4-33
10. Inside rear-view mirror p. 6-08
11. Sunshade illumination dimming control switch* p. 7-76
12. Electric window control switch p. 3-40
13. Lock switch p. 3-40
14. Electric remote-controlled outside rear-view mirrors switch
p. 6-10
15. Central door lock switch p. 3-26

1-08 Overview OGAE15E5


Interior

1
1. Map lamp & room lamp (front) p. 7-75
RHD Sunshade switch* p. 3-41
Microphone (for Bluetooth® 2.0 interface)* p. 7-49
2. Sun visors p. 7-71
2 3 Vanity mirror p. 7-71
Card holder p. 7-71
4 3. Room lamp (rear)* p. 7-75
1 4. Assist grip p. 7-83
Coat hook p. 7-83
5. Rear shelf panel p. 7-82
5 6. Armrest* p. 4-06
Cup holder* p. 7-81
7. Rear seat p. 4-06
8. Armrest* p. 4-05
Auxiliary Audio connector (RCA) p. 7-38
USB input terminal* p. 7-68
Accessory socket p. 7-74
10 9. Bottle holder p. 7-81
10. Supplemental restraint system - airbag (for front passenger’s seat)
p. 4-24, 4-29

8
6

OGAE15E5 Overview 1-09


Luggage compartment

1 Luggage compartment
E00100402882

1. Tyre repair kit p. 8-07


Vehicle with the tyre repair kit 2. Luggage hook p. 7-83
3. Jack p. 8-07
4. Tools p. 8-06
5. Luggage hook p. 7-83
6. Hook
7. Luggage hook p. 7-83
8. Tools p. 8-06

1-10 Overview OGAE15E5


Luggage compartment

1
1. Spare wheel p. 8-14
Vehicle with the spare tyre 2. Luggage hook p. 7-83
3. Jack p. 8-07
4. Tools p. 8-06
5. Luggage hook p. 7-83
6. Hook
7. Luggage hook p. 7-83
8. Tools p. 8-06

OGAE15E5 Overview 1-11


Exterior

1 Exterior
E00100507295

1. Electric window control p. 3-39


2. Outside rear-view mirror p. 6-10
12 Side turn-signal lamps* p. 5-55, 10-26, 10-32
13 3. Fuel tank filler p. 2-03
4. Wheel lip molding*
For details, refer to Vehicle dimensions p. 11-05.
1 5. Position lamps (type 1)* p. 5-48, 10-26, 10-30
11 6. Daytime running lamps (type 2)* p. 5-48, 10-26, 10-33
Position lamps (type 2)* p. 5-48, 10-26, 10-33
2 7. Front fog lamps* p. 5-56, 10-26, 10-32
Daytime running lamps (type 1)* p. 10-26, 10-33, 10-33
8. Headlamps, high-beam p. 5-48, 10-26, 10-29
10 9. Front turn-signal lamps p. 5-55, 10-26, 10-31
3 10. Bonnet p. 10-03
11. Windscreen wipers p. 5-57
12. Headlamps, low beam p. 5-48, 10-26, 10-28, 10-29
13. Side turn-signal lamps* p. 5-55, 10-26, 10-32

8 5

7
6

1-12 Overview OGAE15E5


Exterior

1
1. Keyless entry system* p. 3-04
Keyless operation system* p. 3-08
14 15 Locking and unlocking the doors p. 3-25
2. Changing tyres p. 8-13
Tyre inflation pressures p. 10-13
13
Tyre rotation p. 10-15
Tyre chains p. 10-16
Size of tyres and wheels p. 11-13
Tyre pressure monitoring system (TPMS)* p. 6-59
12 3. Turn-signal lamps/Hazard warning lamps p. 5-55, 5-55, 10-26,
1
10-35
4. Stop lamps/Tail lamps p. 5-48, 10-26, 10-35
5. Corner sensors* p. 6-65
11 6. Reversing lamps p. 5-48, 10-26, 10-36
7. Back sensors* p. 6-64
8. Rear fog lamp* p. 5-56, 10-26, 10-34
10 9. Licence plate lamps p. 5-48, 10-26, 10-37
10. Rear-view camera* p. 6-68
11. Rear window wiper p. 5-61
9 12. Rear spoiler
13. High-mounted stop lamp p. 10-26
8 2 14. Antenna p. 7-47
15. Tailgate p. 3-30

6
5
3

OGAE15E5 Overview 1-13


OGAE15E5
General information
2

Fuel selection...................................................................................... 2-02


Filling the fuel tank............................................................................. 2-03
Installation of accessories................................................................... 2-04
Modification/alterations to the electrical or fuel systems................... 2-05
Genuine parts...................................................................................... 2-05
Safety and disposal information for used engine oil...........................2-06
Disposal information for used batteries.............................................. 2-06
Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system*..................................................... 2-06

OGAE15E5
Fuel selection

Fuel selection NOTE NOTE


2 l Petrol-powered vehicles have the knock con- l Repeatedly driving short distances at low
E00200103076

trol system so that you can use unleaded pet- speeds can cause deposits to form in the fuel
Petrol-powered vehicles rol 90 RON as an emergent measure in case system and engine, resulting in poor starting
Unleaded petrol octane unleaded petrol 95 RON or higher is not and poor acceleration. If these problems oc-
number (EN228) available on journey, etc. cur, you are advised to add a detergent addi-
1600 models, 1800 mod- In such a case, you don’t need to adjust the tive to the gasoline when you refuel the ve-
els engine specially. In case of using unleaded hicle. The additive will remove the deposits,
Recom- petrol 90 RON, the engine performance lev- thereby returning the engine to a normal
95 RON or higher
mended el is reduced. condition. Be sure to use a MITSUBISHI
2000 models
fuel l For diesel fuel, due to the separation of par- MOTORS GENUINE FUEL SYSTEM
90 RON or higher affin, the fluidity of the fuel decreases con- CLEANER. Using an unsuitable additive
siderably as the temperature falls. could make the engine malfunction. For de-
Diesel-powered vehicles Because of this fact there are two kinds of tails, please contact a MITSUBISHI
Cetane number (EN590) fuel: “summer” and “winter”. MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
51 or higher This must be considered in winter use. l Poor quality petrol can cause problems such
Select either of the two kinds of fuel in ac- as difficult starting, stalling, engine noise
cordance with ambient temperature. and hesitation. If you experience these prob-
CAUTION Above -5 °C: “Summer” diesel lems, try another brand and/or grade of pet-
Below -5 °C: “Winter” diesel rol.
l For petrol-powered vehicles, the use of lea- When travelling abroad, find out in advance If the check engine warning lamp flashes,
ded fuel can result in serious damage to the about the fuels served in local service sta- have the system checked as soon as possible
engine and catalytic converter. Do not use tions. at a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
leaded fuel. Service Point.
l Diesel-powered vehicles are designed to use
only diesel fuel that meets the EN590 stand-
ard. E10 type petrol
Use of any other type of diesel fuel (bio die- E00203200022
sel, methylester, etc.) would adversely affect The petrol engines are compatible with E10
the engine’s performance and durability.
type petrol (containing 10 % ethanol) con-
forming to European standards EN 228.

2-02 General information OGAE15E5


Filling the fuel tank

CAUTION WARNING 2. The fuel tank filler is located on the rear


left side of your vehicle.
l Do not use more than 10 % concentration of
ethanol (grain alcohol) by volume.
l Do not move away from the fuel tank fill-
er until refueling is finished. If you moved
Open the fuel tank filler door by pulling 2
the release lever located on the side of
Use of more than 10 % concentration may away and did something else (for exam-
lead to damage to your vehicle fuel system, ple, sitting on a seat) part-way through the driver’s seat.
engine, engine sensors and exhaust system. the refueling process, you could pick up a
fresh charge of static electricity. LHD
l If the tank cap must be replaced, use only
Filling the fuel tank a MITSUBISHI MOTORS genuine part.
E00200204120

Fuel tank capacity


WARNING
l When handling fuel, comply with the safe- Petrol-pow- 2WD models
ty regulations displayed by garages and 58 litres*1
filling stations.
ered vehi- 63 litres*2
cles
l Gasoline is highly flammable and explo-
4WD models 60 litres
sive. You could be burned or seriously in-
jured when handling it. When refueling Diesel-powered vehicles 60 litres RHD
your vehicle, always turn the engine off
and keep away from flames, sparks, and *1: For vehicles with vehicle identification
smoking materials. Always handle fuel in numbers that begin with “4" .
well-ventilated outdoor areas. *2: For vehicles with vehicle identification
l Before removing the fuel cap, be sure to
numbers that begin with “J .
get rid of your body’s static electricity by
touching a metal part of the car or the
fuel pump. Any static electricity on your
body could create a spark that ignites fuel
NOTE
vapour. l For the location of the vehicle identification
l Perform the whole refueling process number, refer to “Vehicle identification
(opening the fuel tank filler door, remov- number” on page 11-02. 3. Remove the fuel cap.
ing the fuel cap, etc.) by yourself. Do not
let any other person come near the fuel
tank filler. If you allowed a person to help
Refueling
you and that person was carrying static
electricity, fuel vapour could be ignited. 1. Before filling with fuel, stop the engine.

OGAE15E5 General information 2-03


Installation of accessories
Open the fuel tank filler tube by slowly CAUTION 6. When the gun stops automatically, do
turning the cap anticlockwise. not fill with fuel any more.
2 l For diesel-powered 1600 models, the fuel
cap does not turn more than 90 degrees.
7. Close the fuel cap.
[Except for diesel-powered vehicles
Except for diesel-powered vehicles 1600 models Turning forcibly could damage the fuel cap.
1600 models]
l Since the fuel system may be under pressure,
remove the fuel cap slowly. This relieves To close, turn the fuel cap slowly clock-
any pressure or vacuum that might have wise until you hear clicking sounds, then
built up in the fuel tank. If you hear a hissing gently push the fuel tank filler door
sound from the cap, wait until it stops before closed.
removing the cap. Otherwise, fuel may spray [For diesel-powered 1600 models]
out, injuring you or others.
Fit the fuel cap with the cap handle side-
ways and turn it clockwise.
4. While filling with fuel, hang the fuel cap
cord on the hook located on the inside of
the fuel tank filler door.
Installation of accessories
Diesel-powered vehicles 1600 models E00200300963

We recommend you to consult a


MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service
Point.
l The installation of accessories, optional
parts, etc., should only be carried out
within the limits prescribed by law in
your country, and in accordance with the
guidelines and warnings contained with-
in the documents accompanying this ve-
hicle.
1- Remove l Installing electric components incorrect-
2- Close 5. Insert the gun in the tank port as far as it ly could lead to a fire. Please refer to
goes. Modification/alteration to the electrical
or fuel systems section within this own-
CAUTION er’s manual.
l Do not tilt the gun.
2-04 General information OGAE15E5
Modification/alterations to the electrical or fuel systems
l Using a cellular phone or radio set inside Consider also that there basically exists no li- CAUTION
the vehicle without an external antenna ability on the part of the appraiser or the offi-
may cause electrical system interference, cial. Maximum safety can only be ensured l If the wires interfere with the vehicle body
or improper installation methods are used
2
which could lead to unsafe vehicle oper- with parts recommended, sold and fitted or
(protective fuses not included, etc.), elec-
ation. installed by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au- tronic devices may be adversely affected, re-
l Tyres and wheels which do not meet thorized Service Point (MITSUBISHI sulting in a fire or other accident.
specifications must not be used. MOTORS genuine replacement parts and
Refer to the “Specifications” section for MITSUBISHI MOTORS accessories). The
information regarding wheel and tyre same also pertains to modifications of Genuine parts
sizes. MITSUBISHI vehicles with respect to the E00200500499

production specifications. For safety reasons, MITSUBISHI MOTORS has gone to great
Important points! do not attempt any modifications other than lengths to bring you a superbly crafted auto-
those that follow the recommendations of a mobile offering the highest quality and de-
Due to large number of accessory and re- MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service
placement parts of different manufactures pendability.
Point. Use MITSUBISHI MOTORS Genuine Parts,
available in the market, it is not possible, not
designed and manufactured to maintain your
only for MITSUBISHI MOTORS, but also Modification/alterations to MITSUBISHI MOTORS automobile at top
for a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
Service Point, to check whether the attach- the electrical or fuel systems performance. MITSUBISHI MOTORS Gen-
ment or installation of such parts affects the E00200400368
uine Parts are identified by this mark and are
overall safety of your MITSUBISHI-vehicle. available at all MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
MITSUBISHI MOTORS CORPORATION thorized Service Points.
has always manufactured safe, high quality
Even when such parts are officially author- vehicles. In order to maintain this safety and
ized, for example by a “general operators quality, it is important that any accessory that
permit” (an appraisal for the part) or through is to be fitted, or any modifications carried
the execution of the part in an officially ap- out which involve the electrical or fuel sys-
proved manner of construction, or when a tems, should be carried out in accordance
single operation permit following the attach- with MITSUBISHI guidelines.
ment or installation of such parts, it cannot be
deduced from that alone, that the driving
safety of your vehicle has not been affected.

OGAE15E5 General information 2-05


Safety and disposal information for used engine oil

Safety and disposal Disposal information for Auto Stop & Go (AS&G)
2 information for used engine used batteries system*
oil E00201300032 E00201500021

E00200600155 Your vehicle contains batter- This paragraph summarizes the major items
ies and/or accumulators. of the Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system
WARNING Do not mix with general such as the characteristics, operating proce-
l Prolonged and repeated contact may household waste. dures, etc. For details, refer to “Auto Stop &
cause serious skin disorders, including For proper treatment, recov- Go (AS&G) system” on page 6-19.
dermatitis and cancer. ery and recycling of used bat-
l Avoid contact with the skin as far as pos-
teries, please take them to ap-
sible and wash thoroughly after any con- The Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system re-
tact. plicable collection points, in
duces the emission of exhaust gases and in-
l Keep used engine oils out of reach of chil- accordance with your nation-
creases fuel efficiency.
dren. al legislation and the Direc-
The Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system auto-
tives 2006/66/EC.
matically stops and restarts the engine with-
Protect the environment By disposing of these batter-
out the use of the ignition switch or the en-
ies correctly, you will help to
gine switch when the vehicle is stopped, such
It is illegal to pollute drains, water courses save valuable resources and
as at traffic lights or in a traffic jam.
and soil. Use authorized waste collection fa- prevent any potential nega-
cilities, including civic amenity sites and ga- tive effects on human health Activation
rages providing facilities for disposal of used and the environment which E00201600051
oil and used oil filters. If in doubt, contact could otherwise arise from The Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system is auto-
your local authority for advice on disposal. inappropriate waste handling. matically activated when the ignition switch
is turned to the “ON” position or the opera-
tion mode is put in ON.

2-06 General information OGAE15E5


Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system*

Deactivation 2. Place the gearshift lever in the “N” Auto go


E00201700065
(Neutral) position. E00201900067
You can deactivate the system by pressing Depress the clutch pedal while the gearshift 2
the “Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) OFF” switch. Vehicles with 5M/T Vehicles with 6M/T lever is in the “N” (Neutral) position. The
Then the “ ” display/indicator will turn on. “ ” display/indicator turns off and the en-
gine restarts automatically.

3. Release the clutch pedal.


4. The “ ” display/indicator will turn on
and the engine will stop automatically.

Auto stop
E00201801076 System characteristics
1. Stop the vehicle. E00202300055
The principle of the Auto Stop & Go
(AS&G) system is that it adapts to the vehi-
cle’s needs (i.e. energy supply). This means
that in certain circumstances the engine will
not stop and in other circumstances the en-
gine will restart by itself.

OGAE15E5 General information 2-07


Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system*

Circumstances when the engine l After the engine restarts automatically


and the vehicle stops again within 10
will restart by itself
2 E00202400027
seconds.
l The interior temperature rises and the air l After the engine restarts automatically
conditioning starts operating in order to and the vehicle remains stationary.
lower the temperature. l Mode selection dial is set to the demister
position (see illustration below).
l Electric power consumption is high.
l The brake pedal is depressed repeatedly.
l Vehicle speed is 3 km/h (2 mph) or
higher when coasting on a slope.
l Mode selection dial is set to the demister
position.
l When the air conditioning is operated by
pressing the air conditioning switch.
l When the preset temperature of the air
conditioning is changed significantly.
l When the air conditioning is operated in
AUTO mode where the temperature con-
trol dial is set to the max. hot or the max. l When the air conditioning is operated in
cool position (for vehicles with automat- AUTO mode where the temperature con-
ic air conditioning). trol dial is set to the max. hot or the max.
cool position (for vehicles with automat-
Other than the conditions mentioned above, ic air conditioning).
the engine may restart automatically. For de-
tails, refer to “Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) sys- Other than the conditions mentioned above,
tem” on page 6-19. the engine may not stop automatically. For
details, refer to “Auto Stop & Go (AS&G)
Circumstances when the engine system” on page 6-19.
will not stop
E00202500044

l Ambient temperature is lower than ap-


proximately 3 °C.
2-08 General information OGAE15E5
Locking and unlocking

3
Keys.................................................................................................... 3-02
Electronic immobilizer (Anti-theft starting system)........................... 3-03
Keyless entry system*.........................................................................3-04
Keyless operation system*..................................................................3-08
Doors...................................................................................................3-25
Central door locks............................................................................... 3-26
Dead Lock System*............................................................................ 3-27
“Child-protection” rear doors..............................................................3-30
Tailgate................................................................................................3-30
Inside tailgate release.......................................................................... 3-31
Security alarm system*....................................................................... 3-32
Electric window control...................................................................... 3-39
Sunshade*........................................................................................... 3-41

OGAE15E5
Keys

Keys Type 2 NOTE


E00300102269
The emergency key fits all locks. l The key number is stamped on the tag as in-
dicated in the illustration.
3 Type 1 Make a record of the key number and store
the key and key number tag in separate pla-
ces, so that you can order a key in the event
The key fits all locks. the original keys are lost.
l The key is a precision electronic device with
a built-in signal transmitter. Please observe
the following in order to prevent a malfunc-
tion.
• Do not leave in a place that is exposed to
direct sunlight, for example on the dash-
board.
• Do not disassemble or modify.
1- Keyless operation key
• Do not excessively bend the key or sub-
(with electronic immobilizer and keyless ject it to strong impacts.
entry system function) • Do not expose to water.
2- Emergency key • Keep away from magnetic key rings.
1- Keyless entry key 3- Key number tag
(with electronic immobilizer) • Keep away from audio systems, personal
computers, TVs, and other equipment that
2- Key number tag generates a magnetic field.
WARNING • Keep away from devices that emit strong
l When taking a key on flights, do not press electromagnetic waves, such as cellular
any switches on the key while on the phones, wireless devices and high fre-
plane. If a switch is pressed on the plane, quency equipment (including medical de-
the key emits electromagnetic waves, vices).
which could adversely affect the plane’s • Do not clean with ultrasonic cleaners or
flight operation. similar equipment.
When carrying a key in a bag, be careful • Do not leave the key where it may be ex-
that no switches on the key can be easily posed to high temperature or high humidi-
pressed by mistake. ty.

3-02 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Electronic immobilizer (Anti-theft starting system)

NOTE [Except vehicles equipped with keyless oper- NOTE


ation system]
l The engine is designed so that it will not The electronic immobilizer is designed to
start if the ID code registered in the immo-
significantly reduce the possibility of vehicle
bilizer computer and the key’s ID code do
not match. Refer to the “Electronic immobil- theft. The purpose of the system is to immo- 3
izer” section for details and key usage. bilize the vehicle if an invalid start is attemp-
l [For vehicles equipped with the security ted. A valid start attempt can only be ach-
alarm system] ieved by using a key “registered” to the im-
Pay attention to the following if the security mobilizer system.
alarm is set to “Active”.
Refer to “Security alarm system” on page
3-32. NOTE
• If the security alarm is in the system
armed mode, the alarm will sound if the l In the following cases, the vehicle may not
be able to receive the registered ID code • When the key contacts or is close to other
doors are opened after being unlocked immobilizing keys (including keys of oth-
from the registered key and the engine may
with the key, the inside lock knob or the er vehicles).
not start.
central door lock switch.
• When the key contacts a key ring or other
• Even if the security alarm is set to “Ac- metallic or magnetic object.
tive”, the system preparation mode is not
entered if the keyless entry system or the
keyless operation function was not used to
lock the vehicle.

Electronic immobilizer
(Anti-theft starting system)
E00300203078

[For vehicles equipped with keyless opera-


tion system] In cases like these, remove the object or
For information on operations for vehicles additional key from the vehicle key. Then
equipped with the keyless operation system, • When the key grip contacts metal of an- try again to start the engine. If the engine
other key. does not start, we recommend you to con-
refer to “Keyless operation system: Electron-
ic immobilizer (Anti-theft starting system)”
on page 3-13.
OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-03
Keyless entry system*

NOTE Keyless entry system* NOTE


tact your MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au- E00300302649
l With a vehicle that has a Dead Lock System,
thorized Service Point. Press the remote control switch, and all doors pressing the LOCK switch (1) two times in
3 l If you lose one of them, contact a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
and the tailgate will be locked or unlocked as
succession causes the Dead Lock System to
be set. (Refer to “Setting the system” on
ice Point as soon as possible. To obtain a re- desired. It is also possible to operate the out- page 3-27.)
placement or extra spare key, take your vehi- side rear-view mirrors (Vehicles equipped
cle and all remaining keys to your with the mirror retractor switch).
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
To unlock
ice Point. All the keys have to be re-regis-
tered in the immobilizer computer unit. The Press the UNLOCK switch (2). All the doors
immobilizer can register up to 8 different and the tailgate will be unlocked. If the doors
keys. and tailgate are unlocked when the front
room lamp switch is in the “DOOR” position
or the rear room lamp switch (except for ve-
CAUTION hicles equipped with the sunshade) is in the
l Do not modify or add parts to the immobiliz- middle (•) position, the room lamp will illu-
er system. Doing so could cause the immo- minate for approximately 15 seconds and the
bilizer to malfunction. turn-signal lamps will blink twice.
1- LOCK switch Depending on the vehicle model, the position
2- UNLOCK switch and tail lamps can also be set to turn on for
3- Indication lamp approximately 30 seconds. Refer to “Instru-
ments and controls: Welcome light” on page
To lock 5-52.

Press the LOCK switch (1). All the doors and NOTE
the tailgate will be locked. The turn-signal
lamps will blink once when the doors and the l The remote control switch does not operate
in the following conditions:
tailgate are locked.
• The key is left in the ignition switch.
• A door or the tailgate is open or ajar. (On-
ly the unlock function operates.)

3-04 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Keyless entry system*

NOTE NOTE Operation of the outside rear-


l Except for vehicles equipped with a Dead • The confirmation function (flashing of the view mirrors (Vehicles equip-
Lock System, the door and tailgate unlock turn-signal lamps) can be set to operate ped with mirror retractor
function can be set so that only the driver’s
door unlocks when the UNLOCK switch (2)
only when the doors and backdoor are
locked or only when the doors and back-
switch) 3
E00310800236
is pressed once. door are unlocked.
If the door and tailgate unlock function is set • The confirmation function (this indicates
to work as described above, all the doors and locking or unlocking of the doors and tail- To fold
the tailgate unlock when the UNLOCK gate with the flash of the turn-signal Within 30 seconds of locking the doors and
switch is pressed two times in succession. lamps) can be deactivated.
tailgate using the LOCK switch (1), press the
Refer to “Setting of door and tailgate unlock • The number of times the turn-signal
function” on page 3-06. lamps are flashed by the confirmation LOCK switch twice rapidly to fold the out-
l The indication lamp (3) comes on each time function can be changed. side rear-view mirrors.
a switch is pressed.
l For vehicles equipped with the mirror retrac-
Operation of the Dead Lock To extend
tor switch, the outside rear-view mirrors au-
tomatically retract or extend when all the System Within 30 seconds of unlocking the doors
doors and tailgate are locked or unlocked us- and tailgate using the UNLOCK switch (2),
ing the remote control switches of the key- In a vehicle that has a Dead Lock System, it press the UNLOCK switch twice rapidly to
less entry system. is possible to set the Dead Lock System using return the outside rear-view mirrors to their
Refer to “Starting and driving: Outside rear- the remote controller. extended positions.
view mirrors” on page 6-10. (Refer to “Dead Lock System” on page
l If the UNLOCK switch (2) is pressed and no
3-27.) The outside rear-view mirrors are not ini-
door or tailgate is opened within approxi- tially set to work as described above. If you
mately 30 seconds, relocking will automati- want them to work as described above, you
cally occur.
need to set them so that they do not retract/
l It is possible to modify functions as follows:
extend when the doors and tailgate are
For further information, please contact your
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv- locked/unlocked using the keyless entry sys-
ice Point. tem or keyless operation system.
• The time for automatic relocking can be Refer to “Starting and driving: Outside rear-
changed. view mirrors” on page 6-10.
For details, please consult a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-05


Keyless entry system*

NOTE NOTE 3. Press and hold the LOCK switch (1) for
4 to 10 seconds and then also press the
l The outside rear-view mirrors cannot be fol- l If you wish to add a remote control switch, UNLOCK switch (2) during this time.
ded or extended using the remote control we recommend you to contact a
4. Release in sequence the LOCK and UN-
3 switch in the following conditions:
• The key is left in the ignition switch.
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point. LOCK switches within 10 seconds of
A maximum of 8 remote control switches pressing the LOCK switch in step 3.
• A door or the tailgate is open or ajar.
are available for your vehicle.
l The remote control switch will operate with-
in approximately 4 m from the vehicle. Procedure for replacing the re-
However, the operating range of the remote mote control switch battery
control switch may change if the vehicle is
Setting of door and tailgate un-
located near a power station, or radio/TV lock function (Except for vehi- E00309501272
1. Before replacing the battery, remove
broadcasting station. cles equipped with a Dead static electricity from your body by
l If either of the following problems occurs,
Lock System)
the battery may be exhausted. touching a metal part such as a doorknob
• The remote control switch is operated at E00310300257 of the room.
the correct distance from the vehicle, but The door and tailgate unlock function can be
the doors and tailgate are not locked/ set to the following two conditions.
unlocked in response. Each time the door and tailgate unlock func- WARNING
• The indication lamp (3) is dim or does not tion is set, a chime will sound to tell you the l Danger of explosion if battery is incor-
come on. rectly replaced.
condition of the door and tailgate unlock
function. Replace only with the same battery or an
For further information, please contact equivalent type.
your MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
Service Point.
Number of
Condition
chimes
If you replace the battery yourself, refer to CAUTION
“Procedure for replacing the remote con- All doors and the tailgate un-
trol switch battery” on page 3-06. One chime l When the remote control switch case is
lock opened, be careful to keep water, dust, etc.
l If your remote control switch is lost or dam-
aged, please contact your MITSUBISHI Two chimes Driver’s door unlock only out. Also, do not touch the internal compo-
MOTORS Authorized Service Point for a re- nents.
placement remote control switch. 1. Remove the key from the ignition
switch.
2. Place the combination headlamps and
dipper switch in the “OFF” position, and
leave the driver’s door open.

3-06 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Keyless entry system*

NOTE to the notch in the remote control switch 4. Remove the remote control transmitter
case and use it to open the case. from the remote control switch case.
l You may purchase a replacement battery at Then, open the remote control transmit-
an electric appliance store.
ter using the method described in step 3.
lA MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
Service Point can replace the battery for you
3
if you prefer.

2. Remove the screw (A) from the remote


control switch.

NOTE
l Be sure to perform the procedure with the 5. Remove the old battery.
MITSUBISHI mark facing you. If the
6. Install a new battery with the + side (B)
MITSUBISHI mark is not facing you when
you open the remote control switch case, the down.
switches may come out.

+ side
3. With the MITSUBISHI mark facing
you, insert the cloth covered tip of a
straight blade (or minus) screwdriver in-
- side

Coin type battery


CR1616

7. Close the remote control transmitter


firmly.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-07


Keyless operation system*
8. Place the remote control transmitter in WARNING WARNING
the remote control switch case, then se-
curely close the remote control switch l People with implantable cardiac pace- l When using electro-medical devices other
makers or implantable cardiovascular-de- than implantable cardiac pacemakers or
case.
3 9. Attach the screw (A) removed in step 2.
fibrillators should not go near the exterior
transmitters (A) or the interior transmit-
implantable cardiovascular-defibrillators,
contact the electromedical device manu-
10. Check the keyless entry system to see ters (B). The radio waves used by the key- facturer ahead of time to determine the
that it works. less operation system could adversely af- affects of radio waves on the devices. Elec-
fect implantable cardiac pacemakers or tromedical device operations could be af-
implantable cardiovascular-defibrillators. fected by radio waves.
Keyless operation system*
E00305601943
You can limit the possible operations of
The keyless operation system allows you to the keyless operation system in the fol-
lock and unlock the doors and tailgate, start lowing ways. (The keyless operation
the engine and change the operation mode system can be used as a keyless entry
simply by carrying the keyless operation key system.) Consult a MITSUBISHI
with you. MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
The keyless operation key can also be used as • You can limit operations to locking
the keyless entry system remote control and unlocking the doors and tailgate.
switch. • You can limit operations to starting
Refer to “Keyless operation system: Keyless the engine.
entry system” on page 3-22. • The keyless operation system can be
disabled.
The driver should always carry the keyless
operation key. This key is necessary for lock- When keyless operation system opera-
ing and unlocking the doors and tailgate, tions are modified, the transmitters oper-
starting the engine and otherwise operating ate as follows.
the vehicle, so before locking and leaving the • Only locking and unlocking doors or
vehicle, be sure to check that you have the tailgate: exterior and interior transmit-
keyless operation key. ters.
• Only starting the engine: interior
transmitter.

3-08 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Keyless operation system*

NOTE NOTE You can only lock and unlock the doors and
tailgate, start the engine and change the oper-
l The keyless operation key uses an ultra- l Because the keyless operation key receives ation mode if the ID codes of your keyless
weak electromagnetic wave. In the following signals in order to communicate with the
operation key and the vehicle match.
cases, the keyless operation system may not
operate properly or may be unstable.
transmitters in the vehicle, the battery con-
tinually wears down regardless of keyless
3
• When there is equipment nearby that operation key use. The battery life is 1 to 3
emits strong radio waves, such as: a pow- years, depending on usage conditions. When
er station, a radio/TV broadcasting station the battery wears out, please consult a
or an airport. MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
• The keyless operation system is carried ice Point.
together with a communications device If you replace the battery yourself, refer to
such as a cellular phone or radio set, or “Procedure for replacing the remote control
with an electronic device such as a per- switch battery” on page 3-24.
sonal computer. l Because the keyless operation key continual-
• The keyless operation key is touching or ly receives signals, strong radio wave recep-
covered by a metal object. tion could affect battery wear. Do not leave
• A keyless entry system is being used the key near a TV, personal computer, or
nearby. other electronic device. NOTE
• When the keyless operation key battery is
worn out. l If the keyless operation key battery is wear-
• When the keyless operation key is placed Operating range of the keyless ing out or there are strong electromagnetic
in an area with strong radio waves or operation system waves or noise present, the operating range
noise. may become smaller and operation may be-
E00305700367
In such cases, use the emergency key. come unstable.
If you are carrying the keyless operation key,
Refer to “To operate without using the
keyless operation function” on page enter the operating range of the keyless oper-
3-21. ation system, and press the driver’s or front
passenger’s door lock/unlock switch, the tail-
gate LOCK switch or the tailgate OPEN
switch, the ID code for your key is verified.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-09


Keyless operation system*

Operating range for locking NOTE Operating range for starting the
and unlocking the doors and l Even if the keyless operation key is within engine and changing the opera-
tailgate 70 cm of the driver’s or front passenger’s tion mode
3 E00306200330
door lock/unlock switch, the tailgate LOCK
switch or the tailgate OPEN switch, if the
E00306300243
The operating range is approximately 70 cm The operating range is the interior of the ve-
key is near to the ground or high up, the sys-
from the driver’s and front passenger’s door tem may not operate. hicle.
lock/unlock switches, the tailgate LOCK l If the keyless operation key is within the op-
switch and the tailgate OPEN switch. erating range, even someone not carrying the
key can lock and unlock the doors and tail-
gate by pressing the driver’s or front passen-
ger’s door lock/unlock switch, the tailgate
LOCK switch or the tailgate OPEN switch.

*: Forward direction

*: Forward direction : Operating range

: Operating range
NOTE
l Even if it is within the operating range, if the
NOTE keyless operation key is in a small item
holder such as the glove box, on top of the
l Locking and unlocking are only possible
when the door or tailgate is operated while instrument panel, door pocket or in the lug-
the keyless operation key is being detected. gage area, it may be impossible to start the
engine and change the operation mode.
l Operation may not be possible if you are too
close to the front door, door window, or tail-
gate.

3-10 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Keyless operation system*

NOTE Tailgate switches


NOTE
l If you are too close to the door or door win- l The tailgate OPEN switch (C) can be used to
dow, the engine may start even though the confirm that the vehicle is locked properly.
keyless operation key is outside the vehicle. Press the tailgate OPEN switch within ap-
proximately 3 seconds of locking the vehi-
3
cle.
To operate using the keyless If the tailgate OPEN switch is pressed 3 sec-
operation function onds or more after the vehicle is locked, the
doors and the tailgate are unlocked.
E00305802043
l The time within which locking confirmation
is possible can be adjusted. For further infor-
Locking the doors and tailgate mation, please contact your MITSUBISHI
When you are carrying the keyless operation
NOTE MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
key, if you press the driver’s or front passen- l For vehicles equipped with the mirror retrac-
ger’s door lock/unlock switch (A), or the tail- tor switch, the outside rear-view mirrors au- Unlocking the doors and tail-
tomatically retract when all the doors and gate
gate LOCK switch (B) within the operating
tailgate are locked using the keyless opera-
range, the doors and the tailgate are locked. tion function. When you are carrying the keyless operation
The turn-signal lamps will blink once. Refer to “Starting and driving: Outside rear- key, if you press the driver’s or front passen-
Also refer to “Locking and unlocking: Doors, view mirrors” on page 6-10. ger’s door lock/unlock switch (A), or the tail-
Central door locks, tailgate” on pages 3-25, l With a vehicle that has a Dead Lock System,
gate OPEN switch (B) within the operating
3-26 and 3-30. pressing the driver’s or front passenger’s
door lock/unlock switch (A), or the tailgate range, all the doors and the tailgate are un-
LOCK switch (B) two times in succession locked.
Driver’s and front passenger’s door lock/unlock switches
causes the Dead Lock System to be set. (Re- If the front room lamp switch is in the
fer to “Setting the system” on page 3-27). “DOOR” position or the rear room lamp
l The keyless operation function does not op- switch (except for vehicles equipped with the
erate under the following conditions: sunshade) is in the middle (•) position at this
• The keyless operation key is inside the time, the room lamp will turn on for 15 sec-
vehicle.
onds. The turn-signal lamps will blink twice.
• A door or the tailgate is open or ajar.
• The operation mode is not in OFF.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-11


Keyless operation system*
If the driver’s or front passenger’s door lock/ NOTE NOTE
unlock switch is pressed and any of the doors
or tailgate is not opened within approximate- l For vehicles equipped with the mirror retrac- l The time between unlocking and automatic
tor switch, the outside rear-view mirrors au- locking can be adjusted. Consult a
ly 30 seconds, relocking will automatically
3 occur. Also refer to “Locking and unlocking:
tomatically extend when all the doors and
tailgate are unlocked using the keyless oper-
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point.
Doors, Central door locks, tailgate” on pages ation function.
3-25, 3-26 and 3-30. Refer to “Starting and driving: Outside rear- Operation confirmation when locking and
view mirrors” on page 6-10.
unlocking
Driver’s and front passenger’s door lock/unlock switches l Except for vehicles equipped with a Dead
Lock System, the keyless operation function Operation can be confirmed as shown below.
can be set so that only the driver’s door un- However, the room lamp will only illuminate
locks when the driver’s door lock/unlock if the front room lamp switch is in the
switch is pressed. “DOOR” position or the rear room lamp
If the keyless operation function is set to
switch (except for vehicles equipped with the
work as described above, all the doors and
the tailgate unlock when the driver’s door sunshade) is in the middle (•) position.
lock/unlock switch is pressed two times in
succession. When lock- The turn-signal lamps will
Refer to “Setting of door and tailgate unlock ing: blink once.
function” on page 3-24. When un- The room lamp illuminates
Tailgate OPEN switch l The keyless operation function does not op-
locking: for approximately 15 sec-
erate under the following conditions:
onds, the turn-signal lamps
• The keyless operation key is inside the
vehicle. blink twice.
• A door or the tailgate is open or ajar.
• The operation mode is not in OFF. NOTE
l The doors and the tailgate cannot be un-
locked by using the tailgate OPEN switch l Functions can be modified as stated below.
for about 3 seconds after locking. For further information, please contact your
l The time within which locking confirmation MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
is possible can be adjusted. For further infor- ice Point.
mation, please contact your MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.

3-12 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Keyless operation system*

NOTE All of the keys provided with your new vehi- Also refer to “Starting and driving: Starting
cle have been programmed into the vehicle’s the engine” on pages 6-14 and 6-15.
• Set the confirmation function (blinking of electronics. Refer to “Engine switch” on page
the turn-signal lamps) to operate only
3-13.
when the vehicle is locked or only when
the vehicle is unlocked.
3
• Disable the operation confirmation func- NOTE
tion (blinking of the turn-signal lamps).
• Change the number of blinks for the oper- l If you lose one of the keyless operation
ation confirmation function (blinks of the keys, contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
turn-signal lamps). Authorized Service Point as soon as possi-
ble.
To obtain a replacement or extra spare key,
Operation of the Dead Lock take your vehicle and all remaining keys to
System your MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
Service Point. All the keys have to be re-reg-
With a vehicle that has a Dead Lock System,
it is possible to set the Dead Lock System us-
istered in the immobilizer computer unit. CAUTION
The immobilizer can register up to 4 differ-
ing the driver’s or front passenger’s door ent keys. l The indication lamp (A) will flash orange
lock/unlock switch, or the tailgate LOCK when there is a problem or malfunction in
switch. the keyless operation system. Never drive if
(Refer to “Dead Lock System” on page Engine switch the indication lamp on the engine switch is
flashing orange. Immediately contact a
3-27.) E00306500753
In order to prevent theft, the engine will not MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
Electronic immobilizer (Anti- start unless a preregistered keyless operation ice Point.
l If the engine switch operation is not smooth
theft starting system) key is used. (Engine immobilizer function)
and feels like it is sticking, do not operate
E00306400387
If you are carrying the keyless operation key, the switch. Immediately contact a
The electronic immobilizer has been de- you can start the engine. MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
signed to significantly reduce the possibility ice Point.
of vehicle theft. The purpose of the system is
to immobilize the vehicle if an invalid start is
attempted. A valid start attempt can only be
achieved (subject to certain conditions) using
a keyless operation system “registered” to the
immobilizer system.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-13


Keyless operation system*

NOTE NOTE CAUTION


l When operating the engine switch, press the l Your vehicle is equipped with an electronic l When the engine is not running, put the op-
switch all the way in. If the switch is not immobilizer. To start the engine, the ID code eration mode in OFF. Leaving the operation
3 fully pressed, the engine may not start or the
operation mode may not change. If the en-
transmitted by the transponder inside the key
must match the code registered in the immo-
mode in ON or ACC for a long time when
the engine is not running may cause the bat-
gine switch is pressed correctly, there is no bilizer computer. tery to be discharged, making it impossible
need to hold the engine switch down. (Refer to “Electronic immobilizer (Anti-theft to start the engine, lock and unlock the steer-
starting system)” on page 3-13.) ing wheel.
Operation mode of the engine l When the battery is disconnected, the cur-
rent operation mode is memorized. After re-
switch and its function Changing the operation mode connecting the battery, the memorized mode
E00312200133 is selected automatically. Before disconnect-
OFF If you press the engine switch without de- ing the battery for repair or replacement,
pressing the brake pedal (A/T or CVT) or the make sure to put the operation mode in OFF.
The indication lamp on the engine switch Be careful if you are not sure which opera-
clutch pedal (M/T), you can change the oper-
turns off. The operation mode cannot be put tion mode the vehicle is in when the battery
ation mode in the order of OFF, ACC, ON,
in OFF when the selector lever is in any posi- is run down.
OFF.
tion other than the “P” (PARK) position (A/T l The operation mode cannot be changed from
or CVT). OFF to ACC or ON if the keyless operation
key is not detected to be in the vehicle. Refer
ACC to “Keyless operation system: Operating
range for starting the engine and changing
The audio system and other electric devices the operation mode” on page 3-10.
can be operated.
The indication lamp on the engine switch il-
luminates orange. ACC power auto-cutout func-
tion
ON E00312300088

All electric devices can be operated. After approximately 30 minutes has elapsed
The indication lamp on the engine switch il- with the operation mode in ACC, the func-
luminates green. tion automatically cuts out the power for the
The indication lamp turns off when the en- audio system and other electric devices that
gine is running. can be operated with that mode.

3-14 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Keyless operation system*
When the engine switch is pressed while the The battery in the keyless opera- Refer to “Key lock-in preven-
operation mode is in ACC, the power is sup- tion system key has worn out. tion system” on page 3-16.
plied again to those devices.
Put the operation mode in OFF Refer to “Door ajar prevention
NOTE and then start the engine again. system” on page 3-16. 3
If the warning is not cancelled,
l It is possible to modify functions as follows: there is a fault in the electronic
• The time until the power cuts out can be Refer to “Operation mode OFF
changed to approximately 60 minutes. immobilizer (Anti-theft starting reminder system” on page
• The ACC power auto-cutout function can system). 3-16.
be deactivated. Please contact a MITSUBISHI
For details, consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Keyless operation key take-out
MOTORS Authorized Service Point. Point. monitoring system
E00308000420
In the following cases, a warning is activated,
Warning activation but it can be cancelled if the correct actions
E00305900486 are followed.
In order to prevent vehicle theft or the acci- l The ID codes for the keyless operation
dental operation of the keyless operation sys- key and vehicle do not match.
tem, the buzzer and the display on the infor-
mation screen in the multi-information dis-
You could be carrying another
play are used to alert the driver. When the vehicle is parked with the opera-
keyless operation key with a dif-
If a warning is activated, always check the tion mode in any mode other than OFF, if
ferent code, or the keyless oper-
vehicle and the keyless operation key. The you close the door after opening any of the
ation key could be outside the
warning is also displayed if there is a fault in doors and taking the keyless operation key
operating range.
the keyless operation system. out of the vehicle, a warning displays and the
If any of the following warnings are activa- Refer to “Keyless operation key buzzer sounds 4 times.
ted, please contact a MITSUBISHI take-out monitoring system” on
MOTORS Authorized Service Point. page 3-15.

There is a fault in the keyless l Even though you press the driver’s or
operation system. front passenger’s door lock/unlock
switch, or the tailgate LOCK switch, the
doors and tailgate are not locked.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-15


Keyless operation system*

NOTE When the operation mode is in OFF, if you When the operation mode is in OFF, if you
close all the doors and the tailgate with the try to lock the doors and tailgate by pressing
l If you take the keyless operation key out of keyless operation key left in the vehicle and the driver’s or front passenger’s door lock/
the vehicle through a window without open-
you try to lock the doors and tailgate by unlock switch, or the tailgate LOCK switch
3 ing a door, the keyless operation key take-
out monitoring system does not operate. pressing the driver’s or front passenger’s with one of the doors or the tailgate not com-
l It is possible to change the setting to make door lock/unlock switch, or the tailgate pletely closed, a warning is issued with the
the keyless operation key take-out monitor- LOCK switch, a warning is issued with the warning display and the buzzer buzzing for
ing system operate if you take the keyless warning display and the buzzer buzzing for approximately 3 seconds and you cannot lock
operation key out from the vehicle through a approximately 3 seconds and you cannot lock the doors and tailgate.
window without opening a door. For further the doors and tailgate.
information, please contact your Operation mode OFF reminder
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point. NOTE system
l Even if you have the keyless operation key E00308300348

within the engine start operating range, if the l Make sure you have the keyless operation
key with you before locking the doors. Even
keyless operation key and vehicle ID codes
if you leave the keyless operation key inside
cannot be matched, for example due to the
the vehicle, it is possible that the doors will
ambient environment or electromagnetic
lock depending on the surrounding environ-
conditions, the warning may be activated.
ment and wireless signal conditions.

Key lock-in prevention system Door ajar prevention system When the operation mode is in any mode oth-
E00308100391
E00308200347
er than OFF, if you close all the doors and the
tailgate then try to lock the doors and tailgate
by pressing the driver’s or front passenger’s
door lock/unlock switch, or the tailgate
LOCK switch, a warning is issued with the
warning display and the buzzer buzzing for
approximately 3 seconds and you cannot lock
the doors and tailgate.

3-16 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Keyless operation system*

Steering wheel lock NOTE l The starter motor will be turning for up
E00306801261
to approximately 15 seconds if the en-
• Open or close one of the doors (except the gine switch is released at once. Pressing
tailgate).
To lock the engine switch again while the starter
Press the engine switch to put the operation
• Lock all doors and the tailgate with the
keyless entry system or the keyless opera- motor is still turning will stop the starter 3
tion function. motor. The starter motor will be turning
mode in OFF. Open one of the doors.
l When the steering wheel does not unlock, for up to approximately 30 seconds
the warning will be displayed on the infor- while the engine switch is pressed.
To unlock mation screen in the multi-information dis- If the engine does not start, wait for a
The following methods can be used to unlock play. Press the engine switch again while while and then attempt to start the en-
the steering wheel. moving the steering wheel slightly.
gine again. Trying repeatedly with the
l Put the operation mode in ACC. starter motor still running will damage
l Start the engine. the starter mechanism.

CAUTION WARNING
l If the engine is stopped while driving, do not l Never run the engine in a closed or poorly
open a door or press the UNLOCK switch ventilated area any longer than is needed
on the remote control switch until the vehi- to move your vehicle in or out of the area.
cle stops in a safe place. This could cause
Starting and stopping the en- Carbon monoxide gases are odourless and
the steering wheel to lock, making it impos- gine can be fatal.
sible to operate the vehicle. E00306901523
l Carry the key with you when leaving the ve-
hicle. Tips for starting CAUTION
If your vehicle needs to be towed, put the
operation mode in ACC to unlock the steer- l The operation mode can be in any mode l Never attempt to start the engine by pushing
or pulling the vehicle.
ing wheel. to start the engine.
l Do not run the engine at high rpm or drive
the vehicle at high speed until the engine has
had a chance to warm up.
NOTE
l When the following operation is performed
with the operation mode in OFF, the steering
wheel is locked.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-17


Keyless operation system*

Starting the engine (petrol-pow- On vehicles equipped with CVT, make NOTE
sure the selector lever is in the “P”
ered vehicles) (PARK) position. l Minor noises may be heard on engine start-
E00307002049 up. These will disappear as the engine
The starting procedure is as follows:
3 1. Fasten the seat belt. Vehicles with M/T Vehicles with CVT
warms up.

2. Make sure the parking brake is applied. When it is difficult to start the engine
3. Press and hold the brake pedal down
After several attempts, you may experience
firmly with your right foot.
that the engine still does not start.
1. Make sure that all electric devices, such
NOTE as lamps, air conditioning blower and
rear window demister, are turned off.
l After the engine has not started for a while,
the brake pedal effort needed to start the en- 2. While depressing the brake pedal (CVT)
gine may become greater. or the clutch pedal (M/T), press the ac-
If this occurs, depress the brake pedal more celerator pedal halfway and hold it there,
firmly than usual.
NOTE then crank the engine. Release the accel-
erator pedal, immediately after the en-
4. Fully depress the clutch pedal (M/T). l The engine can only be started when the se- gine starts.
lector lever is in the “P” (PARK) or “N”
5. On vehicles equipped with M/T, place (NEUTRAL) position (CVT).
the gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) For safety reasons, the engine should be star-
position. ted when the selector lever is in the “P”
(PARK) position in which the driving
wheels lock.

6. Press the engine switch.


7. Make sure that all warning lamps are
functioning properly.

3-18 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Keyless operation system*
3. If the engine still will not start, the en- NOTE NOTE
gine could be flooded with too much
petrol. While depressing the brake pedal l After the engine has not started for a while, l If the engine is cold, the diesel preheat indi-
the brake pedal effort needed to start the en- cation lamp is on for a longer time.
(CVT) or the clutch pedal (M/T), push
the accelerator pedal all the way down
gine may become greater.
If this occurs, depress the brake pedal more
l Putting the operation mode in ON will also
start preheating the engine. When the engine
3
and hold it there, then press the engine firmly than usual. has not been started within about 5 seconds
switch to crank the engine. If the engine after the diesel preheat indication lamp went
does not start after 5 to 6 seconds, push out, put the operation mode in OFF. Then,
4. Fully depress and hold the clutch pedal attempt the engine start procedure to preheat
the engine switch to stop cranking the
(M/T). the engine again.
engine, and release the accelerator pedal.
5. On vehicles equipped with M/T, place l Minor noises may be heard on engine start-
Put the operation mode in OFF. Wait a
the gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) up. These will disappear as the engine
few seconds, and then press the engine warms up.
position.
switch to crank the engine again while
On vehicles equipped with A/T, make
depressing the brake pedal (CVT) or the
sure the selector lever is in the “P” Stopping the engine
clutch pedal (M/T), but do not push the
(PARK) position.
accelerator pedal. If the engine fails to E00312601118

start, repeat these procedures. If the en-


gine still will not start, we recommend Vehicles with M/T Vehicles with A/T
WARNING
you to have the vehicle checked.
l Do not operate the engine switch while
driving except in an emergency. If the en-
Starting the engine (diesel-pow- gine is stopped while driving, the brake
servomechanism will cease to function
ered vehicles) and braking efficiency will deteriorate.
E00308601120
Also, the power steering system will not
1. Fasten the seat belt. function and it will require greater man-
2. Make sure the parking brake is applied. ual effort to operate the steering. This
3. Press and hold the brake pedal down could result in a serious accident.
firmly with your right foot.
6. Press the engine switch.
The diesel preheat indication lamp will
first illuminate, and then after a short
time go out, indicating that preheating is
completed. The engine will start.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-19


Keyless operation system*

NOTE NOTE Remove the keyless operation key from the


key slot after starting the engine or changing
l If you have to bring the engine to an emer- l For diesel-powered vehicles, if the tempera- the operation mode.
gency stop while driving, press and hold the ture inside the engine compartment is high,
3 engine switch for 3 seconds or more, or
press it quickly 3 times or more. The engine
the cooling fans (A) will continue to operate
for some time even if the engine is stopped.
will stop and the operation mode will go to Therefore, the operation sound of the cool-
ACC. ing fans may be heard even after the engine
l Do not stop the engine with the selector lev- is stopped. This sound is normal and does
er in any position other than the “P” (PARK) not indicate a malfunction.
position (A/T or CVT). If the engine is stop- After operating for a period of time, the
ped with the selector lever in any position cooling fans will stop automatically.
other than the “P” (PARK) position, the op-
eration mode will go to ACC rather than
OFF.
Put the operation mode in OFF after placing
the selector lever in the “P” (PARK) posi-
tion. NOTE
l Do not insert into the key slot anything other
1. Stop the vehicle. than the keyless operation key. This could
2. Fully engage the parking brake while de- cause damage or a malfunction.
pressing the brake pedal. l Remove the object or additional key from
3. On vehicles with M/T, press the engine the the keyless operation key before insert-
switch to stop the engine, move the gear- ing the key into the key slot. The vehicle
may not be able to receive the registered ID
shift lever to the 1st (on an uphill) or “R” *: Front of the vehicle code from the registered key. Therefore, the
(Reverse) (on a downhill) position. engine may not start and the operation mode
On vehicles with A/T or CVT, move the may not change.
selector lever to the “P” (PARK) posi-
If the keyless operation key is
l The keyless operation key is fixed in the key
tion, press the engine switch to stop the not operating properly slot when inserted in the illustrated direc-
engine. E00312501162 tion. Simply pull out the key to remove it
Insert the keyless operation key into the key from the key slot.
slot in the glove box. Starting the engine and
changing the operation mode should now be
possible.

3-20 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Keyless operation system*
Keyless operation key reminder To operate without using the NOTE
keyless operation function l After using the emergency key, always re-
E00306000123 turn it into the keyless operation key.
Emergency key 3
E00307200278
Locking and unlocking the driver’s door
The emergency key is built into the keyless
operation key. If the keyless operation func- Turning the emergency key in the forward di-
If the operation mode is in OFF and the driv- tion cannot be used, for example because the rection locks the door, and turning it in the
er’s door is opened with the keyless operation keyless operation key battery has worn out or rear direction unlocks the door. Also refer to
key in the key slot, a warning is issued with the vehicle battery is flat, you can lock and “Locking and unlocking: Doors” on page
the warning display and the buzzer buzzing unlock the driver’s door with the emergency 3-25.
for approximately 3 seconds to remind you to key. To use the emergency key (A), unlock
remove the key. the lock knob (B) and remove it from the
keyless operation key (C).

1- Lock
2- Unlock

NOTE
l Only use the emergency key for emergen-
cies. If the keyless operation key battery
wears out, replace it as quickly as possible
so that you can use the keyless operation
key.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-21


Keyless operation system*

Keyless entry system NOTE NOTE


E00307700967
Press the remote control switch, and all doors l With a vehicle that has a Dead Lock System, l Except for vehicles equipped with a Dead
pressing the LOCK switch (1) two times in Lock System, the door and tailgate unlock
and the tailgate will be locked or unlocked as
3 desired. It is also possible to operate the out-
succession causes the Dead Lock System to
be set. (Refer to “Setting the system” on
function can be set so that only the driver’s
door unlocks when the UNLOCK switch (2)
side rear-view mirrors (Vehicles equipped page 3-27.) is pressed once.
with the mirror retractor switch). If the door and tailgate unlock function is set
To unlock to work as described above, all the doors and
the tailgate unlock when the UNLOCK
Press the UNLOCK switch (2). All the doors switch is pressed two times in succession.
and the tailgate will be unlocked. If the front Refer to “Setting of door and tailgate unlock
room lamp switch is in the “DOOR” position function” on page 3-24.
or the rear room lamp switch (except for ve- l The indication lamp (3) comes on each time
a switch is pressed.
hicles equipped with the sunshade) is in the
l If the UNLOCK switch (2) is pressed and no
middle (•) position at this time, the room door or tailgate is opened within approxi-
lamp will come on for approximately 15 sec- mately 30 seconds, relocking will automati-
onds and the turn-signal lamps will blink cally occur.
twice.
1- LOCK ( ) switch Depending on the vehicle model, the position
2- UNLOCK ( ) switch and tail lamps can also be set to turn on for
3- Indication lamp approximately 30 seconds.
Refer to “Instruments and controls: Welcome
To lock light” on page 5-52.
Press the LOCK switch (1). All the doors and
the tailgate will be locked. The turn-signal NOTE
lamps will blink once when the doors and the
l The remote control switch does not operate
tailgate are locked. when one of the doors or the tailgate is open
or ajar. (Only the unlock function operates.)

3-22 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Keyless operation system*

NOTE Operation of the outside rear- NOTE


l It is possible to modify functions as follows: view mirrors (Vehicles equip- l The outside rear-view mirrors cannot be fol-
For further information, please contact your ped with mirror retractor ded or extended using the remote control
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point. switch)
switch when one of the doors or the tailgate
is open or ajar.
3
• The time from pressing the UNLOCK E00311200325 l For vehicles equipped with the mirror retrac-
switch (2) to the moment of automatic tor switch, the outside rear-view mirrors au-
locking can be changed. To fold tomatically retract or extend when all the
• The confirmation function (flashing of the Within 30 seconds of locking the doors and doors and tailgate are locked or unlocked us-
turn-signal lamps) can be set to operate ing the remote control switches of the key-
only when the doors and backdoor are
tailgate using the LOCK switch (1), press the less entry system.
locked or only when the doors and back- LOCK switch twice rapidly to fold the out- Refer to “Starting and driving: Outside rear-
door are unlocked. side rear-view mirrors. view mirrors” on page 6-10.
• The confirmation function (this indicates l The remote control switch will operate with-
locking or unlocking of the doors and tail- To extend in approximately 4 m from the vehicle.
gate with the flash of the turn-signal Within 30 seconds of unlocking the doors However, the operating range of the remote
lamps) can be deactivated. control switch may change if the vehicle is
and tailgate using the UNLOCK switch (2),
• The number of times the turn-signal located near a power station, or radio/TV
lamps are flashed by the confirmation press the UNLOCK switch twice rapidly to broadcasting station.
function can be changed. return the outside rear-view mirrors to their l If either of the following problems occurs,
extended positions. the battery may be exhausted.
Operation of the Dead Lock • The remote control switch is operated at
The outside rear-view mirrors are not ini- the correct distance from the vehicle, but
System tially set to work as described above. If you the doors and tailgate are not locked/
In a vehicle that has a Dead Lock System, it want them to work as described above, you unlocked in response.
is possible to set the Dead Lock System using need to set them so that they do not retract/ • The indication lamp (3) is dim or does not
come on.
the remote controller. extend when the doors and tailgate are
(Refer to “Dead Lock System” on page locked/unlocked using the keyless entry sys- For further information, please contact
3-27.) tem or keyless operation system. your MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
Refer to “Starting and driving: Outside rear- Service Point.
view mirrors” on page 6-10. If you replace the battery yourself, refer to
For details, please consult a MITSUBISHI “Procedure for replacing the remote con-
MOTORS Authorized Service Point. trol switch battery” on page 3-24.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-23


Keyless operation system*

NOTE 2. Place the combination headlamps and NOTE


dipper switch in the “OFF” position, and
l If your remote control switch is lost or dam- leave the driver’s door open. l You may purchase a replacement battery at
aged, please contact your MITSUBISHI an electric appliance store.
3. Press and hold the LOCK switch (1) for
3 MOTORS Authorized Service Point for a re-
placement remote control switch. 4 to 10 seconds and then also press the lA MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
Service Point can replace the battery for you
l If you wish to add a remote control switch, UNLOCK switch (2) during this time. if you prefer.
please contact your MITSUBISHI 4. Release in sequence the LOCK and UN-
MOTORS Authorized Service Point. A max- LOCK switches within 10 seconds of
imum of 4 remote control switches are avail- 2. With the MITSUBISHI mark facing
pressing the LOCK switch in step 3.
able for your vehicle. you, insert the cloth covered tip of a
straight blade (or minus) screwdriver in-
Procedure for replacing the re- to the notch in the remote control switch
Setting of door and tailgate un- mote control switch battery case and use it to open the case.
lock function (Except for vehi- E00309601114
1. Before replacing the battery, remove
cles equipped with a Dead Lock static electricity from your body by
System) touching a metal part such as doorknob
E00310400304
of the room.
The door and tailgate unlock function can be
set to the following two conditions.
Each time the door and tailgate unlock func- WARNING
tion is set, a chime will sound to tell you the l Danger of explosion if battery is incor-
condition of the door and tailgate unlock rectly replaced.
function. Replace only with the same battery or an
equivalent type.
Number of
chimes
Condition NOTE
CAUTION
All doors and the tailgate un- l Be sure to perform the procedure with the
One chime l When the remote control switch case is MITSUBISHI mark facing you. If the
lock MITSUBISHI mark is not facing you when
opened, be careful to keep water, dust, etc.
Two chimes Driver’s door unlock only out. Also, do not touch the internal compo- you open the remote control switch case, the
nents. transmitter may come out.
1. Put the operation mode in OFF.
3. Remove the old battery.
3-24 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5
Doors
4. Install a new battery with the + side (A) NOTE NOTE
up.
l To prevent the key from being locked inside l If the vehicle is equipped with the keyless
the vehicle, neither the lock knob on the operation system, the driver’s door can be
+ side
driver’s door nor the key can be used to lock
the driver’s door when it is open.
locked or unlocked with the emergency key.
Refer to “Emergency key” on page 3-21.
3

- side To lock or unlock with the key To lock or unlock from inside
the vehicle
Coin type battery
CR2032

5. Close the case firmly.


6. Check the keyless operation function to
see that it works.

Doors 1- Lock
E00300402060
2- Unlock 1- Lock
2- Unlock
CAUTION NOTE
l Make sure the doors are closed: driving with Pull the inside door handle towards you to
doors not completely closed is dangerous. l When locking or unlocking with the key, on- open the door.
ly the driver’s door will be locked or un-
l Never leave children in the vehicle unatten- locked.
ded.
l Be careful not to lock the doors while the
To lock or unlock all doors and the tailgate, NOTE
use the central door lock switch, the keyless
key is inside the vehicle. entry system or the keyless operation func- l The driver’s door can be opened without us-
tion. ing the lock knob by pulling on the inside
Refer to “Central door locks” on pages door handle.
3-26, “Keyless entry system” on pages 3-04,
3-22, and “To operate using the keyless op-
eration function” on page 3-11.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-25


Central door locks

NOTE Operation mode ON reminder NOTE


l In a vehicle that has a Dead Lock System, it
system* l Repeated continuous operation between lock
is not possible to unlock the door by pushing E00310100268 and unlock could activate the central door
For vehicles equipped with the keyless op-
3 the lock knob to the unlock side while the
Dead Lock System is set. eration system
locking systems built-in protection circuit
and prevent the system from operating.
(Refer to “Dead Lock System” on page If this occurs, wait approximately 1 minute
3-27.) before operating the central door lock
switch.
To lock without using the key l When the driver’s door is open, the central
door lock switch cannot be used to lock it.

Front passenger’s door, Rear To lock and unlock the doors


If the driver’s door is opened with the engine
door and tailgate
stopped and the operation mode in any posi-
tion other than OFF, the operation mode ON
reminder buzzer sounds intermittently to re- Using the central door lock
mind you to put the operation mode in OFF. switch
In addition, the warning display will be dis-
played on the information screen in the multi- Using the central door lock switch on the
information display. driver’s door locks or unlocks all doors and
the tailgate.
Central door locks
LHD
E00300801777

Set the inside lock knob (1) to the locked po-


NOTE
sition, and close the door (2). l Each of the doors can be locked or unlocked
independently by using the inside lock knob.
l When locking or unlocking with the key on
NOTE the driver’s door, only the driver’s door will
lock or unlock.
l The driver’s door cannot be locked using the
inside lock knob while the driver’s door is
opened.

3-26 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Dead Lock System*
RHD Using the ignition switch or the Dead Lock System*
engine switch E00305100130

All doors and the tailgate will unlock when- The Dead Lock System helps to prevent
ever the ignition switch is turned to the
“LOCK” position or the operation mode is
theft. When the keyless entry system or the 3
keyless operation system has been used to
put in OFF. lock all of the doors and the tailgate, the
Dead Lock System makes it impossible to
Using the selector lever position unlock the doors using the inside lock knobs.
(A/T or CVT)
1- Lock All doors and the tailgate will unlock when-
2- Unlock CAUTION
ever the selector lever is moved to the “P”
(PARK) position with the ignition switch in l Do not set the Dead Lock System when
To unlock the doors and tail- the “ON” position or the operation mode in someone is inside the vehicle. With the Dead
Lock System set, it is not possible to unlock
gate ON. the doors using the inside lock knobs. If you
E00311300313 erroneously set the Dead Lock System, un-
lock the doors using the UNLOCK switch
You can select the functions to unlock the on the remote control switch or using the
doors and tailgate either using the ignition keyless operation function.
switch or the engine switch, or using the se-
lector lever position A/T or CVT).
These functions are not activated when the
Setting the system
E00305201255
vehicle is shipped from the factory. To acti- 1. Except for vehicles equipped with the
vate or deactivate these functions, please keyless operation system, remove the
contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author- key from the ignition switch.
ized Service Point. For vehicles equipped with the keyless
operation system, put the operation
mode in OFF.
2. Get out of the vehicle. Close all of the
doors and the tailgate.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-27


Dead Lock System*
3. Press the LOCK switch (A) on the re- Driver’s and front passenger’s door lock/unlock Cancelling the system
mote control switch, the driver’s or front switches* E00305301302
passenger’s door lock/unlock switch (B), When the following operation is performed,
or the tailgate LOCK switch (C) to lock the doors and tailgate will unlock and the
3 all of the doors and the tailgate. The Dead Lock System will be simultaneously
turn-signal lamps will blink once. cancelled.
4. Press the switch again within 2 seconds. l The UNLOCK switch (D) on the remote
The turn-signal lamps will blink three control switch is pressed.
times to show that the Dead Lock Sys- l The driver’s or front passenger’s door
tem has been set. lock/unlock switch (E) is pressed while
you are carrying the keyless operation
Except for vehicles equipped with the keyless operation Tailgate LOCK switch* key.
system
l The tailgate OPEN switch (F) is pressed.

Except for vehicles equipped with the keyless


operation system

Vehicles equipped with the keyless operation system


NOTE
l Pressing the LOCK switch (A) on the re-
mote control switch once while the Dead
Lock System is set causes the turn-signal
lamps to blink three times, so it is possible to
confirm that the Dead Lock System is set.

3-28 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Dead Lock System*
Vehicles equipped with the keyless operation system NOTE NOTE
l If neither a door nor the tailgate is opened l It is possible to lock the doors and tailgate
within 30 seconds of unlocking (except us- and set the Dead Lock System at the same
ing the tailgate OPEN switch), the doors and
tailgate are automatically relocked and the
time with a single push of the LOCK switch
(A) on the remote control switch, the driv-
3
Dead Lock System is simultaneously set er’s or front passenger’s door lock/unlock
again. switch (B), or the tailgate LOCK switch (C).
l Even when it is not possible to use the key- For details, please contact a MITSUBISHI
less entry system or keyless operation func- MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
tion to unlock the doors, it is possible to use
the key to unlock the driver’s door. When
the key is used to unlock the driver’s door, Testing the system
Driver’s and front passenger’s door lock/unlock
the Dead Lock System is cancelled for only E00305400104
switches* the driver’s door. If you wish to subsequent- Open all of the door windows, then set the
ly unlock all other doors, perform the fol- Dead Lock System. (Refer to “Setting the
lowing operation. system” on page 3-27.)
• Except for vehicles equipped with the After setting the Dead Lock System, reach
keyless operation system, turn the ignition
switch to the “ON” or “ACC” position. into the vehicle through a window and con-
• For vehicles equipped with the keyless firm that you cannot unlock the doors using
operation system, put the operation mode the lock knobs.
in ON or ACC.
l It is possible to adjust the time between
NOTE
pressing the UNLOCK switch (D) on the re-
Tailgate OPEN switch mote control switch or the driver’s or front l If you need advice on how to set the Dead
passenger’s door lock/unlock switch (E) and Lock System, please contact a MITSUBISHI
automatic locking. For details, please con- MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
tact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
Service Point.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-29


“Child-protection” rear doors

“Child-protection” rear CAUTION WARNING


doors l When driving with a child in the rear seat, l When there is a build up of snow or ice, it
please use the child protection to prevent ac- should be removed before opening the
E00300900999

3 cidental door opening which may cause an


accident.
tailgate. If you open the tailgate without
removing it, there is a possibility that the
tailgate may close suddenly due to the
weight of that snow or ice.
Tailgate l When you open the tailgate make sure
E00301402461
that the tailgate is opened fully and re-
mains fully open. If you only open the tail-
WARNING gate halfway there is a risk that the tail-
gate may drop and slam shut. If you open
l The luggage compartment was not de- the tailgate while your vehicle is parked
signed for people to ride in it. Do not let on an incline it is more difficult to do so
passengers ride in or let children play in than on the flat and also it may drop and
1- Lock the luggage compartment. Riding or play- slam shut.
2- Unlock ing in the luggage compartment could re-
sult in a serious accident.
Child protection helps prevent the rear doors l It is dangerous to drive with the tailgate CAUTION
open, since carbon monoxide (CO) gas
from being opened accidentally from the in- contained in engine exhaust gases can en- l Do not stand behind the exhaust pipe when
side. ter the cabin. loading and unloading luggage. The heat
If the lever is set to the locked position, the You cannot see or smell CO. It can cause from the exhaust could lead to burns.
rear door cannot be opened using the inside unconsciousness and even death. l To avoid damage to the tailgate, make sure
In addition, if the tailgate opens when the area above and behind the tailgate is
handle, but only with the outside handle. clear before opening it.
driving, luggage could fall onto the road
If the lever is set to the “Unlock” position,
and cause an accident.
the child protection mechanism does not
l When opening and closing the tailgate,
NOTE
function. make sure that there are no people near-
by and that there is sufficient space be- l Locking/unlocking with the central door
hind and above the vehicle. In addition, lock switch, the keyless entry system, or the
be careful not to hit your head or pinch keyless operation function also locks/
your hands, neck, etc. unlocks the tailgate.

3-30 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Inside tailgate release

To open To close NOTE


After unlocking, press the tailgate OPEN Pull the tailgate grip (A) downward as illus-
switch (A) and lift the tailgate. trated. Gently push the upper gate from the
outside with enough force so that it is com- 3
pletely closed. Always ensure the tailgate is
securely closed.

To prevent damage or faulty operation.


• Do not hold the gas struts when closing
the tailgate.
• Also, do not push or pull the gas struts.
• Do not attach any plastic material, tape,
etc., to the gas struts.
• Do not tie string, etc., around the gas
NOTE struts.
• Do not hang any object on the gas struts.
l If you do not open the tailgate immediately
after pressing the tailgate OPEN switch, the CAUTION
tailgate can not be lifted. If this happens,
press the tailgate OPEN switch again and lift l Do not close the tailgate completely by hold- Inside tailgate release
ing the tailgate grip (A). Your hand or arm
the tailgate. E00303401354
could be pinched and personal injury could
l The tailgate cannot be opened when the bat-
result. The inside tailgate release is designed to pro-
tery is flat or disconnected.
vide a way to open the tailgate in the case of
a discharged battery.
NOTE
l Gas struts (B) are installed to support the
tailgate.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-31


Security alarm system*
The tailgate release lever (see illustration) is To open WARNING
mounted on the tailgate.
1. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screw- l Always keep the lid (A) on the tailgate
closed when driving so that your luggage
driver into the notch of the lid (A) and
3 pry gently to open the lid.
cannot accidentally bump the lever (B)
and open the tailgate.

Security alarm system*


E00301500891

The security alarm system is for alerting the


surrounding area of suspicious behaviour to
prevent unlawful entry into the vehicle by op-
erating an alarm if a door, the tailgate or the
You and your family should familiarize your- bonnet is opened when the vehicle has not
selves with the location and operation of the been unlocked using the keyless entry system
tailgate release lever. or the keyless operation function.
2. Move the lever (B) to open the tailgate. Also, the alarm will be activated if any of the
following occur.
l Attempt an unlawful moving of the vehi-
cle. (the vehicle inclination detection
function)
l Detect a motion in the vehicle. (the inte-
rior intrusion detection function)
l Disconnect the battery terminal.

The security alarm system is set to “active”.


When making changes to the settings, please
follow the procedure listed in the section ti-
tled “Changing the security alarm settings”
3. Push out on the tailgate to open it. on page 3-34.

3-32 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Security alarm system*

CAUTION NOTE The security alarm has four


l Do not modify or add parts to the security • Parking in an automated car park modes:
alarm system. • Leaving someone or a pet in the vehicle
Doing so could cause the security alarm to
malfunction.
• Leaving a window open
System preparation mode (ap- 3
• Leaving an unstable object such as a stuf-
fed toy or accessory in the vehicle
prox. 20 seconds)
• Suffering a continuous impact or vibra- (The buzzer sounds intermittently and the se-
NOTE tion by hail, thunder, etc. curity indicator (A) blinks.)
l The alarm system will not be activated if the According to the situations, deactivate the
doors and the tailgate have been locked us- vehicle inclination detection function and
ing a key, the inside lock knob or the central the interior intrusion detection function.
door lock switch (instead of the keyless en- Refer to “To deactivate the vehicle inclina-
try system or the keyless operation func- tion detection function and the interior intru-
tion). sion detection function” on page 3-37.
l If the turn-signal lamps do not blink after the l The sensitivity of the interior intrusion de-
locking and unlocking operation using the tection function can be adjusted. For details,
keyless entry system or the keyless operation please contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
function, the security alarm system may be Authorized Service Point.
malfunctioning.
Have the vehicle inspected at a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point.
If the confirmation function (blinking of the The system preparation time extends from
turn-signal lamps by locking and unlocking the point at which all of the doors and the
the doors and the tailgate) is deactivated, the tailgate are locked by pressing the LOCK
turn-signal lamps do not blink after the lock- switch on the remote control switch or the
ing and unlocking operation. keyless operation function to the point at
For information on the confirmation func- which the system armed mode goes into ef-
tion, refer to “Keyless entry system” on pa-
fect.
ges 3-04, 3-22 and “To operate using the
keyless operation function” on page 3-11.
l The security alarm system could be activated
in the following situations.
• Using a car wash
• Taking the vehicle on a ferry

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-33


Security alarm system*
During this time, it is possible to temporarily NOTE Follow the procedure below.
open a door or the tailgate without using the 1. Except for vehicles equipped with the
keyless entry system or the keyless operation l The alarm will resume if unlawful actions keyless operation system, remove the
are taken again, even if the alarm has stop-
function and without causing the alarm to key from the ignition switch. For vehi-
3 sound (for example, when you forget some-
ped.
cles equipped with the keyless operation
thing inside the vehicle or realize that a win- system, put the operation mode in OFF.
dow is open).
System cancellation 2. Place the lamp switch in the “OFF” posi-
It is possible to cancel the system activation tion, and leave the driver’s door open.
System armed mode during the system preparation mode or the
(The security indicator continues to blink system armed mode.
with the indicator’s reduced lit-up duration In addition, it is possible to cancel the alarm
time.) once it has been activated.
Once the system preparation mode has ended, Refer to “Cancelling the system” on page
the system armed mode starts. 3-37, “Cancelling the alarm” on page 3-39.
If an unlawful opening of any of the doors,
tailgate or bonnet is detected during the sys- NOTE
tem armed mode, the alarm will be activated
to warn people around the vehicle of an ab- l When lending the vehicle to another person
or allowing the vehicle to be driven by
normal condition. someone who is unfamiliar with the security
Also, if unlawful moving of the vehicle is at- alarm system, be sure to give the person a
tempted or a vehicle intrusion is detected, the proper explanation of the security alarm sys-
alarm will be activated. tem.
If a person who is unfamiliar with the securi-
Alarm activation ty alarm system accidentally unlocked the
vehicle, causing the alarm to sound, the
The turn-signal lamps blink and the siren alarm would be a nuisance to people nearby.
sounds for approximately 30 seconds.
Refer to “Alarm activation” on page 3-38.
Changing the security alarm
settings
E00301600267
It is possible to set the security alarm to the
“active” mode or “inactive” mode.

3-34 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Security alarm system*
3. Pull the windscreen wiper and washer Except for vehicles equipped with the keyless Number of
switch towards you and hold it there. operation system
times the Security alarm settings
(Since the ignition switch is in the buzzer mode
“LOCK” position or the operation mode sounds
is in OFF, washer fluid will not be 3
sprayed.) 2 Alarm active

6. Any of the following operations can be


used to terminate the system settings
change mode.
• Releasing the windscreen wiper and
Vehicles with keyless operation system washer switch.
• Closing the driver’s door.
• Inserting the key into the ignition
switch (except for vehicles equip-
ped with the keyless operation sys-
tem).
• Putting the operation mode in ON
4. After approximately 10 seconds, the or ACC. (vehicles equipped with
buzzer will make a sound. Keep the the keyless operation system)
windscreen wiper and washer switch • Placing the lamp switch in any posi-
pulled towards you. (If the windscreen tion other than “OFF”.
wiper and washer switch was released, The settings mode can be toggled by
pressing the UNLOCK switch. The • Allowing 30 seconds to pass with-
the setting change mode would be can- out making any changes to the set-
celled. To start over, perform the proce- mode can be confirmed from the number
of times the buzzer sounds. tings.
dure again from step 3.)
5. When the buzzer stops, with the wind- Number of
screen wiper and washer switch still times the Security alarm settings
pulled towards you, press the UNLOCK buzzer mode
switch (A) on the remote control switch sounds
to select the security alarm settings
mode. 1 Alarm inactive

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-35


Security alarm system*

NOTE Except for vehicles with the keyless operation system Tailgate LOCK switch*

l If anything with regard to making changes to


the security alarm system settings is hard to
3 understand, please consult
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
your

ice Point.
l Avoid leaving valuable items inside the ve-
hicle even when the security alarm system
has been set to the “active” mode.

Setting the system Vehicles with the keyless operation system By locking the vehicle using the keyless
E00301700620 entry system or the keyless operation
Follow the procedure below to set the system function, the system preparation mode is
to the system armed mode. activated.
1. Except for vehicles equipped with the The buzzer makes an intermittent beep-
keyless operation system, remove the ing sound and the security indicator (D)
key from the ignition switch. For vehi- in the audio panel blinks for confirma-
cles equipped with the keyless operation tion.
system, put the operation mode in OFF.
2. Exit the vehicle and close all of the
doors, tailgate and bonnet.
3. Press the LOCK switch (A) on the re- Driver’s and front passenger’s door look/unlock switches*
mote control switch of the keyless entry
system or the keyless operation system,
the driver’s or front passenger’s door
lock/unlock switch (B), or the tailgate
LOCK switch (C) in order to lock all the
doors and the tailgate.

3-36 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Security alarm system*

NOTE NOTE The buzzer will sound twice and the function
will be activated.
l The system preparation mode is not activa- l Avoid leaving valuable items inside the ve-
ted when the doors and the tailgate have hicle even when the security alarm system
been locked using a method other than the
keyless entry system or the keyless operation
has been set to the “active” mode.
3
function (namely a key, the inside lock knob
or the central door lock switch). To deactivate the vehicle incli-
l If the bonnet is open, the security indicator nation detection function and
illuminates, and the system does not enter
the system preparation mode. the interior intrusion detection
When the bonnet is closed, the system enters function
the system preparation mode, and after ap-
E00312100116
proximately 20 seconds the system enters
The vehicle inclination detection function
the system armed mode.
and the interior intrusion detection function
can be deactivated when parking in automa- NOTE
4. After approximately 20 seconds, the ted car parks, when leaving pets in the vehi-
buzzer stops, and when the blinking of cle or when leaving the vehicle with the win- l The function will be activated again if the
the security indicator starts to slow following operation is performed.
dows slightly open.
down, the system armed mode goes into • If the doors and the tailgate are unlocked
1. Except for vehicles equipped with the using the keyless entry system or the key-
effect. keyless operation system, remove the less operation function.
The security indicator continues to blink key from the ignition switch. For vehi- • If the ignition switch is turned to the
during the system armed mode. cles equipped with the keyless operation “ON” or “ACC” position (except for vehi-
system, put the operation mode in OFF. cles equipped with the keyless operation
system).
NOTE 2. Raise and hold the wiper and washer
• If the operation mode is put in ON or
switch to the “MIST” position for ap-
l The security alarm system can be activated ACC (vehicles with the keyless operation
when people are riding inside the vehicle or proximately 3 seconds. The buzzer will system).
when the windows are open. To prevent ac- sound once and the function will be de-
cidental activation of the alarm, do not set activated.
the system to the system armed mode while Cancelling the system
people are riding in the vehicle. To activate the function again, raise and hold E00301802003

the wiper and washer switch to the “MIST” The following methods can be used to cancel
position for approximately 3 seconds. the system when it is in the system prepara-
tion mode or the system armed mode.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-37


Security alarm system*
l Pressing the UNLOCK switch on the re- NOTE NOTE
mote control switch.
l Turning the ignition switch to the “ON” l It is possible to register up to 8 remote con- l The time between pressing the UNLOCK
trol switches for the keyless entry system switch on the remote control switch, or the
position (except for vehicles equipped
3 with the keyless operation system).
and 4 remote control switches for the key-
less operation system.
driver’s or front passenger’s door lock/
unlock switch and automatic locking can be
l Putting the operation mode in ON (vehi- As long as they are registered, any of the re- adjusted. Please consult a MITSUBISHI
cles equipped with the keyless operation mote control switches, other than the one MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
system). used to activate the system, can be used to
l Opening any one of the doors or the tail- cancel the system.
gate, or inserting the key into the igni- If you want to register additional remote Alarm activation
control switches, please contact a
tion switch (except for vehicles equipped E00301900635
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv- When the system is in the system armed
with the keyless operation system) when ice Point. mode, the alarm will be activated as follows
the system is in the system preparation l The activation distance for the keyless entry if the vehicle is unlocked or if any of the
mode. system is approximately 4 m.
doors, tailgate or bonnet is opened using a
l Holding the keyless operation key and If it is not possible to lock or unlock the ve-
hicle by pressing the switch at the correct method other than the keyless entry system or
pressing the driver’s or front passenger’s
distance or the security alarm system cannot the keyless operation function.
door lock/unlock switch, or the tailgate
be set or cancelled using the switch, the bat- 1. The alarm will be activated for approxi-
OPEN switch to unlock the doors and
tery may need to be replaced. mately 30 seconds. The turn-signal
the tailgate (vehicles equipped with the For further information, please consult a lamps will blink, and the siren will
keyless operation system). MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv- sound intermittently.
ice Point.
NOTE If you replace the battery yourself, refer to
“Procedure for replacing the remote control
l If the bonnet is opened during the system switch battery” on pages 3-06, 3-24.
preparation mode, the system preparation l If the UNLOCK switch on the remote con-
condition is suspended. trol switch, or the driver’s or front passen-
The system returns to the system preparation ger’s door lock/unlock switch is pressed and
mode when the bonnet is closed. no door or the tailgate is opened within 30
l If the battery terminals are disconnected seconds, the doors and the tailgate will auto-
while the system is in the system preparation matically relock. In this case as well, the
mode, the memory will be erased. system preparation mode will go into effect.

3-38 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Electric window control
2. The alarm will resume if unlawful ac- l Pressing the LOCK or UNLOCK switch Electric window control
tions are taken again, even if the alarm on the remote control switch.
E00302200521
has stopped. (After pressing the LOCK switch, the
vehicle will lock if all the doors and the The electric windows can only be operated
NOTE tailgate are closed, after which the sys- with the ignition switch in the “ON” position 3
tem preparation mode will once again go or the operation mode in ON.
l During an alarm operation, the alarm is dis- into effect.)
played on the information screen in the mul-
ti-information display.
l Turning the ignition switch to the “ON” WARNING
Type 1
position (except for vehicles equipped
with the keyless operation system). l Before operating the electric window con-
trol, make sure that nothing can get trap-
l Putting the operation mode in ON (vehi- ped (head, hand, finger, etc.).
cles equipped with the keyless operation
l Never leave the vehicle without removing
system). the key.
l Holding the keyless operation key and l Never leave a child (or other person who
locking and unlocking the doors and the might not be capable of safe operation of
tailgate using the keyless operation func- the electric window control) in the vehicle
Type 2 alone.
tion (vehicles equipped with the keyless
operation system). l The child may tamper with the switch at
the risk of its hands or head being trap-
ped in the window.
NOTE
l When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position or the operation mode is put
in ON, the buzzer sounds 4 times. This oper-
ation indicates that the alarm was activated
Cancelling the alarm while the vehicle was parked.
E00302000428 Please check the inside of the vehicle to con-
It is possible to halt the activation of an alarm firm that nothing was stolen.
using the following methods: l Even if the battery is disconnected, the alarm
activation memory will not be erased.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-39


Electric window control

Electric window control switch Driver’s switches NOTE


E00302301558
The switches can be used to operate all door l Repeated operation with the engine stopped
Each door window opens or closes while the windows. A window can be opened or closed will run down the battery. Operate the elec-
corresponding switch is operated.
3 by operating the corresponding switch.
Press the switch down to open the window,
tric window switches only while the engine
is running.
Driver’s switch (LHD) and pull up the switch to close it. l The rear door windows only open halfway.
If the switch for the driver’s window is fully
pressed down/pulled up, the door window au- Lock switch
tomatically opens/closes completely. E00303101032
If you want to stop the window movement, When this switch is operated, the passenger’s
operate the switch lightly in the reverse direc- switches cannot be used to open or close the
tion. door windows and the driver’s switch cannot
open or close any door windows other than
Passenger’s switches the driver’s window.
The passenger’s switches can be used to op- To unlock, press it once again.
Driver’s switch (RHD) erate the corresponding passenger’s door
windows. Press the switch down for opening
the window, and pull up the switch for clos-
ing it.

1- Driver’s door window


2- Front passenger’s door window 1- Lock
3- Rear left door window 2- Unlock
4- Rear right door window
5- Lock switch

3-40 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Sunshade*

WARNING WARNING NOTE


l A child may tamper with the switch at the l If the battery terminals are disconnected l If the battery terminals are disconnected or
risk of its hands or head being trapped in or the fuse for electric window is replaced, the fuse for electric window is replaced, the
the window. When driving with a child in
the vehicle, please press the window lock
the safety mechanism will be cancelled.
If a hand or head got trapped, a serious
safety mechanism will be cancelled and the
door window will not automatically open/
3
switch to disable the passenger’s switches. injury could result. close completely.
If the window is open, repeatedly raise the
driver’s door window switch until the win-
Timer function CAUTION dow has been fully closed.
E00302400800 Following this, release the switch, raise the
The door windows can be opened or closed l The safety mechanism is cancelled just be-
switch once again and hold it in this condi-
fore the window is fully closed. This allows
for 30 seconds after the engine is stopped. tion for at least 1 second, then release it.
the window to close completely. Therefore
However, once the driver’s door or the front You should now be able to operate the driv-
be especially careful that no fingers are trap-
er’s door window in the normal fashion.
passenger’s door is opened, the windows can- ped in the window.
not be operated. l The safety mechanism is deactivated while
the switch is pulled up. Therefore be espe-
Safety mechanism (driver’s cially careful that fingers are not trapped in
Sunshade*
the door window opening.
door window only)
E00302800279

E00302501895 WARNING
If a hand or head is trapped in the closing NOTE l Never leave a child (or other person who
window, it will lower automatically. might not be capable of safe operation of
Nonetheless, make sure that nobody puts l The safety mechanism can be activated if the
driving conditions or other circumstances the sunshade switch) in the vehicle alone.
their head or hand out of the window when cause the driver’s door window to be subjec- l Before operating the sunshade, make sure
closing the driver’s door window. ted to a physical shock similar to that caused that nothing can be trapped (head, hand,
The lowered window will become operation- by a trapped hand or head. finger, etc.).
al after a few seconds. l Do not bring your head, hand, finger, etc.
near the opening edge of the sunshade re-
ceptacle while the vehicle is in motion.
It may cause injury to your head, hand,
finger, etc. in the event of sudden braking.

OGAE15E5 Locking and unlocking 3-41


Sunshade*

CAUTION The sunshade can only be operated with the Safety mechanism
ignition switch or the operation mode in ON.
l Do not place heavy luggage on the panoram- If a hand or head is trapped in the closing
ic glass roof. Doing so could damage the
sunshade, it will reopen automatically.
3 l
glass roof.
Do not hang heavy luggage from, allow a Nonetheless, make sure that nobody brings
person to hang onto, or apply any other their head or hand near the sunshade when
strong force to the opening of the sunshade opening or closing.
receptacle or the parts between the ceiling The opened sunshade will become operation-
and the sunshade opening on either side. Do- al after a few seconds.
ing so could damage the sunshade.

CAUTION
NOTE
l The safety mechanism is cancelled just be-
l Release the switch as soon as the sunshade 1- Open fore the sunshade is fully closed. This allows
reaches the fully open or fully closed posi- 2- Close the sunshade to close completely.
tion. 3- Stop Therefore be especially careful that no fin-
l If the sunshade does not operate when the gers are trapped in the sunshade.
sunshade switch is operated, release the
switch and check whether something is trap- To open, press the switch (1).
ped by the sunshade. If nothing is trapped, Press and hold the switch (1), the sunshade NOTE
we recommend you to have the sunshade automatically opens. Release the switch once
checked. the sunshade starts moving automatically. l The safety mechanism can be activated if the
driving conditions or other circumstances
l Operating the sunshade repeatedly with the To stop the moving sunshade, press the cause the sunshade to be subjected to a phys-
engine stationary will run down the battery. switch (1), (2) or (3). ical shock similar to that caused by a trapped
Operate the sunshade while the engine is
hand or head.
running.
To close, press the switch (2).
l Close the sunshade when parking the vehicle
Press and hold the switch (2), the sunshade
for a long time. Parking in the hot sun with
the sunshade open will make the vehicle in- automatically closes. Release the switch once
side extremely hot. the sunshade starts moving automatically.
To stop the moving sunshade, press the
switch (1), (2) or (3).

3-42 Locking and unlocking OGAE15E5


Seat and seat belts

Seat......................................................................................................4-02 4
Seat adjustment................................................................................... 4-03
Front seat.............................................................................................4-03
Rear seat..............................................................................................4-06
Head restraints.....................................................................................4-07
Making a luggage compartment..........................................................4-08
Seat belts............................................................................................. 4-09
Pregnant women restraint....................................................................4-14
Seat belt pretensioner system and force limiter system...................... 4-14
Child restraint......................................................................................4-15
Seat belt inspection............................................................................. 4-24
Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag.................................... 4-24

OGAE15E5
Seat

Seat
E00400103225

1-Front seat
l To adjust forward or backward ® p. 4-03
l To recline the seatback ® p. 4-04
l To adjust seat height (driver’s seat only) ® p. 4-05
l Armrest* ® p. 4-05
l Heated seats* ® p. 4-06

2-Rear seat
l Armrest* ® p. 4-06

4-02 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Seat adjustment

Seat adjustment CAUTION Front seat


E00400300271
l Make sure the seat is adjusted by an adult or E00400400142

with adult supervision for correct and safe


Adjust the driver’s seat so that you are com-
operation. To adjust forward or back-
fortable and that you can reach the pedals, ward
steering wheel, switches etc. while retaining
l Do not place a cushion or the like between

a clear field of vision.


your back and the seatback while driving.
The effectiveness of the head restraints will
E00400500462
4
be reduced in the event of an accident. Manual type
WARNING l When sliding the seat rearward, be careful
not to catch your hand or foot. Pull the seat adjusting lever and adjust the
l Do not attempt to adjust the seat while seat forward or backward to the desired posi-
driving. This can cause loss of vehicle con- tion, and release the adjusting lever.
trol and result in an accident. After ad-
justments are made, ensure the seating is
locked in position by attempting to move
the seat forward and rearward without
using the adjusting mechanism.
l Do not let children or adults ride in areas
of the vehicle that are not equipped with
seats or seat belts. Also, make sure that all
occupants are sitting in their seats and
wearing their seat belts, and that children
are sitting in child restraints.
l To minimize the risk of personal injury in
the event of a collision or sudden braking,
the seatbacks should always be in the al-
most upright position while the vehicle is WARNING
in motion. The protection provided by the
seat belts may be reduced significantly
l To ensure the seat is locked securely, try
to move the seat forward or backward
when the seatback is reclined. There is without using the adjusting lever.
greater risk that the passenger will slide
under the seat belt, resulting in serious in-
jury, when the seatback is reclined.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-03


Front seat
Power type To recline the seatback Power type
Adjust the seat by operating the switch as in- E00400600968
Adjust the seatback angle by operating the
dicated by the arrows. switch as indicated by the arrows.
Manual type
In order to recline the seatback, lean forward
4 slightly, pull the seatback lock lever up, and
then lean backward to the desired position
and release the lever. The seatback will lock
in that position.

1- Adjustment forward 1- To move to forward direction


2- Adjustment backward 2- To recline rearward

NOTE NOTE
l To prevent the battery from discharging, use l To prevent the battery from discharging, use
the power seat while the engine is on. the power seat while the engine is on.

CAUTION
l The reclining mechanism of the seatback is
spring loaded, causing it to return to the ver-
tical position when the lock lever is operat-
ed. When using the lever, sit close to the
seatback or hold it with your hand to control
its return motion.

4-04 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Front seat

To adjust seat height (driver’s 2- To move the rear of the seat up and
seat only) down
E00400700549

Manual type
To adjust the seat height, operate the lever re- 4
peatedly to adjust.

1- To move the front of the seat up and


down

3- To move the whole seat up and down

Armrest*
E00400900378

1- Raise
The lid of the floor console box can be
2- Lower
moved forward and backward, and used as an
Power type armrest.

To adjust the seat height, operate the switch


as indicated by arrows.

NOTE
l To prevent the battery from discharging, use
the power seat while the engine is on.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-05


Rear seat

Heated seats* 1 (HI) - Heater high (for quick heating). CAUTION


E00401102195
2 - Heater off. l Do not use benzine, kerosene, petrol, alcohol
The heated seats can be operated with the ig- or other organic solvents when cleaning the
nition switch or the operation mode in ON. 3 (LO) - Heater low (to keep the seat
seats. Doing so could damage not only the
The indication lamp (A) will illuminate while warm). seat cover, but also the heater element.
the heater is on.
4 l If water or any other liquid is spilled on the
seat, allow it to dry thoroughly before at-
CAUTION tempting to use the heater.
Type 1
l Switch off seat heaters when not in use. l Turn the heater off immediately if it appears
to be malfunctioning during use.
l Operate in the high position for quick heat-
ing. Once the seat is warm, set the heater to
low to keep it warm. Slight variations in seat
temperature may be felt while using the Rear seat
heated seats. This is caused by the operation E00401300412
of the heater’s internal thermostat and does
not indicate a malfunction. WARNING
l If the following types of persons use the
heated seats, they might become too hot or l When a person sits in the rear seat, pull
receive minor burns (red skin, heat blisters, up the head restraint to a height at which
etc.): it locks in position. Be sure to make this
adjustment before starting to drive. Seri-
• Children, elderly or ill people
Type 2 ous injuries could otherwise be suffered as
• People with sensitive skin the result of an impact.
• Excessively tired people
• People under the influence of alcohol or
sleep inducing medication (cold medicine, Armrest*
etc.) E00401700650

l Do not place heavy objects on the seat or To use the armrest, fold it down.
stick pins, needles, or other pointed objects
into it.
l Do not use a blanket, cushion, or other mate-
rial with high heat insulation properties on
the seat while using the heater; this might
cause the heater element to overheat

4-06 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Head restraints
To return to the original position, push it WARNING To remove
backward level with the seat.
l Never place a cushion or similar device on To remove the head restraints, lift the head
the seatback. This can adversely affect
head restraint performance by increasing
restraint with the height adjusting knob (A)
the distance between your head and the pushed in.
restraint.
4
To adjust height
Adjust the head restraint height so that the
centre of the head restraint is as close as pos-
sible to eye level to reduce the chances of in-
jury in the event of collision. Any person too
tall for the head restraint to reach their seated
NOTE eye level, should adjust the restraint as high
l Do not climb or sit on the armrest. Doing so as possible.
could damage the armrest. To raise the head restraint, move it upward. Installation
l The top surface of the armrest contains a cup To lower the restraint, move it downward
holder for rear seat occupants. while pushing the height adjusting knob (A) To install the head restraints, first confirm
Refer to “Cup holder” on page 7-81. in the direction of the arrow. After adjust- that they are facing the correct direction, and
ment, push the head restraint downward and then insert them into the seatback while
Head restraints make sure that it is locked. pressing the height adjusting knob (A) in the
E00403301439 direction indicated by the arrow.

WARNING CAUTION
l Driving without the head restraints in
l Confirm that the height adjusting knob (A)
place can cause you and your passengers
is correctly adjusted as shown in the illustra-
serious injury or death in an accident. To
tion, and also lift the head restraints to en-
reduce the risk of injury in an accident,
sure that they do not come out of the seat-
always make sure the head restraints are
back.
installed and properly positioned when
the seat is occupied.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-07


Making a luggage compartment

Making a luggage CAUTION


compartment l Do not stack luggage in the vehicle higher
than the seatback height. Also, firmly secure
E00403400231
the luggage.
Serious accidents could result due to unre-
WARNING
4 l When making a luggage compartment,
strained objects entering the passenger com-
partment during sudden braking.
never arrange the seats while the vehicle l Make sure that the seat is operated by an
is being driven or is on an incline. The adult. If it is operated by a child, an unex-
seats could move unexpectedly or more pected accident might occur.
than required and cause a serious acci- l Be careful not to catch your hands or feet
dent. when arranging the seat. Personal injury
CAUTION l If required, always operate the seating be- could result.
l The head restraints for the seats differ in fore the vehicle is in motion.
shape and size. When installing head re- l Do not allow anyone to ride in the luggage
straints, make sure the head restraints are fit- compartment while the vehicle is in mo- Folding the rear seatbacks for-
ted in their respective seats and do not install tion. People who are not properly seated ward
the head restraints in the wrong direction. and restrained can be seriously injured or
E00403501675
killed in an accident.
The passenger and luggage compartments
l The luggage compartment in the rear of
can be joined by folding the seatback for-
the vehicle should never be used as a play
area by children. ward. This is useful for carrying long objects.
Children should be seated with seat belts The seatbacks can be folded with the rear
fastened when the vehicle is in motion. seat release button.
l Confirm that the seatback locks securely
when it is returned.
NOTE
l The seatbacks can be folded one side at a
time.

4-08 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Seat belts
To fold the seatbacks 3. Make sure the seatback is locked firmly Refer to “Seat belt pretensioner system and
in place and the seat belt is passed force limiter system” on page 4-14.
Push the rear seat release button (A) to fold
through the seat belt guide (B).
the seatback forward.
WARNING
CAUTION l Always place the shoulder belt over your
l If the red part (C) on the back of the rear shoulder and across your chest. Never put 4
seat release button can be seen, the seatback it behind you or under your arm.
is not locked firmly in place. Push and pull l One seat belt should be used by only one
lightly on the seatback to lock it firmly in person. Doing otherwise can be danger-
place. ous.
l The seat belt will provide its wearer with
maximum protection if the recliner seat-
back is placed in fully upright position.
When the seatback is reclined, there is
greater risk that the passenger will slide
under the belt, especially in a forward im-
To return the seatbacks pact accident, and may be injured by the
belt or by striking the instrument panel or
1. If the seat belt is removed from the seat
seatbacks.
belt guide (B), pass it through the seat
l Seat belts should always be worn by every
belt guide. adult who drives or rides in this vehicle,
2. Fold back the seatback until it is locked and by all children who are tall enough to
properly in position. wear seat belts properly.
Other children should always use proper

NOTE Seat belts child restraint systems.


E00404800636
l Remove any twists when using the belt.
l When the seat belts cannot be pulled out in a l No modifications or additions should be
locked condition, pull the belts once force- To protect you and your passengers in the made by the user which will either pre-
fully and then return them. event of an accident, it is most important that vent the seat belt adjusting devices from
After that, pull the belts out slowly once the seat belts be worn correctly while driving. operating to remove slack, or prevent the
again. The front seat belts have a pretensioner sys- seat belt assembly from being adjusted to
remove slack.
tem. These belts are used the same way as a
conventional seat belt.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-09


Seat belts

WARNING NOTE WARNING


l Never hold a child in your arms or on l You can check if the belt locks by pulling it l Never wear the lap portion of the belt
your lap when riding in this vehicle, even forward quickly. across your abdomen. During accidents it
if you are wearing your seat belt. To do so can press sharply against the abdomen
risks severe or fatal injury to the child in To fasten and increase the risk of injury.
4 l
a collision or sudden stop.
Always adjust the belt to a snug fit. 1. Pull the seat belt out slowly while hold-
l The seat belts must not be twisted when
worn.
l Always wear the lap portion of the belt ing the latch plate.
over your hips. 3. Pull the belt slightly to adjust slackness
NOTE as desired.

l When the seat belts cannot be pulled out in a To unfasten


locked condition, pull the belts once force-
fully and then return them. After that, pull Hold the latch plate and push the button on
the belts out slowly once again. the buckle.

2. Insert the latch plate into the buckle until


a “click” is heard.

3-point type seat belt (with


emergency locking mechanism)
E00404901070
This type of belt requires no length adjust-
ment. Once worn, the belt adjusts itself to the
movement of the wearer, but in the event of a NOTE
sudden or strong shock, the belt automatical-
ly locks to hold the wearer’s body. l As the belt retracts automatically, keep hold-
ing the latch plate while retracting so that the
belt stows slowly. Failure to do this could
damage the vehicle.

4-10 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Seat belts

Driver’s seat belt warning If the vehicle is driven without fastening the Front passenger seat belt warn-
lamp and display seat belt, the warning lamp comes on and ing lamp*
flashes repeatedly, and the tone sounds con-
E00409800833 E00411601284
tinuously. At the same time, the warning dis- The front passenger seat belt warning lamp is
Warning lamp play is displayed on the information screen in located on the instrument panel.
the multi-information display.
The warning lamp goes off and the tone stops 4
after approximately 90 seconds.
Subsequently, if the seat belt is still not fas-
Warning display type 1 tened, the warning lamp and tone will be acti-
vated to remind the driver to fasten the seat
belt whenever the vehicle is stopped and star-
ted again. The warning will operate in the
same way if the seat belt is removed while
driving the vehicle. The warning will stop
when the seat belt is fastened.
Warning display type 2

The lamp comes on when a person sits on the


front passenger seat but does not fasten the
seat belt. It goes off when the seat belt is sub-
sequently fastened.

A tone and warning lamp are used to remind WARNING


the driver to fasten the seat belt.
If the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” l Do not install any accessory or sticker
that makes the lamp difficult to see.
position or the operation mode is put in ON
while a seat belt is not fastened, the warning
lamp illuminates and the tone sounds for Adjustable seat belt anchor
about 6 seconds to remind the driver to fasten (front seats)
the seat belt. E00405000329
The seat belt anchor height can be adjusted.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-11


Seat belts
Raise or lower the seat belt anchor (A) while To fasten
pressing the lock knob (B).
1. Pull the seat belt out slowly and pass it
through the seat belt guide (A).
Down Up

WARNING
l When using the seat belt, make sure to se-
curely connect the latch plate (B) with the
WARNING buckle (C). Failing to do so could signifi-
cantly reduce the amount of protection
l When adjusting the seat belt anchor, set it NOTE and cause serious injures in a collision or
at a position that is sufficiently high so
a sudden stop.
that the belt will make full contact with l When the seat belts cannot be pulled out in a
your shoulder but will not touch your locked condition, pull the belt once forceful-
neck. ly and then return it.
After that, pull the belt out slowly once
again.
3-point type seat belt with 2
buckles 2. After making sure that the seat belt is
E00414700117 not twisted, insert the latch plate (B) into
3-point type seat belt with 2 buckles is fitted the buckle (C) aligning the marks (D) on
in the rear centre seating position. the plate and buckle until a “click” is
heard.
NOTE
l You can check if the belt locks by pulling it
forward quickly.

4-12 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Seat belts
3. Insert the latch plate (E) into the buckle To unfasten 3. Retract the seat belt and remove it from
(F) until a “click” is heard. the seat belt guide (A).
1. Hold the latch plate (E) and push the
button on the buckle (F).

4. Make sure the lap belt is positioned as 4. After the seat belt is retracted complete-
low as possible on the hips and pull the ly, insert the latch plate (E) into the up-
2. Push the button (G) on the buckle (C)
shoulder belt to adjust the slackness of per slit (H) and the latch plate (B) into
using the latch plate (E) to disconnect
the lap belt. the lower slit (I).
the seat belt from the buckle.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-13


Pregnant women restraint

Pregnant women restraint Pretensioner system CAUTION


E00405801135
E00405600077
When the ignition switch or the operation l Installation of audio equipment or repairs in
the vicinity of the pretensioner seat belts or
WARNING mode is under the following conditions, if floor console must be performed in line with
there is a frontal impact or a side impact (ve- MITSUBISHI MOTORS guidelines. It is
l Seat belts work for everyone, including
hicles equipped with SRS side airbags and
4 pregnant women. Pregnant women should
SRS curtain airbags) severe enough to injure
important to do so because the work could
affect the pretensioner systems.
use the available seat belts. This will re-
duce the likelihood of injury to both the the driver and/or front passenger, the preten- l If you need to scrap the vehicle, please con-
woman and the unborn child. The lap belt sioner system will retract their respective seat sult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
should be worn across the thighs and as Service Point.
belts instantaneously, thus maximizing the It is important to do so because unexpected
snug against the hips as possible, but not seat belt’s effectiveness.
across the waist. Consult your doctor if activation of the pretensioner seat belts
[Except for vehicles equipped with keyless could cause injuries.
you have any additional questions or con-
cerns. operation system]
The ignition switch is in the “ON” or
“START” position. NOTE
Seat belt pretensioner [Vehicles equipped with keyless operation l The pretensioner seat belts will be activated
system and force limiter system] if the vehicle suffers a severe frontal impact
The operation mode is in ON. or a severe side impact (vehicles equipped
system with SRS side airbags and SRS curtain air-
bags), even if the seat belts are not worn.
E00405700166
WARNING l The pretensioner seat belts are designed to
The driver’s seat and front passenger’s seat work only once. After the pretensioner seat
each have a seat belt equipped with a preten- l To obtain the best results from your pre- belts have been activated, we recommend
tensioner seat belt, make sure you have
sioner system. adjusted your seat correctly and wear you have it replaced by a MITSUBISHI
your seat belt properly. MOTORS Authorized Service Point.

SRS warning
E00405900243
The same warning lamp/display is shared by
the SRS airbags and the pretensioner seat
belts.
Refer to “SRS warning lamp/display” on
page 4-36.
4-14 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5
Child restraint

Force limiter system WARNING WARNING


E00406000209
In the event of a collision, each force limiter l When attaching a child restraint system l Extreme Hazard!
to the rear seat, prevent the front seat- NEVER use a rearward facing child re-
system will effectively absorb the load ap- backs from touching the child restraint straint on a seat protected by an ACTIVE
plied to the seat belt to minimize the impact system. AIRBAG in front of it, DEATH or SERI-
to the passenger. Otherwise, the child could be seriously in-
jured in the event of hard braking or a
OUS INJURY to the CHILD can occur.
4
Child restraint collision.
E00406403464
NOTE
Caution for installing the child l The labels may be in different positions de-
When transporting children in your vehicle,
some type of child restraint system should al- restraint on vehicles with a pending on the vehicle model.

ways be used according to the size of the front passenger airbag


Use rearward facing child restraints in the
child. This is required by law in most coun-
The label shown here is attached on vehicles rear seat or turn off the front passenger’s air-
tries.
with a front passenger airbag. bag ON-OFF switch (if so equipped). (Refer
The regulations concerning driving with chil-
to “To turn an airbag off” on page 4-28)
dren in the front seat may differ from country
to country. You are advised to comply with
the relevant regulations.
Front passenger’s
airbag ON
WARNING
l When possible, put children in the rear
seat. Accident statistics indicate that chil-
dren of all sizes and ages are safer when
properly restrained in the rear seat rather
than in the front seat.
l Holding a child in your arms is no substi-
tute for a restraint system. Failure to use
a proper restraint system can result in se-
vere or fatal injury to the child.
l Each child restraint device or fixing is to
be used only by one child.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-15


Child restraint

WARNING Instruction: WARNING


lA REARWARD FACING CHILD RE- l For small infants, an infant carrier l When installing a child restraint system,
STRAINT must NOT be used in the front should be used. For small children refer to the instructions provided by the
passenger seat if the front passenger’s air- whose height when seated allows the manufacturer of the restraint system.
bag has not been deactivated. The force of shoulder belt to lie in contact with the Failure to do so can result in severe or fa-
4 an inflating airbag could kill or cause se-
rious injuries to the child. A rearward
face or the throat, a child seat should be
l
tal injury to the child.
After installation, push and pull the child
facing child restraint should be used in
used. restraint system back and forth, and side
the rear seat. l The child restraint system should be ap- to side, to see that it is properly secured.
l A FORWARD FACING CHILD RE- propriate for the child’s weight and If the child restraint system is not instal-
STRAINT should be used in the rear seat height and properly fit in the vehicle. led securely, it may cause injury to the
whenever possible; if used in the front For a higher degree of safety: THE child or other occupants in the case of ac-
seat, turn off the front passenger’s airbag CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM cident or sudden stops.
ON-OFF switch. SHOULD BE INSTALLED IN THE l When the child restraint system is not in
use, keep your child restraint system se-
REAR SEAT.
cured with the seat belt or remove it from
Infants and small children the vehicle in order to prevent it from be-
E00406600609 NOTE ing thrown around inside the vehicle dur-
When transporting infants and small children ing an accident.
in your vehicle, follow the instruction given l Before purchasing a child restraint system,
try installing it in the rear seat to make sure
below. there is a good fit. Because of the location of Depending on the seating position in the
the seat belt buckles and the shape of the vehicle and the child restraint system
seat cushion, it may be difficult to securely that you have, the child restraint can be
install some manufacturer’s child restraint attached using one of the following two
systems. locations:
If the child restraint system can be pulled
• To the lower anchorage in the rear
forward or to either side easily on the seat
cushion after the seat belt has been tight- seat ONLY if the child restraint has
ened, choose another manufacturer’s child ISOFIX mountings (See page 4-18).
restraint system. • To the seat belt (See pages 4-09,
4-23).

4-16 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Child restraint

Older children
E00406700277
Children who have outgrown the child re-
straint system should be seated in the rear
seat and wear combination lap shoulder belt.
The lap portion of the belt should be snug
and positioned low on the abdomen so that it
4
is below the top of the hip-bone. Otherwise,
the belt could intrude into the child’s abdo-
men during an accident and cause injury.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-17


Child restraint

Suitability for various ISOFIX positions


E00411401934

Vehicle ISOFIX positions


Mass group Size class Fixture
Rear outboard
4 Carrycot F ISO/L1 X
G ISO/L2 X
0 - Up to 10 kg
E ISO/R1 X
(0-9 months)
0+ - Up to 13 kg E ISO/R1 IL*1
(0-2 years)
D ISO/R2 X
C ISO/R3 X
I - 9 to 18 kg D ISO/R2 X
(9 months-4 years)
C ISO/R3 IL*2
B ISO/F2 IUF
B1 ISO/F2X IUF, IL*3
A ISO/F3 IUF, IL*4
II & III - 15 to 36 kg
X
(4-12 years)

CAUTION
l When installing a child restraint system, remove the head restraint from the seat.

4-18 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Child restraint
Key of characters to be inserted in the table above:
l IUF- Suitable for ISOFIX forward child restraints systems of universal category approved for use in the mass group.
l IL- Suitable for particular ISOFIX child restraint systems given in the following list (MITSUBISHI MOTORS genuine parts).
l X- ISOFIX position not suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems in this mass group.

IL (Genuine part information) 4


Genuine part No. UN No.
MZ314393 (Child restraint system),
*1 E1-04301146
MZ314394 (ISOFIX base)
MZ314390E (Child restraint system for East area),
MZ314390CS (Child restraint system for Central-South area),
*2 E4-04443718
MZ314390N (Child restraint system for North area),
MZ314417 (Rearward facing ISOFIX base for ALL areas)
*3 MZ313045 E1-04301133
MZ314390E (Child restraint system for East area),
MZ314390CS (Child restraint system for Central-South area),
*4 E4-04443718
MZ314390N (Child restraint system for North area),
MZ314416 (Forward facing ISOFIX base for ALL areas)

NOTE
l MITSUBISHI MOTORS Europe B.V. reserves the right to changes without any prior announcement.
For detailed information, consult your MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Point.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-19


Child restraint

Suitability for various seating positions


E00406802504

Seating position
Front passenger
Mass group
4 Activated air- Deactivated Air- Rear outboard Rear centre
bag bag#1
0 - Up to 10 kg
X X U X
(0-9 months)
0+ - Up to 13 kg
X L*1 U, L*1 L*1,
(0-2 years)
I -9 to 18 kg
X L*2, L*3 U, L*2, L*3 L*2, L*3
(9 months-4 years)
II & III -15 to 36 kg
X L*4 U, L*4 X
(4-12 years)
#1: With front passenger’s airbag deactivated by means of front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch

CAUTION
l When installing a child restraint system, remove the head restraint from the seat.

Key of characters to be inserted in the table above:


l U- Suitable for “universal” category restraints approved for use in this mass group.
l L- Suitable for particular child restraints in the following list (MITSUBISHI MOTORS genuine parts).
l X- Seat position not suitable for children in this mass group.

4-20 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Child restraint

L (Genuine part information)

Genuine part No. UN No.


*1 MZ314393 E1-04301146
*2 MZ313045 E1-04301133 4
*3 MZ314390E (for East area), E4-03443416
MZ314390CS (for Central-South area),
MZ314390N (for North area)
*4 MZ314250 E1-04301169

NOTE
l There is no applicable MITSUBISHI MOTORS Genuine Parts to the Mass Group “0-Up to 10 kg”.
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Europe B.V. reserves the right to changes without any prior announcement.
For further information, please contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Point.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-21


Child restraint

Installing a child restraint sys- Tether anchorage locations Child restraint system with
tem to the lower anchorage There are 2 child restraint anchorage points
ISOFIX mountings
(ISOFIX child restraint mount- located on the back of the rear seatbacks. The child restraint system is designed only
ings) and tether anchorage These are for fastening the child restraint for seats that incorporate lower anchorages.
E00406901986
tether straps to the 2 rear seat seating posi- Retain the child restraint system using the
4 tions. lower anchorages.
Lower anchorage location It is not necessary to retain the child restraint
system using the vehicle’s seat belts.
Your vehicle’s rear seat is fitted with lower
anchorages for attaching a child restraint sys-
tem with ISOFIX mountings.

WARNING A- Child restraint system connectors


l Child restraint anchorages are designed
To install
to withstand only those loads imposed by
correctly fitted child restraints. Under no 1. Remove any foreign material in or
circumstances are they to be used for around the connectors and ensure the ve-
adult seat belts, harnesses, or for attach- hicle seat belt is in its normal storage po-
ing other items or equipment to the vehi-
cle.
sition.
2. Remove the head restraint from the loca-
tion in which you wish to install a child
restraint.
Refer to “Head restraints” on page 4-07.

4-22 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Child restraint
3. Open the gap a little between the seat Installing a child restraint sys-
cushion (A) and the seatback (B) with tem to a 3-point type seat belt
your hand to locate the lower anchorages
(C). (with emergency locking mech-
4. Push the child restraint system’s connec- anism)
tors (D) into the lower anchorages (C) in E00408701845

accordance with the instructions provi- 4


ded by the child restraint system’s man- 3-point type seat belt location
ufacturer. The child restraint system can be fitted by us-
ing the 3-point type seat belt at the below il-
lustrated seating position.
NOTE
l If it is difficult to latch the tether strap hook
(E), turn the hook sideways.

6. Push and pull the child restraint in all di-


rections to be sure it is secure.

To remove
A- Vehicle seat cushion Remove the child restraint in accordance
B- Vehicle seatback with the instructions provided by the child re-
C- Lower anchorage straint system’s manufacturer. Installation:
D- Connector
1. Put a child restraint system on the seat in
If your child restraint system requires
which you wish to install it, and remove
the use of a tether strap, fasten the tether
the head restraint from the seat.
strap in accordance with steps 5.
Refer to “Head restraints” on page 4-07.
2. Fasten the seat belt to secure the child
5. Latch the tether strap hook (E) of the
restraint system. Make sure you hear a
child seat to the tether anchorage bar (F)
“click” when you insert the latch plate in
and tighten the top tether strap hook so it
the buckle.
is securely fastened.
OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-23
Seat belt inspection
3. Use the locking clip to completely elimi- Seat belt inspection WARNING
nate any slackness.
4. Push and pull the child restraint in all di-
E00406300475
l Once the pretensioner has been activated,
it cannot be re-used.
rections to be sure it is secure. l Check the belts for cuts, worn or frayed It must be replaced together with the re-
webbing and for cracked or deformed tractor.
metallic parts. Replace the belt assembly
4 WARNING if it is defective.
l For some types of child restraint, the lock- l A dirty belt should be cleaned with neu- Supplemental restraint
ing clip (A) should be used to help avoid tral detergent in warm water. After rins-
personal injury during a collision or sud-
ing in water, let it dry in the shade. Do
system (SRS) - airbag
den manoeuvre. E00407201944
It must be fitted and used in accordance not attempt to bleach or re-dye the belts
with the child restraint manufacturer’s because this will affect their characteris- The information for SRS airbags includes im-
instructions. tics. portant information concerning the driver’s
The locking clip must be removed when and front passenger’s airbags, the driver’s
the child restraint is removed. knee airbag, the side airbags and the curtain
WARNING
airbags.
l We recommend you to have all seat belt The SRS airbags are designed to supplement
assemblies including retractors and at-
the primary protection of the driver and front
taching hardware inspected after any col-
lision. We recommend that seat belt as- passenger side seat belt systems by providing
semblies in use during a collision be re- those occupants with protection against head
placed unless the collision was minor and and chest injuries in certain moderate-to-se-
the belts show no damage and continue to vere frontal collisions.
operate properly.
l Do not attempt to repair or replace any The SRS driver’s knee airbag (if so equip-
part of the seat belt assemblies; we recom-
ped) is designed to supplement the primary
mend you to have this work done by a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized protection of the driver’s seat belt system. It
Service Point. Incorrect repair or replace- can reduce the forward movement of the
ment could reduce the effectiveness of the driver’s lower legs and provide increased
belts and could result in serious injury in overall body protection in certain moderate-
the event of a collision. to-severe frontal collisions.

4-24 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag
The SRS side airbags (if so equipped) are de- How the Supplemental Re-
signed to supplement properly worn seat straint System works
belts and provide the driver and front passen-
E00407302883
ger with protection against chest and abdo- The SRS includes the following components:
men injuries in certain moderate-to-severe
side impact collisions.
4
The SRS curtain airbags (if so equipped) are
designed to supplement properly worn seat
belts and provide the driver and passenger
with protection against head injuries in cer- 6- Side airbag modules*
tain moderate-to-severe side impact colli- 7- Curtain airbag modules*
sions.
Only when the ignition switch or the opera-
The SRS is NOT a substitute for the seat tion mode is under the following conditions,
belts. To ensure the maximum protection dur- 1- Airbag module (Driver) the airbags will operate.
ing all types of collisions and accidents, all 2- Front passenger’s airbag OFF indication [Except for vehicles equipped with keyless
occupants, including the passengers as well lamp* operation system]
as the driver, must wear their seat belts. 3- Airbag module (Passenger) The ignition switch is in the “ON” or
4- Driver’s knee airbag module* “START” position.
5- Front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF [Vehicles equipped with keyless operation
switch* system]
The operation mode is in ON.
The airbags deployment produces a sudden,
loud noise, and releases some smoke and
powder, but these conditions are not injuri-
ous, and do not indicate a fire in the vehicle.
People with respiratory problems may feel
some temporary irritation from chemicals
used to produce the deployment; open the
windows after airbag deployment, if safe to
do so.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-25


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag
The airbags deflate very rapidly after deploy- WARNING
ment, so there is little danger of obscured vi-
sion. l Place all infants and small children in the
rear seat and properly restrained using an
appropriate child restraint system.
CAUTION The rear seat is the safest place for infants
4 l Airbags inflate at an extremely rapid speed.
and children.
In certain situations, contact with inflating
airbags can result in abrasions, bruises, and
the like.

WARNING Use rearward facing child restraints in the


l IT IS VERY IMPORTANT TO BE rear seat or turn off the front passenger’s air-
PROPERLY SEATED. bag ON-OFF switch (if so equipped). (Refer
A driver or front passenger too close to to “To turn an airbag off” on page 4-28)
the steering wheel or instrument panel
during airbag deployment can be killed or
seriously injured.
Airbags inflate very fast, and with great Front passenger’s
force. WARNING airbag ON
If the driver and front passenger are not
properly seated and restrained, the air- l Infants and small children should never
be unrestrained, stand up against the in-
bags may not protect you properly, and
strument panel or be held in your arms or
could cause serious or fatal injuries when
on your lap. They could be seriously in-
it inflates.
jured or killed in a collision, including
l Do not sit on the edge of the seat or sit
when the airbag inflates. They should be
with your lower legs too close to the in-
properly seated in the rear seat in an ap-
strument panel, or lean head or chest
propriate child restraint system. See the
close to the steering wheel or instrument
“Child restraint” section of this owner’s
panel. Do not put feet or legs on or against
manual.
the instrument panel.

4-26 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag

WARNING Caution for installing the child Front passenger’s airbag ON-
lA REARWARD FACING CHILD RE- restraint on vehicles with a OFF switch*
STRAINT must NOT be used in the front front passenger airbag E00410100285

passenger seat if the front passenger’s air- E00408802175


The front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch
bag has not been deactivated. The force of The label shown here is attached on vehicles can be used to disable the front passenger’s
an inflating airbag could kill or cause se-
rious injuries to the child.
with a front passenger airbag. airbag. If you have a child restraint system 4
that cannot be fitted to any seat other than the
A rearward facing child restraint should
front passenger seat, be sure to turn OFF the
be used in the rear seat.
front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch be-
l A FORWARD FACING CHILD RE-
STRAINT should be used in the rear seat fore using it.
whenever possible; if they must be used in (Refer to “To turn an airbag off” on page
the front passenger seat, turn off the front 4-28.)
passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch. Fail- The front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch
ure to do so could kill or cause serious in- is located in the glove box.
juries to the child.
l Older children should be seated in the
rear seat, properly wearing the seat belt,
with an appropriate booster seat if nee-
ded.

WARNING
l Extreme Hazard!
NEVER use a rearward facing child re-
straint on a seat protected by an ACTIVE
AIRBAG in front of it, DEATH or SERI-
OUS INJURY to the CHILD can occur.

NOTE
l The labels may be in different positions de-
pending on the vehicle model.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-27


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag

Front passenger’s airbag OFF WARNING WARNING


indication lamp* l Do not fit any accessory that makes the • Do not turn OFF the front passenger’s
E00410201355 indication lamp impossible to see, and do airbag ON-OFF switch except when a
The front passenger’s airbag OFF indication not cover the indication lamp with a stick- child restraint system is fitted to the
lamp is located in the instrument panel. er. You would not be able to verify the front passenger seat.
4 status of the passenger airbag system. • If the indicator does not come on when
the front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF
switch is turned OFF, do not fit a child
To turn an airbag off restraint system to the front passenger
E00412301145 seat. We recommend you to have the
system inspected by a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
WARNING • If the indication lamp remains on when
l To reduce risk of serious or fatal injury: the front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF
• Always remove the key from the igni- switch is turned ON, do not allow any-
tion switch before operating a front one to sit on the front passenger seat.
passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch. We recommend you to have the system
Failure to do so could adversely affect inspected by a MITSUBISHI
the airbag performance. MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
The indicator normally illuminates when the • Wait at least 60 seconds to operate the
front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF
ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position To turn an airbag off, follow these steps:
switch after turning the ignition switch
or the operation mode is put in ON, and goes to the “LOCK” position or putting the 1. Insert the key into the front passenger’s
off a few seconds later. operation mode in OFF. airbag ON-OFF switch, and turn it to the
When the front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF The SRS airbag system is designed to “OFF” position.
switch is turned OFF, the indication lamp retain enough voltage to deploy the air- 2. Remove the key from the key opening of
will stay on to show that the front passen- bag. the front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF
ger’s airbag is not operational. When the • Always remove the key from the front switch.
passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch af-
front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch is
ter operating that switch. Failure to do
turned ON, the indication lamp goes off to so could lead to improper position of
show that the front passenger’s airbag is op- the front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF
erational. switch.

4-28 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag
3. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” po- The driver’s airbag and the front passenger’s The driver’s knee airbag is designed to de-
sition or put the operation mode in ON. airbag are designed to inflate at the same ploy at the same time as the driver’s front air-
The front passenger’s airbag OFF indi- time even if the passenger seat is not occu- bag.
cation lamp will stay on. pied.

Driver’s knee airbag system*


The front passenger’s airbag is now deactiva-
E00412400022
ted and will not deploy until switched on
The driver’s knee airbag is located under the
again.
steering wheel.
Driver’s and front passenger’s
airbag system
E00407400792
The driver’s airbag is located under the pad-
ded cover in the middle of the steering wheel.
The front passenger’s airbag is contained in
the instrument panel above the glove box.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-29


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag

Deployment of front airbags The front airbags and driver’s knee airbag The front airbags and driver’s
and driver’s knee airbag will deploy if the severity of the impact is knee airbag MAY NOT DE-
E00407501644
above the designed threshold level, compara- PLOY when…
ble to a collision at approximately 25 km/h
With certain types of frontal collisions, the
The front airbags and driver’s (16 mph) when impacting straight into a solid
vehicle’s body structure is designed to absorb
knee airbag ARE DESIGNED wall that does not move or deform. If the se-
4 TO DEPLOY when… verity of the impact is below the above
the shock to help protect the occupants from
harm. (The vehicle body’s front area may de-
threshold level, the front airbags and driver’s
The front airbags and driver’s knee airbag are form significantly as it absorbs the impact.)
knee airbag may not deploy. However, this
designed to deploy when the vehicle suffers a Under such circumstances, the front airbags
threshold speed will be considerably higher if
moderate to severe frontal impact. Examples and driver’s knee airbag may not deploy irre-
the vehicle strikes an object that absorbs the
of some typical conditions are shown in the spective of the deformation and damage to
impact by either deforming or moving (for
illustration. the vehicle body.
example, another stationary vehicle, pole or a
Examples of some typical conditions are
guard rail).
shown in the illustration.
Because frontal collisions can easily move
you out of position, it is important to always
properly wear your seat belts. Your seat belts
will help keep you a safe distance from the
steering wheel and instrument panel during
the initial stages of airbag deployment. The
initial stage of airbag inflation is the most
forceful, and can possibly cause serious or fa-
tal injuries. Moreover, the seat belts in your
1- Head-on collision with a solid wall at a vehicle are your primary means of protection
speed of approximately 25 km/h in a collision. The SRS airbags are designed
(16 mph) or higher to provide additional protection. Therefore, 1- Collision with a utility pole, tree or other
2- Moderate-to-severe frontal impact with- for your safety and the safety of all occu- narrow object
in the shaded area between the arrows pants, be sure to always properly wear your 2- Vehicle slides under the rear body of a
seat belts. truck
3- Oblique frontal impacts

4-30 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag
Because the front airbags and driver’s knee The front airbags and driver’s Because the front airbags and driver’s knee
airbag do not protect the occupant in all types knee airbag MAY DEPLOY airbag may deploy in certain types of unex-
of frontal collisions, be sure to always prop- when… pected impacts as shown in the illustration
erly wear your seat belts. that can easily move you out of position, it is
The front airbags and driver’s knee airbag
important to always properly wear your seat
The front airbags and driver’s may deploy if the bottom of the vehicle suf-
belts. Your seat belts will help keep you a
knee airbag ARE NOT DE- fers a moderate-to-severe impact (undercar-
safe distance from the steering wheel and in- 4
SIGNED TO DEPLOY when… riage damage).
strument panel during the initial stages of air-
Examples of some typical conditions are
The front airbags and driver’s knee airbag are bag deployment. The initial stage of airbag
shown in the illustration.
not designed to deploy in conditions where inflation is the most forceful and can possibly
they cannot typically provide protection to cause serious or fatal injuries if you contact it
the occupant. at this stage.
Such conditions are shown in the illustration.
WARNING
l Do not attach anything to the steering
wheel’s padded cover, such as badges or
accessories. It might strike and injure an
occupant if the airbag inflates.
l Do not set anything on, or attach anything
to, the instrument panel above the glove
1- Collision with an elevated median/island box. It might strike and injure an occu-
or kerb pant if the airbag inflates.
2- Vehicle travels over a deep hole/pothole
3- Vehicle drives down a steep slope and
1- Rear end collisions hits the ground
2- Side collisions
3- Vehicle rolls onto its side or roof

Because the front airbags and driver’s knee


airbag do not protect the occupant in all types
of collisions, be sure to always properly wear
your seat belts.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-31


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag

WARNING WARNING The side airbag is designed to inflate only on


the side of the vehicle that is impacted, even
l Do not attach accessories to, or put them l Do not put packages, pets or other objects with no passenger in the front seat.
in front of, the windscreen. These objects between the airbags and the driver or
could restrict the airbag inflation, or front passenger. It could affect airbag
strike and injure an occupant if the air- performance, or could cause injury when
4 l
bags inflate.
Do not attach additional keys or accesso- l
the airbag inflates.
Right after the airbag inflation, several
ries (hard, pointed or heavy objects) to airbag system components will be hot. Do
the ignition key. Such objects could pre- not touch these components. There is a
vent the driver’s knee airbag from inflat- danger of being burnt.
ing normally or could be propelled and l The airbag system is designed to work on-
cause serious injury if the airbag inflates. ly once. Once the airbags have deployed,
l Do not attach accessories to the lower they will not work again. They must
portion of the driver’s side instrument promptly be replaced, and we recommend
panel. Such objects could prevent the you to have the entire airbag system in-
driver’s knee airbag from inflating nor- spected by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
mally or could be propelled and cause se- Authorized Service Point. The label shown here is attached to the seat-
rious injury if the airbag inflates. backs with a side airbag.
Side airbag system*
E00407600303
The side airbags (A) are contained in the
driver and front passenger seatbacks.

4-32 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag

Curtain airbag system* The typical condition is shown in the illustra- The side airbags and curtain
E00409100559
tion. airbags MAY NOT DEPLOY
The curtain airbags are contained in the front when…
pillars and roof side rail. The curtain airbag is With certain types of side collisions, the ve-
designed to inflate only on the side of the ve- hicle’s body structure is designed to absorb
hicle that is impacted, even with no passen-
ger in the front seat or rear seat.
the shock to help protect the occupants from 4
harm. (The vehicle body’s side area may de-
form significantly as it absorbs the impact.)
Under such circumstances, the side airbags
and curtain airbags may not deploy irrespec-
tive of the deformation and damage to the ve-
hicle body. Also, depending on the location
of the impact, the side airbags and curtain air-
The seat belts in your vehicle are your pri- bags may not deploy simultaneously.
mary means of protection in a collision. The
SRS side airbags and curtain airbags are de-
signed to provide additional protection.
Therefore, for your safety and the safety of
all occupants, be sure to always properly
Deployment of side airbags and
wear your seat belts.
curtain airbags
E00407701415

The side airbags and curtain


airbags ARE DESIGNED TO
DEPLOY when…
The side airbags and curtain airbags are de-
signed to deploy when the vehicle suffers a
moderate-to-severe side impact to the middle
of the passenger compartment.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-33


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag
Examples of some typical conditions are Because the side airbags and curtain airbags WARNING
shown in the illustration. do not protect the occupant in all types of
side collisions, be sure to always properly l The side airbags and curtain airbags are
designed to supplement the driver and
wear your seat belts.
passenger seat belts in certain side im-
pacts. Seat belts should always be worn
The side airbags and curtain
4 airbags ARE NOT DESIGNED
properly, and the driver and passenger
should sit well back and upright without
TO DEPLOY when… leaning against the window or door.
The side airbags and curtain airbags are not l The side airbags and curtain airbags in-
flate with great force. The driver and pas-
designed to deploy in conditions where they senger should not put their arms out the
cannot usually provide protection to the oc- window, and should not lean against the
cupant. Typical conditions are shown in the door, in order to reduce risk of serious or
illustration. possible fatal injury from the deploying
1- Side impacts in an area away from the
side airbags and curtain airbags.
passenger compartment
2- Motorcycle or other similar small vehi-
cle collides with the side of vehicle
3- Collision with a utility pole, tree or other
narrow object

1- Head-on collisions
2- Rear end collisions

Because the side airbags and curtain air-


bags do not protect the occupant in all
types of collisions, be sure to always prop-
4- Oblique side impacts erly wear your seat belts.
5- Vehicle rolls onto its side or roof

4-34 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag

WARNING WARNING
l Do not allow any rear seat occupant to l Do not allow a child to lean against or
hold onto the seatback of either front seat, close to the front door even if the child is
in order to reduce risk of injury from the seated in a child restraint system.
deploying side airbags. Special care The child’s head should also not be leaned

l
should be taken with children.
Do not place any objects near or in front
against or be close to the area where the
side airbags and curtain airbags are loca-
4
of the seatback of either front seat. They ted. It is dangerous if the side airbags and
could interfere with proper side airbag in- curtain airbags inflate.
flation, and also could cause injury if Failure to follow all of these instructions
thrown free by side airbag deployment. could lead to serious or fatal injury to the
l Do not place stickers, labels or additional
WARNING child.
trim on the seatback of either front seat. l We recommend work around and on the
They could interfere with proper side air- l Do not put a hanger or any heavy or poin- side airbags and curtain airbags system to
bag inflation. ted object on the coat hook. If the curtain be done by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
l Do not install seat covers on seats with airbag was activated, any such item could Authorized Service Point.
side airbags. Do not re-cover seats that be propelled away with great force and
have side airbags. This could interfere could prevent the curtain airbag from in-
with proper side airbag inflation. flating correctly. Hang clothes directly on
l Do not attach a microphone (A) or any the coat hook (without using a hanger).
other device or object around the part Make sure there are no heavy or sharp
where the curtain airbags (B) activate objects in the pockets of clothes that you
such as on the windscreen, side door glass, hang on the coat hook.
front and rear pillars and roof side or as- l Never install a rearward facing child re-
sist grips. When the curtain airbags in- straint in the front passenger seat. A for-
flate, the microphone or other device or ward facing child restraint should be used
object will be hurled with great force or in the rear seat whenever possible. If a
the curtain airbags may not activate cor- forward facing child restraint must be
rectly, resulting in death or serious injury. used in the front passenger seat, adjust
the seat to the most rearward position,
and ensure that the child stays in the child
restraint and away from the door.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-35


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag

SRS warning lamp/display If there is a problem involving one or more of SRS servicing
E00407802790
the SRS components, the warning lamp will E00407901521
come on and stay on. At the same time, the
Warning lamp warning display will appear on the informa-
tion screen in the multi-information display. WARNING
The SRS warning lamp/display is shared by l We recommend any maintenance per-
4 the SRS airbag and the seat belt pretensioner formed on or near the components of the
system. SRS to be performed by a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
Warning display type 1
Improper work on the SRS components
WARNING or wiring could result in inadvertent de-
ployment of the airbags, or could render
l If any of the following conditions occur, the SRS inoperative; either situation
there may be a problem with the SRS air- could result in serious injury.
bags and/or seat belt pretensioners, and
they may not function properly in a colli- l Do not modify your steering wheel, seat
belt retractor or any other SRS compo-
sion or may suddenly activate without a nents. For example, replacement of the
Warning display type 2 collision: steering wheel, or modifications to the
• Even when the ignition switch or the front bumper or body structure can ad-
operation mode is in ON, the SRS versely affect SRS performance and lead
warning lamp does not come on or it to possible injury.
remains on.
• The SRS warning lamp and/or the
l If your vehicle has sustained any damage,
we recommend you to have the SRS in-
warning display comes on while driv- spected to ensure it is in proper working
ing. order.
The SRS airbags and seat belt pretension-
The system checks itself every time the igni- ers are designed to help reduce the risk of
tion switch is turned to the “ON” position or serious injury or death in certain colli-
the operation mode is put in ON. The SRS sions. If either of the above conditions oc-
warning lamp will come on for several sec- curs, immediately have your vehicle
onds and then go out. This is normal and checked by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
Authorized Service Point.
means the system is working properly.

4-36 Seat and seat belts OGAE15E5


Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag

WARNING
l On vehicles with the side airbags, do not
modify your front seats, centre pillar and
centre console.
It can adversely affect SRS performance
and lead to possible injury.
If you found any tear, scratch, crack or
4
damage to the seat fabric near the side
airbag, the portion of the front and rear
pillars and roof side rail, you should have
the SRS inspected by a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.

NOTE
l When you transfer ownership of the vehicle
to some other person, we urge you to alert
the new owner that it is equipped with the
SRS and refer the new owner to the applica-
ble section in this owner’s manual.
l If your vehicle has to be scrapped, do this in
line with local legislation and contact a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point to safely dismantle the airbag sys-
tem.

OGAE15E5 Seat and seat belts 4-37


OGAE15E5
Instruments and controls

Instruments..........................................................................................5-02
Multi-information display................................................................... 5-03
Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen 5
display list....................................................................................... 5-26
Indication lamps..................................................................................5-44
Warning lamps.................................................................................... 5-45
Information screen display..................................................................5-46
Combination headlamps and dipper switch........................................ 5-48
Headlamp levelling............................................................................. 5-54
Turn-signal lever................................................................................. 5-55
Hazard warning flasher switch............................................................5-55
Fog lamp switch.................................................................................. 5-56
Wiper and washer switch.................................................................... 5-57
Rear window demister switch............................................................. 5-63
Horn switch......................................................................................... 5-63

OGAE15E5
Instruments

Instruments Tachometer NOTE


E00500301123
E00500101147
The tachometer indicates the engine speed l You can adjust to 8 different levels for when
the position lamps are illuminated and 8 for
(r/min). The tachometer helps you to obtain when they are not.
more economical driving and also warns you l When the lamp switch is in a position other
of excessive engine speeds (Red zone). than the “OFF” position, the meter illumina-
tion switches automatically to the adjusted
5 brightness, depending on the brightness out-
side the vehicle.
l The brightness level of the instruments is
stored when the ignition switch is turned to
the “OFF” position or the operation mode is
put in OFF.
1- Tachometer ® p. 5-02 l If you press and hold the button for longer
than about 1 second when the position lamps
2- Multi-information display ® p. 5-03
are illuminated, the brightness level changes
Information screen display list to the maximum level. Pressing and holding
® p. 5-28 the button for longer than about 1 second
3- Speedometer (km or mph + km/h) again returns the brightness level to the pre-
4- Daytime dipper button (meter illumina- vious level.
tion control) ® p. 5-02 CAUTION
l When driving, watch the tachometer to make
sure that the engine speed indication does
not rise into the red zone (excessive engine
rpm).

Daytime dipper button (meter


illumination control)
E00519800198
Each time you press this button, there is a
sound and the brightness of the instruments
1- Brightness display
changes.
2- Rheostat illumination button

5-02 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Multi-information display

Multi-information display
E00519901141

Always stop the vehicle in a safe place before operating.


The following information is included on the multi-information display: warnings, odometer, tripmeter, service reminder, engine coolant temper-
ature, fuel remaining, outside temperature, selector lever position, 4WD operation status, average and momentary fuel consumption, driving
range, average speed and meter illumination.
It is also possible to change elements such as the language and units used on the multi-information display.
5
When the ignition switch or the When the ignition switch or the When the ignition switch or the
operation mode is OFF operation mode is ON (A/T, CVT) operation mode is ON (M/T)

Type 1 Type 2 Type 1 Type 2 Type 1 Type 2

1- 2- Information screen (when the ignition 3- Door ajar warning display screen (when
mark display screen (when the igni-
switch or the operation mode is OFF) the ignition switch or the operation
tion switch or the operation mode is
® p. 5-05 mode is OFF) ® p. 5-08
OFF) ® p. 5-05
Interrupt display screen (when the igni- 4- Drive mode indicator display screen*
tion switch or the operation mode is ® p. 5-09
OFF) ® p. 5-07

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-03


Multi-information display
5- 8- Selector lever position display screen* 12- Gearshift indicator display screen*
mark display screen (when the igni-
® p. 5-15 ® p. 6-23
tion switch or the operation mode is ON)
Gearshift indicator display screen* 13- Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) display
® p. 5-09
® p. 6-29 screen* ® p. 6-19
6- Active Stability Control (ASC) OFF dis-
9- Outside temperature display screen Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) OFF display
play screen* ® p. 5-09
® p. 5-15 screen* ® p. 6-22
7- Information screen (when the ignition
10- Fuel remaining display screen
switch or the operation mode is ON)
® p. 5-15
5 ® p. 5-10
11- Engine coolant temperature display*
Interrupt display screen (when the igni-
® p. 5-11
tion switch or the operation mode is ON)
® p. 5-14

NOTE
l The fuel units, temperature units, display language, and other settings can be changed.
Refer to “Changing the function settings (when the ignition switch or the operation mode is ON)” on page 5-19.
l The display screen is different depending on whether the ignition switch or the operation mode is OFF or ON.
Refer to “Information screen (when the ignition switch or the operation mode is OFF)” on page 5-05.
Refer to “Warning display list (when the ignition switch or the operation mode is OFF)” on page 5-28.
Refer to “Information screen (when the ignition switch is turned from the “LOCK” position to the “ON” position or the operation mode is changed from
OFF to ON)” on page 5-08.
Refer to “Information screen (when the ignition switch or the operation mode is ON)” on page 5-10.
Refer to “Warning display list (when the ignition switch or the operation mode is ON)” on page 5-32.

5-04 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Multi-information display

Multi-information meter mark display screen (when Information screen (when the
switch the ignition switch or the oper- ignition switch or the operation
E00520000608 ation mode is OFF) mode is OFF)
Each time the multi-information meter switch E00520100553 E00520200570
is operated, a sound is emitted and the multi- If you press the multi-infor- Each time you lightly press the multi-infor-
information display changes between infor- mation meter switch and re- mation meter switch, the display screen
mation such as warnings, odometer (Type 1), turn from the warning dis- switches in the following order.
tripmeter, service reminder, engine coolant play screen to the previous 5
temperature (Type 1), average and momenta- screen, the mark is dis- Type 1
ry fuel consumption, driving range, and aver- played.
age speed. Refer to “To return to the screen displayed
It is also possible to change elements such as before the warning display” on page 5-07. When there is no
the language and units used on the multi-in- This mark is also displayed if there is another warning display
formation display by operating the multi-in- warning other than the one displayed. When
formation meter switch. the cause of the warning display is elimina-
When there is a
ted, the mark goes out automatically. warning display

NOTE
l When the mark is displayed, the warning Type 2
display screen can be redisplayed on the in-
formation screen.
Refer to “Information screen (when the igni- When there is no
warning display
tion switch or the operation mode is OFF)”
on page 5-05.
Refer to “Information screen (when the igni-
When there is a
tion switch or the operation mode is ON)”
warning display
on page 5-10.

1- Odometer (Type 1)/Tripmeter


2- Odometer (Type 1)/Tripmeter
OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-05
Multi-information display
3- Service reminder To reset the tripmeter NOTE
4- Redisplay of a warning display screen
To return the display to 0, hold down the l If there is no warning display, the switching
multi-information meter switch for about 2 sequence is: Odometer/Tripmeter →
Odometer/Tripmeter seconds or more. Only the currently dis- Odometer/Tripmeter → Service remind-
E00521201516
played value will be reset. er → Odometer/Tripmeter .
Each time you lightly press the multi-infor- l Both tripmeters and can count up to
mation meter switch, the display screen Example 9999.9 km (9999.9 miles).
5 switches. If tripmeter is displayed, only tripmeter When a tripmeter goes past 9999.9 km
(9999.9 miles), it returns to 0.0 km
will be reset.
Odometer/Tripmeter → Odometer/Trip- (0.0 miles).
meter → Service reminder → Redisplay l When disconnecting the battery terminal, the
Type 1 memories of tripmeter display and dis-
of a warning display screen → Odometer/
Tripmeter play are erased, and their displays return
to 0.0 km (0.0 miles).
Odometer
Service reminder
The odometer indicates the distance travel- E00521301126
led. This displays the distance
Type 1 and number of months until
Tripmeter the next periodic inspection.
The tripmeter indicates the distance travelled Refer to “Service reminder”
Type 2
between two points. on page 5-16.

Example usage of tripmeter and tripmeter

It is possible to measure two currently


Type 2
travelled distances, from home using
tripmeter and from a particular point
on the way using tripmeter .

5-06 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Multi-information display

Interrupt display screen (when To return to the screen dis- NOTE


the ignition switch or the oper- played before the warning dis-
play l Warning display screens with a “ ” or “ ”
ation mode is OFF) mark displayed in the upper right of the
E00520500616 Even if the cause of the warning display is screen can be switched. If you want to
When there is information to be announced, not eliminated, you can return to the screen switch the display, press the multi-informa-
such as lamp reminders, the buzzer sounds that was displayed before the warning dis- tion meter switch as follows.
and the multi-information display switches to play. “ ”: Press lightly.
the warning display screen. Refer to the ap- If you press the multi-information meter “ ”: Press for about 2 seconds or more. 5
propriate page and take the necessary meas- switch, the display screen switches to the
ures. screen that was displayed before the warning Redisplay of a warning display screen
When the cause of the warning display is display and the mark (A) is displayed. When the mark is displayed, if you lightly
eliminated, the warning display goes out au- press the multi-information meter switch a
tomatically. Type 1 few times, the warning display screen you
Refer to “Warning display list (when the ig- switched from is displayed again.
nition switch or the operation mode is OFF)” Refer to “Information screen (when the igni-
on page 5-28. tion switch or the operation mode is OFF)”
on page 5-05.
Type 1

Type 2

Type 2

1- Information generated
2- Cause eliminated

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-07


Multi-information display

Door ajar warning display Information screen (when the System check screen
screen (when the ignition ignition switch is turned from When the ignition switch is turned to the
switch or the operation mode is the “LOCK” position to the “ON” position or the operation mode is put in
OFF) “ON” position or the operation ON, the system check screen is displayed for
about 4 seconds. If there is no fault, informa-
E00520600473 mode is changed from OFF to
If any of the doors or the tailgate is not com- tion screen (when the ignition switch or the
ON) operation mode is ON) is displayed.
pletely closed, this displays the open door or
5 tailgate.
E00520700881
If there is a fault, the screen changes to warn-
When the ignition switch is turned to the ing display.
“ON” position or the operation mode is put in Refer to “Warning display list (when the ig-
Type 1 ON, the display screen switches in the fol- nition switch or the operation mode is ON)”
lowing order. on page 5-32.

Type 1
Type 1 Type 2
Type 2

Type 2

1- Doors and tailgate are closed


2- Doors or tailgate are open

1- Screen when the ignition switch or the


operation mode is OFF
2- System check screen NOTE
3- Screen when the ignition switch or the l The system check screen display varies de-
operation mode is ON pending on the customer’s equipment.

5-08 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Multi-information display
Service reminder Drive mode indicator display NOTE
When the time for periodic inspection ar- screen* l When the mark is displayed, the warning
rives, the warning display is displayed for a E00520800303 display screen can be redisplayed on the in-
few seconds after the ignition switch or the This displays the 4WD sta- formation screen.
operation mode ON screen. Refer to “Service Type 1 tus. Refer to “Information screen (when the igni-
reminder” on page 5-16. If you select “4WD LOCK” tion switch or the operation mode is OFF)”
mode with the drive mode on page 5-05.
Type 1 selector, “4WD LOCK” is Refer to “Information screen (when the igni-
tion switch or the operation mode is ON)”
5
displayed; if you select
on page 5-10.
“4WD AUTO” mode,
Type 2
“4WD” is displayed.
Nothing is displayed when Active Stability Control (ASC)
2WD mode is selected. Refer OFF display screen*
Type 2 to “Drive mode selector” on E00521000373
page 6-39. This is displayed when the
Active Stability Control
mark display screen (when (ASC) is turned off with the
the ignition switch or the oper- ASC OFF switch.
If there is a fault with the
ation mode is ON) ASC, the ASC OFF display
E00520900333
is shown.
This is displayed when you
Refer to ““ASC OFF” switch” on page
press the multi-information
6-52.
meter switch and switch the
warning display screen.
This mark is also displayed
if there is another warning
other than the one displayed.
When the cause of the warning display is
eliminated, the mark goes out automatical-
ly.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-09


Multi-information display

Information screen (when the 3- Service reminder Odometer/Tripmeter


ignition switch or the operation 4- Engine coolant temperature display E00568400046
(Type 1)
mode is ON) 5- Driving range display (Type 1)
Type 1 Type 2
E00521100576
6- Average speed display, average fuel
Each time you lightly press the multi-infor-
consumption display, momentary fuel
mation meter switch, the display screen
consumption display (Type 1)
switches in the following order.
7- Driving range display, momentary fuel
5 consumption display (Type 2)
Type 1
8- Average fuel consumption display, mo-
mentary fuel consumption display (Type
2)
9- Average speed display, momentary fuel
When there is no warning display
consumption display (Type 2)
10- Function setting screen
11- Redisplay of a warning display screen The operation method is the same as when
the ignition switch or the operation mode is
OFF.
When there is a NOTE Refer to “Odometer/Tripmeter” for further
warning display details on page 5-06.
Type 2 l While driving, even if you operate the multi-
information meter switch, the function set-
ting screen is not displayed. Always stop the
vehicle in a safe place before operating.
When there is no warning display Refer to “Changing the function settings
(when the ignition switch or the operation
mode is ON)” on page 5-19.
l When there is information to be announced,
such as a system fault, the buzzer sounds
and the screen display is switched.
When there is a
warning display Refer to “Interrupt display screen (when the
ignition switch or the operation mode is
ON)” on page 5-14.

1- Odometer (Type1)/Tripmeter
2- Odometer (Type1)/Tripmeter
5-10 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5
Multi-information display

Service reminder Engine coolant temperature Refuel as soon as possible.


E00522500694 display
This displays the distance E00521400566 Type 1 Type 2
Type 1 and number of months until This indicates the engine
the next periodic inspection. coolant temperature.
Type 1
Refer to “Service reminder” If the coolant becomes hot,
on page 5-16. “ ” will blink.
Pay careful attention to the 5
engine coolant temperature
display while you are driv-
ing.
Type 2
Type 2

NOTE
l The driving range is determined based on
the fuel consumption data. This may vary
depending on the driving conditions and
habits. Treat the distance displayed as just a
CAUTION rough guideline.
l If the engine is overheating, “ ” will blink. l When you refuel, the driving range display
In this case, the bar graph is on the red zone. is updated.
lmmediately park the vehicle in a safe place However, if you only add a small amount of
and take the required measures. Refer to fuel, the correct value will not be displayed.
“Engine overheating” on page 8-04. Fill with a full tank whenever possible.
l On rare occasions, the value displayed for
the driving range may change if you are
Driving range display parked on an extremely steep incline. This is
E00568500047
due to the movement of fuel in the tank and
This displays the approximate driving range does not indicate a malfunction.
(how many more kilometres or miles you can
drive). When the driving range falls below
approximately 50 km (30 miles), “---” is dis-
played.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-11


Multi-information display

NOTE l When the average speed is being dis- l When the engine switch or the operation
played, if you hold down the multi-infor- mode is in the following conditions, the
l The display setting can be changed to the mation meter switch, the average speed average speed display is automatically
preferred units (km or miles).
displayed at that time is reset. reset.
Refer to “Changing the function settings
(when the ignition switch or the operation l When the following operation is per- [Except for vehicles equipped with key-
mode is ON)” on page 5-19. formed, the mode setting is automatical- less operation system]
. ly switched from manual to auto. The ignition switch is in the “ACC” or
[Except for vehicles equipped with key- “LOCK” position for about 4 hours or
5 less operation system] longer.
Average speed display Turn the ignition switch from the
E00568600048
“ACC” or “LOCK” position to the “ON” NOTE
This displays the average speed from the last
position.
reset to the present time. l The average speed display and the average
[For vehicles equipped with keyless op-
There are the following 2 mode settings. fuel consumption display can be reset indi-
eration system]
For the method for changing the average vidually for the auto reset mode and manual
Change the operation mode from ACC reset mode.
speed display setting, refer to “Changing the
or OFF to ON.
function settings (when the ignition switch or l “---” is displayed when the average speed
cannot be measured.
the operation mode is ON)” on page 5-19.
Switching to auto occurs automatically. l The initial (default) setting is “Auto reset
If switching to manual mode is done, mode”.
Type 1 Type 2 however, the data from the last reset is l The display setting can be changed to the
displayed. preferred units (km/h or mph).
Refer to “Changing the function settings
(when the ignition switch is “ON”)” on page
Auto reset mode 5-19.
l When the average speed is being dis- l The memory of the auto reset mode or man-
played, if you hold down the multi-infor- ual reset mode for the average speed display
mation meter switch, the average speed is erased if the battery is disconnected.
displayed at that time is reset.
Average fuel consumption dis-
play
Manual reset mode E00568700049
This displays the average fuel consumption
from the last reset to the present time.
5-12 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5
Multi-information display
There are the following 2 mode settings. l When the following operation is per- l When the engine switch or the operation
For information on how to change the aver- formed, the mode setting is automatical- mode is in the following conditions, the
age fuel consumption display setting, refer to ly switched from manual to auto. average fuel consumption display is au-
“Changing the function settings (when the ig- [Except vehicles equipped with keyless tomatically reset.
nition switch or the operation mode is ON)” operation system] [Except vehicles equipped with keyless
on page 5-19. Turn the ignition switch from the operation system]
“ACC” or “LOCK” position to the “ON” The ignition switch is in the “ACC” or
position. “LOCK” position for about 4 hours or
Type 1 Type 2
[For vehicles equipped with keyless op- longer.
5
eration system] [For vehicles equipped with keyless op-
Change the operation mode from ACC eration system]
or OFF to ON. The operation mode is in ACC or OFF
for about 4 hours or longer.
Switching to auto occurs automatically.
If switching to manual mode is done, NOTE
however, the data from the last reset is
displayed. l The average speed display and the average
fuel consumption display can be reset indi-
Auto reset mode vidually for the auto reset mode and manual
The “ ” mark (A) in the momentary fuel reset mode.
gauge shows the average fuel consumption. l When the average fuel consumption is l “---” is displayed when the average fuel con-
(Type 2) being displayed, if you hold down the sumption cannot be measured.
multi-information meter switch, the l The initial (default) setting is “Auto reset
mode”.
average fuel consumption displayed at
that time is reset. l The average fuel consumption depends on
the driving condition (road condition, driv-
ing behavior, etc.). The displayed fuel con-
Manual reset mode sumption may vary from the actual fuel con-
sumption. Treat the fuel consumption dis-
l When the average fuel consumption is played as just a rough guideline.
being displayed, if you hold down the l The memory of the auto reset mode or man-
multi-information meter switch, the ual reset mode for the average fuel con-
average fuel consumption displayed at sumption display is erased if the battery is
that time is reset. disconnected.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-13


Multi-information display

NOTE Be conscious of maintaining the value of mo- Interrupt display screen (when
mentary fuel consumption below the value of the ignition switch or the oper-
l The display setting can be changed to the average fuel consumption, driving with the
preferred units {km/L, mpg (US), mpg (UK)
bet-ter fuel consumption can be possible. ation mode is ON)
or L/100 km}. E00522000673
Refer to “Changing the function settings
(when the ignition switch or the operation NOTE Warning display
mode is ON)” on page 5-19.
l When the momentary fuel consumption can- When there is information to be announced,
5 not be measured, the bar graph is not dis- such as a system fault, a sound is emitted and
Momentary fuel consumption played.
the information screen switches to the warn-
display l The display setting can be changed to the
ing display screen.
preferred units {km/L, mpg (US), mpg (UK)
E00568800040
or L/100 km}. Refer to the warning list and take the neces-
While driving, this displays the momentary Refer to “Changing the function settings sary measures.
fuel consumption, using a bar graph. (when the ignition switch or the operation Refer to “Warning display list (when the ig-
mode is ON)” on page 5-19. nition switch or the operation mode is ON)”
l It is possible to cancel the green bar graph. on page 5-32.
Refer to “Changing the function settings
Type 1 Type 2 When the cause of the warning display is
(when the ignition switch or the operation
mode is ON)” on page 5-19. eliminated, the warning display goes out au-
tomatically.
Function setting screen
To return to the screen displayed before
E00521900271
the warning display
The “Display language”,
“Temperature unit”, “Fuel Even if the cause of the warning display is
consumption unit”, and not eliminated, you can return to the screen
“Average fuel consumption that was displayed before the warning dis-
and speed reset method” etc. play.
When the value of momentary fuel consump- settings can be modified as
tion surpasses the value of average fuel con- desired.
sumption, the momentary fuel consumption Refer to “Changing the function settings
is displayed with a white bar graph. (Type 2) (when the ignition switch or the operation
mode is ON)” on page 5-19 for further de-
tails.

5-14 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Multi-information display
If you press the multi-information meter Redisplay of a warning display Outside temperature display
switch, the display screen switches to the screen screen
screen that was displayed before the warning
When the mark is displayed, if you lightly E00522100300
display and the mark (A) is displayed. This shows the temperature
press the multi-information meter switch a
few times, the warning display screen you outside the vehicle.
Type 1
switched from is displayed again.

Other interrupt displays 5


The operation status of each system is dis-
played on the information screen.
NOTE
Refer to the appropriate page in the warning l The display setting can be changed to the
Type 2 display list for further details. preferred units (°C or °F).
Refer to “Changing the function settings
Refer to “Other interrupt displays” on page
(when the ignition switch or the operation
5-40. mode is ON)” on page 5-19.
Selector lever position display l Depending on factors such as the driving
conditions, the displayed temperature may
screen* vary from the actual outside temperature.
E00532500323
Shows the position of the se- Fuel remaining display screen
lector lever.
NOTE Refer to “Selector lever op-
E00522200402
This displays the amount of fuel remaining.
l Warning display screens with a “ ” or “ ” eration” on page 6-32.
mark displayed in the upper right of the Type 1 Type 2
screen can be switched. If you want to
switch the display, press the multi-informa-
tion meter switch as follows.
“ ”: Press lightly.
“ ”: Press for about 2 seconds or more.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-15


Multi-information display

CAUTION After a few seconds, the information screen NOTE


returns from the fuel remaining warning dis-
l For petrol-powered vehicles, do not run out play to the previous screen. l On inclines or curves, the display may be in-
of fuel, or the catalytic converter may be ad- correct due to the movement of fuel in the
If the remaining fuel level is reduced further,
versely affected. If the warning display ap- tank.
the information screen switches to the fuel re-
pears, refuel as soon as possible. l For the location of the vehicle identification
l For diesel-powered vehicles, do not drive maining warning display and the “ ” mark number, refer to “Vehicle identification
with an extremely low fuel level; running (B) on the fuel remaining display flashes number” on page 11-02.
quickly (about twice per second).
5 out of fuel could cause damage to the fuel
system.
*1: For vehicles with vehicle identification Service reminder
numbers that begin with “J” (except for E00522500708
NOTE diesel-powered 1600 models) or “4” Displays the approximate time until the next
(4WD vehicles) periodic inspection recommended by
l It may take several seconds to stabilise the
display after refilling the tank. MITSUBISHI MOTORS. “---” is displayed
*2: For vehicles with vehicle identification
l If fuel is added with the ignition switch or when the inspection time has arrived.
the operation mode is in ON, the fuel gauge
numbers that begin with or “J” (diesel-
may incorrectly indicate the fuel level. powered vehicles 1600 models) “4”
(2WD vehicles) NOTE
Fuel lid mark l Depending on the vehicle specifications, the
Type 1 displayed time until the next periodic inspec-
E00522300070
tion may differ from that recommended by
The arrow (A) indicates that the fuel tank fill- MITSUBISHI MOTORS.
er is located on the left side of the body. In addition, the display settings for the next
periodic inspection time can be modified.
Fuel remaining warning display To modify the display settings, have it adjus-
E00522402088 ted at a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
When the fuel is reduced to about 10 litres*1 Service Point.
Type 2 For more details, consult a MITSUBISHI
or 7 litres*2, the information screen switches
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
to the interrupt display of the fuel remaining
warning display, and the “ ” mark (B) on the
fuel remaining display flashes slowly (about
once per second).

5-16 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Multi-information display
Type 1 2. This informs you that a periodic inspec- To reset
tion is due. We recommend you to con-
The “---” display can be reset while the igni-
sult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
tion switch or the opertion mode is in OFF.
ized Service Point.
When the display is reset, the time until the
next periodic inspection is displayed and the
At that time, when the ignition switch is
warning display is no longer displayed when
switched from the “LOCK” position to
the ignition switch is turned from the
the “ON” position or the operation mode
Type 2
is changed from OFF to ON, the warn-
“LOCK” position to the “ON” position or the 5
operation mode is changed from OFF to ON.
ing display is displayed for a few sec-
1. When you lightly press the multi-infor-
onds on the information screen.
mation meter switch a few times, the in-
Type 1 formation screen switches to the service
reminder display screen.

Type 1
1. Displays the time until the next periodic
inspection.

Type 2
NOTE
l The distance is shown in units of 100 km
(100 miles). The time is shown in units of
months. Type 2

3. After your vehicle is inspected at a


MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
Service Point, it displays the time until
the next periodic inspection.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-17


Multi-information display
2. Press and hold the multi-information CAUTION Door ajar warning display
meter switch for about 2 seconds or screen (when the ignition
more to display “ ” and make it flash. l The customer is responsible for making sure
(If there is no operation for about 10 sec-
that periodic inspection and maintenance are switch or the operation mode is
performed. Inspections and maintenance ON)
onds with flashing, the display returns to must be performed to prevent accidents and
the previous screen.) malfunctions. E00522600565

3. Lightly press the multi-information me-


Type 1
ter switch while the icon is flashing to
5 change the display from “---” to NOTE
“CLEAR”. After this, the time until the l “---”display cannot be reset when the igni-
next periodic inspection will be dis- tion switch or the operation mode is in ON.
played. l When “---” is displayed, after a certain dis-
tance and a certain period of time, the dis-
play is reset and the time until the next peri- Type 2
Type 1
odic inspection is displayed.
l If you accidentally reset the display, we rec-
ommend you to consult a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.

If any of the doors or the tailgate is not com-


Type 2 pletely closed, this displays the open door or
tailgate.
If the vehicle speed exceeds approximately
8 km/h (5 mph) while a door is ajar, a buzzer
sounds 4 times. This notifies the driver that a
door is ajar.

CAUTION
l Before moving your vehicle, check that the
warning lamp is OFF.

5-18 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Multi-information display

Changing the function settings CAUTION NOTE


(when the ignition switch or the l For safety, stop the vehicle before operating. l If no operations are made within about 15
operation mode is ON) While driving, even if you operate the multi- seconds of the menu screen being displayed,
E00522701808
information meter switch, the function set- the display returns to the function setting
1. Stop the vehicle in a safe place. ting screen is not displayed. screen.
Firmly apply the parking brake and put
the gearshift lever into the “N” (Neutral) 3. Press and hold the multi-information 4. Select the item to change on the menu
position (M/T) or the selector lever into meter switch for about 2 seconds or screen and change to the desired setting. 5
the “P” (PARK) position (A/T or CVT). more to switch from the setting mode Refer to the following items for further
2. Lightly press the multi-information me- screen to the menu screen. details on the operation methods.
ter switch a few times to switch from the Refer to “Changing the reset mode for
information screen to the function set- Type 1 average fuel consumption and average
ting screen. speed” on page 5-20.
Refer to “Information screen (when the Refer to “Changing the fuel consump-
ignition switch or the operation mode is tion display unit” on page 5-21.
ON)” on page 5-10. Refer to “Changing the temperature
unit” on page 5-22.
Type 1 Type 2 Refer to “Changing the display lan-
Type 2 guage” on page 5-22.
Refer to “Operation sound setting” on
page 5-23.
Refer to “Changing the time until
“REST REMINDER” is displayed” on
page 5-24.
Refer to “Changing the turn-signal
sound” on page 5-25.
Refer to “Changing the momentary fuel
NOTE consumption display” on page 5-25.
l To return the menu screen to the function Refer to “Reset of low tyre pressure
setting screen, press and hold the multi-in- warning threshold” on page 6-63
formation meter switch for about 2 seconds
Refer to “Tyre ID set change” on page
or more.
6-64

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-19


Multi-information display
Refer to “Returning to the factory set- 2. Lightly press the multi-information me- Manual reset mode
tings” on page 5-25. ter switch to select “AVG” (average fuel
consumption and average speed setting). l When the average fuel consumption and
average speed are being displayed, if
Changing the reset mode for you hold down the multi-information
Type 1
average fuel consumption and meter switch, the average fuel consump-
average speed tion and average speed displayed at that
time are reset.
5 E00522900845
The mode conditions for the average fuel l When the following operation is per-
consumption and average speed display can formed, the mode setting is automatical-
be switched between “Auto reset” and “Man- ly switched from manual to auto.
ual reset”. Type 2
[Except vehicles equipped with keyless
1. Press and hold the multi-information operation system]
meter switch for about 2 seconds or Turn the ignition switch from the
more to switch from the setting mode “ACC” or “LOCK” position to the “ON”
screen to the menu screen. position.
Refer to “Changing the function settings [For vehicles equipped with the keyless
(when the ignition switch or the opera- operation system] Change the operation
tion mode is ON)” on page 5-19. mode from ACC or OFF to ON.
3. Press and hold the multi-information
Switching to auto occurs automatically.
meter switch for about 2 seconds or
If switching to manual mode is done,
more to switch in sequence from A or 1
however, the data from the last reset is
(Auto reset mode) → M, 2 or P (Manual
displayed.
reset mode) → A or 1 (Auto reset
mode). Auto reset mode
The setting is changed to the selected
mode condition. l When the average fuel consumption and
average speed are being displayed, if
you hold down the multi-information
meter switch, the average fuel consump-
tion and average speed displayed at that
time are reset.

5-20 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Multi-information display
l When the engine switch or the operation Changing the fuel consumption 3. Press and hold the multi-information
mode is in the following conditions, the meter switch for about 2 seconds or
average fuel consumption display and
display unit more to display “AVG UNIT” (fuel con-
E00523000579
average speed display are automatically The display unit for fuel consumption can be sumption display unit setting).
reset. switched. The distance, speed, and amount 4. Lightly press the multi-information me-
[Except vehicles equipped with keyless units are also switched to match the selected ter switch to switch in sequence from
operation system] fuel consumption unit. km/L → L/100 km → mpg (US) → mpg
The ignition switch is in the “ACC” or (UK) → RETURN → km/L.
“LOCK” position for about 4 hours or
1. Press and hold the multi-information 5
meter switch for about 2 seconds or
longer. more to switch from the setting mode Type 1 Type 2
[For vehicles equipped with keyless op- screen to the menu screen.
eration system] Refer to “Changing the function settings
The operation mode is in ACC or OFF (when the ignition switch or the opera-
for about 4 hours or longer. tion mode is ON)” on page 5-19.
2. Lightly press the multi-information me-
NOTE ter switch to select “AVG UNIT” (fuel
consumption display setting).
l The average fuel consumption display and
average speed display can be reset individu-
ally for the auto reset mode and manual reset Type 1
mode. 5. Press and hold the multi-information
l The memory of the auto reset mode or man-
meter switch for about 2 seconds or
ual reset mode for the average fuel con-
sumption display and average speed display more to change the setting to the selec-
is erased if the battery is disconnected. ted unit.
l The initial (default) setting is “Auto reset
mode”.
Type 2

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-21


Multi-information display

NOTE 1. Press and hold the multi-information NOTE


meter switch for about 2 seconds or
l The display units for the driving range, the more to switch from the setting mode l If the battery is disconnected, the unit setting
average fuel consumption, the average speed is erased from memory and is automatically
screen to the menu screen.
and the momentary fuel consumption are set to °C.
switched, but the units for the indicating Refer to “Changing the function settings
needle (speedometer), the odometer and the (when the ignition switch or the opera-
tripmeter will remain unchanged. tion mode is ON)” on page 5-19. Changing the display language
2. Lightly press the multi-information me-
5 l The memory of the unit setting is erased if
the battery is disconnected, and it returns au- ter switch to select “ ” (temperature The language of the multi-information dis-
E00523200715

tomatically to L/100 km. unit setting). play can be switched.


1. Press and hold the multi-information
The distance and speed units are also switch- Type 1
meter switch for about 2 seconds or
ed in the following combinations to match more to switch from the setting mode
the selected fuel consumption unit. screen to the menu screen.
Refer to “Changing the function settings
Distance Speed (when the ignition switch or the opera-
Fuel con-
(driving (average tion mode is ON)” on page 5-19.
sumption
range) speed)
L/100 km km km/h Type 2

mpg (US) mile(s) mph


mpg (UK) mile(s) mph
km/L km km/h

Changing the temperature unit


E00523100466
The display unit for temperature can be 3. Press and hold the multi-information
switched. meter switch for about 2 seconds or
more to switch in sequence from °C →
°F → °C.
The setting is changed to the selected
temperature unit.

5-22 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Multi-information display
2. Lightly press the multi-information me- NOTE 2. Lightly press the multi-information me-
ter switch to select “LANGUAGE” (lan- ter switch to select “ ” (operation sound
guage setting). l The memory of the language setting is setting).
erased if the battery is disconnected, and it
returns automatically to ENGLISH or RUS-
Type 1 SIAN. Type 1
l If “---” is selected in the language setting, a
warning message is not displayed when
there is a warning display or interrupt dis-
play.
5

Operation sound setting


Type 2 Type 2
E00523401714
You can turn off the operation sounds of the
multi-information meter switch and daytime
dipper button.
1. Press and hold the multi-information
meter switch for about 2 seconds or
more to switch from the setting mode
screen to the menu screen.
3. Press and hold the multi-information Refer to “Changing the function settings 3. Press and hold the multi-information
meter switch for about 2 seconds or (when the ignition switch or the opera- meter switch for about 2 seconds or
more to display “LANGUAGE” (lan- tion mode is ON)” on page 5-19. more to switch in sequence from ON
guage setting). (operation sound on) → OFF (operation
4. Lightly press the multi-information me- sound off) → ON (operation sound on).
ter switch to select the desired language. The setting is changed to the selected
5. If you hold down the multi-information condition.
meter switch for about 2 seconds or
more, the setting is changed to the selec-
ted language.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-23


Multi-information display

NOTE 2. Lightly press the multi-information me- 3. Press and hold the multi-information
ter switch to select “ALARM” (rest time meter switch for about 2 seconds or
l The memory of the operation sound setting setting). more to display “ALARM” (rest time
is erased if the battery is disconnected, and it
setting).
returns automatically to ON (operation
sound on). Type 1
l The operation sound setting only deactivates Type 1 Type 2
the operation sound of the multi-information
5 meter switch and daytime dipper button. The
warning display and other sounds cannot be
deactivated.

Changing the time until “REST Type 2

REMINDER” is displayed
E00523501715
The time until the display appears can be
changed. 4. Lightly press the multi-information me-
1. Press and hold the multi-information ter switch to select the time until the dis-
meter switch for about 2 seconds or play.
more to switch from the setting mode 5. Press and hold the multi-information
screen to the menu screen. meter switch for about 2 seconds or
Refer to “Changing the function settings more, the setting is changed to the selec-
(when the ignition switch or the opera- ted time.
tion mode is ON)” on page 5-19.

NOTE
l If the battery is disconnected, the unit setting
is erased from memory and is automatically
set to OFF.
l The drive time is reset when the ignition
switch is turned off or the operation mode is
put in OFF.

5-24 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Multi-information display

Changing the turn-signal sound 3. Press and hold the multi-information 2. Lightly press the multi-information me-
E00529101407 meter switch for about 2 seconds or ter switch to select (changing the
It is possible to change the turn-signal sound. more to switch in sequence from 1 (turn- momentary fuel consumption display)
1. Press and hold the multi-information signal sound 1) → 2 (turn-signal sound
meter switch for about 2 seconds or 2) → 1 (turn-signal sound 1).
more to switch from the setting mode The setting changes to the selected turn-
screen to the menu screen. signal sound.
Refer to “Changing the function settings 5
(when the ignition switch or the opera- Changing the momentary fuel
tion mode is ON)” on page 5-19.
2. Lightly press the multi-information me-
consumption display (Type 2)
E00529200195
ter switch to select (changing the It is possible to change the bar graph setting
turn-signal sound). of the momentary fuel consumption display.
1. Press and hold the multi-information
Type 1 meter switch for about 2 seconds or 3. Press and hold the multi-information
more to switch from the setting mode meter switch for about 2 seconds or
screen to the menu screen. more to switch in sequence from ON
Refer to “Changing the function settings (with the green bar graph) → OFF (with-
(when the ignition switch or the opera- out the green bar graph) → ON (with the
tion mode is ON)” on page 5-19. green bar graph).
Type 2 The setting changes to the selected bar
graph setting.

Returning to the factory set-


tings
E00523601888
Many of the function settings can be returned
to their factory settings.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-25


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list
1. Press and hold the multi-information 3. When you press and hold the multi-in-
meter switch for about 2 seconds or formation meter switch for about 5 sec-
more to switch from the setting mode onds or more, the buzzer sounds and all
screen to the menu screen. of the function settings are returned to
Refer to “Changing the function settings the factory settings.
(when the ignition switch or the opera-
tion mode is ON)” on page 5-19. NOTE
2. Lightly press the multi-information me-
5 ter switch to select “RESET” (returning l The factory settings are as follows.
to the factory settings). • Average fuel consumption and average
speed reset mode: A (Auto reset)
• Fuel consumption display unit: L/100 km
Type 1 • Temperature unit: °C (Celsius)
• Display language: ENGLISH or RUSSI-
AN
• Cooperative language setting: A
• Operation sounds: ON (Operation sounds
on)
• “REST REMINDER” display: OFF
Type 2 • Turn-signal sound: Turn-signal sound 1
• Momentary fuel consumption with the
green bar graph (Type 2): ON
l The low tyre pressure warning threshold and
tyre ID set cannot be returned to their facto-
ry settings.

Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list


E00523700013

5-26 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Indication and warning lamp list


E00523802210

1- Position lamp indication lamp 8- Tyre pressure monitoring system warn- 15- Active Stability Control (ASC) indica-
® p. 5-44 ing lamp* ® p. 6-60 tor* ® p. 6-53
2- High-beam indication lamp ® p. 5-44 9- Brake warning lamp ® p. 5-45 16- Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) OFF indica-
3- Charge warning lamp ® p. 5-46 10- Cruise control indication lamp* tion lamp* ® p. 6-22
4- Turn-signal indication lamps/Hazard ® p. 6-55 17- Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) indication
warning indication lamps ® p. 5-44 11- Seat belt warning lamp ® p. 4-11 lamp* ® p. 6-19
5- Front fog lamp indication lamp* 12- Supplement Restraint System (SRS) 18- Diesel preheat indication lamp (diesel-
® p. 5-44 warning lamp ® p. 4-36 powered vehicles) ® p. 5-44
6- Rear fog lamp indication lamp 13- Check engine warning lamp ® p. 5-45 19- Information screen display list
® p. 5-44 14- Active Stability Control (ASC) OFF in- ® p. 5-28
7- Anti-lock brake system (ABS) warning dicator* ® p. 6-53
lamp ® p. 6-49

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-27


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Information screen display list


E00523900233
When there is information to be announced, such as lamp reminders, a sound is emitted and the screen switches to the displays shown below.
Refer to the appropriate page and take the necessary measures.
When the cause of the warning display is eliminated, the warning display goes out automatically.
Refer to “Warning display list (when the ignition switch or the operation mode is OFF)” on page 5-28.
Refer to “Warning display list (when the ignition switch or the operation mode is ON)” on page 5-32.
5 Refer to “Other interrupt displays” on page 5-40.

NOTE
l A warning may be displayed on the information screen and the buzzer may sound in the following rare cases.
This is caused by the system picking up interference such as noise or strong electromagnetic waves, and is not a functional problem.
• An extremely strong electromagnetic wave is received from a source such as an illegal radio set, a spark from a wire, or a radar station.
• Abnormal voltage or a static electricity discharge is generated by the operation of installed electrical equipment (including after-market parts).
If the warning display appears many times, we recommend you to consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Point.

Warning display list (when the ignition switch or the operation mode is OFF)
E00524000983

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l You have forgotten to turn off l Refer to “Lamps (headlamps,
the lamps. fog lamp, etc.) auto-cutout
function” on page 5-48.

5-28 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l The security alarm system is l Refer to “Security alarm sys-
operating. tem” on page 3-32.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-29


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l There is a fault in the keyless l Refer to “Keyless operation
operation system. system” on page 3-08.

––

l There is a fault in the elec- l We recommend you to con-


tronic immobilizer (Anti-theft sult a MITSUBISHI
–– starting system). MOTORS Authorized Service
Point.

5-30 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l The keyless operation key is l Insert the keyless operation
not detected. key into the key slot in the
glove box.
––
Refer to “If the keyless opera-
tion key is not operating prop-
erly” on page 3-20.
l You have forgotten to remove l Remove the keyless operation
5
the keyless operation key key from the key slot in the
–– from the key slot in the glove glove box.
box.

l The steering wheel is locked. l Press the engine switch.


Refer to “Steering wheel
–– lock” on page 3-17.

l The engine is stopped and the l On vehicles with A/T or


selector lever is in a position CVT, move the selector lever
–– other than the “P” (PARK) to the “P” (PARK) position to
position. put the operation mode in
OFF.
l The driver’s door is opened l Refer to “Steering wheel
with the steering wheel un- lock” on page 3-17.
–– locked.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-31


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l There is a fault in the electri- l Immediately stop the vehicle
cal system. in a safe place. We recom-
–– mend you to consult a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
thorized Service Point.

5
Warning display list (when the ignition switch or the operation mode is ON)
E00524102281

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l There is a fault in the EPS. l Have the vehicle inspected by
a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
Authorized Service Point as
soon as possible.
Refer to “Electric power
steering system (EPS)” on
page 6-36.

5-32 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l There is a fault in the keyless l Refer to “Keyless operation
operation system. system” on page 3-08.

––

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-33


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l The brake fluid level in the l Immediately stop the vehicle
reservoir has fallen to a low in a safe place.
level. We recommend you to con-
l There is a fault in the brake sult a MITSUBISHI
system. MOTORS Authorized Service
Point.
5 Refer to “Brake warning dis-
play” on page 5-46.
l There is a fault in the ABS. l Avoid sudden braking and
high-speed driving, stop the
vehicle in a safe place, and
take corrective measures. Re-
fer to “ABS warning” on page
6-49.
l The tyre pressure in one of l Refer to “Tyre pressure moni-
the tyres is low. toring system (TPMS)” on
page 6-59.

l There is a fault in the tyre l Refer to “Tyre pressure moni-


pressure monitoring system. toring system (TPMS)” on
page 6-59.

l One of the doors or the tail- l Close the door or tailgate.


gate is not completely closed. Refer to “Door ajar warning
The open door is displayed. display screen (when the igni-
tion switch or the operation
mode is ON)” on page 5-18.

5-34 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l The bonnet is open. l Close the bonnet.
Refer to “Bonnet” on page
10-03.

l There is a fault in the elec-


tronic immobilizer (Anti-theft
l Put the operation mode in
OFF, and then start the engine
5
starting system). again.
–– If the warning is not cancel-
led, please contact a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
thorized Service Point.
l The driver’s door is open and l Put the operation mode in
the operation mode is put in a OFF.
–– mode other than OFF. Refer to “Changing the opera-
tion mode” on page 3-14.

l There is a fault in the steering l Immediately stop the vehicle


wheel lock. in a safe place.
We recommend you to con-
––
sult a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service
Point.
l There is a fault in the electri- l Immediately stop the vehicle
cal system. in a safe place.
We recommend you to con-
––
sult a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service
Point.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-35


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l The engine is overheated. l Stop the vehicle in a safe
place and take corrective
measures.
Refer to “Engine overheat-
ing” on page 8-04.

5 l The automatic transmission


(A/T or CVT) fluid tempera-
l Refer to “Automatic transmis-
sion INVECS-II Sports Mode
ture is too high. 6A/T (Intelligent & Innova-
tive Vehicle Electronic Con-
trol System II)” on page
6-26.
l Refer to “Automatic transmis-
sion INVECS-III Sports
Mode 6CVT (Intelligent &
Innovative Vehicle Electronic
Control System III)” on page
6-32.
l You turned the ignition l Fasten your seat belt properly.
switch to the “ON” position “Seat belt warning” on page
or put the operation mode in 4-11.
ON without fastening your
seat belt.
l There is a fault in the fuel l We recommend you to con-
system. sult a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service
Point.

5-36 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l You are driving with the l Release the parking brake.
parking brake still applied. Refer to “Brake warning dis-
play” on page 5-46.

l There is a fault in the engine


oil circulation system.
l Immediately stop the vehicle
in a safe place. We recom-
5
mend you to have it checked.
Refer to “Oil pressure warn-
ing display” on page 5-48.
l There is a fault in the charg- l Immediately stop the vehicle
ing system. in a safe place. We recom-
mend you to consult a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
thorized Service Point.
Refer to “Charge warning dis-
play” on page 5-47.
l There is a fault in the SRS l We recommend you to have it
airbag or the pretensioner sys- checked, immediately.
tem. Refer to “Supplemental re-
straint System (SRS) warning
lamp” on page 4-36.
l There is an automatic head- l We recommend you to have it
lamp levelling fault. checked.
Refer to “Automatic head-
lamp levelling” on page
5-54.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-37


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l There is a fault in the Active l We recommend you to have it
Stability Control (ASC). checked.
Refer to “Active stability con-
trol (ASC)” on page 6-51.
l There is a fault in the hill start l Have the vehicle checked at a
assist. MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
5 thorized Service Point.
Refer to “Hill start assist” on
page 6-45.
l There is a fault in the elec- l We recommend you to have it
tronically controlled 4WD checked.
system. Refer to “Electronically con-
trolled 4WD system” on page
6-39.
l There is a fault in the A/T or l We recommend you to have it
CVT. checked.
Refer to “Automatic transmis-
sion INVECS-II Sports Mode
6A/T (Intelligent & Innova-
tive Vehicle Electronic Con-
trol System II)” on page
6-26.
Refer to “Automatic transmis-
sion INVECS-III Sports
Mode 6CVT (Intelligent &
Innovative Vehicle Electronic
Control System III)” on page
6-32.

5-38 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l The electronically controlled l Refer to “Electronically con-
4WD system is hot. trolled 4WD system” on page
6-39.

l The fuel additives are running


low.
l Refill the fuel additives at a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
5
thorized Service Point.

l The fuel is running low. l Refuel as soon as possible.


Refer to “Fuel remaining
warning display” on page
5-16.

l An excessive amount of par- l Refer to “Diesel particulate


ticulate matter (PM) accumu- filter (DPF)” on page 6-17.
lates inside the diesel particu-
late filter (DPF).

l It is suspected that the engine l Immediately have your vehi-


oil level has increased exces- cle checked by a
sively. MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
thorized Service Point.
Refer to “Engine oil level
warning display” on page
5-48.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-39


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Cause Solution (Reference)


l More than specified limit wa- l We recommend you to have it
ter has accumulated in the checked.
fuel filter. Refer to “Fuel filter indicator
display” on page 5-46 .

5 l The outside temperature is


3 °C (37 °F) or less.
l Be careful of ice on the road.
l The road can be icy even
when this warning is not dis-
played, so drive carefully.

Other interrupt displays


E00524200842

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 System operation status Reference


l When starting the engine, you l On vehicles with M/T, place
pressed the engine switch the gearshift lever in the “N”
without depressing the clutch (Neutral) position, fully de-
pedal (M/T). press the clutch pedal, depress
–– the brake pedal with the right
foot. Then, press the engine
switch. Refer to “Starting and
stopping the engine” on page
3-17.

5-40 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 System operation status Reference


l When starting the engine, the l On vehicles with A/T or
selector lever is in a position CVT, place the selector lever
other than the “P” (PARK) or in the “P” (PARK) position,
the “N” (NEUTRAL) posi- depress the brake pedal with
––
tion, or you pressed the en- the right foot. Then, press the
gine switch without depress- engine switch. Refer to
ing the brake pedal (A/T or “Starting and stopping the en- 5
CVT). gine” on page 3-17.

The operation status of each system is displayed on the information screen. Refer to the appropriate page for the system for further details.

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 System operation status Reference


l When “2WD” mode is selec- l Refer to “Electronically con-
ted with the drive mode selec- trolled 4WD system” on page
tor 6-39.

l When “4WD AUTO” mode is


selected with the drive mode
selector

l When “4WD LOCK” mode is


selected with the drive mode
selector

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-41


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 System operation status Reference


l When the Active Stability l Refer to “Active stability con-
Control (ASC) is operating trol (ASC)” on page 6-51.

5
This informs you that a periodic inspection is due.

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Solution


l We recommend you to have it checked. Refer to “Service remind-
er” on page 5-16 for further details.

The setting for rest interval can be changed.

5-42 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Indication lamp, warning lamp, and information screen display list

Screen type 1 Screen type 2 Solution


Stop the vehicle in a safe place, turn off the engine, and take a rest.
Use this display as rough guide for taking rests during a long drive.
The interval from the start of your trip until this message is displayed
can be set.
Refer to “Changing the function settings (when the ignition switch or
the operation mode is ON)” on page 5-19.
The display and buzzer alert the driver when the set time is reached. If 5
you continue to drive without having a rest, the buzzer sounds about
every 5 minutes to encourage you to take a rest.
l In the following cases, the time driven is reset and the display re-
turns to the previous display screen. After this, when the set time
is reached again, the buzzer and display encourage you to take a
rest.
• The buzzer sounds 3 times.
• Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” position or put the op-
eration mode in OFF.
• The multi-information meter switch is held for about 2 seconds
or more.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-43


Indication lamps

Indication lamps NOTE Position lamp indication lamp


E00508900173
E00501600100
l If these indication lamps blink too fast due
This indication lamp illumi-
to any operation other than sudden braking,
nates while the position
Turn-signal indication lamps/ the cause may be a blown lamp bulb or a
lamps are on.
faulty turn-signal connection.
Hazard warning indication
lamps
High-beam indication lamp
5 E00501700361
These indication lamps blink E00501800173 Diesel preheat indication lamp
in the following situations. This indication lamp illumi- (diesel-powered vehicles)
• When the turn-signal nates when the high-beam is
E00502300247
lever is moved to ac- used.
This indicates the glow plug
tivate a turn-signal preheat condition.
lamp. [Except for vehicles equip-
Refer to “Turn-signal ped with keyless operation
lever” on page 5-55.
Front fog lamp indication
system]
• When the hazard lamp* When the ignition switch is
warning flasher E00501900350
turned to the “ON” position, the lamp illumi-
switch is pressed to This lamp illuminates while nates. As the glow plug becomes hot, the
activate the hazard the front fog lamps are on. lamp goes out and the engine can be started.
warning lamps. [For vehicles equipped with keyless opera-
Refer to “Hazard tion system]
warning flasher When the operation mode is put in ON, the
switch” on page lamp illuminates and preheating of the glow
5-55. Rear fog lamp indication lamp
lamp starts automatically. As the glow plug
• When the hazard E00502001326
becomes hot, the lamp goes out and the en-
warning lamps auto- This lamp illuminates while
gine starts.
matically activate due the rear fog lamp is on.
to sudden braking
while driving.
Refer to “Emergency
stop signal system”
on page 6-48.
5-44 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5
Warning lamps

NOTE CAUTION Check engine warning lamp


E00502601960
l If the engine is cold, the diesel preheat indi- l In the situations listed below, brake perform- This lamp is a part of an on-
cation lamp is on for a longer time. ance may be compromised or the vehicle
board diagnostic system
l When the engine is warm, the diesel preheat may become unstable if brakes are applied
indication lamp does not come on even if the suddenly; consequently, avoid driving at which monitors the emis-
ignition switch is turned to the “ON” posi- high speeds or applying the brakes suddenly. sions, engine control system
tion or the operation mode is put in ON. Furthermore, the vehicle should be brought or A/T control system/CVT
to a stop in a safe location and to have it control system. 5
Warning lamps checked.
• The brake warning lamp does not illumi-
If a problem is detected in one of these sys-
E00502400147
nate when the parking brake is applied or
tems, this lamp illuminates or flashes.
does not turn off when the parking brake Although your vehicle will usually be driva-
Brake warning lamp is released. ble and not need towing, we recommend you
E00502502357 • The ABS warning lamp and brake warn- to have the system checked as soon as possi-
This lamp illuminates when ing lamp illuminate at the same time ble.
the ignition switch is turned For details, refer to “ABS warning lamp” This lamp will also illuminate when the igni-
on page 6-49. tion switch is turned “ON” or the operation
to the “ON” position or the
• The brake warning lamp remains illumi- mode is put in ON, and goes off after the en-
operation mode is put in ON, nated during driving.
and goes off after a few sec- gine has started. If it does not go off after the
l The vehicle should be brought to a halt in
onds. the following manner when brake perform- engine has started, we recommend you to
Always make sure that the lamp goes off be- ance has deteriorated. have the vehicle checked.
fore driving. • Depress the brake pedal harder than usual.
Even if the brake pedal moves down to
With the ignition switch or the operation
the very end of its possible stroke, keep it CAUTION
mode in ON, the brake warning lamp illumi-
pressed down hard. l Prolonged driving with this lamp on may
nates under the following conditions: • Should the brakes fail, use engine braking cause further damage to the emission control
l When the parking brake lever has been to reduce your speed and pull the parking system. It could also affect fuel economy
engaged. brake lever. and drivability.
l When the brake fluid level in the reser- Depress the brake pedal to operate the l If the lamp does not illuminate when the ig-
voir falls to a low level. stop lamp to alert the vehicles behind you. nition switch is turned to the “ON” position
l When the brake force distribution func- or the operation mode is put in ON, we rec-
tion is not operating correctly. ommend you to have the system checked.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-45


Information screen display

CAUTION CAUTION CAUTION


l If the lamp illuminates while the engine is l If it illuminates while the engine is running, l If this warning display is displayed we rec-
running, avoid driving at high speeds and there is a problem in the charging system. ommend you to have it checked.
have the system inspected by a Immediately park your vehicle in a safe Prolonged driving with the warning display
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv- place and we recommend you to have it shown may damage the engine.
ice Point as soon as possible. checked.
Accelerator pedal and brake pedal response
5 may be negatively influenced under these
Information screen display NOTE
conditions.
E00524600051 l If “REMOVE WATER IN SEPARATOR”
does not go out or appears frequently after
NOTE Fuel filter indicator display* removing the water, we recommend you to
E00529400083 consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
l The engine electronic control module ac- ized Service Point.
commodating the onboard diagnostic system Type 1
has various fault data (especially about the
exhaust emission) stored. Brake warning display
E00524700267

Charge warning lamp Type 1


E00502701192
This lamp illuminates when
the ignition switch is turned Type 2
“ON” or the operation mode
is put in ON, and goes off af-
ter the engine has started.
A warning is also displayed Type 2
on the multi-information display.
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position or the operation mode is put in
ON, if more water than the specified limit has
accumulated in the fuel filter, the warning
display is displayed on the information
screen in the multi-information display.

5-46 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Information screen display
This warning is displayed if you drive with The warning lamp in the instrument cluster Charge warning display
the parking brake still applied. The warning also illuminates. E00524800200
lamp in the instrument cluster only illumi-
nates when the parking brake is applied. Type 1
CAUTION
l If this warning stays illuminated and does
CAUTION not go out while driving, there is a danger of
ineffective braking. In this case, immediate-
l If a vehicle is driven without releasing the
parking brake, the brake will be overheated, ly park your vehicle in a safe place and we 5
resulting in ineffective braking and possible recommend you to have it checked.
brake failure. l If the brake warning display is displayed and
the brake warning lamp and the ABS warn- Type 2
If this warning is displayed, release the park-
ing brake. ing lamp are illuminated at the same time,
the braking force distribution function will
not operate, so the vehicle may be destabi-
Type 1 lised during sudden braking. Avoid sudden
braking and high-speed driving, stop the ve-
hicle in a safe place, and we recommend you
to have it checked.
If there is a fault with the charging system,
l The vehicle should be brought to a halt in
the following manner when brake perform- the warning display is displayed on the infor-
ance has deteriorated. mation screen in the multi-information dis-
• Depress the brake pedal harder than usual. play. The warning lamp in the instrument
Type 2 Even if the brake pedal moves down to cluster also illuminates.
the very end of its possible stroke, keep it
pressed down hard.
• Should the brakes fail, use engine braking CAUTION
to reduce your speed and pull the parking
brake lever. l If the warning is displayed while the engine
is running, immediately park your vehicle in
Depress the brake pedal to operate the
a safe place and we recommend you to have
stop lamp to alert the vehicles behind you.
When the ignition switch is turned to the it checked.
“ON” position or the operation mode is put in
ON, if the brake fluid is low, this warning is
displayed.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-47


Combination headlamps and dipper switch

Oil pressure warning display Engine oil level warning dis- NOTE
E00524900214 play* l Immediately have your vehicle checked by a
Type 1 E00526700072 MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point.
Type 1

Combination headlamps
5 and dipper switch
E00506003588

Type 2
Type 2 Headlamps
NOTE
l When entering a country in which vehicles
are driven on the opposite side of the road to
If the engine oil pressure drops while the en- the country in which your vehicles is sup-
plied, necessary measures have to be taken
gine is running, the warning display is dis- When the ignition switch or the operation to avoid dazzling oncoming traffic. Howev-
played on the information screen in the multi- mode is in ON, if it is suspected that the en- er, headlamps on this vehicle do not need
information display. gine oil level has increased excessively, the any adjustment.
warning display is displayed on the informa- l Do not leave the lights on for a long time
while the engine is stationary (not running).
CAUTION tion screen in the multi-information display.
A rundown battery could result.
l If the vehicle is driven while the engine oil l When it rains, or when the vehicle has been
is low, or the oil level is normal but the CAUTION washed, the inside of the lens sometimes be-
warning is displayed, the engine may burn comes foggy, but this does not indicate a
out and be damaged. l If this warning is displayed while driving, functional problem.
stop the vehicle in a safe place, turn off the When the lamp is switched on, the heat will
l If the warning is displayed while the engine
engine, and check the engine oil level.
is running, immediately park your vehicle in remove the fog. However, if water gathers
Refer to “Engine oil” on page 10-05. inside the lamp, we recommend you to have
a safe place and check the engine oil level.
l If the warning is displayed while the engine it checked.
oil level is normal, have it inspected.

5-48 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Combination headlamps and dipper switch
Type 1 Type 2 With the ignition switch or
Rotate the switch to turn on the lamps. Rotate the switch to turn on the lamps. the operation mode is in
ON, headlamps, position,
tail, licence plate, and in-
strument panel lamps turn
on and off automatically in
accordance with outside
AUTO
light level. {Daytime run- 5
ning lamps (if so equipped)
will be turned on while the
tail lamps are off.} All
lamps turn off automatically
when the ignition switch is
turned to “OFF” position or
All lamps off { except daytime run- the operation mode is put in
OFF All lamps off {except day-
ning lamps (if so equipped)} OFF.
OFF time running lamps (if so
Position, tail, licence plate and instru- equipped)} Position, tail, licence plate
ment panel lamps on and instrument panel lamps
Headlamps and other lamps go on on
Headlamps and other lamps
go on

NOTE
l On vehicles with the rain sensor, the sensi-
tivity of the automatic on/off control can be
adjusted. For further information, contact a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-49


Combination headlamps and dipper switch

NOTE Lamps (headlamps, fog lamp, l If the following operation is performed


etc.) auto-cutout function while the lamp switch is in the “ ” po-
l When the headlamps are turned off by the sition, the lamps will remain on for
automatic on/off control with the ignition
l If the following operation is performed about 3 minutes while the driver’s door
switch in the “ON” position, the front fog
lamps (if so equipped) and rear fog lamps al- while the lamp switch is in the “ ” po- is shut and will then automatically go
so go off. When the headlamps are subse- sition, the lamps will automatically go out.
quently turned back on by the automatic out when the driver’s door is opened. [Except vehicles equipped with keyless
operation system]
5 on/off control, the front fog lamps also come
on but the rear fog lamp stays off. If you
[Except vehicles equipped with keyless
The ignition switch is turned to the
operation system]
wish to turn the rear fog lamp back on, oper- “LOCK” or “ACC” position, or the key
ate the switch again. The ignition switch is turned to the
“LOCK” or “ACC” position, or the key is removed from the ignition switch.
l Do not place anything on the automatic light
[For vehicles equipped with keyless op-
sensor (A), and do not clean with a glass is removed from the ignition switch.
cleaner. [For vehicles equipped with keyless op- eration system]
eration system] The operation mode is in OFF or ACC.
The operation mode is in OFF or ACC.
NOTE
[When the engine was started using the
key] l The lamp auto-cutout will not function when
the lamp switch is in the “ ” position.
• If the key is removed and the driver’s
l The lamp auto-cutout function can also be
door is opened, a buzzer sounds at a disabled.
high pitch intermittently to remind the For further information, we recommend you
driver to turn off the lamps. to consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
thorized Service Point.
[When the engine was started using the
keyless operation function]
l If the lamps do not turn on or off with the • If the operation mode is put in OFF
switch in the “AUTO” position, manually
and the driver’s door is opened, a buz-
operate the switch and we recommend you
to have your vehicle checked. zer sounds at a high pitch intermittent-
ly to remind the driver to turn off the
lamps.

5-50 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Combination headlamps and dipper switch
When you want to keep the NOTE Daytime running lamp*
lamps on: E00530601079
The buzzer stops when the driver’s door is
1. In the following cases, turn the lamp closed. (The warning is also displayed on the
The daytime running lamps come on when
switch to the “OFF” position. multi-information display.) the engine is running and the lamp switch is
[Except vehicles equipped with keyless The buzzer stops in the following manner. in the “OFF” or “AUTO” position and the
operation system] • Turn the lamp switch to the “OFF” posi- tail lamps are off.
tion.
The ignition switch is in the “LOCK” or
“ACC” position.
• Close the driver’s door.
NOTE 5
[For vehicles equipped with keyless op-
Lamp monitor buzzer l If the lamp switch is in the “ ” or
eration system]
“ ”position, or if the tail lamps are on
The operation mode is in OFF or ACC. E00506100559 when the lamp switch is in the “AUTO” po-
2. Turn on the lamps with the switch in the [When the engine was started using the key] sition, the daytime running lamps come on
“ ” or “ ” position again, then the If the driver’s door is opened when the key is as position lamps. (type 2 only).
lamps will remain on. in the “LOCK” or “ACC” position or re-
moved from the ignition switch while the
NOTE lamps are on, a buzzer will sound to remind
the driver to turn off the lamps.
l When the engine was started using the key,
if the driver’s door is opened and the key is
[When the engine was started using the key-
removed, the lamp monitor buzzer sounds at
a high pitch intermittently.
less operation function]
The buzzer stops when the driver’s door is If the driver’s door is opened when the opera-
closed. (The warning is also displayed on the tion mode is in ACC or OFF with the lamps
multi-information display.) illuminated, a buzzer will sound to remind 1 - Daytime running lamp (type 1)
The buzzer stops in the following manner. the driver to turn off the lamps. 2 - Daytime running lamp (type 2)
• Turn the lamp switch to the “OFF” posi-
tion. In both cases, the buzzer will automatically
• Close the driver’s door. stop if the auto-cutoff function is activated,
l When the engine was started using the key-
the lamp switch is turned off, or the door is
less operation function, if the driver’s door is
opened and the operation mode is put in closed.
OFF, the lamp monitor buzzer sounds at a
high pitch intermittently.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-51


Combination headlamps and dipper switch

Dipper (High/Low beam NOTE This function turns on the position and tail
change) lamps for about 30 seconds after the UN-
l The high-beams can also flash when the LOCK switch (A) on the remote control
E00506200329 lamp switch is OFF.
When the lamp switch is in the “ ” posi- transmitter is pressed when the combination
l If you turn the lamps off with the headlamps
headlamps and dipper switch is in the “OFF”
tion, the beam changes from high to low (or set to high-beam, the headlamps are auto-
low to high) each time the lever is pulled matically returned to their low-beam setting or “AUTO” position (for vehicles equipped
fully (1). While the high-beam is on, the when the lamp switch is next turned to the with the automatic lamp control). On vehicles
equipped with automatic lamp control, the
5 high-beam indication lamp in the instrument “ ” position.
welcome light function will operate only
cluster will also illuminate.
when it is dark outside the vehicle.
Welcome light*
E00528901642

Headlamp flasher
E00506300199
NOTE
The high-beams flash when the lever is l While the welcome light function is operat-
pulled slightly (2), and will go off when it is ing, perform one of the following operations
released. to cancel the function.
When the high-beam is on, the high-beam in- • Push the LOCK switch (B) on the remote
control transmitter.
dication lamp in the instrument cluster will il-
luminate.

5-52 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Combination headlamps and dipper switch

NOTE 1. Turn the combination headlamps and 4. The headlamps will come on in the low-
dipper switch to the “OFF” or “AUTO” beam setting for about 30 seconds. After
position (for vehicles equipped with the the headlamps go off, the headlamps can
automatic lamp control). be turned on again in the low beam set-
2. Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” ting for about 30 seconds by pulling the
position or put the operation mode in turn signal lever towards you within 60
OFF. Also, if a key was used to start the seconds of turning the ignition switch to
engine, remove the key from the ignition the “OFF” position or putting the opera-
switch. tion mode in OFF.
5
3. Within 60 seconds of turning the igni- To turn on the headlamps again after 60
tion switch to the “OFF” position or put- seconds of turning the ignition switch to
ting the operation mode in OFF, pull the the “OFF” position or putting the opera-
turn signal lever towards you. tion mode in OFF, repeat the process
• Turn the combination headlamps and dip-
per switch to the “ ” or “ ” position.
from step 1.
• Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” posi-
tion or put the operation mode in ON. NOTE
l It is possible to modify functions as follows:
• The headlamps can be set to come on in l While the coming home light function is op-
the low beam setting. erating, perform one of the following opera-
• The welcome light function can be deacti- tions to cancel the function.
vated. • Pull the lever towards you.
For further information, please contact your • Turn the combination headlamps and dip-
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv- per switch to the “ ” or “ ” position.
ice Point. • Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” posi-
tion or put the operation mode in ON.
l It is possible to modify functions as follows:
Coming home light • The time that the headlamps remain on
E00529000526 can be changed.
This function turns on the headlamps in the • The coming home light function can be
low beam setting for about 30 seconds after deactivated.
the ignition switch is turned to the “OFF” po- For further information, please contact your
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
sition or the operation mode is put in OFF.
ice Point.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-53


Headlamp levelling

Headlamp levelling CAUTION Switch position Driver only/Driver + 1


0- front passenger
E00517400031
l Always perform adjustments before driving.
Do not attempt to adjust while driving, as it Switch position 5 passengers (including
Headlamp levelling switch (ex- could cause an accident. 1- driver)
cept for vehicles with discharge
Switch position 5 passengers (including
headlamps) Vehicle condition Switch position 2- driver) + Full luggage
E00517501677
loading
5 The angle of the headlamp beam varies de- “0”
pending on the load carried by the vehicle. Switch position Driver + Full luggage
The headlamp levelling switch can be used to 3- loading
adjust the headlamp illumination distance
(when the lower beam is illuminated) so that
Automatic headlamp levelling
“0”
the headlamps’ glare does not distract other (vehicles with discharge head-
drivers. lamps)
Set the switch according to the following ta- E00517600453
ble. “1” This mechanism automatically adjusts the di-
rection of the headlamps (beam position) de-
pending on changes in the condition of the
vehicle, such as the number of occupants or
luggage weight. When the headlamps are il-
“2”
luminated with the ignition switch or the op-
eration mode in ON, the beam position of the
headlamps is automatically adjusted when the
vehicle is stopped.
“3”

●:1 person
:Full luggage loading

5-54 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Turn-signal lever
Headlamp automatic levelling Turn-signal lever NOTE
system warning display E00506501592
l If the lamp flashes unusually quickly, the
Type 1 bulb in a turn-signal lamp may have burned
out. We recommend you to have the vehicle
inspected.
l It is possible to activate the following func-
tions.
• Flashing of the turn-signal lamps when
the lever is operated with the ignition
5
switch or the operation mode is in ACC.
Type 2 • Deactivate the turn-signal lamp 3-flash
function for lane changes.
• The time required to operate the lever for
1- Turn-signals the 3-flash function can be adjusted.
For further information, we recommend you
When making a normal turn, use posi-
to consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
tion (1). The lever will return automati- thorized Service Point.
cally when cornering is completed.
If there is a fault in the automatic headlamp 2- Lane-change signals
levelling system, the warning display is dis- When moving the lever to (2) slightly to Hazard warning flasher
played on the information screen in the multi- change a lane, the turn-signal lamps and switch
information display. indication lamp in the instrument cluster
E00506600860
will only flash while the lever is operat-
ed. Use the hazard warning flasher switch when
CAUTION Also, when you move the lever to (2) the vehicle has to be parked on the road for
l If a warning is displayed, the system may be slightly then release it, the turn-signal any emergency.
malfunctioning, so we recommend you to lamps and indication lamp in the instru- The hazard warning flashers can always be
have your vehicle inspected.
ment cluster will flash 3 times. operated, regardless of the ignition switch po-
sition or the operation mode.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-55


Fog lamp switch
Push the switch to turn on the hazard warning Fog lamp switch NOTE
flashers, all turn-signal lamps flash continu-
ously. To turn them off, push the switch
E00506700034
l The front fog lamps are automatically turned
off when the headlamps or tail lamps are
again. Front fog lamp switch* turned off. To turn the front fog lamps on
E00508300702 again, turn the knob in the “ON” direction
The front fog lamps can be operated while after turning on the headlamps or tail lamps.
the headlamps or tail lamps are on. Turn the l Do not use fog lamps except in conditions of
knob in the “ON” direction to turn on the
5 front fog lamps. An indication lamp in the in-
fog, otherwise excessive lamp glare may
temporarily blind oncoming vehicle drivers.
strument cluster will also come on. Turn the
knob in the “OFF” direction to turn off the Rear fog lamp switch
front fog lamps. The knob will automatically
E00508400572
return to its original position when you re- The rear fog lamp can be operated when the
lease it. headlamps or front fog lamps (if so equipped)
turn on.
An indication lamp in the instrument cluster
NOTE comes on when the rear fog lamp is turned
l While the hazard warning lamps are blinking on.
due to having manually pushed the switch,
the emergency stop signal system does not [Vehicle without front fog lamps]
operate. Turn the knob once in the “ON” direction to
Refer to “Emergency stop signal system” on
turn on the rear fog lamp. To turn the rear fog
page 6-48.
lamp off, turn the knob once in the “OFF” di-
rection. The knob will automatically return to
its original position when you release it.

[Vehicle with front fog lamps]

5-56 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Wiper and washer switch
Turn the knob once in the “ON” direction to NOTE Except for vehicles equipped
turn on the front fog lamps. Turn the knob with rain sensor
once more in the “ON” direction to turn on l To turn the rear fog lamp on again, turn the
knob twice in the “ON” direction after turn- The windscreen wipers can be operated with
the rear fog lamp. To turn the rear fog lamp
ing on the headlamps. (Vehicle with front the ignition switch or the operation mode is
off, turn the knob once in the “OFF” direc- fog lamps) in ON or ACC.
tion. Turn the knob once more in the “OFF”
If the blades are frozen to the windscreen or
direction to turn off the front fog lamps. The
rear window, do not operate the wipers until
knob will automatically return to its original Wiper and washer switch the ice has melted and the blades are freed, 5
position when you release it. E00507101218
otherwise the wiper motor may be damaged.
CAUTION
l If the washer is used in cold weather, the
washer fluid sprayed against the glass may
freeze, which may hinder visibility. Warm
the glass with the defroster or rear window
demister before using the washer.

Windscreen wipers
E00516900648

NOTE
NOTE MIST Misting function
l To ensure a clear rearward view, the rear
- The wipers will operate once.
l The rear fog lamp is automatically turned off window wiper will automatically perform
when the headlamps or front fog lamps (if so several continuous operations if the gearshift
equipped) are turned off. OFF- Off
lever or the selector lever is put in the “R”
l To turn the rear fog lamp on again, turn the position while the windscreen wipers are op- INT- Intermittent (Speed sensitive)
knob once in the “ON” direction after turn- erating.
ing on the headlamps. (Vehicle without front LO- Slow
Refer to “Rear window wiper and washer”
fog lamps) on page 5-61. HI- Fast

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-57


Wiper and washer switch

To adjust intermittent intervals The wipers will operate once if the wiper lev- If the blades are frozen to the windscreen or
er is raised to the “MIST” position and re- rear window, do not operate the wipers until
With the lever in the “INT” (speed-sensitive) leased. This operation is useful when it is the ice has melted and the blades are freed,
position, the intermittent intervals can be ad- drizzling, etc. The wipers will continue to op- otherwise the wiper motor may be damaged.
justed by turning the knob (A). erate while the lever is held in the “MIST”
position.

MIST- Misting function


1- Fast The wipers will operate once.
2- Slow
Vehicles with rain sensor OFF- Off
E00517001555
AU- Auto-wiper control
NOTE The windscreen wipers can be operated with TO- Rain sensor
the ignition switch or the operation mode is
l The speed-sensitive-operation function of The wipers will automatically oper-
the windscreen wipers can be deactivated. in ON or ACC. ate depending on the degree of wet-
For further information, we recommend you ness on the windscreen.
to consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
thorized Service Point. LO- Slow
HI- Fast
Misting function
The misting function can be operated with Rain sensor
the ignition switch or the operation mode is Can only be used when the ignition switch or
in ON or ACC. the operation mode is in ON.

5-58 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Wiper and washer switch
If the lever is put in the “AUTO” position, CAUTION NOTE
the rain sensor (A) will detect the extent of
rain (or snow, other moisture, dust, etc.) and • When cleaning the outside surface of the • When the wipers do not operate even
windscreen, if you touch on top of the though it is raining.
the wipers will operate automatically.
Keep the lever in the “OFF” position if the
rain sensor. l The wipers may automatically operate when
• When cleaning the outside surface of the things such as insects or foreign objects are
windscreen is dirty and the weather is dry. windscreen, if you wipe with a cloth on affixed to the windscreen on top of the rain
Wiper operation under these conditions can top of the rain sensor. sensor or when the windscreen is frozen.
scratch the windscreen and damage the wip-
ers.


When using an automatic car wash.
A physical shock is applied to the wind-
Objects affixed to the windscreen will stop
the wipers when the wipers cannot remove
5
screen. them. To operate the wipers again, move the
• A physical shock is applied to the rain lever in the “LO” or “HI” position.
sensor. Also, the wipers may operate automatically
due to strong direct sunlight or electromag-
netic wave. To stop the wipers, place the
NOTE lever in the “OFF” position.
l Contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
l To protect the rubber parts of the wipers, ized Service Point when replacing the wind-
this operation of the wipers does not take screen or reinforcing the glass around the
place even if the lever is put in the “AUTO” sensor.
position when the vehicle is stationary and
the ambient temperature is about 0 °C or
lower.
l Do not cover the sensor by affixing a sticker
CAUTION or label to the windscreen. Also, do not put
any water-repellent coating on the wind-
l With the ignition switch or the operation screen. The rain sensor would not be able to
mode in ON and lever in the “AUTO” posi- detect the extent of rain, and the wipers
tion, the wipers may automatically operate might stop working normally.
in the situations described below. l In the following cases, the rain sensor may
If your hands get trapped, you could suffer be malfunctioning.
injuries or the wipers could malfunction. Be For further information, we recommend you
sure to turn the ignition switch to the “OFF” to consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
position or put the operation mode in OFF, thorized Service Point.
or move lever to the “OFF” position to deac- • When the wipers operate at a constant in-
tivate the rain sensor. terval despite changes in the extent of
rain.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-59


Wiper and washer switch

To adjust the sensitivity of the rain sensor. Misting function The wipers will operate once if the lever is
moved to the “AUTO” position and the knob
With the lever in the “AUTO” (rain sensor) Move the lever in the direction of the arrow (C) is turned in the “+” direction when the ig-
position, it is possible to adjust the sensitivity and release, to operate the wipers once. nition switch is in the “ON” position or the
of the rain sensor by turning the knob (B). Use this function when you are driving in operation mode is in ON.
mist or drizzle.
The wipers will operate once if the lever is
raised to the “MIST” position and released
5 when the ignition switch or the operation
mode is in the “ON” or “ACC” position. The
wipers will continue to operate while the lev-
er is held in the “MIST” position.

“+”- Higher sensitivity to rain


“-”- Lower sensitivity to rain
Windscreen washer*
E00507201293
The windscreen washer can be operated with
NOTE the ignition switch or the operation mode in
l It is possible to activate the following func- ON or ACC.
tions. The washer fluid will be sprayed onto the
• Automatic operation (rain droplet sensi- windscreen by pulling the lever towards you.
tive) can be changed to intermittent opera- When the wipers are not in operation or in in-
tion (vehicle-speed sensitive). termittent operation, by pulling the lever to-
• Automatic operation (rain droplet sensi- wards you, the wipers will operate several
tive) can be changed to intermittent opera-
tion (except vehicle-speed sensitive). times while the washer fluid is being sprayed.
For further information, we recommend you Except for vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan
to consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au- and Ukraine, then about 6 seconds later, wip-
thorized Service Point. ers operate once more.

5-60 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Wiper and washer switch
On vehicles equipped with a headlamp wash- NOTE Rear window wiper and wash-
er, while the headlamps are on, the headlamp er
washer will operate once together with the l It is possible to modify functions as follows:
windscreen washer. • Causing the wiper never to operate when E00507301340

washer fluid is sprayed. The rear window wiper and washer switch
Also, except for vehicles for Russia, Kazakh- can be operated with the ignition switch or
• Except for vehicles for Russia, Kazakh-
stan and Ukraine, by releasing the lever soon stan and Ukraine, deactivating the com- the operation mode in ON or ACC.
after pulling it towards you, the washer fluids fort washer.
will be sprayed several times while the wip-
ers are operating several times. (Comfort
• Except for vehicles for Russia, Kazakh-
stan and Ukraine, deactivating the func-
5
washer) Then about 6 seconds later, wipers tion that operates the wipers once more
about 6 seconds later.
operate once more.
• Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Uk-
Comfort washer will stop operating with any raine, activating the comfort washer.
operation of the lever. • Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Uk-
raine, the wipers can be set to operate
again after about 6 seconds.
For further information, we recommend you
to consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
thorized Service Point.
INT- The wiper operates continuously
for several seconds then oper-
ates intermittently at intervals of
about every 8 seconds
OFF- Off
The washer fluid will be sprayed
- onto the rear window when the
CAUTION knob is turned fully in either di-
l If the washer is used in cold weather, the rection.
washer fluid sprayed against the glass may The wipers operate automatical-
freeze resulting in poor visibility. Heat the ly several times while the wash-
glass with the defroster or demister before
using the washer.
er fluid is being sprayed.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-61


Wiper and washer switch

NOTE Headlamp washer switch* Precautions to observe when


l The rear window wiper will automatically
E00510101469 using wipers and washers
perform several continuous operations if the
The headlamp washer can be operated with E00507601330

gearshift lever or the selector lever is put in the ignition switch or the operation mode in l If the moving wipers become blocked
the “R” position while the windscreen wip- ON or ACC and the lamp switch at the “ ” partway through a sweep by ice or other
ers or the rear window wiper is operating. position. deposits on the glass, the wipers may
(automatic operation mode). temporarily stop operating to prevent the
5 After the automatic operation, the rear win-
dow wiper will stop operating if the knob is
Push the button once and the washer fluid motor from overheating. In this case,
will be sprayed on to the headlamps. park the vehicle in a safe place, turn the
in the “OFF” position. If the knob is in the
“INT” position, the rear window wiper will ignition switch to the “OFF” position or
return to the intermittent operation. put the operation mode in OFF, and then
It is possible to set the rear window wiper to remove the ice or other deposits.
perform the automatic operation only if the The wipers will start operating again af-
gearshift lever or the selector lever is put in ter the wiper motor cools down, so
the “R” position while the rear window wip-
check that the wipers operate before us-
er is operating with the knob in the “INT”
position. ing them.
For further information, we recommend you l Do not use the wipers when the glass is
to consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au- dry.
thorized Service Point. They may scratch the glass surface and
l If the knob is in the “OFF” position, turn the the blades wear out prematurely.
knob to the “INT” position twice quickly to l Before using the wipers in cold weather,
operate the rear window wiper continuously. NOTE check that the wiper blades are not fro-
(continuous operation mode)
Turn the knob to the “OFF” position to stop l If the ignition switch or the operation mode zen onto the glass. The motor may burn
the rear window wiper continuous operation. is in ON or ACC and the headlamps are on, out if the wipers are used with the blades
l The interval for intermittent operation can be the headlamp washer operates together with frozen onto the glass.
adjusted. the windscreen washer the first time the l Avoid using the washer continuously for
For further information, we recommend you windscreen washer lever is pulled. more than 20 seconds. Do not operate
to consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au- the washer when the fluid reservoir is
thorized Service Point. empty.
Otherwise, the motor may burn out.

5-62 Instruments and controls OGAE15E5


Rear window demister switch
l Periodically check the level of washer The indication lamp (A) will illuminate while Horn switch
fluid in the reservoir and refill if re- the demister is on.
E00508000682
quired.
During cold weather, add a recommen- Press the steering wheel on or around the
ded washer solution that will not freeze “ ” mark.
in the washer reservoir. Failure to do so
could result in loss of washer function
and frost damage to the system compo-
nents.
5

Rear window demister


switch
E00507901186

The rear window demister switch can be op- NOTE


erated when the engine is running. l When the rear window demister switch is
Push the switch to turn on the rear window pressed, the outside rear-view mirrors are
demister. It will be turned off automatically defogged or defrosted. Refer to “Heated mir-
in about 20 minutes. To turn off the demister ror” on page 6-12.
within about 20 minutes, push the switch l The demister switch is not to melt snow but
to clear mist.
again. Remove snow before use of the demister
switch.
l When cleaning the inside of the rear win-
dow, use a soft cloth and wipe gently along
the heater wires, being careful not to damage
the wires.
l Do not allow objects to touch the inside of
the rear window glass, damaged or broken
wires may result.

OGAE15E5 Instruments and controls 5-63


OGAE15E5
Starting and driving

Economical driving............................................................................. 6-02 Emergency stop signal system............................................................ 6-48


Driving, alcohol and drugs..................................................................6-03 Anti-lock brake system (ABS)............................................................6-48
Safe driving techniques.......................................................................6-03 Electric power steering system (EPS).................................................6-50
Running-in recommendations............................................................. 6-04 Active stability control (ASC)*.......................................................... 6-51
Parking brake...................................................................................... 6-06 Cruise control*....................................................................................6-54 6
Parking................................................................................................ 6-07 Tyre pressure monitoring system (TPMS)*........................................6-59
Steering wheel height and reach adjustment.......................................6-08 Reversing sensor system*................................................................... 6-64
Inside rear-view mirror....................................................................... 6-08 Rear-view camera*............................................................................. 6-68
Outside rear-view mirrors................................................................... 6-10 Cargo loads......................................................................................... 6-71
Ignition switch.....................................................................................6-12 Trailer towing......................................................................................6-72
Steering wheel lock.............................................................................6-13
Starting................................................................................................ 6-14
Diesel particulate filter (DPF)*...........................................................6-17
Turbocharger operation*.....................................................................6-18
Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system*..................................................... 6-19
Manual transmission*......................................................................... 6-23
Automatic transmission INVECS-II Sports Mode 6A/T
(Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control
System II)*......................................................................................6-26
Automatic transmission INVECS-III Sports Mode 6CVT
(Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control
System III)*.................................................................................... 6-32
Electronically controlled 4WD system*............................................. 6-39
4-wheel drive operation...................................................................... 6-41
Inspection and maintenance following rough road operation.............6-43
Cautions on handling of 4-wheel drive vehicles.................................6-43
Braking................................................................................................6-44
Hill start assist*...................................................................................6-45
Brake assist system............................................................................. 6-47

OGAE15E5
Economical driving

Economical driving Selecting the 4WD drive mode Tyre inflation pressure
E00600101076 (4WD vehicles)
Check the tyre inflation pressures at regular
For economical driving, there are some tech- The drive mode-selector should be set to intervals. Low tyre inflation pressure increa-
nical requirements that have to be met. The “2WD” when driving on normal roads and ses road resistance and fuel consumption. In
prerequisite for low fuel consumption is a express ways to obtain best possible fuel addition, low tyre pressures adversely affect
properly adjusted engine. In order to achieve economy. tyre wear and driving stability.
longer life of the vehicle and the most eco-
nomical operation, we recommend you to City traffic Cargo loads
6 have the vehicle checked at regular intervals
Do not drive with unnecessary articles in the
in accordance with the service standards. Frequent starting and stopping increases the
Fuel economy and generation of exhaust gas average fuel consumption. Use roads with luggage compartment. Especially during city
and noise are highly influenced by personal smooth traffic flow whenever possible. When driving where frequent starting and stopping
driving habits as well as the particular operat- driving on congested roads, avoid use of a is necessary, the increased weight of the ve-
ing conditions. The following points should low shift position at high engine speeds. hicle will greatly affect fuel consumption. Al-
be observed in order to minimize wear of so avoid driving with unnecessary luggage or
brakes, tyres and engine as well as to reduce Idling carriers, etc., on the roof; the increased air re-
environmental pollution. sistance will increase fuel consumption.
The vehicle consumes fuel even during
Starting the engine idling. Avoid extended idling whenever pos- Cold engine starting
sible.
Avoid sudden acceleration and sudden starts, Starting of a cold engine consumes more
as they will increase fuel consumption. Speed fuel.
Unnecessary fuel consumption is also caused
Shifting At higher vehicle speed, more fuel is con- by keeping a hot engine running. After the
sumed. Avoid driving at full speed. Even a engine is started, commence driving as soon
Shift only at an appropriate speed and engine slight release of the accelerator pedal will as possible.
speed. Always use the highest shift position save a significant amount of fuel.
possible. Air conditioning
The use of the air conditioning will increase
the fuel consumption.

6-02 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Driving, alcohol and drugs

Driving, alcohol and drugs Seat belts Carrying children in the vehi-
E00600200070 cle
Before starting the vehicle, make sure that
Driving after drinking alcohol is one of the you and your passengers have fastened your l Never leave your vehicle unattended
most frequent causes of accidents. seat belts. with the key and children inside the ve-
Your driving ability can be seriously im- hicle. Children may play with the driv-
paired even with blood alcohol levels far be- Floor mats ing controls and this could lead to an ac-
low the legal minimum. If you have been cident.
drinking, don’t drive. Ride with a designated WARNING l Make sure that infants and small chil-
non-drinking driver, call a cab or a friend, or
l Keep floor mats clear of the pedals by dren are properly restrained in accord- 6
use public transportation. ance with the laws and regulations, and
correctly laying floor mats that are suita-
Drinking coffee or taking a cold shower will ble for the vehicle. for maximum protection in case of an
not make you sober. To prevent the floor mats from slipping accident.
Similarly, prescription and nonprescription out of position, securely retain them using l Prevent children from playing in the lug-
drugs affect your alertness, perception and re- the hook etc. gage compartment. It is quite dangerous
action time. Consult with your doctor or Note that laying a floor mat over a pedal
to allow them to play there while the ve-
pharmacist before driving while under the in- or laying one floor mat on top of another
can obstruct pedal operation and lead to a hicle is moving.
fluence of any of these medications.
serious accident.
Loading luggage
WARNING
When loading luggage, be careful not to load
l NEVER DRINK AND DRIVE.
above the height of seats. This is dangerous
Your perceptions are less accurate, your
reflexes are slower and your judgment is not only because rearward vision will be ob-
impaired. structed, but also the luggage may be projec-
ted into the passenger compartment under
hard braking.
Safe driving techniques
E00600300446

Driving safety and protection against injury


cannot be fully ensured. However, we recom-
mend that you pay extra attention to the fol-
lowing:

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-03


Running-in recommendations

Running-in recommendations
E00600403914

During the running-in period for the first 1,000 km (620 miles) it is advisable to drive your new vehicle using the following precautions as a
guideline to aid long life as well as future economy and performance.
l Do not race the engine at high speeds.
l Avoid rapid starting, accelerating, braking and prolonged high-speed running.
l Keep to the running-in speed limit shown below.
Please note that the legal speed limits displayed must be adhered to.
6 l Do not exceed loading limits.
l Refrain from towing a trailer.

Vehicles with M/T


Speed limit
Shift point Petrol-powered vehicles
Diesel-powered vehicles
1600 models 2000 models
1st gear 30 km/h (19 mph) 30 km/h (19 mph) 20 km/h (12 mph)
2nd gear 60 km/h (37 mph) 65 km/h (40 mph) 45 km/h (28 mph)
3rd gear 90 km/h (56 mph) 95 km/h (59 mph) 70 km/h (43 mph)
4th gear 120 km/h (74 mph) 120 km/h (74 mph) 95 km/h (59 mph)
5th gear 120 km/h (74 mph) 125 km/h (78 mph) 120 km/h (74 mph)
6th gear - - 120 km/h (74 mph)

6-04 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Running-in recommendations

Vehicles with A/T


Shift point Speed limit
1st gear 15 km/h (9 mph)
2nd gear 35 km/h (22 mph)
3rd gear 60 km/h (37 mph)
4th gear 80 km/h (50 mph)
6
5th gear 110 km/h (68 mph)
6th gear 125 km/h (78 mph)

Vehicles with CVT


Shift point Speed limit
“D” (DRIVE) 120 km/h (74 mph)
1st position 30 km/h (19 mph)
2nd position 50 km/h (30 mph)
3rd position 70 km/h (43 mph)
In sports mode
4th position 90 km/h (56 mph)
5th position 120 km/h (74 mph)
6th position 120 km/h (74 mph)

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-05


Parking brake

Parking brake CAUTION To release


E00600502833
l When you intend to apply the parking brake,
To park the vehicle, first bring it to a com- firmly press the brake pedal to bring the ve-
hicle to a complete stop before pulling the
plete stop, fully apply the parking brake lever parking brake lever.
sufficiently to hold the vehicle. Pulling the parking brake lever with the ve-
hicle moving could make the rear wheels
To apply lock up, thereby making the vehicle unsta-
ble. It could also make the parking brake
malfunction.
6
NOTE 1- Firmly depress and hold the brake pedal,
l Apply sufficient force to the parking brake then pull the lever up slightly.
lever to hold the vehicle stationary after the 2- Push the button at the end of hand grip.
foot brake is released. 3- Lower the lever fully.
l If the parking brake does not hold the vehi-
cle stationary after the foot brake is released,
have your vehicle checked immediately.

1- Firmly depress and hold the brake pedal,


then pull the lever up without pushing
the button at the end of hand grip.

6-06 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Parking

CAUTION CAUTION On vehicles equipped with A/T, CVT, apply


the parking brake and place the selector lever
l Before driving, be sure that the parking l If the brake warning lamp does not extin- into the “P” (PARK) position.
brake is fully released and brake warning guish when the parking brake is fully re-
If necessary, apply chocks to wheels.
lamp is off. leased, the brake system may be behaving
If you drive without the parking brake fully abnormal.
released, the warning display will appear on Have your vehicle checked immediately. Parking on an uphill slope
the information screen in the multi-informa- For details, refer to “Brake warning lamp” Turn the front wheels away from the kerb
tion display. on page 5-45.
and move the vehicle back until the kerb side
If a vehicle is driven without releasing the
parking brake, the brake will be overheated,
wheel gently touches the kerb.
resulting in ineffective braking and possible Parking On vehicles equipped with M/T, apply the 6
brake failure. E00600601664
parking brake and place the gearshift lever
into the 1st position.
Warning lamp To park the vehicle, fully engage the parking On vehicles equipped with A/T, CVT, apply
brake, and then move the gearshift lever to 1st the parking brake and place the selector lever
or “R” (Reverse) position for vehicles equip- into the “P” (PARK) position.
ped with M/T, or set the selector lever to “P” If necessary, apply chocks to wheels.
(PARK) position for vehicles equipped with
Warning display type 1 A/T or CVT.
NOTE
Parking on a hill l If your vehicle is equipped with A/T, CVT,
be sure to apply the parking brake before
To prevent the vehicle from rolling, follow moving selector lever to the “P” (PARK) po-
these procedures: sition. If you move the selector lever to the
“P” (PARK) position before applying the
Parking on a downhill slope parking brake, it may be difficult to disen-
Warning display type 2 gage the selector lever from the “P” (PARK)
Turn the front wheels towards the kerb and position when next you drive the vehicle, re-
move the vehicle forward until the kerb side quiring application of a strong force to the
wheel gently touches the kerb. selector lever to move from the “P” (PARK)
position.
On vehicles equipped with M/T, apply the
parking brake and place the gearshift lever
into the “R” (Reverse) position.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-07


Steering wheel height and reach adjustment

Parking with the engine run- When leaving the vehicle WARNING
ning l Do not attempt to adjust the steering
Always carry the key and lock all doors and
wheel while you are driving the vehicle.
Never leave the engine running while you the tailgate when leaving the vehicle unatten-
take a short sleep/rest. Also, never leave the ded.
engine running in a closed or poorly ventila- Always try to park your vehicle in a well lit Inside rear-view mirror
ted place. area. E00600801998

Steering wheel height and Adjust the rear-view mirror only after mak-
WARNING ing any seat adjustments so you have a clear
6 reach adjustment view to the rear of the vehicle.
l Leaving the engine running carries the
riskof injury or death from accidentally E00600700512

moving the gearshift lever (M/T) or the


1. Release the lever while holding the Type 1
selector lever (A/T or CVT) or the accu-
mulation of toxic exhaust fumes in the steering wheel up.
passenger compartment. 2. Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
position.
Where you park 3. Securely lock the steering wheel by pull-
ing the lever fully upward.
WARNING Type 2
l Do not park your vehicle in areas where
combustible materials such as dry grass
or leaves can come in contact with a hot
exhaust, since a fire could occur.

Do not keep the steering wheel


fully turned for a long time
More effort could be required to turn the
steering wheel. A- Locked
Refer to “Electric power steering system B- Release
(EPS)” on page 6-50.

6-08 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Inside rear-view mirror

WARNING To adjust the mirror position To reduce the glare


l Do not attempt to adjust the rear-view It is possible to move the mirror up/down and
mirror while driving. This can be danger- Type 1
ous.
left/right to adjust its position.
Always adjust the mirror before driving. The lever (A) at the bottom of the mirror can
be used to adjust the mirror to reduce the
Adjust the rear-view mirror to maximize the glare from the headlamps of vehicles behind
view through the rear window. you during night driving.

To adjust the vertical mirror 6


position
It is possible to move the mirror up and down
to adjust its position.

1- Normal
2- Anti-glare

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-09


Outside rear-view mirrors
Type 2 Outside rear-view mirrors 1. Place the lever (A) to the same side as
the mirror whose adjustment is desired.
When the headlamps of the vehicles behind E00600900628

you are very bright, the reflection factor of


the rear-view mirror is automatically changed
To adjust the mirror position Except for vehicles equipped with the mirror
E00601000642
retractor switch
to reduce the glare. The outside rear-view mirrors can be operat-
ed when the ignition switch or the operation
mode is in ON or ACC.

6 WARNING
Vehicles equipped with the mirror retractor switch
l Do not attempt to adjust the rear-view
mirrors while driving. This can be dan-
gerous.
Always adjust the mirrors before driving.
l Your vehicle is equipped with convex type
mirrors.
Please take into consideration, that ob-
jects you see in the mirror will look small- L- Left outside mirror adjustment
When the ignition switch is turned to the
er and farther away compared to a nor- R- Right outside mirror adjustment
“ON” position or the operation mode is put in mal flat mirror.
ON, the reflection factor of the mirror is au- Do not use this mirror to estimate dis-
tomatically changed. tance of following vehicles when changing 2. Press the switch (B) to the left, right, up
lanes. or down to adjust the mirror position.
1- Up
NOTE 2- Down
l Do not hang items on, or spray glass cleaner 3- Right
on the sensor (1), as reduced sensitivity 4- Left
could result. 3. Return the lever (A) back to the middle
position (•).

6-10 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Outside rear-view mirrors

Retracting and extending the [For vehicles equipped with the mirror re- CAUTION
outside mirrors tractor switch]
l It is possible to retract and extend the mir-
E00601100715
The outside mirror can be folded in towards
Retracting and extending the rors by hand. After retracting a mirror using
the mirror retractor switch, however, you
the side window to prevent damage when
mirrors using the mirror re- should extend it by using the switch again,
parking in narrow areas.
tractor switch not by hand. If you extended the mirror by
With the ignition switch or the operation hand after retracting it using the switch, it
would not properly lock in position. As a re-
mode in ON or ACC, push the mirror retrac-
CAUTION tor switch to retract the mirrors.
sult, it could move because of the wind or
vibration while you are driving, taking away
l Do not drive the vehicle with the mirror fol- Push it again to extend the mirrors to their your rearward visibility. 6
ded in. original positions.
The lack of rearward visibility normally pro-
After turning the ignition switch to the
vided by the mirror could lead to an acci-
dent. “LOCK” position or putting the operation NOTE
mode in OFF, it is possible to retract and ex- l Be careful not to get your hands trapped
tend the mirrors using the mirror retractor while a mirror is moving.
[Except for vehicles equipped with the switch for about 30 seconds.
mirror retractor switch]
l If you move a mirror by hand or it moves af-
ter hitting a person or object, you may not be
Push the mirror towards the back of the vehi- able to return it to its original position using
cle with your hand to retract it in. When ex- the mirror retractor switch. If this happens,
tending the mirror, pull it out towards the push the mirror retractor switch to place the
front of the vehicle until it clicks to lock in mirror in its retracted position and then push
place. the switch again to return the mirror to its
original position.
l When freezing has occurred and mirrors fail
to operate as intended, please refrain from
repeated pushing of the retractor switch as
this action can result in burn-out of the mir-
ror motor circuits.

Retracting and extending the


mirrors without using the mir-
ror retractor switch
[Vehicles with keyless entry system]

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-11


Ignition switch
The mirrors automatically retract or extend NOTE Ignition switch
when the doors are locked or unlocked using
the remote control switches of the keyless en- • Automatically retract when the driver’s E00601401845

door is opened after turning the ignition [For vehicles equipped with keyless opera-
try system.
switch to the “LOCK” position or putting
Refer to “Keyless entry system” on page the operation mode in OFF.
tion system]
3-04. • Automatically extend when the vehicle For information on operations for vehicles
[Vehicles equipped with keyless operation speed reaches 30 km/h (19 mph). equipped with the keyless operation system,
system] • Deactivate the automatic extension func- refer to “Keyless operation system: Engine
The mirrors automatically retract or extend tion. switch” on page 3-13.
6 when the doors are locked or unlocked using
[Except for vehicles equipped with keyless
the remote control switches or the keyless op- Heated mirror
eration function of the keyless operation sys- operation system]
E00601200497
tem. To demist or defrost the outside rear-view
Refer to “Keyless operation system: To oper- mirrors, press the rear window demister
ate using the keyless operation function, Key- switch.
less entry system” on pages 3-11 and 3-22. The indication lamp (A) will illuminate while
the demister is on.
NOTE The heater will be turned off automatically in
about 20 minutes.
l Functions can be modified as stated below.
Consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
ized Service Point.
• Automatically extend when the following
operation is performed.
[Except vehicles equipped with keyless LOCK
operation system]
Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” or The engine is stopped and the steering wheel
“ACC” position.
locked. The key can only be inserted and re-
[Vehicles equipped with keyless operation
system] moved in this position.
Put the operation mode in ON or ACC.
ACC
The engine is stopped, but the audio system
and other electric devices can be operated.
6-12 Starting and driving OGAE15E5
Steering wheel lock

ON NOTE CAUTION
The engine is running, and all the vehicle’s l It is possible to modify functions as follows: l Do not remove the ignition key from the ig-
electrical devices can be operated. • The time until the power cuts out can be nition switch while driving. The steering
changed to approximately 60 minutes. wheel will be locked, causing loss of con-
• The ACC power auto-cutout function can trol.
START be deactivated. l If the engine is stopped while driving, the
For details, we recommend you to consult brake servomechanism will cease to function
The starter motor operates. After the engine a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized and braking efficiency will deteriorate. Also,
has started, release the key and it will auto- Service Point. the power steering system will not function
and it will require greater manual effort to
matically return to the “ON” position.
operate the steering. 6
To remove the key l Do not leave the key in the “ON” position
NOTE E00620400528 for a long time when the engine is not run-
1. Set the selector lever to the “P” (PARK) ning, doing so will cause the battery to be
l Your vehicle is equipped with an electronic discharged.
immobilizer. position (A/T or CVT).
To start the engine, the ID code transmitted 2. Push the key in at the “ACC” position l Do not turn the key to the “START” position
by the transponder inside the key must while the engine is running. Doing so could
and keep it depressed until it is turned to
match the code registered in the immobilizer damage the starter motor.
the “LOCK” position and remove it.
computer.
Refer to “Electronic immobilizer (Anti-theft
starting system)” on page 3-03. Steering wheel lock
E00601500676

ACC power auto-cutout func- [For vehicles equipped with keyless opera-
tion tion system]
For information on operations for vehicles
E00620300224
After about 30 minutes has elapsed with the equipped with the keyless operation system,
ignition switch in the “ACC” position, the refer to “Keyless operation system: Steering
function automatically cuts out the power for wheel lock” on page 3-17.
the audio system and other electric devices [Except for vehicles equipped with keyless
that can be operated with that position. operation system]
When the ignition switch is turned from the
“ACC” position, the power is supplied again
to those devices.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-13


Starting

To lock Starting Starting the engine (petrol-


E00620601370 powered vehicles)
Remove the key at the “LOCK” position.
E00620701632
Turn the steering wheel until it is locked. [For vehicles equipped with keyless opera-
Tips for starting tion system]
To unlock For information on operations for vehicles
l Do not operate the starter motor continu-
ously longer than 10 seconds; doing so equipped with the keyless operation system,
Turn the key to the “ACC” position while
could run down the battery. If the engine refer to “Keyless operation system: Starting”
moving the steering wheel slightly right and
does not start, turn the ignition switch on page 3-18.
6 left.
back to “LOCK”, wait a few seconds,
and then try again. Trying repeatedly [Except vehicles equipped with keyless op-
with the starter motor still turning will eration system]
damage the starter mechanism. The starting procedure is as follows:
1. Insert the ignition key and fasten the seat
belt.
WARNING 2. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
l Never run the engine in a closed or poorly 3. Press and hold the brake pedal down
ventilated area any longer than is needed firmly with your right foot.
to move your vehicle in or out of the area. 4. Fully depress the clutch pedal (M/T).
Carbon monoxide gases are odourless and 5. On vehicles equipped with M/T, place
can be fatal.
the gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral)
position.
CAUTION
CAUTION
l Remove the key when leaving the vehicle.
In some countries, it is prohibited to leave l Never attempt to start the engine by pushing
the key in the vehicle when parked. or pulling the vehicle.
l Do not run the engine at high rpm or drive
the vehicle at high speed until the engine has
had a chance to warm up.
l Release the ignition key as soon as the en-
gine starts to avoid damaging the starter mo-
tor.

6-14 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Starting
On vehicles equipped with CVT, make NOTE 3. If the engine still will not start, the en-
sure the selector lever is in the “P” gine could be flooded with too much
(PARK) position. l Minor noises may be heard on engine start- petrol. While depressing the brake pedal
up. These will disappear as the engine
(CVT) or the clutch pedal (M/T), push
warms up.
Vehicles with M/T Vehicles with CVT the accelerator pedal all the way down
and hold it there, then crank the engine
When it is difficult to start the for 5 to 6 seconds. Return the ignition
engine switch to the “LOCK” position and re-
After several attempts, you may experience lease the accelerator pedal. Wait a few
that the engine still does not start. seconds, and then crank the engine again 6
1. Make sure that all electric devices, such for 5 to 6 seconds while depressing the
as lamps, air conditioning blower and brake pedal (CVT) or the clutch pedal
rear window demister, are turned off. (M/T), but do not push the accelerator
2. While depressing the brake pedal (CVT) pedal. Release the ignition key if the en-
or the clutch pedal (M/T), press the ac- gine starts. If the engine fails to start, re-
NOTE celerator pedal halfway and hold it there, peat these procedures. If the engine still
then crank the engine. Release the accel- will not start, we recommend you to
l On vehicles with CVT, the starter will not
have the vehicle checked.
operate unless the selector lever is in the “P” erator pedal, immediately after the en-
(PARK) or “N” (NEUTRAL) position. gine starts.
For safety reasons, start the engine in the Starting the engine (diesel-
“P” (PARK) position so that the wheels are
locked. powered vehicles)
E00625501316
[For vehicles equipped with keyless opera-
6. After turning the ignition key to the tion system]
“ON” position, make certain that all For information on operations for vehicles
warning lamps are functioning properly equipped with the keyless operation system,
before starting the engine. refer to “Keyless operation system: Starting”
7. Turn the ignition key to the “START” on page 3-19.
position without depressing the accelera- [Except vehicles equipped with keyless op-
tor pedal, and release it when the engine eration system]
starts. 1. Insert the ignition key and fasten the seat
belt.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-15


Starting
2. Make sure the parking brake is applied. NOTE NOTE
3. Press and hold the brake pedal down
firmly with your right foot. l When the engine has not been started within l For diesel-powered vehicles, if the tempera-
about 5 seconds after the diesel preheat indi- ture inside the engine compartment is high,
4. Fully depress the clutch pedal (M/T).
cation lamp went out, return the ignition key the cooling fans (A) will continue to operate
5. On vehicles equipped with M/T, place to the “LOCK” position. Then, turn the key for some time even if the engine is stopped.
the gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) to the “ON” position to preheat the engine Therefore, the operation sound of the cool-
position. again. ing fans may be heard even after the engine
On vehicles equipped with A/T, make l When the engine is warm, the diesel preheat is stopped. This sound is normal and does
sure the selector lever is in the “P” indication lamp does not come on even if the not indicate a malfunction.
ignition key is placed in the “ON” position. After operating for a period of time, the
6 (PARK) position.
Start the engine by turning the ignition key cooling fans will stop automatically.
right to the “START” position.
Vehicles with M/T Vehicles with A/T

7. Turn the ignition key to the “START”


position without depressing the accelera-
tor pedal, and release it when the engine
starts.

NOTE
l Minor noises may be heard on engine start- *: Front of the vehicle
up. These will disappear as the engine
warms up.
6. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” posi-
tion. Fuel injection amount learning
The diesel preheat indication lamp will process (diesel-powered 2200
first illuminate, and then after a short models)
time go out, indicating that preheating is E00627901079
completed. To keep exhaust emissions and engine noise
low, the engine very occasionally performs a
NOTE learning process for the fuel injection
amount.
l If the engine is cold, the diesel preheat indi-
cation lamp is on for a longer time.

6-16 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Diesel particulate filter (DPF)*
The engine sounds slightly different from CAUTION DPF warning display
usual while the learning process is taking
place. The change in the engine sound does l Do not use any type of fuel or engine oil that Type 1
is not specified for your vehicle. Also, do
not indicate a fault.
not use any moisture-removing agent or oth-
er fuel additive. Such substances could have
Diesel particulate filter a detrimental effect on the DPF.
Refer to “Fuel selection” on page 2-02 and
(DPF)* “Engine oil” on page 10-05.
E00619801330
Type 2
The diesel particulate filter (DPF) is a device
NOTE 6
that captures most of the particulate matter
(PM) in the exhaust emissions of the diesel l To minimize the likelihood of excessive ac-
engine. The DPF automatically burns away cumulation of PM, try to avoid driving for
long periods at low speeds and repeatedly
trapped PM during vehicle operation. Under
driving short distances.
certain driving conditions, however, the DPF
l The engine sounds slightly different than
The DPF warning display illuminates in the
is not able to burn away all of the trapped PM usual while the DPF automatically burns
and, as a result, an excessive amount of PM away trapped PM. The change in the engine event of an abnormality in the DPF system.
accumulates inside it. sound does not indicate a fault.
If the DPF warning display il-
WARNING luminates during vehicle oper-
ation
l The DPF reaches very high temperatures.
Do not park your vehicle in areas where
Steady illumination of the DPF warning dis-
combustible materials such as dry grass
or leaves can come in contact with a hot play shows that the DPF has not been able to
exhaust system since a fire could occur. burn away all of the trapped PM and that, as
a result, an excessive amount of PM has ac-
cumulated inside it. To enable the DPF to
burn away the PM, try to drive the vehicle as
follows:
[Except for diesel-powered 1600 models]

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-17


Turbocharger operation*
l With the bar graph of engine coolant If the DPF warning display and CAUTION
temperature display stabilized in roughly check engine warning lamp il-
the middle of the scale, drive for about l Continuing to drive with the DPF warning
20 minutes at a speed of at least 40 km/h luminate at the same time dur- display and check engine warning lamp illu-
ing vehicle operation minating could result in engine trouble and
(25 mph). DPF damage.

[Diesel-powered 1600 models] Warning lamp


l As soon as traffic conditions allow, re- Turbocharger operation*
generate the filter by driving at a speed E00611200083

6 of over 60 km/h (37 mph) until the


CAUTION
warning display goes out. Warning display type 1
l Do not run the engine at high speeds (for ex-
If the DPF warning display subsequently ample, by revving it or by accelerating rap-
stays on, contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS idly) immediately after starting it.
Authorized Service Point. l Do not stop the engine immediately after
high-speed or uphill driving. First allow the
engine to idle to give the turbocharger a
CAUTION Warning display type 2 chance to cool down.

l You do not have to continuously drive ex-


actly as indicated above. Always strive to
drive safely in accordance with road condi-
tions.

If an abnormal condition occurs in the DPF


system, the DPF warning display and check
engine warning lamp illuminate. Have the
system inspected by a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.

6-18 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system*

Turbocharger Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) posi-
tion.
The turbocharger increases engine power by system*
pushing large amounts of air into the engine’s E00627400035 Vehicles with 5M/T
cylinders. The finned parts inside the turbo- The Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system auto-
charger turn at extremely high speeds and are matically stops and restarts the engine with-
subjected to extremely high temperatures. out operating the ignition switch or the en-
They are lubricated and cooled by engine oil. gine switch when the vehicle is stopped, such Vehicles with 6M/T
If the engine oil is not replaced at the speci- as at a traffic light or in a traffic jam, to re-
fied intervals, the bearings may seize or emit duce exhaust gases and increase fuel efficien- 6
abnormal noise. cy.

CAUTION
2. Release the clutch pedal. The “ ” dis-
l If the vehicle will be stopped for a long time play/indicator will turn on and the en-
or if you will leave the vehicle unattended,
turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” posi- gine will stop automatically.
tion and press the engine switch to stop the
engine.

Automatically stopping the en-


1- Air compressor
gine
E00627501150
2- Compressed air The Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system is auto-
3- Cylinder Type 1 Type 2
matically activated when the ignition switch
4- Turbo fin is turned to the “ON” position or the opera-
5- Turbine tion mode is put in ON.
6- Exhaust gas You can deactivate the system by pressing
the “Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) OFF” switch.
Refer to “To deactivate” on page 6-22.
1. Stop the vehicle.
While depressing the brake pedal, fully
depress the clutch pedal and place the
OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-19
Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system*

NOTE CAUTION NOTE


l When the engine is automatically stopped, • Do not move the gearshift lever to a posi- • After the engine restarts automatically
changes will occur in the driving operations. tion other than the “N” (Neutral) position. and the vehicle stops again within 10 sec-
Pay close attention to the following. If the gearshift lever is moved to a posi- onds.
• The brake booster becomes inoperative tion other than the “N” (Neutral) position, • After presing the engine switch to start
and the pedal effort will increase. If the the “ ” display/indicator blinks and the the engine from the operation mode is in
vehicle is moving, press down the brake buzzer sounds. ON, approximately 30 seconds or more
pedal harder than usual. If the gearshift lever is returned to the “N” have not elapsed.
• The electric power steering system (EPS) (Neutral) position, the display/indicator • Engine coolant temperature is low.
becomes inoperative and it will become
6 harder to turn the steering wheel.
stops blinking and the buzzer stops sound-
ing. The engine will not restart if the gear-
• Ambient temperature is lower than ap-
proximately 3 °C.
shift lever is in a position other than the • Air conditioning is operating and passen-
“N” (Neutral) position. ger compartment has not sufficiently
CAUTION cooled.
• Mode selection dial is set to the demister
l Observe the following precautions when the NOTE position.
engine is stopped automatically. Otherwise,
an unexpected accident might occur when Refer to “Demisting of the windscreen
l In the following cases, the Auto Stop & Go and door windows: For quick demisting”
the engine restarts automatically. (AS&G) system will not operate and the en-
on page 7-09.
• Do not depress the accelerator pedal to gine will not stop automatically even if the
race the engine while the vehicle is stop- • When the air conditioning is operated in
vehicle is stopped.
ped (regardless of whether the engine is AUTO mode where the temperature con-
• Driver’s seat belt is not fastened. trol dial is set to the max. hot or the max.
running or stopped). • Driver’s door is open.
Otherwise, an unexpected accident might cool position (for vehicles with automatic
• Bonnet is open. air conditioning).
occur when the engine restarts automati-
cally. • After the engine restarts automatically, • Electric power consumption is high, such
the vehicle speed has not exceeded ap- as when the rear window demister or oth-
• When the engine is automatically stopped, proximately 5 km/h (3 mph).
do not attempt to exit the vehicle. er electrical components are operating or
Because the engine restarts automatically • Brake booster vacuum pressure is low be- the blower speed is set to a high setting.
cause the brake pedal is depressed repeat- • Battery voltage or battery performance is
when the driver’s seat belt is unfastened
edly or depressed harder than usual. low.
or the driver’s door is opened, an unex-
pected accident might occur when the ve- • After the ignition switch is turned from • Check engine warning lamp is illuminated
the “ON” position to the “START” posi- or the “ ” display/indicator is blinking.
hicle starts moving.
tion, approximately 30 seconds or more
have not elapsed.

6-20 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system*

NOTE Automatically restarting the NOTE


l If the Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system oper-
engine l If the engine does not restart automatically
ates while the air conditioning is operating, E00627601148 or if the engine stalls, the oil pressure warn-
both the engine and the air conditioning Depress the clutch pedal while the gearshift ing lamp, charge warning lamp, and check
compressor will stop. Therefore, the wind- lever is in the “N” (Neutral) position. The engine warning lamp will illuminate.
screen and door windows may mist up be- “ ” display/indicator in the meter turns off If this occurs, the engine will not restart
cause only the blower will operate. and the engine restarts automatically. even if the clutch pedal is depressed again.
If the windscreen and door windows mist up, While depressing the brake pedal, fully de-
set the mode selection dial to “ ” to restart press the clutch pedal and turn the ignition
switch to the “START” position to start the
the engine.
→ “Mode selection dial” on page 7-03 engine. 6
l If the windscreen and door windows mist up For details, refer to “Starting and stopping
every time the engine stops, it is recommen- the engine” on page 3-17 or “Starting” on
ded to deactivate the Auto Stop & Go page 6-14.
(AS&G) system by pressing the “Auto Stop
& Go (AS&G) OFF” switch. Type 1 Type 2
→ “To deactivate” on page 6-22 CAUTION
l If the air conditioning is operating, set the
l In the following cases, the engine will restart
temperature control dial higher to lengthen automatically even if the engine was stopped
the time that the engine is stopped automati- by the Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system. Pay
cally. attention, otherwise an unexpected accident
might occur when the engine restarts.
• Vehicle speed is 3 km/h (2 mph) or higher
when coasting down a slope.
• Brake booster vacuum pressure is low be-
cause the brake pedal is depressed repeat-
edly or depressed harder than usual.
• Engine coolant temperature is low.
• When the air conditioning is operated by
pressing the air conditioning switch.
• When the preset temperature of the air
conditioning is changed significantly.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-21


Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system*

CAUTION NOTE To reactivate the Auto Stop & Go (AS&G)


system, press the “Auto Stop & Go (AS&G)
• When the air conditioning is operated in l If the bonnet is opened when the engine is OFF” switch; the display/indicator will turn
AUTO mode where the temperature con- automatically stopped, the “ ” display/ in- off.
trol dial is set to the max. hot or the max. dicator will blink, the buzzer will sound, and
cool position (for vehicles with automatic the engine will not restart automatically. To
air conditioning). restart the engine, fully depress the clutch
• When the air conditioning is ON, the pas- pedal while depressing the brake pedal, and
senger compartment temperature rises and then turn the ignition switch to the
the air conditioning compressor operates “START” position or press the engine
to lower the temperature.
6 • Mode selection dial is set to the demister
switch. For details, refer to “Starting and
stopping the engine” on page 3-17 or “Start-
position. ing” on page 6-14.
Refer to “Demisting of the windscreen l When the engine restarts automatically, the
Type 1 Type 2
and door windows: For quick demisting” audio volume may temporarily decrease.
on page 7-09. This does not indicate a malfunction.
• Electric power consumption is high, such l When the engine is stopped automatically,
as when the rear window demister or oth- the air conditioning may temporarily change
er electrical components are operating or the air volume.
the blower speed is set to a high setting. This does not indicate a malfunction.
• Driver’s seat belt is unfastened.
• Driver’s door is open.
To deactivate
E00627700096 NOTE
NOTE The Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system is auto-
matically activated when the ignition switch l This display/indicator will also turn on for a
l If the “Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) OFF”
is turned to the “ON” position. You can deac-
few seconds when the ignition switch is
switch is pressed to deactivate the Auto Stop turned to the “ON” position or the operation
& Go (AS&G) system while the engine is tivate the system by pressing the “Auto Stop mode is put in ON.
stopped automatically, the engine will not & Go (AS&G) OFF” switch.
restart automatically even if the clutch pedal When the Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system is
is depressed. deactivated, the “ ” display/indicator will If the display/indicator
turn on. blinks while driving
E00627800039
If the “ ” display/indicator blinks, the Auto
Stop & Go (AS&G) system is malfunctioning
and will not operate.
6-22 Starting and driving OGAE15E5
Manual transmission*
We recommend you to consult a Manual transmission* NOTE
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service
Point.
E00602001806
l During cold weather, shifting may be diffi-
The shift pattern is shown on the gearshift cult until the transmission lubricant has
warmed up. This is normal and not harmful
lever knob. To start off, depress the clutch to the transmission.
pedal all the way down and shift into 1st or l If it is hard to shift into 1st, depress the
“R” (Reverse) position. Then gradually re- clutch pedal again; the shift will then be eas-
lease the clutch pedal while depressing the ier to make.
accelerator pedal. l The gearshift indicator (if so equipped)
shows recommended gearshift points for
fuel-efficient driving. It shows a “ ” when
6
Vehicles with 5M/T Vehicles with 6M/T
an upshift is recommended, and it shows a
“ ” when a downshift is recommended.

Type 1 Type 2

CAUTION
l Do not put the gearshift lever into the re-
verse position while the vehicle is moving
forward. Doing so could damage the trans-
mission.
l Do not rest your foot on the clutch pedal
while driving as this will cause premature
clutch wear or damage.
l Do not coast in the “N” (Neutral) position.
l Do not use the gearshift lever as a handrest,
because this can result in premature wear of
the transmission shift forks.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-23


Manual transmission*

Moving the gearshift lever to CAUTION


the “R” (Reverse) position l Do not pull up the pull-ring (A) when mov-
E00615400100 ing the gearshift lever to any position other
than the “R” (Reverse) position. If you al-
Vehicles equipped with 5M/T ways pulled up the pull-ring (A) when mov-
ing the gearshift lever, you could uninten-
To shift into the “R” (Reverse) position from tionally move the gearshift lever to the “R”
5th gear, move the gearshift lever to the “N” (Reverse) position and cause an accident
(Neutral) position, and then move it to the and/or a transmission fault.
6 “R” (Reverse) position.
The pull-ring will return to its original posi-
Vehicles equipped with 6M/T tion when you return the gearshift lever to the
Pull up the pull-ring (A), then move the gear- “N” (Neutral) position.
shift lever to the “R” (Reverse) position with
the pull-ring still pulled. CAUTION
l If the pull-ring will not return from the
pulled-up position, we recommend you to
have the vehicle inspected.

6-24 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Manual transmission*

Possible driving speed


E00610802770
Avoid shifting down at high speed, as this may cause excessive engine speed (the tachometer needle into the red zone) and damage the engine.
Petrol-powered vehicles
Speed limit
Shift point
1600 models 2000 models
1st gear 50 km/h (30 mph) 50 km/h (30 mph)
2nd gear 95 km/h (59 mph) 100 km/h (62 mph) 6
3rd gear 140 km/h (87 mph) 140 km/h (87 mph)
4th gear 180 km/h (112 mph) 185 km/h (115 mph)

Use 5th gear whenever vehicle speed allows, for maximum fuel economy.
Diesel-powered vehicles
Shift point Speed limit
1st gear 35 km/h (22 mph)
2nd gear 65 km/h (40 mph)
3rd gear 105 km/h (65 mph),
4th gear 140 km/h (87 mph)
5th gear 180 km/h (112 mph)
Use 6th gear whenever vehicle speed allows, for maximum fuel economy.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-25


Automatic transmission INVECS-II Sports Mode 6A/T (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System II)*

Automatic transmission The individual gears are selected automati- Move the selector lever through the
cally, depending on the speed of the vehicle gate.
INVECS-II Sports Mode and the position of the accelerator pedal.
6A/T (Intelligent & The selector lever (A) has 2 gates; the main
gate (B) and the manual gate (C). WARNING
Innovative Vehicle
l Always depress the brake pedal when
Electronic Control System shifting the selector lever into a gear from
the “P” (PARK) or “N” (NEUTRAL) po-
II)* sition.
Never put your foot on the accelerator
6 E00603200866
pedal while shifting the selector lever
Automatic transmission will automatically from the “P” (PARK) or “N” (NEU-
change its gear depending on road and driv- TRAL) position.
ing conditions. This helps achieve smooth
driving and excellent fuel efficiency.
Also you can manually shift up and shift NOTE
down the transaxle. Refer to “Sports mode” l To avoid erroneous operation, move the se-
on page 6-29. lector lever firmly into each position and
briefly hold it there. Always check the posi-
tion shown by the selector lever position dis-
NOTE play after moving the selector lever.
l During running-in period or immediately af- l If the brake pedal is not depressed and held,
ter reconnection of the battery cable, there the shift-lock device activates to prevent the
may be a case where gear shifts are not selector lever from being moved from the
made smoothly. This does not indicate a “P” (PARK) position.
faulty transmission.
Gear shifts will become smooth after the
transmission has been shifted several times
by the electronic control system.

While depressing the brake pedal,


Selector lever operation move the selector lever through the
E00603301200 gate.
The transmission has 6 forward gears and 1
reverse gear.

6-26 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Automatic transmission INVECS-II Sports Mode 6A/T (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System II)*

When the selector lever cannot 3. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screw- straight blade (or minus) screwdriver
driver with a cloth over its tip into notch down.
be shifted from the “P” (PARK) (A) or the cover. Pry gently as shown to
position remove the cover.
E00629100153
When the selector lever cannot be shifted
from the “P” (PARK) position to another po-
sition while the brake pedal is pressed and
held down with the ignition switch or the op-
eration mode in ON, the battery may be flat
or the shift-lock mechanism may be malfunc-
6
tioning. Immediately have your vehicle
checked by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
thorized Service Point.
If you need to move the vehicle, shift the se-
lector lever as follows. For RHD vehicles
For LHD vehicles 4. Depress the brake pedal with the right 1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
1. Make sure the parking brake is applied. foot. 2. Stop the engine if it is running.
2. Stop the engine if it is running. 5. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screw- 3. Depress the brake pedal with the right
driver in the shiftlock release hole (B). foot.
Shift the selector lever to the “N” (NEU-
TRAL) position while pressing the

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-27


Automatic transmission INVECS-II Sports Mode 6A/T (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System II)*
4. Shift the selector lever to the “N” (NEU- Selector lever positions (Main WARNING
TRAL) position while pressing the shift- gate)
lock release button (A). l Never move the selector lever to the “N”
E00603800833 (NEUTRAL) position while driving. A se-
rious accident could occur since you could
“P” PARK accidentally move the lever into the “P”
(PARK) or “R” (REVERSE) position or
This position locks the transmission to pre- you will lose engine braking.
vent the vehicle from moving. The engine l On a gradient the engine should be star-
can be started in this position. ted in the “P” (PARK) position, not in the
“N” (NEUTRAL) position.
6 “R” REVERSE l To prevent rolling, always keep your foot
on the brake pedal when the vehicle is in
This position is to back up. “N” (NEUTRAL) position, or when shift-
ing into or out of “N” (NEUTRAL) posi-
tion.
CAUTION
Selector lever position display l Never shift into the “P” (PARK) or “R” “D” DRIVE
E00603500944
(REVERSE) position while the vehicle is in
When the ignition switch is turned to the motion to avoid transmission damage. This position is used for most city and high-
“ON” position or the operation mode is put in way driving. The transmission will automati-
ON, the position of the selector lever is indi- “N” NEUTRAL cally change its gear depending on road and
cated in the multi-information display. driving conditions.
At this position the transmission is disengag-
ed. It is the same as the neutral position on a
Type 1 Type 2 manual transmission, and should only be CAUTION
used when the vehicle is stationary for an ex- l To prevent transmission damage, never shift
tended length of time during driving, such as into the “D” (DRIVE) position from the “R”
in a traffic jam. (REVERSE) position while the vehicle is in
motion.

6-28 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Automatic transmission INVECS-II Sports Mode 6A/T (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System II)*

Sports mode NOTE CAUTION


E00603901381
Whether the vehicle is stationary or in mo-
• Push the selector lever from the “D” l Do not use the left- and right-hand shift pad-
(DRIVE) position into the manual gate dles at the same time. Doing so could cause
tion, sports mode is selected by gently push- (A) and push the selector lever back into a shift of gear ratio that you do not expect.
ing the selector lever from the “D” (DRIVE) the main gate (B).
position into the manual gate (A). To return
to “D” range operation, gently push the selec- NOTE
tor lever back into the main gate (B). l The upward shift may be made automatical-
SHIFT
ly in sports mode when the engine revolu-
In sports mode, gear shifts can be made rap-
UP SHIFT
DOWN
SHIFT
UP
tions rises and approaches the tachometer’s 6
idly simply by moving the selector lever red zone (the red-coloured part of the tach-
backward and forward. Shift paddles at the ometer dial).
steering wheel can also be used to perform l In sports mode, only the 6 forward gears can
be selected. To reverse or park the vehicle,
gearshifts. In contrast to a manual transmis- SHIFT
move the selector lever to the “R” (RE-
DOWN
sion, the sports mode allows gear shifts with VERSE) or “P” (PARK) position as re-
the accelerator pedal depressed. quired.
+ (SHIFT UP) l To maintain good running performance, the
The transmission shifts up by one gear transmission may refuse to perform an up-
NOTE shift when the selector lever is moved to the
with each operation.
l You can shift into sports mode with shift “+ (SHIFT UP)” position at certain vehicle
paddles when the selector lever is in the speeds. Also, to prevent over-revving of the
- (SHIFT DOWN) engine, the transmission may refuse to per-
main gate as well. Also, you can return to
the “D” range operation in any of following The transmission shifts down by one gear form a downshift when the lever is moved to
ways. with each operation. the “- (SHIFT DOWN)” position at certain
When returning to “D” range operation, the vehicle speeds. When this happens, a buzzer
selector lever position display will change to sounds to indicate that a downshift is not go-
“D” (DRIVE) position.
CAUTION ing to take place.
• Pull the “+ (SHIFT UP)” side shift paddle l In sports mode, the driver must execute up- l In sports mode, downward shifts are made
forward (towards the driver) for over 2 ward shifts in accordance with prevailing automatically when the vehicle slows down.
seconds. road conditions, taking care to keep the en- When the vehicle stops, 1st gear is automati-
• Stop the vehicle. gine speed below the red zone. cally selected.
l Repeated continuous operation of the selec-
tor lever or the shift paddles will continuous-
ly switch shift position.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-29


Automatic transmission INVECS-II Sports Mode 6A/T (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System II)*

NOTE NOTE
or
l When driving away on a slippery road, push l While driving in sport mode, the display
the selector lever forward into the may change to show “D” and shifting in
“+ (SHIFT UP)” position. This cause the sports mode may no longer be possible. Type 2
transmission to shift into the 2nd gear which This indicates that controls to drive in the
is better for smooth driving away on a slip- “D” position are operating normally in order
pery road. Push the selector lever to the to lower the temperature of the A/T fluid; it or
“- (SHIFT DOWN)” side to shift back to the does not indicate a malfunction. Once the
1st gear. temperature of the A/T fluid drops, shifting
in the sports mode will be possible again.
6 l The gearshift indicator shows recommended When the warning display ap-
Sports mode display gearshift points for fuel-efficient driving. It pears
E00612301541 shows a “ ” when an upshift is recommen-
There could be a system malfunction if the
In sports mode, the currently selected posi- ded.
warning display or the warning display is
tion is displayed on the multi-information
displayed on the information screen in the
display Type 1 Type 2 multi-information display.
Type 1 Type 2

When a malfunction occurs in


the A/T
E00615100282

Type 1

6-30 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Automatic transmission INVECS-II Sports Mode 6A/T (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System II)*

CAUTION Operation of the A/T CAUTION


E00604200704
l If malfunction occurs in the A/T while driv- l Do not race the engine with brake pedal
ing, the warning display or the warning pressed when the vehicle is stationary.
display will appear on the information CAUTION This can damage the A/T.
screen in the multi-information display. Also, when you depress the accelerator ped-
In this case, immediately park your vehicle l Before selecting a gear with the engine run- al while holding down the brake pedal with
in a safe place and follow these procedures: ning and the vehicle stationary, fully depress the selector lever in the “D” (DRIVE) posi-
the brake pedal to prevent the vehicle from tion, the engine revolutions may not rise as
creeping. high as when performing the same operation
When warning display is showing
The vehicle will begin to move as soon as with the selector lever in the “N” (NEU-
The automatic transmission fluid is over-
heating.
the gear is engaged, especially when the en- TRAL) position. 6
gine speed is high, at fast idle or with the air
Stop the vehicle in a safe place, place the se-
conditioning operating, the brakes should
lector lever in the “P” (PARK) position, and
open the bonnet with the engine running to
only be released when you are ready to drive Passing acceleration
away.
allow the engine to cool down. E00604500358

After a while, confirm that the warning


l Depress the brake pedal with the right foot at To gain extra acceleration in “D” (DRIVE)
all times. position, push the accelerator to the floor.
display is no longer showing. It is safe to Using the left foot could cause driver move-
continue driving if the display is no longer The A/T will automatically downshift.
ment delay in case of an emergency.
showing. If the warning display remains or
appears frequently, we recommend you to
l To prevent sudden acceleration, never race
have your vehicle inspected.
the engine when shifting from the “P” NOTE
(PARK) or “N” (NEUTRAL) position.
l Operating the accelerator pedal while the l In “Sports mode”, downshifts do not take
When warning display is showing other foot is resting on the brake pedal will place when the accelerator is depressed all
It may be that there is something unusual affect braking efficiency and may cause pre- the way to the floor.
happening in the A/T, causing a safety de- mature wear of brake pads.
vice to activate. We recommend you to have
l Use the selector lever in the correct shift po-
Uphill/downhill driving
your vehicle inspected as soon as possible. sition in accordance with driving conditions.
E00610500207
Never coast downhill backward with the se-
lector lever in the “D” (DRIVE) or sports
mode position or coast forward with the se- DRIVING UPHILL
lector lever in the “R” (REVERSE) position. The transmission prevents unnecessary up-
The engine may stop and the unexpected in- shifts even when the accelerator pedal is re-
crease in brake pedal effort and steering
leased and ensures smooth driving.
wheel weight could lead to an accident

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-31


Automatic transmission INVECS-III Sports Mode 6CVT (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System III)*

DRIVING DOWNHILL If you are going to leave the vehicle unatten- Automatic transmission
ded, always switch off the engine and carry
According to the conditions, the transmission the key. INVECS-III Sports Mode
will automatically shift to a lower gear to
achieve stronger engine braking. This may 6CVT (Intelligent &
help reduce your need to use the service NOTE Innovative Vehicle
brake. l On a slope, be sure to apply the parking
brake before moving the selector lever to the
Electronic Control System
Waiting “P” (PARK) position. If you move the selec- III)*
E00604600388 tor lever to the “P” (PARK) position before
6 For short waiting periods, such as at traffic applying the parking brake, it may be diffi-
E00602100262

signals, the vehicle can be left in gear and cult to disengage the selector lever from the The CVT will automatically and continuous-
held stationary with the service brake. “P” (PARK) position when next you drive ly change its gear ratio depending on road
For longer waiting periods with the engine the vehicle, requiring application of a strong and driving conditions. This helps achieve
force to the selector lever to move from the smooth driving and excellent fuel efficiency.
running, place the selector lever in the “N”
“P” (PARK) position.
(NEUTRAL) position and apply the parking Also you can manually shift up and shift
brake, while holding the vehicle stationary down the transmission. Refer to “Sports
with the service brake. When the A/T makes no speed mode” on page 6-36.
change Selector lever operation
CAUTION E00604800742
E00602200221
If the transmission does not change speeds
l Never hold the vehicle stationary while in The CVT selects an optimum gear ratio auto-
while driving, or your vehicle does not pick
gear on a hill with the accelerator, always matically, depending on the speed of the ve-
apply the parking brake and/or service
up enough speed when starting on an uphill
hicle and the position of the accelerator ped-
brake. slope, it may be that there is something un-
al.
usual happening in the transmission, causing
a safety device to activate. We recommend
Parking you to have your vehicle checked as soon as
E00604700305
possible.
To park the vehicle, first bring it to a com-
plete stop, fully engage the parking brake,
and then move the selector lever to the “P”
(PARK) position.

6-32 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Automatic transmission INVECS-III Sports Mode 6CVT (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System III)*
The selector lever (A) has 2 gates; the main WARNING When the selector lever cannot
gate (B) and the manual gate (C).
l Always depress the brake pedal when be shifted from the “P” (PARK)
shifting the selector lever into the other position
position from the “P” (PARK) or “N”
E00629000312
(NEUTRAL) position.
When the selector lever cannot be shifted
Never put your foot on the accelerator
pedal while shifting the selector lever from the “P” (PARK) position to another po-
from the “P” (PARK) or “N” (NEU- sition while the brake pedal is pressed and
TRAL) position. held down with the ignition switch or the op-
eration mode in ON, the battery may be flat
or the shift-lock mechanism may be malfunc-
6
NOTE tioning. Immediately have your vehicle
l To avoid erroneous operation, move the se- checked by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
lector lever firmly into each position and thorized Service Point.
briefly hold it there. Always check the posi-
tion shown by the selector lever position dis- If you need to move the vehicle, shift the se-
play after moving the selector lever.
lector lever as follows.
l If the brake pedal is not depressed and held,
1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
the shift-lock device activates to prevent the
selector lever from being moved from the 2. Stop the engine if it is running.
“P” (PARK) position.

While depressing the brake pedal,


move the selector lever through
the gate.
Move the selector lever through
the gate.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-33


Automatic transmission INVECS-III Sports Mode 6CVT (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System III)*
3. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screw- 5. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screw- Selector lever position display
driver with a cloth over its tip into notch driver in the shiftlock release hole (B). E00602301492
(A) of the cover. Pry gently as shown to Shift the selector lever to the “N” (NEU- When the ignition switch is turned to the
remove the cover. TRAL) position while pressing the “ON” position or the operation mode is put in
straight blade (or minus) screwdriver ON, the position of the selector lever is indi-
down. cated in the multi-information display.

Type 1 Type 2

4. Depress the brake pedal with the right


foot.
When the selector lever position
display blinks
WARNING
l To avoid unintended vehicle movement,
keep the brake pedal applied with your
right foot and do not depress the accelera-
tor pedal, while the selector lever position
display is blinking.

6-34 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Automatic transmission INVECS-III Sports Mode 6CVT (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System III)*
If the ambient temperature is low, the selec- Selector lever positions (Main WARNING
tor lever position display on the multi-infor- gate)
mation display may blink when the selector l Never move the selector lever to the “N”
E00602400311 (NEUTRAL) position while driving. A se-
lever is placed in the “D” (DRIVE) or “R”
rious accident could occur since you could
(REVERSE) position immediately after the “P” PARK accidentally move the lever into the “P”
engine has been started. This indicates that (PARK) or “R” (REVERSE) position or
the transmission requires warming up. This position locks the transmission to pre- you will lose engine braking.
While the display is blinking, the vehicle will vent the vehicle from moving. The engine l On a gradient the engine should be star-
not move, because the transmission keeps can be started in this position. ted in the “P” (PARK) position, not in the
“N” (NEUTRAL) position.
disengaging until the warm-up is completed
“R” REVERSE l To prevent rolling, always keep your foot 6
even if the selector lever is placed in the “D”
on the brake pedal when the vehicle is in
or “R” position. This position is to back up. “N” (NEUTRAL) position, or when shift-
When the selector lever position display is ing into or out of “N” (NEUTRAL) posi-
blinking, perform the following procedure: tion.
1. Depress the brake pedal with your right
CAUTION
foot and place the selector lever in the l Never shift into the “P” (PARK) or “R” “D” DRIVE
“N” (NEUTRAL) position for several (REVERSE) position while the vehicle is in
motion to avoid transmission damage. This position is used for most city and high-
seconds.
2. Keep depressing the brake pedal and way driving. The transmission will automati-
then place the selector lever in the “D” “N” NEUTRAL cally and continuously change its gear radio
(DRIVE) or “R” (REVERSE) position. depending on road and driving conditions.
At this position the transmission is disengag-
If the selector lever position display ed. It is the same as the neutral position on a
stops blinking, the warm-up is comple- manual transmission, and should only be CAUTION
ted and the transmission will function used when the vehicle is stationary for an ex-
normally. l To prevent transmission damage, never shift
tended length of time during driving, such as into the “D” (DRIVE) position from the “R”
3. If the display is still blinking, repeat in a traffic jam. (REVERSE) position while the vehicle is in
steps 1 and 2 above. motion.

NOTE
l While the selector lever position display is
blinking, a buzzer will sound intermittently.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-35


Automatic transmission INVECS-III Sports Mode 6CVT (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System III)*

Sports mode NOTE CAUTION


E00602500194
Whether the vehicle is stationary or in mo-
• Push the selector lever from the “D” l Do not use the left- and right-hand shift pad-
(DRIVE) position into the manual gate dles at the same time. Doing so could cause
tion, sports mode is selected by gently push- (A) and push the selector lever back into a shift of gear ratio that you do not expect.
ing the selector lever from the “D” (DRIVE) the main gate (B).
position into the manual gate (A). To return
to “D” range operation, gently push the selec- NOTE
tor lever back into the main gate (B). l The upward shift may be made automatical-
SHIFT
ly in sports mode when the engine revolu-
6 In sports mode, gear ratio shifts can be made
UP SHIFT
DOWN
SHIFT
UP
tions rises and approaches the tachometer’s
rapidly simply by moving the selector lever red zone (the red-coloured part of the tach-
backward and forward. Shift paddles at the ometer dial).
steering wheel can also be used to shift the l In sports mode, only the 6 forward gears can
be selected. To reverse or park the vehicle,
gear ratio. In contrast to a manual transmis- SHIFT
move the selector lever to the “R” (RE-
DOWN
sion, the sports mode allows gear shifts with VERSE) or “P” (PARK) position as re-
the accelerator pedal depressed. quired.
+ (SHIFT UP) l To maintain good running performance, the
The transmission shifts up once by each transmission may refuse to perform an up-
NOTE shift when the selector lever is moved to the
operation.
l You can shift into sports mode with shift “+ (SHIFT UP)” position at certain vehicle
paddles when the selector lever is in the speeds. Also, to prevent over-revving of the
- (SHIFT DOWN) engine, the transmission may refuse to per-
main gate as well. Also, you can return to
the “D” range operation in any of following The transmission shifts down once by form a downshift when the lever is moved to
ways. each operation. the “- (SHIFT DOWN)” position at certain
When returning to “D” range operation, the vehicle speeds. When this happens, a buzzer
selector lever position display will change to sounds to indicate that a downshift is not go-
“D” (DRIVE) position.
CAUTION ing to take place.
• Pull the “+ (SHIFT UP)” side shift paddle l In sports mode, the driver must execute up- l In sports mode, downward shifts are made
forward (towards the driver) for over 2 ward shifts in accordance with prevailing automatically when the vehicle slows down.
seconds. road conditions, taking care to keep the en- When the vehicle stops, 1st gear is automati-
• Stop the vehicle. gine speed below the red zone. cally selected.
l Repeated continuous operation of the selec-
tor lever or the shift paddles will continuous-
ly switch shift position.

6-36 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Automatic transmission INVECS-III Sports Mode 6CVT (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System III)*

Sports mode display When the warning display ap- CAUTION


E00612200396 pears
It may be that there is something unusual
In sports mode, the currently selected posi-
There could be a system malfunction if the happening in the CVT, causing a safety de-
tion is displayed on the multi-information vice to activate. We recommend you to have
warning display or the warning display is
display. your vehicle inspected as soon as possible.
displayed on the information screen in the
multi-information display.
Type 1 Type 2
Operation of the CVT
CAUTION E00602600326

l If malfunction occurs in the CVT while driv- 6


ing, the warning display or the warning CAUTION
display will appear on the information
screen in the multi-information display. l Before selecting a position with the engine
running and the vehicle stationary, fully de-
In this case, follow these procedures:
press the brake pedal to prevent the vehicle
[When warning display is showing] from creeping.
The CVT fluid is overheating. The engine The vehicle will begin to move as soon as
control may activate to lower the CVT fluid the CVT is engaged, especially when the en-
temperature, causing the engine revolutions
When a malfunction occurs in and vehicle speed to decrease. In this case,
gine speed is high, at fast idle or with the air
conditioning operating, the brakes should
the CVT take one of the following measures. only be released when you are ready to drive
E00602300336 • Slow down your vehicle. away.
• Stop the vehicle in a safe place, place the l Depress the brake pedal with the right foot at
Type 1 selector lever in the “P” (PARK) position, all times.
and open the bonnet with the engine run- Using the left foot could cause driver move-
ning to allow the engine to cool down. ment delay in case of an emergency.
or After a while, confirm that the warning l To prevent sudden acceleration, never race
display is no longer showing. It is safe to the engine when shifting from the “P”
Type 2 continue driving if the display is no longer (PARK) or “N” (NEUTRAL) position.
showing. If the warning display remains or l Operating the accelerator pedal while the
appears frequently, we recommend you to other foot is resting on the brake pedal will
or have your vehicle inspected. affect braking efficiency and may cause pre-
[When warning display is showing] mature wear of brake pads.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-37


Automatic transmission INVECS-III Sports Mode 6CVT (Intelligent & Innovative Vehicle Electronic Control System III)*

CAUTION Uphill/downhill driving CAUTION


E00603000112
l Use the selector lever in the correct shift po- l Never hold the vehicle stationary while in
sition in accordance with driving conditions. DRIVING UPHILL CVT on a hill with the accelerator, always
Never coast downhill backward with the se- apply the parking brake and/or service
lector lever in the “D” (DRIVE) or sports The transmission prevents unnecessary up- brake.
mode position or coast forward with the se- shifts even when the accelerator pedal is re-
lector lever in the “R” (REVERSE) position. leased and ensures smooth driving.
The engine may stop and the unexpected in- Parking
crease in brake pedal effort and steering DRIVING DOWNHILL E00602900039

wheel weight could lead to an accident. To park the vehicle, first bring it to a com-
6 l Do not race the engine with brake pedal According to the conditions, the transmission plete stop, fully engage the parking brake,
pressed when the vehicle is stationary. will automatically shift to a lower gear ratio and then move the selector lever to the “P”
This can damage the CVT. to achieve stronger engine braking. This may (PARK) position.
Also, when you depress the accelerator ped- help reduce your need to use the service If you are going to leave the vehicle unatten-
al while holding down the brake pedal with brake.
the selector lever in the “D” (DRIVE) posi- ded, always switch off the engine and carry
the key.
tion, the engine revolutions may not rise as Waiting
high as when performing the same operation E00602800126
with the selector lever in the “N” (NEU-
TRAL) position.
For short waiting periods, such as at traffic NOTE
signals the vehicle can be left in selector lev-
er position and held stationary with the serv- l On a slope, be sure to apply the parking
brake before moving the selector lever to the
Passing acceleration ice brake. “P” (PARK) position. If you move the selec-
E00602700109 For longer waiting periods with the engine tor lever to the “P” (PARK) position before
To gain extra acceleration in “D” (DRIVE) running, place the selector lever in the “N” applying the parking brake, it may be diffi-
position, push the accelerator to the floor. (NEUTRAL) position and apply the parking cult to disengage the selector lever from the
The CVT will automatically downshift. brake, while holding the vehicle stationary “P” (PARK) position when next you drive
with the service brake. the vehicle, requiring application of a strong
force to the selector lever to move from the
NOTE “P” (PARK) position.
l In “Sports mode”, downshifts do not take
place when the accelerator is depressed all
the way to the floor.

6-38 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Electronically controlled 4WD system*

When the CVT makes no speed Drive mode Function Drive mode-selector
change The default mode. The drive mode can be changed by pressing
E00603100139 This mode is for automat- the drive mode-selector while the ignition
If the transmission does not change speeds ically controlling the dis-
while driving, or your vehicle does not pick switch or the operation mode is in ON.
4WD AUTO tribution of driving torque
up enough speed when starting on an uphill to all four wheels accord-
slope, it may be that there is something un- ing to the driving condi-
usual happening in the transmission, causing tions.
a safety device to activate.
We recommend you to have your vehicle This mode is for driving 6
checked as soon as possible. in slippery conditions
such as on snow-covered
roads or sand.
Electronically controlled The large amount of driv-
4WD system* 4WD LOCK ing torque that is applied
E00604901405 to the rear tyres enables
getting out of slippery
The electronically controlled 4WD system is By pressing the drive mode-selector, the
areas and powerful driv-
a 4-wheel drive system that allows one of drive mode can be changed in order of
ing is possible across all
three drive modes to be selected with a “2WD”, “4WD” AUTO and “4WD LOCK”.
ranges.
switch, in accordance with the driving condi-
tions. 4-wheel drive operation requires special driv- The drive mode is displayed as an interrupt
ing skills. display on the information screen in the mul-
The following drive modes are available. Carefully read the “4-wheel drive operation” ti-information display when the drive mode is
on page 6-41 and take care to drive safely. changed.
Drive mode Function
After a few seconds, the information screen
This mode is for econom- will then return to its prior display.
ical driving on normal dry
2WD roads and motorway.
Driving in front-wheel
drive.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-39


Electronically controlled 4WD system*

Display Drive mode indicator CAUTION


Drive mode
Type 1 Type 2 l If the selected drive mode indicator is blink-
Type 1
ing, the vehicle switches automatically to
front-wheel drive in order to protect the
2WD
drive-system components, and drive mode
selection is no longer possible with the drive
mode-selector.
Type 2
4WD AUTO The warning display is also displayed in the
information screen in the multi-information
display.
6 Reduce speed, and if the indicator goes out
4WD LOCK after driving a while, resume driving as be-
Normally the indicator illuminates when the fore. If the indicator continues blinking for
ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position more than about 5 minutes, have the vehicle
or the operation mode is put in ON, and then inspected at a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
CAUTION the drive mode is displayed a few seconds af- thorized Service Point.
l Do not operate the drive mode-selector with ter the engine is started.
the front wheels spinning on a snowy road or
in similar conditions. The vehicle could Type 1 Type 2
Drive mode indicator
lunge in an unexpected direction.
Drive mode “4WD” indi- “LOCK” in-
l Driving on dry, paved roads in “4WD
LOCK” mode causes increased fuel con- cator dicator
sumption and noise.
2WD OFF OFF
l Do not drive with the tyres spinning in
“2WD” mode. 4WD AUTO ON OFF
Doing so could generate heat in the drive-
system components. 4WD LOCK ON ON

NOTE
l The drive mode can be switched while driv-
ing or stopped.

6-40 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


4-wheel drive operation

CAUTION But its unique 4-wheel drive system allows WARNING


you to occasionally travel on unpaved roads,
l If the warning display on the information to campgrounds, picnic sites, and similar lo- rollover in which you and your passengers
screen in the multi-information display, a could be seriously injured or killed.
cations.
problem has occurred with the electronically • Follow all instructions and guidelines in
controlled 4WD system and the safety de- Not only does this ensure better handling on the owner’s manual.
vice has activated. Have an inspection made dry, paved roads but also permits better trac- • Keep your speed low and do not drive
by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized tion when driving on slippery, wet or snow- faster than conditions allow you to.
Service Point. covered roads and when moving out of mud.
But it is not suitable for heavy off road use or
towing in rough conditions. NOTE 6
Type 1 Type 2
It is particularly important to note that 4- l Driving on rough roads can be hard on a ve-
wheel drive may not give sufficient hill hicle. Before you leave paved roads, be sure
climbing ability and engine braking on steep all scheduled maintenance and service has
slopes. You should try to avoid driving on been done, and that you have inspected your
vehicle. Pay special attention to the condi-
steep slopes.
tion of the tyres, and check the tyre pres-
Also, you must exercise caution when driving sures.
on sand and mud and when driving through l MITSUBISHI MOTORS is not responsible
water because sufficient traction may not be to the operator for any damage or injury
CAUTION available in certain circumstances. caused or liability incurred by improper and
l Always use tyres of the same size, same Please avoid driving the vehicle through negligent operation of a vehicle. All techni-
type, and same brand, and which have no areas where the tyres may get stuck in deep ques of vehicle operation depend on the skill
wear differences. Using tyres that differ in and experience of the operator and other par-
sand or mud.
size, type, brand, or wear amount may acti- ticipating parties. Any deviation from the
vate the protection of the drive-system com- recommended operating instructions above
ponents, causing the drive mode in “4WD WARNING is at their own risk.
AUTO” mode to lock or the “4WD” and l Note that the stopping distance required of a
“LOCK” indicators to blink alternately. l Do not over-rely on the 4-wheel drive ve- 4-wheel drive vehicle differs very little from
hicles. Even 4-wheel drive vehicles have that of a 2-wheel drive vehicle. When driv-
limits to the system and ability to main- ing on a snow-covered road or a slippery,
4-wheel drive operation tain control and traction. Reckless driving
may lead to accidents. Always drive care-
muddy surface, make sure that you keep a
E00606601116
sufficient distance between your vehicle and
fully, taking account of the road condi- the one ahead of you.
Your vehicle has been designed primarily for tions.
use on paved roads. l Improperly operating this vehicle on or
off-paved roads can cause an accident or

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-41


4-wheel drive operation

NOTE On snowy or icy roads CAUTION


l The driving posture should be more upright; Set the drive mode-selector to “4WD AUTO” l Do not force the vehicle or drive recklessly
adjust the seat to a good position for easy on sandy surfaces. In comparison with nor-
steering and pedal operation. Be sure to wear
or “4WD LOCK” in accordance with the mal road surfaces, the engine and other
the seat belt. road conditions, and then gradually depress drive-system components are put under ex-
l After driving on rough roads, check each the accelerator pedal for a smooth start. cessive strain when driving on such a sur-
part of the vehicle and wash it thoroughly face. This could lead to accidents.
with water. Refer to the “Inspection and
NOTE l If the engine coolant temperature display
maintenance following rough road opera- flashes on the information screen in the mul-
tion” section and “Maintenance” section.
6 l The use of snow tyres is recommended. ti-information display or the engine power
drops suddenly while the vehicle is being
l Maintain a safe distance between vehicles,
avoid sudden braking, and use engine brak- driven, park your vehicle immediately in a
CAUTION ing (downshifting). safe place.
Refer to “Engine overheating” on page
l Setting the drive mode-selector to “4WD
8-04 for details and take the required meas-
LOCK” to drive on dry paved road will in-
crease fuel consumption, with possible noise CAUTION ures.
generation.
l Avoid sudden braking, sudden acceleration
and sharp turning. Skidding occurs and con- WARNING
Turning sharp corners trol of the vehicle could be lost.
l When attempting to rock your vehicle out
of a stuck position, be sure that the area
When turning a sharp corner in “4WD Driving on sandy or muddy around the vehicle is clear of people and
LOCK” position at low speed, a slight differ- roads physical objects. The rocking motion may
ence in steering may be experienced similar cause the vehicle to suddenly launch for-
to as if the brakes were applied. This is called Set the drive mode-selector to “4WD LOCK” ward or backward, causing injury or
tight corner braking and results from each of and then gradually depress the accelerator damage to nearby people or objects.
the 4 tyres being at a different distance from pedal for a smooth start. Keep the pressure on
the corner. The phenomenon is typical of 4- the accelerator pedal as constant as possible,
wheel drive vehicles. If this occurs, either NOTE
and drive at low speed.
straighten out the steering wheel, or change l Avoid sudden braking, sudden acceleration
to “2WD” or “4WD AUTO” mode. and sharp turning; such operations could re-
sult in the vehicle becoming stuck.

6-42 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Inspection and maintenance following rough road operation

NOTE CAUTION l Carefully wash the vehicle with water.


Drive the vehicle slowly while lightly
l If the vehicle becomes stuck in sandy or l Never drive through water that is deep depressing the brake pedal in order to
muddy roads, it can often be moved with a enough to cover wheel hubs, axles or ex-
dry out the brakes. If the brakes still do
rocking motion. Move the gearshift lever al- haust pipe. Do not change the gearshift lever
position (M/T) or the selector lever position not function properly, we recommend
ternately between the 1st and “R” (Reverse)
positions (M/T), the “D” (DRIVE) and “R” (A/T or CVT) while driving through water. you to have the brakes checked as soon
(REVERSE) positions (A/T or CVT), while Frequent driving through water can adverse- as possible.
pressing lightly on the accelerator pedal. ly affect the life span of the vehicle; we rec- l Remove the insects, dried grass, etc.
l Driving on rough roads can cause rust on the ommend you to take the necessary measures clogging the radiator core.
to prepare, inspect, and repair the vehicle.
vehicle; wash the vehicle thoroughly as soon
as possible after such use. l After driving through water, apply the
l After driving through water, check the 6
engine, transmission and differential oil.
brakes to be sure they are functioning prop-
erly. If the brakes are wet and not function- If the oil or grease is milky or cloudy be-
Climbing/descending sharp ing properly, dry them out by driving slowly cause of water contamination, it must be
grades while lightly depressing the brake pedal. In- replaced with new oil or grease.
spect each part of the vehicle carefully. l Check the inside of the vehicle. If water
Your vehicle may not provide sufficient hill entry is found, dry the carpet etc.
climbing ability and engine braking on steep l Inspect the headlamps, If the headlamp
slopes. Avoid driving on steep slopes even Inspection and maintenance bulb is flooded with water, we recom-
though the vehicle is a 4-wheel drive vehicle. following rough road mend you to have it drained.

Driving through water operation


E00606700338
Cautions on handling of 4-
E00618900106
If the electrical circuits become wet, further After operating the vehicle in rough road wheel drive vehicles
operation of the vehicle will be impossible; conditions, be sure to perform the following E00606800818

therefore, avoid driving through water unless inspection and maintenance procedures:
absolutely necessary. If driving through wa- l Check that the vehicle has not been dam- Tyres and wheels
ter is unavoidable, use the following proce- aged by rocks, gravel, etc.
dure: Since the driving torque can be applied to the
4 wheels, the driving performance of the ve-
Check the depth of the water and the terrain hicle when operating in 4-wheel drive is
before attempting to drive through it. Drive greatly affected by the condition of the tyres.
slowly to avoid creating excessive water
splashing.
OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-43
Braking
Pay close attention to the tyres. Towing Jacking up a 4-wheel drive ve-
l Install only the specified tyres on all hicle
wheels. Refer to “Tyres and wheels” on
page 11-13.
l Be sure all 4 tyres and wheels are the
WARNING
same size and type. l Do not crank the engine while the vehicle
When it is necessary to replace any of is jacked up.
the tyres or wheels, replace all 4 tyres. The tyre on the ground may turn and the
vehicle may roll off the jack.
l All tyres should be rotated before the
6 wear difference between the front and
Clutch operation
rear tyres is recognizable.
Quick or slight clutch engagement made
Good vehicle performance cannot be expec-
while the engine is running at high speed will
ted if there is a difference in wear between
cause damage to the clutch and transmission
tyres. Refer to “Tyre rotation” on page 10-15.
because the tractive force is very great.
l Check the tyre inflation pressure regular-
Operate the pedal slowly and positively.
ly.
CAUTION Braking
CAUTION l Do not tow 4-wheel drive vehicles with the E00607001784

l Always use tyres of the same size, same front or rear wheels on the ground (Type A
type, and same brand, and which have no or Type B) as illustrated. This could result in All the parts of the brake system are critical
wear differences. Using tyres of different damage to the drivetrain, or unstable towing. to safety. We recommend you to have the ve-
size, type, brands or degree of wear, will in- If you tow 4-wheel drive vehicles, use Type hicle checked at regular intervals according
crease the differential oil temperature, result- C or Type D equipment. to the service booklet.
ing in possible damage to the driving sys- l Even in “2WD” drive mode, the vehicle can-
tem. Further, the drive train will be subjec- not be towed with the front or the rear
ted to excessive loading possibly leading to wheels on the ground. CAUTION
oil leakage, component seizure, or other seri-
l Avoid driving habits that cause heavy brak-
ous faults. ing and never “ride” the brakes by resting
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
It causes brake overheating and fade.

6-44 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Hill start assist*

Brake system When brakes are wet Brake pad


The service brake is divided into two brake Check the brake system while driving at a l Avoid hard braking situations.
circuits. And your vehicle is equipped with low speed immediately after starting, espe- New brakes need to be broken-in by
power brakes. If one brake circuit fails, the cially when the brakes are wet, to confirm moderate use for the first 200 km
other is available to stop the vehicle. If you they work normally. (124 miles).
should lose the power assist for some reason, A film of water can be formed on the brake l The disc brakes are provided with a
the brakes will still work. In these situations, discs and prevent normal braking after driv- warning device which emits a shrieking
even if the brake pedal moves down to the ing in heavy rain or through large puddles, or metallic sound while braking if the brake
very end of its possible stroke or resists being after the vehicle is washed. If this occurs, dry pads have reached their wear limit. If 6
depressed, keep depressing the brake pedal the brakes out by driving slowly while lightly you hear this sound, have the brake pads
down harder and further than usual; stop depressing the brake pedal. replaced immediately.
driving as soon as possible and have the
brake system repaired. When driving downhill WARNING
It is important to take advantage of the en- l Driving with worn brake pads will make
WARNING gine braking by shifting to a lower shift posi- it harder to stop, and can cause an acci-
dent.
l Do not turn off the engine while your ve- tion while driving on steep downhill roads in
hicle is in motion. If you turn off the en- order to prevent the brakes from overheating.
gine while driving, the power assistance
for the braking system will stop working Hill start assist*
and your brakes will not work effectively. WARNING E00628000155

l If the power assist is lost or if either brake


l Do not leave any objects near the brake The hill start assist makes it easy to start off
hydraulic system stops working properly,
pedal or let a floor mat slide under it; do- on a steep uphill slope by preventing the ve-
have your vehicle checked immediately.
ing so could prevent the full pedal stroke
hicle from moving backwards. It keeps the
that would be necessary in an emergency.
Warning display Make sure that the pedal can be operated
braking force for about 2 seconds when you
freely at all times. Make sure the floor move your foot from the brake pedal to the
The brake warning lamp illuminates to indi- mat is securely held in place. accelerator pedal.
cate a fault in the braking system. A warning
is also displayed on the multi-information
display. Refer to “Brake warning lamp” on
page 5-45 and “Brake warning display” on
page 5-46.
OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-45
Hill start assist*

CAUTION On vehicles equipped with A/T, CVT, NOTE


place the selector lever into the “D” po-
l Do not overly rely on the hill start assist to sition. • On vehicles equipped with M/T, the gear-
prevent backwards movement of the vehicle. shift lever is in the following position.
Under certain circumstances, even when hill [When starting an uphill slope forwards.]
start assist is activated, the vehicle may NOTE The gearshift lever is in any position other
move backwards if the brake pedal is not than “R”.
sufficiently depressed, if the vehicle is heav- l When reversing on an uphill slope, place the (The hill start assist will operate, even if
ily loaded, or if the road is very steep or slip- gearshift lever or the selector lever into the the gearshift lever is in the “N” position.)
pery. “R” position. [When starting an uphill slope back-
6 l The hill start assist is not designed to keep wards.]
the vehicle stopped in place on uphill slopes 3. Release the brake pedal and the hill start The gearshift lever is in the “R” position.
for more than 2 seconds. assist will maintain the braking force ap- (The hill start assist will not operate when
l When facing uphill, do not rely on using the
plied while stopping for approximately 2 the gearshift lever is in the “N” position.)
hill start assist to maintain a stopped position • On vehicles equipped with A/T, CVT, the
as an alternative to depressing the brake ped- seconds. selector lever is in any position other than
al. 4. Depress the accelerator pedal and the “P” or “N”.
Doing so could result in an accident. hill start assist gradually will decrease • The vehicle is completely stationary, with
l Do not perform the following operation the braking force as the vehicle starts the brake pedal depressed.
while the hill start assist is operating. moving. • The parking brake is released.
[Except for vehicles equipped with keyless l The hill start assist will not operate if the ac-
operation system] celerator pedal is depressed before the brake
Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” or NOTE pedal is released.
“ACC” position. l The hill start assist also operates when re-
[Vehicles equipped with keyless operation l The hill start assist is activated when all of
the following conditions are met. versing on an uphill slope.
system]
• The engine is running.
Put the operation mode in OFF or ACC. (The hill start assist will not be activated
The hill start assist could stop operating, while the engine is starting or immediate-
Warning display
which could result in an accident. ly after the engine is started.) E00628200199
If an abnormal condition occurs in the sys-
To operate tem, the following display/indicator will turn
on.
E00628100374
1. Stop the vehicle completely using the ASC indicator
brake pedal. -
2. On vehicles equipped with M/T, place
the gearshift lever into the 1st position.
6-46 Starting and driving OGAE15E5
Brake assist system

Warning display type 1 CAUTION CAUTION


l Park your vehicle in a safe place and stop l The brake assist system is not a device de-
the engine. signed to exercise braking force greater than
Restart the engine and check whether the its capacity. Make sure to always keep a suf-
warning display went out, in which case the ficient distance between vehicles in front of
hill start assist is again working normally. you without relying too much on the brake
If the warning remains displayed or reap- assist system.
Warning display type 2 pears frequently, it is not necessary to stop
the vehicle immediately, but the vehicle
should be inspected at a MITSUBISHI NOTE 6
MOTORS Authorized Service Point as soon
as possible. l Once the brake assist system is operational,
it maintains great braking force even if the
brake pedal is lightly released.
To stop its operation, completely remove
Brake assist system your foot from the brake pedal.
NOTE
E00627001588
l The brake assist system may become opera-
The brake assist system is a device assisting tional when the brake pedal is fully de-
l The combination of items shown on the dis- pressed even if it has not been depressed
drivers who cannot depress the brake pedal suddenly. [Except for vehicles equipped
play varies depending on the vehicle model.
firmly when it is necessary to do so (such as with Active Stability Control (ASC)]
in emergency stop situations) and provides l When the brake assist system is in use, you
CAUTION greater braking force. may feel as if the depressed brake pedal is
soft, the pedal moves in small motions in
l If the warning is displayed, the hill start as- If the brake pedal is depressed suddenly, the conjunction with the sound of the ABS oper-
sist will not operate. Start off carefully. ation, or the vehicle body and the steering
brakes will be applied with more force than
wheel vibrate. This occurs when the brake
usual.
assist system is operating normally and does
not indicate faulty operation. Continue to
firmly depress the brake pedal.
l You may hear an operation noise when the
brake pedal is suddenly or fully depressed
while stationary. This does not indicate a
malfunction and the brake assist system is
operating normally.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-47


Emergency stop signal system

NOTE NOTE Driving hints


l When the ABS warning lamp/display or on- l [Activating condition for the emergency stop l Always keep a safe distance from the ve-
ly ASC warning display illuminate, the signal system]
brake assist system in not functioning. [Ve- It activates when all of the following condi-
hicle in front of you. Even if your vehi-
hicles equipped with Active Stability Con- tions are met. cle is equipped with ABS, leave a great-
trol (ASC)] • The vehicle speed is approximately er braking distance when:
55 km/h (34 mph) or higher. • Driving on gravel or snow-covered
• The brake pedal has been depressed, and roads.
Emergency stop signal the system judges that it was sudden brak- • Driving with tyre chains installed.
ing from the vehicle deceleration and the
6 system operating condition of the anti-lock brake
• Driving on uneven road surfaces.
E00626000018 system (ABS).
l Operation of ABS is not restricted to sit-
[Deactivating condition for the emergency uations where brakes are applied sud-
This is a device that reduces the possibility of stop signal system] denly. This system may also prevent the
rear end collisions by the rapid and automatic It deactivates when one of the following wheels from locking when you drive
blinking of the hazard warning lamps to alert conditions is met. over manholes, steel roadwork plates,
vehicles approaching from behind during • The brake pedal is released. road markings, or any uneven road sur-
sudden braking. When the emergency stop • The hazard warning flasher switch is face.
signal system operates, the hazard warning pressed. l When the ABS is activated, you may
indication lamp in the instrument cluster • The system judges that it was not sudden feel the brake pedal pulsation and the vi-
blinks rapidly at the same time. braking from the vehicle deceleration and
the operating condition of the anti-lock brations of the vehicle body and steering
brake system (ABS). wheel. It may also feel as if the pedal re-
CAUTION sists being pressed.
In this situation, simply hold the
l If the ABS warning or ASC warning is dis-
played, the emergency stop signal system
Anti-lock brake system brake pedal down firmly. Do not
may not operate. (ABS) pump the brake, which will result in
Refer to “ABS warning lamp/display” on reduced braking performance.
E00607101046
page 6-49.
Refer to “ASC warning display” on page The anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps pre-
6-53. vent the wheels from locking up when brak-
ing. This helps maintain vehicle drivability
and steering wheel handling.

6-48 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Anti-lock brake system (ABS)
l An operation noise is emitted from the ABS warning lamp/display CAUTION
engine compartment or you can feel a E00607201135
shock from the brake pedal when start l Any of the following indicates that the ABS
Warning lamp is not functioning and only the standard
driving immediately after starting the en-
brake system is working. (The standard
gine. These are normal sounds or opera- brake system is functioning normally.) If
tions that the ABS makes when perform- this happens, we recommend you to have
ing a self-check. It does not indicate a your vehicle inspected as soon as possible.
malfunction. • When the ignition switch is turned to the
l The ABS can be used after the vehicle Warning display type 1 “ON” position or the operation mode is
put in ON, the warning lamp does not
has reached a speed over approximately
come on or it remains on and does not go 6
10 km/h (6 mph). It stops working when
off.
the vehicle slows below approximately
• The warning lamp comes on while driv-
5 km/h (3 mph). ing.
• The warning display appears while driv-
ing.
CAUTION Warning display type 2
l The ABS cannot prevent accidents. It is your
responsibility to take safety precautions and If the warning lamp/display il-
to drive carefully. luminate while driving
l To prevent failure of the ABS, be sure all 4
E00607301295
wheels and tyres are the same size and the
same type.
If only the ABS warning lamp/
l Do not install any aftermarket limited-slip
display illuminate
differential (LSD) on your vehicle. The ABS If there is a malfunction in the system, the
may stop functioning properly. ABS warning lamp will come on and the Avoid hard braking and high-speed driving.
warning display will appear on the informa- Stop the vehicle in a safe place.
tion screen in the multi-information display. Restart the engine and check to see whether
Under normal conditions, the ABS warning the lamp goes out after a few minutes driv-
lamp only comes on when the ignition switch ing; if it then remains off during driving,
is turned to the “ON” position or the opera- there is no problem.
tion mode is put in ON and goes off a few However, if the warning lamp/display do not
seconds later. disappear, or if they come on again when the
vehicle is driven, we recommend you to have
the vehicle checked.
OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-49
Electric power steering system (EPS)
If the ABS warning lamp/ NOTE Rear
display and brake warning
lamp/display illuminate at the l The ABS warning lamp and brake warning
lamp illuminate at the same time and the
same time warning displays appear alternately on the
information screen in the multi-information
Warning lamp
display.

After driving on icy roads


6 E00618800150
After driving on snow or icy roads, remove
Warning display type 1 any snow and ice which may have accumula- Electric power steering
ted around the wheels. On vehicles that have
an ABS, be careful not to damage the wheel system (EPS)
speed sensors (A) or the cables located at E00629200226

each wheel. The power steering system operates while the


engine is running. It helps reduce the effort
Front needed to turn the steering wheel.
Warning display type 2 The power steering system has mechanical
steering capability in case the power assist is
lost. If the power assist is lost for some rea-
son, you will still be able to steer your vehi-
cle, but you will notice it takes much more
effort to steer. If this happens, have your ve-
hicle inspected at a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
The ABS and brake force distribution func- Authorized Service Point.
tion may not work, so hard braking could
make the vehicle unstable.
Avoid hard braking and high-speed driving.
Stop the vehicle in a safe place and we rec-
ommend you to have it checked.

6-50 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Active stability control (ASC)*

WARNING Electric power steering system Active stability control


l Do not stop the engine while the vehicle is
warning display (ASC)*
moving. Stopping the engine would make
E00616700331
the steering wheel extremely hard to turn, Type 1
possibly resulting in an accident. The Active Stability Control (ASC) takes
overall control of the anti-lock brake system,
traction control function and stability control
NOTE function to help maintain the vehicle’s con-
l During repeated full-lock turning of the trol and traction. Please read this section in
steering wheel (for example, while you are conjunction with the page on the anti-lock 6
manoeuvring the vehicle into a parking brake system, traction control function and
Type 2
space), a protection function may be activa-
stability control function.
ted to prevent overheating of the power
steering system. This function will make the
steering wheel gradually harder to turn. In Anti-lock brake system (ABS) ® p. 6-48
this event, limit your turning of the steering Traction control function ® p. 6-52
wheel for a while. When the system has Stability control function ® p. 6-52
cooled down, the steering action will return
to normal. When there is a malfunction in the system,
l If you turn the steering wheel while the vehi- the warning display will appear on the infor- CAUTION
cle is stationary with the headlamps on, the mation screen in the multi-information dis-
headlamps may become dim. This behaviour
l Do not over-rely on the ASC. Even the ASC
play. cannot prevent the natural laws of physics
is not abnormal. The headlamps will return from acting on the vehicle.
to their original brightness after a short This system, like any other system, has lim-
while. CAUTION its and cannot help you to maintain traction
and control of the vehicle in all circumstan-
l If the warning display appears while engine ces. Reckless driving may lead to accidents.
is running, have the vehicle inspected by a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv- It is the driver’s responsibility to drive care-
ice Point as soon as possible. It may become fully. This means taking into account the
harder to turn the steering wheel. traffic, road and environmental conditions.
l Be sure to use the same specified type and
size of tyre on all 4 wheels. Otherwise, the
ASC may not work properly.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-51


Active stability control (ASC)*

CAUTION Traction control function “ASC OFF” switch


E00619000087 E00619200353
l Do not install any aftermarket limited-slip
On slippery surfaces, the traction control The ASC is automatically activated when the
differential (LSD) on your vehicle. The ASC
may stop functioning properly. function prevents the drive wheels from spin- ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position
ning excessive, thus helping the vehicle to or the operation mode is put in ON. You can
start moving from a stopped condition. It also deactivate the system by pressing down the
NOTE provides sufficient driving force and steering “ASC OFF” switch for 3 seconds or longer.
l An operation noise may be emitted from the performance as the vehicle turns while press- When the ASC is deactivated, the display/
engine compartment in the following situa- ing the acceleration pedal. indicator will turn on. To reactivate the ASC,
6 tions. The sound is associated with checking momentarily press the “ASC OFF” switch;
the operations of the ASC. At this time, you the display/indicator is turned off.
may feel a shock from the brake pedal if you CAUTION
depress it. These do not indicate a malfunc- l When driving a vehicle on a snowy or icy
tion. road, be sure to install snow tyres and drive
• When the ignition switch is turned to the the vehicle at moderate speeds.
“ON” position or the operation mode is
put in ON.
• When the vehicle is driven for a while af- Stability control function
ter the engine is turned on. E00619100017
l When the ASC is activated, you may feel a The stability control function is designed to
vibration in the vehicle body or hear a whin- help the driver maintain control of the vehicle
ing sound from the engine compartment.
on slippery roads or during rapid steering ma-
This indicates that the system is operating
normally. It does not indicate a malfunction. noeuvres. It works by controlling the engine
l When the anti-lock brake system warning output and brake on each wheel.
lamp is illuminated, the ASC is not active. CAUTION
NOTE l For safety reasons, the “ASC OFF” switch
should be operated when your vehicle is
l The stability control function operates at
stopped.
speeds of about 15 km/h (9 mph) or higher.
l Be sure to keep the ASC on while driving in
normal circumstances.

6-52 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Active stability control (ASC)*

NOTE NOTE NOTE


l When moving out of mud, sand or fresh l The combination of items shown on the dis- l The display/indicator may turn on when
snow, pressing the accelerator pedal may not play varies depending on the vehicle model. you start the engine. This means that the bat-
allow the engine speed to increase. In such tery voltage momentarily dropped when the
situations, temporarily turning off the ASC engine was started. It does not indicate a
with the “ASC OFF” switch will make it CAUTION malfunction, provided that the display goes
easier to move out your vehicle. out immediately.
l Using the “ASC OFF” switch turns off both l When display/indicator blinks, ASC is
operating, which means that the road is slip- l When a compact spare tyre has been put on
the stability control function and the traction your vehicle, the gripping ability of the tyre
control function. pery or that your vehicle’s wheels are begin-
l If you continue to press the “ASC OFF” ning to slip. If this happens, drive slower
will be lower, making it more likely that the
display/indicator will blink.
6
switch after the ASC is turned off, the “mis- with less accelerator input.
taken operation protection function” will ac- l If the temperature in the braking system con-
tivate and the ASC will turn back on. tinues to increase due to continuous brake ASC warning display
control on a slippery road surface, the dis-
E00619400443
play/indicator will blink. To prevent the
If an abnormal condition occurs in the sys-
ASC operation display or ASC brake system from overheating, the brake
control of the traction control function will tem, the following display/indicator will turn
OFF display be temporarily suspended. on.
E00619300426
The engine control of the traction control
function and normal brake operation will not ASC indicator
ASC operation display/ASC indica- be affected. Park your vehicle in a safe -
- tor place. When the temperature in the braking
The display/indicator will blink ASC OFF display/ASC OFF in-
system has come down, the display/indi- -
when the ASC is operating. dicator
cator will be turned off and the traction con-
ASC OFF display/ASC OFF indica- trol function will start operating again.
- tor
This display/incicator will turn on
when the ASC is turned off with the
“ASC OFF” switch.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-53


Cruise control*

Warning display type 1 Towing CAUTION


E00624400050
l Do not use cruise control when driving con-
ditions will not allow you to stay at the same
CAUTION speed, such as in heavy traffic or on roads
that are winding, icy, snow-covered, wet,
l When towing the vehicle with only the front slippery, on a steep downhill slope.
wheels or only the rear wheels raised off the
ground, do not place the ignition switch in l On vehicles with M/T, do not move the
Warning display type 2 gearshift lever to the “N” (Neutral) position
the “ON” position or do not put the opera-
while driving at a set speed without depress-
tion mode in ON. Placing the ignition switch
ing the clutch pedal. The engine will run too
6 in the “ON” position or putting the operation
fast and might be damaged.
mode in ON could cause the ASC to operate,
resulting in an accident.
Note that the correct towing method depends
on the transmission type and the vehicle’s
NOTE
drive configuration. l Cruise control may not be able to keep your
For details, refer to “Towing” on page speed on uphills or downhills.
NOTE 8-20. l Your speed may decrease on a steep uphill.
You may use the accelerator pedal if you
l The combination of items shown on the dis- want to stay at your set speed.
play varies depending on the vehicle model.
Cruise control* l Your speed may increase to more than the
E00609101138
set speed on a steep downhill. You must use
CAUTION Cruise control is an automatic speed control
the brake to control your speed. As a result,
the set speed driving is deactivated.
l The system may be malfunctioning. system that keeps a set speed. It can be acti-
Park your vehicle in a safe place and stop vated at about 40 km/h (25 mph) or more.
the engine.
Restart the engine and check whether the
display/indicator goes out. If they go out, CAUTION
there is no abnormal condition. If they do
not go out or appear frequently, it is not nec- l When you do not wish to drive at a set
essary to stop the vehicle immediately, but speed, turn off the cruise control for safety.
we recommend you to have your vehicle in-
spected.

6-54 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Cruise control*

Cruise control switches NOTE NOTE


l When operating the cruise control switches, l If the cruise control is on when the following
press the cruise control switches correctly. operation is performed, cruise control will
The set speed driving may be deactivated be on automatically the next time you start
automatically if two or more switches of the the engine. The “CRUISE” indication lamp
cruise control are pressed at the same time. will also be on.
[Except vehicles equipped with keyless op-
eration system]
To activate Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” or
“ACC” position.
E00609301198
1. With the ignition switch is in “ON” posi- [Vehicles equipped with keyless operation 6
tion or the operation mode is in ON, system]
press the CRUISE CONTROL ON/OFF Put the operation mode in OFF or ACC.
A- CRUISE CONTROL ON/OFF switch switch (A) to turn on the cruise control. l If the battery voltage is insufficient, the
memory data for the cruise control may be
Used to turn on and off the cruise control. The “CRUISE” indication lamp in the erased.
meter cluster will come on. As a result, the “CRUISE” indication lamp
B- SET - switch may not come on when you restart the en-
Used to reduce the set speed and to set the gine.
desired speed. If this happens, press the CRUISE CON-
TROL ON/OFF switch once again to turn on
the cruise control.
C- RES + switch
Used to increase the set speed and to return to
the original set speed.

D- CANCEL switch
Used to deactivate the set speed driving.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-55


Cruise control*
2. Accelerate or decelerate to your desired When you reach your desired speed, release Accelerator pedal
speed, then push down and release the the switch. Your new cruising speed is now
While driving at the set speed, use the accel-
SET - switch (B) when the “CRUISE” set.
erator pedal to reach your desired speed and
indication lamp is illuminated. The vehi-
then push down the SET - switch (B) and re-
cle will then maintain the desired speed.
lease the switch momentarily to set a new de-
sired cruising speed.

To increase your speed in small amounts,


push up the RES + switch for less than about
NOTE 1 second and release it.
Each time you push up the RES + switch,
l When you release the SET - switch, the ve- your vehicle will go about 1.6 km/h (1 mph) To decrease the set speed
hicle speed will be set.
faster. E00609500614
There are 2 ways to decrease the set speed.
To increase the set speed
SET - switch
E00609400697
There are 2 ways to increase the set speed. Push down and hold the SET - switch (B)
while driving at the set speed, and your speed
RES + switch will slow down gradually.
Push up and hold the RES + switch (C) while
driving at the set speed, and your speed will
then gradually increase.

6-56 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Cruise control*
When you reach your desired speed, release Brake pedal To temporarily increase or de-
the switch. Your new cruising speed is now crease the speed
While driving at the set speed, use the brake
set.
pedal, which disengages the cruise control, E00609600211

then push down the SET - switch (B) and re-


lease the switch momentarily to set a new de- To temporarily increase the
sired cruising speed. speed
Depress the accelerator pedal as you would
normally. When you release the pedal, you
will return to your set speed.
6

To slow down your speed in small amounts,


push down the SET - switch for less than
about 1 second and release it.
Each time you push down the SET - switch,
your vehicle will slow down by about
1.6 km/h (1 mph).

NOTE
l In some driving conditions, the set speed
driving may be deactivated. If this happens,
refer to “To activate” on page 6-55 and re-
peat the speed setting procedure.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-57


Cruise control*
To temporarily decrease the l Depress the brake pedal. WARNING
speed
l On vehicles equipped with A/T, CVT, al-
Depress the brake pedal to decrease the though the set speed driving will be deac-
speed. To return to the previously set speed, tivated when shifting to the “N” (NEU-
push up the RES + switch (C). TRAL) position, never move the selector
Refer to “To resume the set speed” on page lever to the “N” (NEUTRAL) position
while driving.
6-59. You would have no engine braking and
could cause a serious accident.
6
Also, the set speed driving may be deactiva-
ted as follows:
l When the engine speed rises and ap-
The set speed driving is deactivated automat- proaches the tachometer's red zone (the
ically in any of the following ways. red-coloured part of the tachometer di-
l When you depress the clutch pedal (on al).
vehicles with M/T).
l When your speed slows to about
15 km/h (9 mph) or more below the set CAUTION
speed because of a hill, etc. l When the set speed driving is deactivated
To deactivate l When your speed slows to about automatically in any situation other than
E00609701437
40 km/h (25 mph) or less. those listed above, there may be a system
The set speed driving can be deactivated as malfunction.
l When the Active Stability Control
follows: (ASC) starts operating. (if so equipped)
Press the CRUISE CONTROL ON/OFF
l Press the CRUISE CONTROL ON/OFF switch to turn off the cruise control and have
Refer to “Active stability control (ASC)” your vehicle inspected by a MITSUBISHI
switch (A) (Cruise control will be turned on page 6-51. MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
off.)
l Press the CANCEL switch (D).

6-58 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Tyre pressure monitoring system (TPMS)*

To resume the set speed l [Except vehicles equipped with keyless The tyre inflation pressure sensor IDs for two
E00609800675
operation system] sets of tyres can be registered by a
If the set speed driving is deactivated by the Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service
condition described in “To deactivate” on or “ACC” position. Point, and the valid ID set can be switched by
page 6-58, you can resume the previously set [Vehicles equipped with keyless opera- the multi-information meter switch (It’s ben-
speed by push up the RES + switch (C) while tion system] eficial in case of seasonal tyre change be-
driving at a speed of about 40 km/h (25 mph) Put the operation mode in OFF or ACC. tween summer tyre and winter tyre.)
or higher. l “CRUISE” indication lamp is turned
OFF.
6
Tyre pressure monitoring
system (TPMS)*
E00637100165

The tyre pressure monitoring system (TPMS)


uses tyre inflation pressure sensors (A) on the
wheels to monitor the tyre inflation pressures.
The system only indicates when a tyre is sig-
nificantly under-inflated.
The base tyre pressure can be set at desired
Under either of the following conditions, WARNING
value by the driver with the reset function ex-
however, using the switch does not allow you
ecution. (The low pressure warning threshold l The spare wheel does not have a tyre in-
to resume the previously set speed. flation pressure sensor.
is set based on the reset.)
In these situations, repeat the speed setting When the spare tyre is used, the tyre pres-
procedure: sure monitoring system will not work
l The CRUISE CONTROL ON/OFF properly.
switch is pressed. See a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
ized Service Point as soon as possible to
replace or repair the original tyre.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-59


Tyre pressure monitoring system (TPMS)*

NOTE When the ignition switch is turned to the NOTE


“ON” position or the operation mode is put in
l The tyre pressure monitoring system ON, the tyre pressure monitoring system Type 2
(TPMS) is not a substitute for regularly
warning lamp normally illuminates and goes
checking tyre inflation pressures.
Be sure to check the tyre inflation pressures off a few seconds later.
as described in “Tyres” on page 10-13.
l The tyre inflation pressure sensor (B) is in- If one or more of the vehicle tyres (except for
stalled in the illustrated location. the spare tyre) is significantly under-inflated,
Replace grommet and washer (C) with a the warning lamp will remain illuminated
new one when the tyre is replaced.
6 For details, please contact a MITSUBISHI
while the ignition switch or the operation
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
mode is in ON. CAUTION
Refer to “If the warning lamp/display illumi-
l If the warning lamp does not illuminate
nates while driving” on page 6-62 and take when the ignition switch is turned to the
the necessary measurements. “ON” position or the operation mode is put
in ON, it means that the tyre pressure moni-
toring system (TPMS) is not working prop-
NOTE erly. Have the system inspected by a
l In addition, the warning display will be dis- MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
played on the information screen in the mul- ice Point.
ti-information display. In such situations, a malfunctioning of the
system may prevent the monitoring of the
Type 1 tyre pressure. Avoid sudden braking, sharp
turning and high-speed driving.
The tyre pressure monitoring
system warning lamp/display
E00637200111

6-60 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Tyre pressure monitoring system (TPMS)*

CAUTION NOTE Accordingly, when the low tyre pressure tell-


tale illuminates, you should stop and check
l If a malfunction is detected in the tyre pres- Type 1 your tyres as soon as possible, and inflate
sure monitoring system (TPMS), the warn-
them to the proper pressure. Driving on a sig-
ing lamp will blink for approximately 1 mi-
nute and then remain continuously illumina- nificantly under-inflated tyre causes the tyre
ted. to overheat and can lead to tyre failure.
The warning lamp will issue further warn- Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency
ings each time the engine is restarted as long and tyre tread life, and may affect the vehi-
as the malfunction exists. cle’s handling and stopping ability.
Check to see whether the warning lamp goes
off after few minutes driving.
Type 2 Please note that the tyre pressure monitoring 6
system (TPMS) is not a substitute for proper
If it then goes off during driving, there is no
problem. tyre maintenance, and it is the driver’s re-
However, if the warning lamp does not go sponsibility to maintain correct tyre pressure,
off, or if it blinks again when the engine is even if under-inflation has not reached the
restarted, have the vehicle inspected by a level to trigger illumination of the tyre pres-
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv- sure monitoring system (TPMS) low tyre
ice Point. pressure telltale.
In such situations, a malfunctioning of the Each tyre, including the spare (if so equip- Your vehicle has also been equipped with a
system may be preventing the monitoring of ped), should be checked monthly when cold
the tyre pressure. For safety reasons, when
warning lamp to indicate when the system is
and inflated to the inflation pressure recom- not operating properly.
the warning lamp appears while driving, mended by the vehicle manufacturer on the
avoid sudden braking, sharp turning and The warning lamp is combined with the low
high-speed driving.
tyre inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle tyre pressure telltale.
has tyres of a different size than the size indi- When the system detects a malfunction, the
cated on the tyre inflation pressure label, you telltale will flash for approximately one mi-
NOTE should determine the proper tyre inflation nute and then remain continuously illumina-
pressure for those tyres.) ted. This sequence will continue upon subse-
l In addition, the warning display will be dis-
played on the information screen in the mul- As an added safety feature, your vehicle has quent vehicle start-ups as long as the mal-
ti-information display. been equipped with the tyre pressure moni- function exists.
toring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low When the warning lamp is illuminated, the
tyre pressure telltale when one or more of system may not be able to detect or signal
your tyres is significantly under-inflated. low tyre pressure as intended.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-61


Tyre pressure monitoring system (TPMS)*
The tyre pressure monitoring system (TPMS) NOTE CAUTION
malfunctions may occur for a variety of rea-
sons, including the installation of replace- l After inspecting or adjusting the tyre pres- l The warning lamp/display may not illumi-
sure, always reinstall the valve cap on the nate immediately in the event of a tyre blow-
ment or alternate tyres or wheels on the vehi-
valve stem. out or rapid leak.
cle that prevent the tyre pressure monitoring Without the valve cap, dirt or moisture could
system (TPMS) from functioning properly. get into the valve, resulting in damage to the
Always check the tyre pressure monitoring tyre inflation pressure sensor. NOTE
system (TPMS) malfunction telltale after re- l Do not use metal valve caps, which may
placing one or more tyres or wheels on your cause a metal reaction, resulting in corrosion l To avoid the risk of damage to the tyre infla-
tion pressure sensors, have any punctured
and damage of the tyre inflation pressure
6 vehicle to ensure that the replacement or al-
sensors.
tyre repaired by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
ternate tyres and wheels allow the tyre pres- Authorized Service Point. If the tyre repair is
sure monitoring system (TPMS) to continue l Once adjustments have been made, the
not done by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
warning lamp will go off after a few minutes
to function properly. thorized Service Point, damage to the tyre
of driving.
inflation pressure sensor is not covered by
If the warning lamp/display il- your warranty.
luminates while driving 2. If the warning lamp remains illuminated l Do not use an aerosol puncture-repair spray
after you have been driving for about 10 on any tyre.
E00637300037
minutes after you adjust the tyre infla- Such a spray could damage the tyre inflation
1. If the warning lamp illuminates, avoid pressure sensors.
hard braking, sharp steering manoeuvres tion pressure, one or more of the tyres
Have any puncture repaired by a
and high speeds. You should stop and may have a puncture. Inspect the tyre MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
adjust the tyres to the proper inflation and if it has a puncture, have it repaired ice Point.
pressure as soon as possible. Adjust the by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author- l Using the tyre repair kit may damage the
spare tyre at the same time. Refer to ized Service Point as soon as possible. tyre inflation pressure sensor. The vehicle
must promptly be inspected and repaired by
“Tyres” on page 10-13 a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
WARNING ice Point.
NOTE l If the warning lamp/display illuminates
while you are driving, avoid hard brak- The tyre pressure monitoring system (TPMS)
l In addition, the warning display will be dis- ing, sharp steering manoeuvres and high
played on the information screen in the mul- may not work normally in the following cir-
speeds.
ti-information display. Driving with an under-inflated tyre ad-
cumstances:
l When inspecting or adjusting the tyre pres- versely affects vehicle performance and l A wireless facility or device using the
sure, do not apply excessive force to the can result in an accident. same frequency is near the vehicle.
valve stem to avoid breakage.

6-62 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Tyre pressure monitoring system (TPMS)*
l Snow or ice is stuck inside the fenders Whenever the tyres and wheels 1. Operate the multi-information meter
and/or on the wheels. are replaced with new ones switch to switch the information screen
l The tyre inflation pressure sensor’s bat-
E00637400025
to the menu screen.
tery is dead. If new wheels with new tyre inflation pres- Refer to “Multi information display
l Wheels other than MITSUBISHI sure sensors are installed, their ID codes must switch” on page 5-05.
MOTORS GENUINE wheels are being be programmed into the tyre pressure moni- Refer to “Changing the function settings
used. toring system. Have tyre and wheel replace- (when the ignition switch or the opera-
l Wheels that are not fitted with tyre infla- ment performed by a MITSUBISHI tion mode is ON)” on page 5-19.
tion pressure sensors are being used. MOTORS Authorized Service Point to avoid 2. Lightly press the multi-information me-
l Wheels whose ID codes are not memo- the risk of damaging the tyre inflation pres- ter switch to select “ ” (reset 6
rized by the vehicle are used. sure sensors. If the wheel replacement is not of low tyre pressure warning threshold).
l A window tint that affects the radio done by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author- 3. Press and hold the multi-information
wave signals is installed. ized Service Point, it is not covered by your meter switch for about 3 seconds or
warranty. more, the buzzer sounds.
NOTE
l Tyre inflation pressures vary with the ambi- CAUTION Type 1 Type 2
ent temperature. If the vehicle is subjected to
large variations in ambient temperature, the l The use of non-genuine wheels will prevent
tyre inflation pressures may be low (causing the proper fit of the tyre inflation pressure
the warning lamp/display to come on) when sensors, resulting air leakage or damage of
the ambient temperature is relatively low. If the sensors.
the warning lamp/display comes on, adjust
the tyre inflation pressure. Reset of low tyre pressure
warning threshold
E00637500039
The threshold is set based on the tyre pres- 4. The warning lamp start flashing slowly.
sure which the reset function is executed by 5. Drive for a while. The reset is completed
following procedure. if the warning lamp goes out.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-63


Reversing sensor system*

NOTE 3. Press and hold the multi-information NOTE


meter switch for about 3 seconds or
l The reset function should be executed every more. l When changing the tyre ID set, the reset
time when the tyre pressure or tyre rotation function of low tyre pressure warning
The setting changes the selected tyre ID
is adjusted. threshold is automatically started. (The
set.
l The reset function should be executed when warning lamp start flashing slowly.) If the
the tyre is cold. If it is executed when the tyre is warm at this time. the reset function
tyre is warm (e.g. after driving), there may Type 1 should be executed again when the tyre is
be a low tyre pressure warning earlier than cold.
usual.
6 Reversing sensor system*
Tyre ID set change E00615500345
E00637600030
In case that 2 sets of tyre inflation pressure This system operates when you are backing
sensor ID are registered in the receiver, the Type 2 the vehicle. It uses corner and back sensors to
valid tyre ID set can be changed by following detect an obstacle and the information screen
procedure. in the multi-information display and the buz-
1. Operate the multi-information meter zer to inform you of the approximate distance
switch to switch the information screen to the obstacle.
to the menu screen.
Refer to “Multi information display CAUTION
switch” on page 5-05
Refer to “Changing the function settings NOTE l The reversing sensor system assists you in
determining the approximate distance be-
(when the ignition switch or the opera- tween the vehicle and an obstacle located
tion mode is ON)” on page 5-19 l Each time this procedure is done, the tyre ID
set is changed. (1 - 2 - 1 - 2 …) behind the vehicle. It has limitations in terms
2. Lightly press the multi-information me- l The tyre ID set is NOT changed, in case that of detectable areas and objects, and may not
ter switch to select “ ” (tyre only 1 set of ID is registered. properly detect some objects. Therefore, do
ID set change). not place excessive confidence in the revers-
ing sensor system and operate the vehicle as
carefully as you would do with a vehicle not
equipped with this system.

6-64 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Reversing sensor system*

CAUTION Reversing sensor system detec- Vehicles with a towing bar


tion areas The detection areas are within approximately
l Make sure to check the surroundings with
your own eyes to ensure safety. Do not oper- Depending on whether the vehicle is equip- 60 cm (A) from the corner sensors, 150 cm
ate the vehicle by relying on the reversing ped with a towing bar, you can change the re- (B) from the back sensors, and 60 cm (C) or
sensor system alone. versing sensor system between the standard less from the ground surface, excluding the
mode and the towing bar mode. The towing area approximately 10 cm (D) from the
Obstacle detection areas bar mode changes the system to exclude the ground surface. The non-detection areas (E)
E00615600421
area in which the towing bar is mounted from are within approximately 20 cm (F) from the
The detection areas of the corner and back the detection areas. bumper.
sensors are limited to those shown in the il-
6
lustration. Moreover, the sensors are unable Vehicles without a towing bar
to detect low or thin objects or objects near The detection areas are within approximately
the rear bumper. Thus, make sure to check 60 cm (A) from the corner sensors, 150 cm
the surroundings as you operate the vehicle in (B) from the back sensors, and 60 cm (C) or
a safe manner. less from the ground surface, excluding the
area approximately 10 cm (D) from the
Corner and back sensor loca- ground surface.
tions
There are two corner sensors (A) at the cor-
ners of the rear bumper, and two back sensors
(B) in the centre of the rear bumper.
NOTE
l If the rear bumper has been exposed to an
impact, the corner or back sensors may fail
and prevent the system from functioning
properly. Have the vehicle inspected at a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-65


Reversing sensor system*

NOTE CAUTION To operate


E00615700738
l The sensors do not detect objects located in • The sensors or surroundings have been
To operate the system, move the gearshift
the area directly below or near the bumper. wiped by hand, or stickers or accessories
If the height of an object is lower than the have been attached. lever or selector lever to the “R” position
mounted position of the corner or back sen- l The reversing sensor system may not proper- while the ignition switch or the operation
sors, the sensors may not continue detecting ly detect the following: mode is in ON. When the reversing sensor
it even if they detected it initially. • Objects that are thin, such as wire nets or system is operated, the reversing sensor sys-
ropes. tem operation indication lamp (A) will turn
• Objects that absorb sound waves, such as on. To stop the operation, push the “SO-
For information on how to change the detec- snow.
6 tion areas, please refer to “Changing the de- • Objects that are shaped with a sharp an-
NAR” switch; the reversing sensor system
tection areas” on page 6-67. gle. operation indication lamp (A) is turned off.
• Objects with a smooth surface, such as
glass.
CAUTION • Objects that are low, such as kerbstones.
l The reversing sensor system may not operate
properly under the following conditions:
• The sensors or surroundings are covered NOTE
with ice, snow, or mud.
• The sensors are frozen. l The buzzer may sound lower than the nor-
mal warning sound when the reversing sen-
• The system receives ultrasonic noise from sor system is receiving ultrasonic noise from
other sources (the horns of other vehicles, other sources, but this is not a malfunction.
motorcycle engines, brakes, radios, pour- The buzzer will stop sounding and the sys-
ing rain, splashing water, tyre chains, tem will return to normal operation after the
etc.). noise is no longer received.
• The sensors are extremely hot or cold NOTE
(while the vehicle is parked for a long pe-
riod of time under a blazing sun or in cold l Only when the gearshift lever or selector
weather). lever is in the “R” position, the reversing
• The vehicle tilts significantly. sensor system can be operated or be stopped
by using the “SONAR” switch.
• The vehicle is driven on a rough road
(with a bumpy, gravel, hilly, or grassy
surface).
• The vehicle is too close to an obstacle.

6-66 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Reversing sensor system*
Warning for obstacles Back sensor (vehicles without a towing NOTE
bar)
If there is an obstacle behind the vehicle, a l When the sensors detect different obstacles
warning will be issued with the information Vehicle to obstacle Warning display/ at the same time, the information screen in
screen in the multi-information display and a distance sound cycle the multi-information display indicates the
warning buzzer. directions of the obstacles each sensor is de-
Approx. 150 to Intermittent tecting. However, closer obstacles are given
80 cm priority over other detected obstacles and the
Type 1 Type 2
warning buzzer sounds to inform you of
Approx. 80 to 40 cm Fast intermittent closer obstacles.
Within approx. Continuous 6
40 cm Changing the detection areas
E00615800159
Back sensor (vehicles with a towing bar)
The detection areas can be changed as fol-
Vehicle to obstacle Warning display/ lows:
distance sound cycle
Vehicles with a towing bar
1- Corner sensor (left) Approx. 150 to Intermittent
While the operation of the system is stopped
2- Back sensor 100 cm
at the “SONAR” switch, push the “SONAR”
3- Corner sensor (right) Approx. 100 to Fast intermittent switch approximately 3 seconds or more, and
60 cm release it. The buzzer sounds twice to indi-
Corner sensor cate that the detection area has been changed.
Within approx. Continuous
Vehicle to obstacle Warning display/ 60 cm
Vehicles without a towing bar
distance sound cycle
While the operation of the system is stopped
Approx. 60 to 40 cm Intermittent CAUTION at the “SONAR” switch, push the “SONAR”
Approx. 40 to 20 cm Fast intermittent l The distances given are to be used for refer- switch approximately 3 seconds or more, and
ence only, as errors may be caused by vari- release it. The buzzer sounds once to indicate
Within approx. Continuous ous factors, such as temperature, humidity, that the detection area has been changed.
20 cm or the shape of the obstacles.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-67


Rear-view camera*

NOTE Reversing sensor system warn- CAUTION


l The detection area will not change if you ing display l The rear-view camera is an assistance sys-
keep the “SONAR” switch pushed for E00615900277 tem that enables the driver to check for ob-
10 seconds or more. In case there is a malfunction in the reversing stacles behind the vehicle. Its range of view
l After pushing the “SONAR” switch, revers- sensor system, the display for the malfunc- is limited, so you should not overly depend
ing sensor system operation differs accord- tioning sensor will blink and the warning on it. Please drive just as carefully as you
ing to the detection area setting. buzzer will sound for approximately 5 sec- would if the vehicle did not have the rear-
• Setting when towing bar is not equipped onds. Even after the buzzer has stopped view camera.
When the gearshift lever or selector lever
sounding, the display will continue blinking l Be sure to visually confirm safety around the
is moved to the “R” position, the revers- vehicle with your own eyes. Do not depend
6 ing sensor system will operate even if cor- until the system reverts to the normal state. entirely on the rear-view camera.
ner sensor operation was stopped by push- Have the vehicle inspected at a
ing the “SONAR” switch. MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service
• Setting when towing bar is equipped Point.
Range of view of rear-view
When reversing sensor system operation camera
was stopped by pushing the “SONAR”
Example: Corner sensor (left) mulfunctioning
switch, the reversing sensor system will The range of view of the rear-view camera is
not operate until the engine has been stop- Type 1 Type 2 limited to the area shown in the illustrations.
ped even if the gearshift lever or selector It cannot show both sides and the lower part
lever is moved to the “R” position. of the rear bumper, etc.
To resume reversing sensor system opera-
When reversing, be sure to visually confirm
tion, push the “SONAR” switch or stop
and restart the engine, and then move the safety around the vehicle.
gearshift lever or selector lever to the “R”
position.

Rear-view camera*
E00618401687

The rear-view camera is a system that shows


the view behind the vehicle on the screen of
the MITSUBISHI Multi Communication
System (MMCS) or the DISPLAY AUDIO.

6-68 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Rear-view camera*
Location of rear-view camera NOTE
The rear-view camera (A) is integrated into l Because the rear-view camera has a special
the part near the tailgate handle. lens, the lines on the ground between park-
ing spaces may not look parallel on the
screen.
l In the following situations, the screen indi-
cation may be difficult to see. There is no
abnormality.
• Low light (nighttime).
• When the light of the sun or the light from
a vehicle’s headlamps shines directly into
6
How to use the rear-view cam- the lens.
era l If the camera is hot and is then cooled by
rain or a car wash, the lens can mist up. This
phenomenon does not indicate a malfunc-
When you place the gearshift lever or selec-
tion.
tor lever in the “R” position with the ignition
Range of view of rear-view switch or the operation mode in ON, the view
l It is not possible to fully see obstacles when
camera behind the vehicle will automatically appear
the lens is dirty. If the lens becomes conta-
minated by water droplets, snow, mud or oil,
on the screen of the MITSUBISHI Multi wipe off the contamination, taking care not
Communication System (MMCS) or the DIS- to scratch the lens.
PLAY AUDIO. When you move the gear- l Please observe the following cautions. Ig-
shift lever or the selector lever to any other noring them could lead to a camera malfunc-
tion.
position, the screen will return to its original
• Do not subject the camera to physical
indication. shock.
• Do not apply wax to the camera.
CAUTION • Do not splash the camera with boiling wa-
ter.
l The rear-view camera has a special lens that • Do not disassemble the camera.
can make objects shown on the screen ap-
pear to be closer or further away than they
actually are. Reference lines on the screen
Reference lines and upper surface of the rear
bumper (A) are displayed on the screen.
OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-69
Rear-view camera*
l Red line (B) indicates approximately NOTE NOTE
50 cm behind the rear bumper.
tion of the road surface, the lines in the view • When there is an upward slope at the
l Two Green lines (C) indicate approxi-
from the rear-view camera may not be accu- back.
mately 20 cm outside of the vehicle
rately positioned relative to the actual road.
body. The reference lines for distance and vehicle
l Short transverse lines (1 to 3) indicate width are based on a level, flat road surface.
distance from the rear bumper. In the following cases, objects shown on the
screen will appear to be farther off than they
actually are.
• When the rear of the vehicle is weighed
6 down with the weight of passengers and
luggage in the vehicle.

Check surroundings for safety. A- Actual objects


B- Objects shown on the screen
l The reference lines for distance and vehicle
width are intended to indicate the distance to
1. Approximately at the rear edge of the a flat object such as a level, flat road surface.
rear bumper This may make the distance to a projecting
2. Approximately 100 cm object shown on the screen differ from the
3. Approximately 200 cm actual distance to the projecting object. Do
not use them as a guide for distances to solid
A- Actual objects objects.
NOTE B- Objects shown on the screen Example: On the screen the point B appears
the nearest, then the point C and A in order
l It is possible to change the display language of distance. The points A and B actually are
of the screen.
For details, please refer to the separate own- the same distances from the vehicle, and the
er’s manual for “MITSUBISHI Multi Com-
munication System (MMCS)”.
l When the vehicle is tilting because of the
number of people in the vehicle, the weight
and positioning of luggage, and/or the condi-

6-70 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


Cargo loads

NOTE CAUTION Roof carrier mounting brack-


point C is farther off than the points A and l Load heavy cargo or luggage in the front of
ets*
B. the vehicle. If the load in the back of the ve-
hicle is too heavy, steering may become un- When installing the roof carrier, use the
stable. brackets (A).
The brackets (A) are located under each cov-
Loading a roof carrier er (B).

CAUTION 6
l Use a roof carrier that properly fits your ve-
hicle. Do not load luggage directly onto the
Check surroundings for safety. roof. For installation, refer to the instruction
manual accompanying the roof carrier.
l When attaching/removing the roof carrier
and loading/removing luggage, do not apply
excessive pressure on a single point.
Cargo loads Depending on how and where the force is
E00609901383 applied, this may cause dents on the vehicle
roof.
Attaching the roof carrier
Cargo loads precautions
NOTE Slide each cover (B) towards the front of the
vehicle to remove it.
CAUTION l We recommend you to use a genuine
l Do not load cargo or luggage higher than the MITSUBISHI roof carrier, since the brack-
top of the seatback. Be sure that your cargo ets to be used have a special shape.
or luggage cannot move once your vehicle is For details, we recommend you to consult a
moving. Having the driver’s vision blocked, MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
and your cargo being thrown inside the cab- ice Point.
in if you suddenly have to brake can cause a
serious accident or injury.

OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-71


Trailer towing
Refitting the covers CAUTION Trailer towing
1. With each cover, put the tabs (C) on the l When luggage is loaded onto the vehicle, E00610001788

cover in the holes (D) in the roof. please make sure to drive slowly and avoid
In order to tow a trailer with your vehicle,
2. Slide the cover (B) towards the rear of excessive manoeuvres such as sudden brak-
ing or quick turning. have a trailer towing device mounted that
the vehicle to install it.
In addition, place the luggage on the carrier meets all relevant regulations in your area,
so that its weight is distributed evenly with consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
the heaviest items on the bottom. Do not ized Service Point.
load items that are wider than the roof carri- The regulations concerning the towing of a
er.
6 The additional weight on the roof could raise
trailer may differ from country to country.
You are advised to obey the regulations in
the vehicle’s centre of gravity and affect ve-
hicle handling characteristics.
each area.
As a result, driving errors or emergency ma-
noeuvres could lead to a loss of control and CAUTION
result in an accident.
l Before driving and after travelling a short l Danger of Accident!
distance, always check the load to make sure A towing bar should be fitted according to
it is securely fastened to the roof carrier. MITSUBISHI MOTORS guidelines.
Roof carrier precaution Check periodically during your travel that
the load remains secure. Maximum towable weight with
CAUTION brake and maximum trailer-
l Make sure that the weight of the luggage NOTE nose weight
does not exceed the allowable roof load.
If the allowable roof load is exceeded, this l To prevent wind noise or reduction in fuel
Never exceed the maximum towable weight
may cause damage to the vehicle. economy, remove the roof carrier when not
The roof load is the total allowable load on in use. with brake and the maximum trailer-nose
the roof (the weight of the roof carrier plus l Remove the roof carrier before using an au- weight as listed in the specifications.
the weight of luggage placed on the roof car- tomatic car wash. (Refer to page 11-08.)
rier). l Be sure that adequate clearance is main- If you tow a trailer at an altitude of more than
For the specific value, refer to “Maximum tained for raising the tailgate when installing 1,000 m above sea-level, reduce your weight
roof load” on page 11-08. a roof carrier.
by 10 % of the gross combination weight for
every increase of 1,000 m above sea-level, as
the engine output is lowered owing to de-
crease in atmospheric pressure.
6-72 Starting and driving OGAE15E5
Trailer towing

Towing bar mounting specifi- 375 mm to 401 mm


cations 10 378 mm to 396 mm*
(at laden condition)
See the following table for fixing points (A) 11 447 mm
for the towing bar.
12 487 mm
13 495 mm
14 525.5 mm
*: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Uk- 6
raine

NOTE
l The values under item 12 can be varied de-
1 830.5 mm pending on the loading condition of cargo or
luggage.
2 461 mm
3 68.5 mm Operating hints
4 75 mm
l To prevent the clutch from slipping (Ve-
5 310 mm hicle with a M/T only), do not rev the
engine more than is required when start-
6 13.5 mm
ing off.
7 66.5 mm l Be sure that the driving speed does not
8 50 mm exceed 100 km/h (62 mph) for trailer op-
eration. It is also recommended that you
9 52 mm obey the local regulations in case driving
464 mm to 476 mm speed with a trailer is limited to less than
464 mm to 479 mm* 100 km/h (62 mph).
10
(at kerb weight con- l To prevent shocks from the overrun
dition) brake, depress the brake pedal lightly at
first and then more strongly.
OGAE15E5 Starting and driving 6-73
Trailer towing
l To make full use of engine braking, CAUTION
change to a lower shift point before de-
scending a slope. l If the engine overheats, please refer to the
“Engine overheating” section of “For emer-
gencies” prior to taking any corrective ac-
Additional precautions for vehi- tion.
cles equipped with an A/T or l On vehicles equipped with A/T, CVT, if the
CVT warning display is showing, the tempera-
It is recommended the “D” position on slopes ture of the automatic transmission fluid,
CVT fluid is high.
or at low speed.
6 Use the sports mode in mountainous areas in
Read the reference page and take the re-
quired measures.
order to make better use of engine braking Refer to “When a malfunction occurs in the
and to assist the brake system. However, be A/T” on page 6-30, “When a malfunction
sure that the speed does not exceed the maxi- occurs in the CVT” on page 6-37.
mum speed limit for the selected shift posi-
tion.

Overheating
This will normally occur as a result of some
mechanical failure. If your vehicle should
overheat, stop and check for a loose or bro-
ken water pump/alternator drive belt, a
blocked radiator air intake or a low coolant
level. If these items are satisfactory the over-
heating could be caused by a number of me-
chanical causes that would have to be
checked at a competent service centre.

6-74 Starting and driving OGAE15E5


For pleasant driving

Ventilators...........................................................................................7-02 Ashtray*.............................................................................................. 7-72


Heater/Air conditioning...................................................................... 7-03 Cigarette lighter*.................................................................................7-73
Important operation tips for the air conditioning................................ 7-11 Accessory socket.................................................................................7-74
Air purifier.......................................................................................... 7-12 Interior lamps...................................................................................... 7-74
LW/MW/FM radio/CD player*.......................................................... 7-12 Storage spaces..................................................................................... 7-78
Handling of Discs................................................................................7-15 Cup holder...........................................................................................7-81
Audio Files (MP3/WMA/AAC)..........................................................7-16 Bottle holder........................................................................................7-81 7
Important Points on Safety for the Customer......................................7-20 Rear shelf panel*.................................................................................7-82
Operation Keys................................................................................... 7-21 Assist grips..........................................................................................7-83
Listen to Radio.................................................................................... 7-24 Coat hook*.......................................................................................... 7-83
Listen to DAB*................................................................................... 7-25 Luggage hooks.................................................................................... 7-83
Listen to Traffic Messages..................................................................7-27
Listen to CDs...................................................................................... 7-27
Listen to MP3s.................................................................................... 7-28
Listen to an iPod................................................................................. 7-29
Listen to Audio Files on a USB Device..............................................7-31
To play iPod/USB memory device tracks via voice opera-
tion (vehicles with Bluetooth® 2.0 interface)................................. 7-34
Listen to Bluetooth Audio*.................................................................7-36
Use AUX*...........................................................................................7-38
Display Indicator.................................................................................7-39
Audio Quality and Volume Balance Adjustment............................... 7-40
System Settings................................................................................... 7-41
Troubleshooting.................................................................................. 7-45
Antenna............................................................................................... 7-47
Link System*...................................................................................... 7-47
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*....................................................................7-48
USB input terminal*........................................................................... 7-68
Sun visors............................................................................................7-71

OGAE15E5
Ventilators

Ventilators To close the ventilator, fully move the knob To close the ventilator, fully move the knob
(A) to the inner side. (A) to the outer side.
E00700100878

Left Right

*
7 *: Optional equipment *

1- Centre ventilators 1- Close 1- Close


2- Side ventilators 2- Open 2- Open

NOTE Side ventilators NOTE


Move the knob (A) to adjust the air flow di-
l Do not place beverages on top of the instru- l On vehicles with air conditioning, the cool
ment panel. rection. air from the ventilators may appear as a
If they splash into the air conditioning venti- mist.
lators, they could damage the system. This is due to moist air being suddenly
cooled by the air conditioning. This will
clear after a few moments.
Air flow and direction adjust- l Be careful not to spill drinks, etc., into the
ments ventilators.
E00700200938 Doing so might cause the air conditioning
not to function normally.
Centre ventilators
Move the knob (A) to adjust the air flow di-
rection.

7-02 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Heater/Air conditioning

Mode selection dial Demister position NOTE


E00726501473
Air flows mainly to the windscreen and the l With the mode selection dial between the
To change the amount of air flowing from the
door windows. “ ” and “ ” positions, the air flows
ventilators, turn the mode selection dial.
mainly to the leg area. With the mode selec-
tion dial between the “ ” and “ ” posi-
Heater/ Automatic air conditioning CAUTION tions, the air flows mainly to the windscreen
Manual air conditioning
l When using the mode selection dial between and door windows.
the “ ” and “ ” positions, prevent fog-
ging by pressing the air selection switch to
select outside air. (Refer to “Air selection Heater/Air conditioning
switch” on page 7-05.) E00700500449

The heater/air conditioning can only be used


7
NOTE while the engine is running.
l For vehicles equipped with the Auto Stop &
Go (AS&G) system, the windscreen and
Face position door windows may mist up while the Auto
Air flows only to the upper part of the pas- Stop & Go (AS&G) system is operating. If
the windscreen and door windows mist up,
senger compartment.
set the mode selection dial to “ ” to de-
mist the windscreen and door windows.
Foot/face position
l With the mode selection dial between the
Air flows to the upper part of the passenger “ ” and “ ” positions, the air flows
compartment, and flows to the leg area. mainly to the upper part of the passenger
compartment. With the mode selection dial
Foot position between the “ ” and “ ” positions, the
air flows mainly to the leg area.
Air flows mainly to the leg area.
l With the mode selection dial in the “ ” po-
sition, a small amount of air flows to the
Foot/demister position
windscreen and the door windows.
Air flows to the leg area, the windscreen and
the door windows.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-03


Heater/Air conditioning

Control panel NOTE Turn the dial clockwise to increase the air
E00700601678
flow and anticlockwise to decrease the air
l On vehicles with automatic air conditioning, flow.
there is an interior air temperature sensor
Heater/Manual air conditioning (G) in the illustrated position.
Never place anything over the sensor, since Heater/ Automatic air conditioning
Manual air conditioning
doing so will prevent it from functioning
properly.

Automatic air conditioning


7

Temperature control dial


E00700901453
Turn the temperature control dial clockwise
A- Temperature control dial
B- Air selection switch
Blower speed selection dial or anticlockwise.
E00700700249
C- Blower speed selection dial Select the blower speed by turning the blower Heater/ Automatic air conditioning
D- Air conditioning switch speed selection dial clockwise or anticlock- Manual air conditioning
E- Mode selection dial wise.
F- Rear window demister switch ® p. 5-63

NOTE
l On vehicles with the heater, button (D) is
not available for use. The indicator below
the button doesn’t come on even if it is
pushed.

7-04 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Heater/Air conditioning

NOTE Refer to “Customizing the air selection” on CAUTION


page 7-06.
l While the engine coolant temperature is low, l Normally, use the outside position to keep
the temperature of the air from the heater Air selection switch the windscreen and side windows clear and
will be cool/cold until the engine warms up, E00701300721
quickly remove fog or frost from the wind-
even if you have selected warm air with the To change the air selection, simply press the screen.
dial. If high cooling performance is desired, or if
air selection switch. There is a sound each
l On vehicles with the automatic air condi-
time the switch is pressed.
the outside air is dusty or otherwise contami-
tioning, when the temperature is set to the nated use the recirculation position. Switch
highest or the lowest setting under the AU- l Outside air: Indication lamp (A) is OFF to the outside position periodically to in-
TO operation, the air selection and the air Outside air is introduced into the passen- crease ventilation so that the windows do not
conditioning will be automatically changed ger compartment. become fogged up.
as follows. l Recirculated air: Indication lamp (A) is l Use of the recirculation position for exten-
7
• Quick Heating (When the temperature is ON ded time may cause the windows to fog up.
set to the highest setting) Air is recirculated inside the passenger
Outside air will be introduced and the air
compartment.
conditioning will stop. NOTE
• Quick Cooling (When the temperature is
set to the lowest setting) Heater/ Automatic air conditioning l On vehicles with the heater and the manual
Manual air conditioning air conditioning, when the system operates
Inside air will be recirculated and the air
with the selection switch in the outside posi-
conditioning will operate.
tion, the system automatically determines
whether to continue using outside air or to
The settings described above are the factory perform recirculation. If the outside air tem-
settings. The air selection and air condition- perature is high, the system selects recircula-
ing switches can be customized (function set- tion and causes the indication lamp (A) in
the switch to illuminate (for vehicles with
ting changed), and the automatic switching of
the manual air conditioning, the system se-
outside air and the air conditioning according lects recirculation to achieve rapid cooling).
to operating conditions can be changed as de- Press the selection switch to return to out-
sired. side air introduction.
For further information, we recommend you
to consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
thorized Service Point.
Refer to “Customizing the air conditioning
switch (Automatic air conditioning)” on page
7-07.
OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-05
Heater/Air conditioning

NOTE • Heater/Manual air conditioning: Air conditioning switch (Air


Even when the system operates, the
l On vehicles with the automatic air condi- air selection switch will not be auto-
conditioning)
tioning, when the mode selection dial or the E00701501052
matically controlled. Push the switch to turn the air conditioning
blower speed selection dial is set to the
“AUTO” position again after manual opera- • Automatic air conditioning: on, indication lamp (A) will come on.
tion, the air selection dial will also be auto- Even when the mode selection dial or There is a sound each time the switch is
matically controlled. blower speed selection dial is turned pressed.
l On vehicles with the automatic air condi- to the “AUTO” position, the air selec-
tioning, when the engine coolant tempera- tion switch is not controlled automati-
ture rises to a certain level, the air selection Manual air conditioning Automatic air conditioning
cally.
is automatically switched to the recirculation
position and the indication lamp (A) comes
l Setting change method
7 on. At this time, the system will not switch Hold down the air selection switch for
to the outside position even if the air selec- about 10 seconds or more.
tion switch is pushed. When the setting is changed, a sound is
emitted and the indication lamp flashes.
• When the setting is changed from ena-
Customizing the air selection ble to disable 3 sounds are emitted and
E00732500107
the indication lamp flashes 3 times.
Functions can be changed as desired, as sta-
• When the setting is changed from dis-
ted below.
able to enable 2 sounds are emitted Push the switch again to switch it off.
l Enable automatic air control and the indication lamp flashes 3
• Heater/Manual air conditioning:
times.
When the system operates, the air se- CAUTION
lection switch will be automatically
controlled. NOTE l When using the air conditioning, the idling
speed may slightly increase as the air condi-
• Automatic air conditioning: tioning compressor is switched on/off auto-
l The factory setting is “Enable automatic air
When the mode selection dial or control.” matically. While the vehicle with an A/T or
blower speed selection dial is turned l When the mode selection dial is turned to CVT is stationary, fully depress the brake
to the “AUTO” position, the air selec- “ ”, in order to prevent misting of the pedal to prevent the vehicle from creeping.
tion switch is also controlled automat- windows the ventilator automatically
ically. switches to outside air even if “Disable auto-
matic air control” is set.
l Disable automatic air control

7-06 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Heater/Air conditioning

NOTE l Disable automatic air conditioning con- Operating the air conditioning
trol: system
l If a problem is detected in the air condition- The air conditioning switch is not con-
ing system, the air conditioning operation in- E00701800436
trolled automatically as long as the air
dication lamp (A) blinks. Press the air condi-
tioning switch once to turn it off, then once conditioning switch is not operated. Heating (Heater/Manual air
more to turn it back on. If the air condition- l Setting change method conditioning)
ing operation indication lamp does not blink Hold down the air conditioning switch
for a while, there is nothing wrong. If it for about 10 seconds or more. Set the mode selection dial to the “ ” posi-
starts to blink again, we recommend you to When the setting is changed, a sound is tion and set the air selection switch (A) to the
have it checked. emitted and the indication lamp flashes. outside position.
l Sometimes, for example after using a high-
• When the setting is changed from ena- Turn the temperature control dial clockwise
pressure car wash, the condenser can get
wet, and the operation indication lamp (A) ble to disable 3 sounds are emitted and or anticlockwise to the desired temperature. 7
the indication lamp flashes 3 times. Select the desired blower speed.
blinks temporarily. In this case there is noth-
ing wrong. Wait a while, press the air condi- • When the setting is changed from dis-
tioning switch once to turn the system off, able to enable 2 sounds are emitted
then once more to turn it back on. Once the and the indication lamp flashes 3
water evaporates, the blinking will stop. times.

Customizing the air condition- NOTE


ing switch (Automatic air condi- l The factory setting is “Enable automatic air
tioning) conditioning control”.
E00764700030 l When you turn the mode selection dial to
Functions can be changed as desired, as sta- “ ”, in order to prevent misting of the
windows the air conditioning operates auto-
ted below.
matically even if “Disable automatic air con-
l Enable automatic air conditioning con- ditioning control” is set. NOTE
trol:
l For quick heating, set the blower speed se-
If the mode selection dial or blower lection dial to the position shown in the il-
speed selection dial is turned to the lustration.
“AUTO” position, or the temperature
control dial is set to the minimum tem-
perature, the air conditioning switch is
controlled automatically.
OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-07
Heater/Air conditioning

CAUTION The air flow will be directed to the leg area


and the upper part of the passenger compart-
l If the outside air is dusty or otherwise conta- ment. Select the desired blower speed.
minated, or if high cooling performance is
desired, set air selection switch to the recir-
culation position and the temperature control
dial all the way to the left.
Switch to the outside position periodically to
increase ventilation so that the windows do
not become fogged up.

7 Cooling (Manual air condition- NOTE


ing) l When the air conditioning operates with the
selection switch in the outside position, the
E00701900684
system automatically determines whether to
continue using outside air or to perform re- Warm air flows to the leg area and unheated
circulation. If the outside air temperature is
or slightly warm air (depending upon temper-
high, the system selects recirculation to ach-
ieve rapid cooling and causes the indication ature setting) flows to the upper part of the
lamp in the switch to illuminate. Press the passenger compartment.
selection switch to return to outside air intro-
duction.

Combination of unheated air


and heated air (Heater/Manual
1. Set the mode selection dial to the “ ” air conditioning)
position. E00702000435
2. Set the air selection switch (A) to the Select the mode selection dial to the position
outside position. shown in the illustration and set the air selec-
3. Push the air conditioning switch (B). tion switch (A) to the outside position.
4. Change the temperature by turning the
control dial clockwise or anticlockwise.
5. Select the desired blower speed.
7-08 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5
Heater/Air conditioning

Automatic mode (Automatic air CAUTION Manual mode (Automatic air


conditioning) l When using the air conditioning, the idling conditioning)
E00764801113 speed may slightly increase as the air condi- E00764900032

tioning compressor is switched on/off auto- Blower speed and ventilator mode may be
matically. While the vehicle with an A/T or controlled manually by setting the blower
CVT is stationary, fully depress the brake speed selection dial and the mode selection
pedal to prevent the vehicle from creeping. dial to the desired positions. To return to au-
tomatic operation, set the dials to the “AU-
NOTE TO” position.

l While the engine coolant temperature is low, Demisting of the windscreen


the temperature of the air from the heater
and door windows 7
will be cool/cold until the engine warms up,
E00702100768
even if you have selected warm air with the
dial. To prevent the windscreen and win-

In normal conditions, use the system in the


dows from fogging up, the ventilator mode CAUTION
will be changed to “ ” and the blower
AUTO mode and follow these procedures: speed will be reduced. l For safety, make sure you have a clear view
1. Set the blower speed selection dial to the through all the windows.
l If the blower speed selection dial, air condi-
“AUTO” position. tioning switch, mode selection dial, or air se-
2. Set the temperature control dial to the lection switch is operated while the system Use the mode selection dial (“ ” or “ ”)
desired temperature. is operating in the AUTO mode, the activa-
to remove frost or mist from the windscreen
ted function overrides the corresponding
3. Set the mode selection dial to the “AU- or door windows.
function of automatic control. All other
TO” position. functions remain under automatic control.

The outlet position recirculation/outside air


select and blower speed, and ON/OFF of the
air conditioning will be controlled automati-
cally.
To stop the system, turn the blower speed se-
lection dial to the “OFF” position.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-09


Heater/Air conditioning

For ordinary demisting For quick demisting NOTE


Perform the following settings to prevent l On vehicles with air conditioning, do not set
misting of the windscreen and door windows, Heater/Manual air conditioning the temperature control dial to the max. cool
and to heat the leg area. position. Cool air will blow against the win-
dow glasses and prevent demisting.
Heater/Manual air conditioning
l For vehicles with the Auto Stop & Go
(AS&G) system, if the mode selection dial is
set to the demister position shown in the il-
lustration, the Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) sys-
tem will not operate and the engine will not
Automatic air conditioning stop automatically even if the vehicle is
stopped. This is to ensure that good visibility
7 is maintained.
Automatic air conditioning

1. Set the mode selection dial to the “ ”


position.
2. Set the blower to the maximum speed.
1. Set the air selection switch (A) to the 3. Set the temperature to the highest posi-
outside position. tion.
2. Set the mode selection dial to the “ ”
position. NOTE
3. Select your desired blower speed by
turning the blower speed selection dial. l When the mode selection dial is in the “ ”
4. Select your desired temperature by turn- position, the system operates automatically
and outside air is set automatically.
ing the temperature control dial.
5. On vehicles with air conditioning, push l To demist effectively, direct the air flow
from the side ventilators towards the door
the air conditioning switch (B). windows.

7-10 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Important operation tips for the air conditioning

Introduction of outside air Important operation tips for Air conditioning system refrig-
(Heater/Manual air condition- the air conditioning erant and lubricant recommen-
ing) E00708301033
dations
E00702200408
To introduce air into the vehicle during hot l Park the vehicle in the shade. If the air conditioning seems less effective
weather, set the air selection switch (A) to the Parking in the hot sun will make the ve- than usual, the cause might be a refrigerant
outside position and set the temperature con- hicle inside extremely hot, and it will re- leak. We recommend you to have the system
trol dial to the positions shown in the illustra- quire more time to cool the interior. inspected.
tion. Be sure to set the temperature control If it is necessary to park in the sun, open The air conditioning system in your vehicle
dial all the way to the left. Select the desired the windows for the first few minutes of must be charged with the refrigerant
air conditioning operation to expel the HFC-134a and the lubricant SUN-PAG56.
blower speed.
hot air. Use of any other refrigerant or lubricant will
7
l Close the windows when the air condi- cause severe damage which will result in the
tioning is in use. need to replace your vehicle’s entire air con-
The entry of outside air through open ditioning system. The release of refrigerant
windows will reduce the cooling effi- into the atmosphere is not recommended.
ciency. The new refrigerant HFC-134a in your vehi-
l Too much cooling is not good for the cle will not harm the ozone layer.
health. Keep the difference between the We recommend you to recover and recycle
vehicle interior temperature and outside the refrigerant for reuse.
temperature to 5 to 6 °C.
l When operating the system, make sure During a long period of disuse
the air intake, which is located in front
of the windscreen, is free of obstructions The air conditioning should be operated for at
NOTE such as leaves and snow. Leaves collec- least five minutes each week, even in cold
l Turn the mode selection dial clockwise and ted in the air-intake plenum may reduce weather. This is to prevent the compressor
air will flow to the leg area and the wind- air flow and plug the plenum water from seizing and to maintain the air condi-
screen. tioning in the best operating condition.
drains.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-11


Air purifier

Air purifier NOTE Important Points on Usage


E00735500023
E00708400561
l To listen to the audio system while the en-
gine is not running, turn the ignition switch
An air filter has been incorporated into the air
to the “ACC” position or put the operation
iPod/iPhone Playback Func-
conditioning so that pollen and dust are mode in ACC. tion*
cleaned from the air. If the ignition switch or the operation mode
Replace the air filter periodically as its ability is left in ACC, the accessory power will au-
l This product supports audio playback
to clean the air will be reduced as it collects tomatically turn off after a certain period of
from iPod/iPhone devices, however dif-
pollen and dirt. For the maintenance interval, time and you will no longer be able to use fering versions mean that playback can-
refer to the “SERVICE BOOKLET”. the audio system. The accessory power not be guaranteed.
comes on again if the ignition switch or the l Please be aware that depending on the
engine switch is operated with it in the iPod/iPhone model or version, operation
7 NOTE “ACC” position. Refer to “ACC power auto- may differ.
cutout function” on pages 3-14 and 6-13.
l Operation in certain conditions such as driv-
l If a cellular phone is used inside the vehicle,
ing on a dusty road and frequent use of the
it may create noise from the audio equip- How to Clean
air conditioning can lead to reduction of
ment. This does not mean that anything is E00735700025
service life of the filter. When you feel that
the air flow is lower than normal or when
wrong with your audio equipment. In such a l If the product becomes dirty, wipe with
case, use the cellular phone at a place as far a soft cloth.
the windscreen or windows start to fog up
away as possible from the audio equipment. l If very dirty, use a soft cloth dipped in
easily, replace the air filter.
We recommend you to have it checked. l If foreign objects or water get into the audio
neutral detergent diluted in water, and
equipment, or if smoke or a strange odour
comes from it, immediately turn off the au- then wrung out. Do not use benzene,
thinners, or other chemical wipes. This
LW/MW/FM radio/CD dio system. We recommend you to have it
checked. Never try to repair it by yourself. may harm the surface.
player* Avoid continuous usage without inspection
E00708502348
by a qualified person. Trademarks
The audio system can only be used when the E00735801153

ignition switch or the operation mode is in l Product names and other proper names
ON or ACC. are the trademarks or registered trade-
marks of their respective owners.
l Furthermore, even if there is no specific
denotation of trademarks or registered
trademarks, these are to be observed in
their entirety.
7-12 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5
LW/MW/FM radio/CD player*
Inc., registered in the U.S. and other NOTE
countries.
Apple is not responsible for the opera- l For vehicles with a Bluetooth® 2.0 interface,
tion of this device or its compliance with the types of devices that can be connected
may vary. For details, access the
safety and regulatory standards.
MITSUBISHI MOTORS website.
Please read and agree to the “Warning about
“Made for iPod,” “Made for iPhone”
mean that an electronic accessory has
NOTE Links to the Web Sites of Other Compa-
nies”.
been designed to connect specifically to l iPod and iTunes licensing allows individual The websites mentioned above may connect
iPod or iPhone, respectively, and has users to privately reproduce and play back you to websites other than the MITSUBISHI
been certified by the developer to meet non- copyrighted material as well as material MOTORS website.
that may be legally copied and reproduced.
Apple performance standards. Infringement of copyright is prohibited.
http://www.mitsubishi-motors.com/en/prod-
ucts/index.html
7
iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod nano,
and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-13


LW/MW/FM radio/CD player*

5th generation 5th generation


(video) (video)

6th generation 5th generation 4th generation (video)


(video camera)

3rd generation 2nd generation 1st generation


(video) (aluminium)

7-14 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Handling of Discs

Important Points on Handling l If discs are not going to be used for a


long period of time, remove these from
l Fingerprints or other marks on the read the product.
surface of the disc may result in its con-
4th generation
8GB 32GB 64GB
3rd generation
32GB 64GB
tent being more difficult to read. When Disc Playback Environment
holding the disc, grip both edges, or one
edge and the centre hole, in order that In cold environments such as in mid-winter
the read surface is not touched. when the interior of the vehicle is cold, turn-
l Do not affix paper or stickers, or other- ing the heater on and immediately trying to
2nd generation 1st generation
8GB 16GB 32GB 8GB 16GB 32GB wise damage the disc. use the product may cause condensation (wa-
l Do not forcefully insert a disc if another ter droplets) to form on the disc and internal
is already within the device. This can re- optical components, and this may prevent the 7
sult in damage to discs, or malfunction. product from operating correctly.
16GB 32GB 64GB 16GB 32GB
In these conditions, remove the disc, and wait
Cleaning a short time before use.

l Periodically clean the read surface of the Copyright


disc. When cleaning, do not wipe in a
8GB 16GB 32GB 8GB 16GB circular motion. Instead, wipe gently Actions such as unauthorized reproduction,
outwards from the centre of the disc to broadcast, public performance, or rental of
the outer edge. discs that comprise other than personal use
l New discs may have burring around the are prohibited by law.
Handling of Discs outer edge or in the hole in the centre.
E00735900027
Ensure you check for these. If there are
Types of Disc That Can Be
This explains care that should be taken in the burrs, these may lead to faulty operation, Played Back
handling of discs. therefore ensure these are removed. E00736001064
The following marks are printed on the disc
Important Points on Storage label, package, or jacket.

l When not using discs, ensure these are


kept in cases, and stored out of direct
sunlight.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-15


Audio Files (MP3/WMA/AAC)

Maxi- l Do not insert irregularly-shaped discs l Playback of other than standard CDs is
mum (for example, heartshaped), as these may not guaranteed. Even if the audio can be
Siz result in malfunction. Additionally, discs played back, the audio quality cannot be
Type play- Comments
e that have transparent portions may not guaranteed.
back
time be played back. l When playing back other than standard
l Discs that have not been finalized cannot CDs, the following may occur.
CD-DA 12 74 mi- — be played back. • There may be noise during playback.
cm nutes
l Even if recorded using the correct for- • There may be jumping in the audio.
mat on a recorder or computer, applica- • The disc may not be recognized.
tion software settings and environments; • The first track may not be played
CD-TEXT 12 74 mi- —
disc peculiarities, damage, or marking; back.
cm nutes
7 or dirt or condensation on the lens inside • It may take longer than usual until
the product may render the disc unplaya- start of playback of tracks.
ble. • Playback may start from within the
CD-R/RW 12 — •Disc containing l Depending on the disc, some functions track.
cm MP3 files may not be used, or the disc may not • Some parts may not be played back.
play back. • Tracks may freeze during playback.
l Do not use discs with cracks or warps. • Tracks may be displayed erroneously.
l If the disc has stickers affixed, remains
from removed stickers, or affixed adhe- Audio Files (MP3/WMA/
sive, then do not use the disc.
l Discs that have decorative labels or AAC)
Discs That May Not Be Played stickers may not be used. E00736100026
Back This product can play back MP3/WMA/AAC
l Playback of discs other than those de-
Nonstandard CDs format audio files recorded on CD-ROM,
scribed in “Types of Disc That Can Be This product will play back audio CDs, how- CD-R/RW, and USB devices.
Played Back” is not guaranteed. ever please be aware of the following points
l 8 cm discs may not be used. regarding CD standards.
l Ensure that you use discs with on
the label surface.

7-16 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Audio Files (MP3/WMA/AAC)
There are limitations on the files and media NOTE You can create a folder structure as in Genre
that can be used, therefore read the following - Artist - Album - Track (MP3/WMA/AAC
prior to recording MP3/WMA/AAC format l Depending on the condition of the disc re- format audio files) for management of tracks.
corder or recording software used, correct
audio files on discs or USB devices. Addi-
playback may not be possible. In these ca-
tionally, ensure you read the user manuals for ses, refer to the user manual for your product
your CDR/RW drive and the writing soft- or software. ROOT
Folder
ware, and ensure these are used correctly. l Depending on your computer’s operating
If the MP3/WMA/AAC format audio files in- system, version, software, or settings, files Audio file
cludes title information or other data, then may not have a file extension appended. In
this can be displayed. these cases, append the file extensions
“.mp3”, “.wma”, or “.m4a” when copying
the files.
CAUTION l Files larger than 2GB in size cannot be 7
played back.
l CD-ROM and CD-R/RW media can only
play back MP3 format audio files.
l Actions such as copying audio CDs or files Data Formats That Can Be
and either distributing these to others for
free or for charge, or uploading files via the Played Back 1 level 2 level 3 level 4 level 5 level

Internet or other means to servers is an in- E00736200027

fringement of the law. Data formats that can be played on discs


l Do not append the file extensions “.mp3”, (CD-ROM, CDR/RW) and USB devices dif-
“.wma”, or “.m4a”, to other than fer.
MP3/WMA/AAC format files. Playing back
discs with these types of files recorded upon Data format DISC USB device
them may cause the files to be incorrectly
identified for playback, which may lead to MP3
loud noise, resulting in speaker damage or
WMA X
accident.
AAC X

Folder Structure
E00736300060
Up to 8 folder levels can be recognized.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-17


Audio Files (MP3/WMA/AAC)

Speci- Speci- What Is MP3?


Name fica- Explanation Name fica- Explanation E00736400029
tion tion MP3 is the abbreviation of “MPEG-1 Audio
Layer 3”. MPEG is an abbreviation of “Mo-
ISO96 Level Maximum 8 File name Maximum 64 bytes (for Uni-
tion Picture Experts Group”, and this is a vid-
60 1 character file and fold- code, 32 characters), files/folders
eo compression standard used in video CDs,
name, and 3 er name with file/folder names longer
etc.
character file restric- than this will not be displayed or
MP3 is one of the audio compression meth-
extension. (sin- tions played back.
ods contained in the MPEG audio standard,
gle-byte alpha- USB sup- The recommended file system is
Format and reduces the quality of sounds that are be-
numeric capital
specifica- ported FAT32. yond the auditory resolution of the human ear
7 tions
letters, numer-
als, “_” may be
formats 1 partition only and that are hidden by louder sounds, thus
creating high-quality data with a lower data
used)
*1: Do not include other than size.
ISO96 Joliet Files names up MP3/WMA/AAC files. However, if This can compress CD audio to approximate-
60 ex- to a maximum storing many tracks within the same ly 1/10 its original data size without percepti-
tension 64 characters folder, these may not be recognized ble loss, approximately 10 CDs can be writ-
can be used. even if less than the maximum number ten to a single CD-R/RW disc.
of tracks. In these cases, divide the
Multises- Not supported (only first session
tracks up into multiple folders.
sion supported) CAUTION
Maxi- 8 levels (if the root is the 1st lev- l MP3 files different to the standards at right
mum el) NOTE may not play back correctly, or file/folder
number l The order in which folders and audio files names may not be displayed correctly.
of levels are displayed on this product may be differ-

Maxi- 700 folders (including root)


ent to how they are displayed on a computer. Standards for MP3 Files That
mum
Can Be Played Back
folder Specifications for MP3 files that can be
number played are as shown below.
Maxi- 65,535 files (total number on Item Details
mum file media. Other than MP3, WMA,
number*1 and AAC files not included) Specification MPEG-1 AUDIO LAYER3

7-18 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Audio Files (MP3/WMA/AAC)

Item Details What Is WMA? Item Details


Specification MPEG-2 AUDIO LAYER3 E00736600021
Sampling fre- 32/44.1/48
WMA is the abbreviation of Windows Media
Sampling fre- MPEG-1: 32/44.1/48 quency [kHz]
Audio, and this is an audio compression for-
quency [kHz] mat from Microsoft. This is a compression Bit rate 48 to 320
MPEG-2: 16/22.05/24
format that has a higher compression ratio [kbps]
Bit rate [kbps] MPEG-1: 32 to 320
than MP3. VBR Support
MPEG-2: 8 to 160 (variable bit
VBR (varia- Support NOTE rate)
ble bit rate) l Microsoft, Windows Media, and Windows Channel Stereo/Monaural
Channel Stereo/ Joint stereo/ Dual are registered trademarks of Microsoft Cor- mode 7
poration (USA) and in other countries.
mode channel/ Monaural File exten- wma
File exten- mp3 sion
sion CAUTION Supported tag WMA tags
Supported tag ID3 tag Ver. 1.0, Ver. 1.1, l WMA supports digital rights management information Title name, Artist name, Al-
(DRM). This product cannot play back bum name
information Ver. 2.2, Ver. 2.3, Ver. 2.4
WMA files protected using this system.
(ISO-8859-1, UTF-16 (Uni- Maximum 64 characters
l WMA files different to the standards at right
code)), Titles, Artist name, may not play back correctly, or file/folder number of
Album name names may not be displayed correctly. characters
Maximum 64 characters l “Pro”, “Lossless”, and “Voice” are not sup- that can be
ported. indicated on
number of
characters the display
that can be
Standards for WMA Files That
Can Be Played Back What is AAC?
indicated on
E00736800023
the display Specifications for WMA files that can be AAC is the abbreviation of Advanced Audio
played are as shown below. Coding, and this is an audio compression
Item Details standard used in “MPEG-2” and “MPEG-4”.
This features 1.4x the compression of MP3,
Specification Windows Media Audio Ver- with comparable audio quality.
sion7.0/8.0/9.0

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-19


Important Points on Safety for the Customer

CAUTION Item Details WARNING


l AAC supports digital rights management Supported tag infor- AAC tags or ID3 l The driver should not perform complica-
(DRM). This product cannot play back AAC mation tags ted operations while driving.
files protected using this system. Title, Artist name, Performing complicated operations while
l AAC files different to the standards at right Album name driving may prevent the driver looking
may not play back correctly, or file/folder where they are going, and cause an acci-
names may not be displayed correctly. Maximum number of 64 characters dent.
characters that can be Therefore stop the vehicle in a safe loca-
Standards for AAC Files That indicated on the dis- tion before performing such operations.
Can Be Played Back play l Do not use during malfunctions, such as
when no sound is audible.
This may lead to accident, fire, or electric
7 Specifications for AAC files that can be
Important Points on Safety shock.
played are as shown below.
for the Customer l Ensure water or other foreign objects do
Item Details not enter the product.
E00737000035 This may lead to smoking, fire, electric
Specification Advanced Audio shock, or malfunction.
This product features a number of pictorial
Coding l Do not insert foreign objects into the disc
indications as well as points concerning han- slot.
MPEG4/AAC-LC
dling so that you can use the product correct- This may lead to fire, electric shock, or
MPEG2/AAC-LC
ly and in a safe manner, as well as prevent in- malfunction.
Sampling MPEG4 8/11.025/12/16/22.05 jury or damage to yourself, other users, or l In the event of abnormalities occurring
frequency /24/32/44.1/48 property. when foreign objects or water enter the
[kHz] product, resulting in smoke or a strange
MPEG2 8/11.025/12/16/22.05 smell, immediately stop using the product,
/24/32/44.1/48 WARNING and consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
Bit rate MPEG4 8 to 320 Authorized Service Point.
l The driver should not pay close attention Continuing to use the product may result
[kbps] to the display while driving.
MPEG2 8 to 320 This may prevent the driver looking
in accident, fire, or electric shock.
VBR (variable bit Support where they are going, and cause an acci- l Do not disassemble or modify the prod-
uct.
rate) dent.
This may lead to malfunction, fire, or
Channel mode Stereo/Monaural electric shock.

File extension m4a

7-20 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Operation Keys

WARNING
l During thunderstorms, do not touch the
antenna or the front panel.
This may lead to electrical shock from
lightning.

CAUTION
l Do not block ventilation holes or heat sinks
on the product.
Blocking ventilation holes or heat sinks may
prevent heat from escaping from within the Turn the power on, and resume playback
from the previous status.
Turn the PWR/VOL key clockwise to
increase, and counter- clockwise to de-
7
product, leading to fire or malfunction.
l Do not turn the volume up to the extent that crease the volume.
you cannot hear sounds from outside the ve- 2. Press the PWR/VOL key.
hicle while driving. Turn the power OFF.
Driving without being able to hear sounds NOTE
from outside the vehicle may result in an ac- l The maximum value for volume is 45, and
cident. NOTE the minimum is 0.
l Do not insert your hand or fingers into the
l Hold down the steering MODE key to also l The initial setting for volume is “17”.
disc slot.
turn the audio function ON/OFF.
This may result in injury.
Insert/Eject Discs
Adjust Volume
Operation Keys E00737300025
E00737400026
1. Insert the disc into the disc slot with the
E00737100023
1. Turn the PWR/VOL key to adjust the label surface up.
Turn the Power ON/ OFF volume.
E00737200024
1. Press the PWR/VOL key.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-21


Operation Keys

Disc slot

Disc
*Label side

7 Push the disc in a certain amount, and


the product will pull the disc in, and
playback will start.

2. Press the key.


This will eject the disc from the product,
so remove the disc.

CAUTION
l When replacing discs, first ensure that the
vehicle is stopped in an area in which stop-
ping is permitted.
l Do not insert your hand, fingers, or foreign
objects into the disc slot. This may lead to
injury, smoking, or fire.
l 8 cm CDs are not supported.

7-22 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Operation Keys

Explanation of Buttons
E00737500030
This explains names and functions of each part.

1- key 6- PWR/VOL key 11- Disc slot


Use to eject a disc. Adjust the volume, and turn the power 12- PAGE key
2- 3 key/4 key ON/OFF. Display indicator page advance.
For audio, rewind/fast forward. 7- MEDIA key 13- 5 key
For radio, use as preset keys 3 and 4. Switch between CD and other sources. Play/Pause Bluetooth Audio*, and use as
3- 2RDM key Hold down the key to switch to AUX. preset key 5 for radio.
For audio, play random playback; for ra- 8- DISP key 14- 6 key
dio, use as preset key 2. Switch the content of the display. Return during audio track search, and
4- 1RPT key 9- PTY/SCAN key stop Bluetooth Audio*.
For audio, play repeat playback; for ra- For audio, play scan playback; for radio, For radio, use as preset key 6.
dio, use as preset key 1. search PTY. 15- key/ key
5- RADIO key 10- TP key For audio, select audio track/file; for ra-
Switch the radio and the band. Receive traffic messages. dio, perform automatic station selection.
OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-23
Listen to Radio
16- MENU key 17- /SEL key
Switch to Menu mode. Adjust audio quality and select items.
For radio, manually select stations.

*: Requires a separately-purchased Bluetooth-capable audio device in equipment by type (vehicles with a Bluetooth® 2.0 interface).

Steering wheel audio remote 3- MODE Key *3: Requires DAB tuner connection.
control switches* Hold down to turn the audio function
ON/OFF. Additionally, each time this is
E00737600103
pressed, this switches the audio source. Listen to Radio
7 The order of switching is as shown be- E00737700032

low. If devices are not connected, then This explains how to listen to FM, MW, and
these are to be skipped, and the next LW radio broadcasts.
source selected.
To Listen to the Radio
Press the RADIO key to switch the band.
CD or MP3
iPod*1 or USB device
Switch between FM1, FM2, FM3, MW, and
Bluetooth Audio*2
FM1, 2, 3
LW bands.
DAB1, 2, 3*3 The selected band is indicated on the display.
1- Vol + key, - key MW

Adjust audio functions and the mobile LW


NOTE
phone function volume.
2- CH key, key l This switches in the order FM1, FM2, FM3,
DAB1*, DAB2*, DAB3*, MW, and LW.
Select CD and other audio source tracks *:When a DAB tuner is connected.
and radio stations. *1: An iPod cable (available separately) is
Hold down to skip up and down through required.
tracks.
Manual/Seek Station Selection
*2: Requires a separately-purchased Blue-
tooth-capable audio device (vehicles Turn the /SEL key to the frequency to lis-
with a Bluetooth® 2.0 interface). ten to.
7-24 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5
Listen to DAB*

NOTE 1. During FM reception, press the PTY/


/SEL key Reduces the frequency being
SCAN key.
(counter- received. l Pressing the preset key will select the previ- This switches to the PTY selection
clockwise) ously registered frequency.
mode.
/SEL key Increases the frequency be- 2. Turn the /SEL key to select PTY.
(clockwise) ing received.
Auto Memory (Auto Store) The PTY (program content) indicator
will flash, and station selection will au-
Release the button to start The top 6 stations with a strong signal can be
key tomatically start. When a station is re-
seek station selection, and automatically registered in order with preset
(hold down) ceived, the station name is displayed.
when a station is received, keys.
key scanning stops. Hold down the RADIO key.
NOTE
(hold down)
After completion of auto store operations, the
7
l This receives the station detected first.
Preset Memory product will receive the station registered in l 10 seconds after reception, PTY search
the preset key [1]. mode will be cancelled.
Register the broadcast station in advance, and
select this at a later time. CAUTION Listen to DAB*
1. Tune in to the frequency to register. l Please be aware that the formerly-registered E00739100014
frequency in the memory will be overwrit-
2. Hold down any of the keys from the This explains how to listen to DAB.
ten.
1RPT key to the 6 key.
To listen to DAB
A “Beep” sounds, and the preset key is NOTE
registered. 1. Press the RADIO key to switch the
l Using auto store for FM1 and FM2 switches
to FM3. band.
NOTE Switch between DAB1, DAB2, and
DAB3 bands.
l The preset memory can register a maximum PTY Search
The selected band is indicated on the
of 6 stations for each band (FM1, FM2,
Select PTY (program content), and automati- display.
FM3).
l If a preset key that already has a station reg- cally scan for stations.
istered is selected, then this is overwritten
with the new preset.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-25


Listen to DAB*

NOTE Register the Service NOTE


l This switches in the order FM1, FM2, FM3, Register the service in advance, and select l If the text information for the service name
DAB1, DAB2, DAB3, MW, and LW. cannot be obtained, then nothing is dis-
this at a later time. played.
1. Tune in to the service to register.
Select a Service l If there is no operation for 10 seconds, then
2. Hold down any of the keys from the service search mode will be cancelled.
1RPT key to the 6 key.
1. Hold down the key or the key. A “Beep” sounds, and the preset key is
Receives the lead services of the ensem- PTY Search
registered.
bles that can be received.
2. Press the key or the key to select Select PTY (program content), and automati-
NOTE cally scan for services.
7 the service.
1. Press the PTY/SCAN key.
l If a preset key that already has a service reg-
This switches to the PTY selection
Automatically receives low- istered is selected, then this is overwritten
key with the new preset. mode.
er lead services within en- 2. Turn the /SEL key to select PTY.
(hold down) sembles that can be received. l Pressing the preset key will select the previ-
ously registered service. 3. Press the key or key.
Automatically receives high- This starts PTY search.
key er lead services within en-
(hold down) sembles that can be received.
Search for a Service
key Lower PTY search starts.
Search for ensembles and services that can be
key Switches to lower services.
received. key Higher PTY search starts.
key Switches to higher services. 1. Turn the /SEL key to select the en-
semble.
2. Press the /SEL key. NOTE
NOTE The service name within the selected en- l When selecting PTY, press any of the keys
semble is displayed. from the 1RPT key to the 6 key to
l Going to the first service or last service
within the ensemble switches to the next en- 3. Turn the /SEL key to select the serv- switch to the PTY registered as a preset.
semble. ice. l When selecting PTY, select the PTY to reg-
4. Press the /SEL key. ister, and hold down any of the keys from
Receive the selected service. the 1RPT key to the 6 key to register the
PTY as a preset.

7-26 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Listen to Traffic Messages

NOTE NOTE Listen to CDs


l While in PTY select status, if there is no op- l If traffic messages are received, then this E00737800062

eration for 2 seconds, then an upwards will switch to the volume of the previously This explains how to listen to audio CDs
search within the selected PTY will start. received traffic messages or emergency
broadcasts. The volume when receiving traf-
(CD-DA/CD-TEXT).
fic messages or emergency broadcasts is that
Listen to Traffic Messages at which subsequent broadcasts will be re- Play CDs
E00739200015
ceived.
Insert the disc.
This explains how to listen to traffic messag-
Traffic Message Standby Mode
es. Insert a disc to automatically start playback.
When the broadcast of traffic messages starts,
To Listen to Traffic Messages this automatically switches to the station that
→ “Insert/Eject Discs” on page 7-21 7
If a disc is already within the product, press
is broadcasting traffic messages. the MEDIA key to switch to CD as the
1. When not in MW or LW mode, press the 1. When not in MW or LW mode, press the source.
TP key. TP key.
If traffic messages are being broadcast, “TP” is indicated on the display, and the Select the Track
these are received. product switches to standby mode.
If traffic messages are being broadcast, Press the key or key to select the
CAUTION these are received. track.
2. When not in MW or LW mode, press the
l When receiving a MW or LW signal, traffic TP key. This enables selection of the next or previous
messages cannot be received.
“TP” disappears from the display, and track.
standby mode will be cancelled.
NOTE Fast Forward or Rewind
l Receiving traffic messages will indicate CAUTION Hold down the 3 key or the 4 key.
“TRAF INF” on the display, and if text in-
formation can be received, the station name l When receiving a MW or LW signal, traffic
message standby mode will be cancelled. Fast forward/rewind is possible.
is displayed.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-27


Listen to MP3s

Switch Playback Mode Play the first 10 seconds of each of the tracks NOTE
on the whole disc in order.
Repeat playback, random playback, and scan l Depending on the file structure, it may take
some time to read the contents of the disc.
playback are possible. NOTE
Repeat Playback (RPT) l Press this button again during playback if Select the Track (File)
you wish to hear that track, and that track
Press the 1RPT key. will play normally. Press the key or key to select the
track.
Repeat playback of the track currently being
played. Listen to MP3s This enables selection of the next or previous
7
E00737900047
track.
NOTE This explains how to listen to audio files on a
disc. Fast Forward or Rewind
l Pressing again will cancel.
l Selecting a track, ejecting, fast forwarding, Hold down the 3 key or the 4 key.
or rewinding will cancel. CAUTION
l CD-ROM and CD-R/RW media can only Fast forward/rewind is possible.
Random Playback (RDM) play back MP3 format audio files.
Press the 2RDM key. Switch Playback Mode
To Listen to MP3s
Repeat playback, random playback, and scan
Play the tracks on the disc in a random order.
Insert the disc. playback are possible.

NOTE Insert a disc to automatically start playback. Repeat Playback (RPT)


l Pressing again will cancel. → “Insert/Eject Discs” on page 7-21 Press the 1RPT key.
l Ejecting will cancel this. If a disc is already within the product, press
the MEDIA key to switch to CD as the Repeat playback of the track currently being
source.
Scan Playback (SCAN) played.

Press the PTY/SCAN key.

7-28 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Listen to an iPod

NOTE Play all tracks in folders on the disc in a ran- NOTE


dom order.
l Pressing again will cancel. l If there is no operation for 10 seconds after
selecting the folder, then track search mode
l Selecting a file, ejecting, fast forwarding, or NOTE
rewinding will cancel. will be cancelled.
l Pressing again will cancel. l Select the folder, and hold down the /SEL
key to start playback from the first track in
Folder Repeat Playback that folder.
Hold down the 1RPT key. Scan Playback (SCAN) l While the file is selected, press the 6 key
to return to the previous operation.
Press the SCAN key.
Repeat playback of the tracks within the fold- l While the file is selected, hold down the 6
er currently being played. key to cancel rack search mode.
Play the first 10 seconds of each of the tracks
in the folder currently being played in order.
l If there is no operation for five seconds after
selecting the file, that file is played back.
7
NOTE l Disc operations such as selecting a track will
Search Tracks cancel track search mode.
l Pressing again will cancel.
l Even if the file is selected, folder repeat Search folders and files, and select a track.
playback will not be cancelled.
1. Turn the /SEL key to select the folder. Listen to an iPod
2. Press the /SEL key. E00738001156
Random Playback (RDM) By connecting commercially-available iPod/
Press the 2RDM key. Files within the selected folder are dis- iPhone devices to this product, you can play
played. back tracks on these through the product.
Play the tracks in the folder in a random or- 3. Turn the /SEL key to select the file.
der. 4. Press the /SEL key.
CAUTION
This plays the selected file (track). l Do not leave the iPod/iPhone unattended in
NOTE the vehicle.
l Pressing again will cancel. l Never hold these devices in your hand to op-
NOTE erate while driving, as this is dangerous.
l While the folder is selected, press the 6 l No indemnification for data loss resulting
Folder Random Playback key to cancel track search mode. when the iPod/iPhone is connected to the
product will be possible.
Hold down the 2RDM key.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-29


Listen to an iPod

CAUTION NOTE Play iPod


l Depending on how the devices are handled, l Set up the device in order that no unsafe ac- Press the MEDIA key to set the iPod as the
audio files being damaged or lost, therefore tions, such as plugging in the connection ca-
it is recommended that data be backed up. ble are taken while driving.
source.
l When inserting and removing the iPod/
iPhone, for safety’s sake first stop the vehi- The selected source is indicated on the dis-
NOTE cle. play.
l Depending on the generation, model, or soft- l Depending on the status of the iPod/iPhone,
ware version of the iPod/iPhone, playback
it may take some time until the device is rec- Select the Track (File)
ognized, or playback starts.
on this product may not be possible.
(→7-12) Additionally, playback as ex- l Buttons on the product will not operate Press the key or key to select the
while iPod/iPhone is connected.
7 plained in this document may not be possi-
l iPod/iPhone specifications and settings may
track.
ble.
mean that connection is not possible, or re-
l For vehicles with a Bluetooth® 2.0 interface, sult in differences in operation or display. This enables selection of the next or previous
the types of devices that can be connected track.
may vary.
l Depending on audio data in the iPod/iPhone,
track information may not be displayed cor-
For details, access the MITSUBISHI
MOTORS website.
rectly. Fast Forward or Rewind
Please read and agree to the “Warning about
l Depending on the status of the vehicle and
device, the iPod/iPhone may not play back Hold down the 3 key or the 4 key.
Links to the Web Sites of Other Compa- after starting the engine.
nies”. The websites mentioned above may
connect you to websites other than the
l Data containing copyright information may
Fast forward/rewind is possible.
not play back.
MITSUBISHI MOTORS website.
http://www.mitsubishi-motors.com/en/prod-
l It is recommended that the iPod/iPhone
Switch Playback Mode
equaliser settings be set to flat.
ucts/index.html
l Operate the iPod/iPhone while connected to
l Usage of iPod/iPhone hardware with the lat- this product. Repeat playback and shuffle playback are
est software version is recommended. possible.
l If the iPod/iPhone is connected via Blue-
l Regarding how to connect the iPod/iPhone, tooth as a Bluetooth- capable audio device,
refer to “How to connect an iPod” on page
7-69.
then do not connect the iPod/iPhone using Repeat Playback (RPT)
an iPod cable. Connection using both meth-
l When connecting the iPod/iPhone, use a ods will result in erroneous operation. Press the 1RPT key.
commerciallyavailable iPod connection ca-
ble.
l If an iPod/iPhone does not operate correctly,
then remove the iPod/iPhone from the prod- Repeat playback of the track currently being
uct, reset, then reconnect. played.

7-30 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Listen to Audio Files on a USB Device

NOTE 2. Press the /SEL key. Categories or Listen to Audio Files on a


tracks within the selected category are
l Pressing again will cancel. displayed. USB Device
3. Turn the /SEL key to select the cate- E00736501388

Shuffle Playback (RDM) gory or track. By connecting commercially-available USB


4. Press the /SEL key. devices such as USB memory to this product,
Press the 2RDM key.
Repeat steps 1 to 4, and search for you can play back audio files on these
tracks. through the product.
Play tracks in the category currently being
Select the track, and press the /SEL
played in a random order.
key to play.
CAUTION
NOTE NOTE l Do not leave the USB device unattended in 7
the vehicle.
l Pressing again will cancel.
l While the category (1st level) is selected, l Never hold these devices in your hand to op-
press the 6 key to cancel track search erate while driving, as this is dangerous.
Album Shuffle Playback mode. l Do not use hard discs, card readers, or mem-
l If there is no operation for 10 seconds after ory readers, as damage may occur to these or
Hold down the 2RDM key. to the data contained therein. If these are er-
selecting the category, then track search
mode will be cancelled. roneously connected, then turn the ignition
Play back the album in a random order l Select the category, and hold down the switch to the “LOCK” position or put the
(tracks in any order on the album). /SEL key to start playback from the first operation mode in OFF, then remove.
track in that category. l Because of the risk of data loss, it is recom-
l While the track is selected, press the 6 mended that files be backed up.
NOTE key to return to the previous operation. l No guarantee is made as regards damage to
the USB device, nor regarding loss or dam-
l Pressing again will cancel. l While the track is selected, hold down the 6
key to cancel track search mode. age to data contained therein.
l If there is no operation for five seconds after l Depending on how the devices are handled,
Search Tracks selecting the track, that file is played back. audio files being damaged or lost, therefore
it is recommended that data be backed up.
l iPod operations such as selecting a track will
Search categories or track names, and select a cancel track search mode.
track.
1. Turn the /SEL key to select the cate-
gory.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-31


Listen to Audio Files on a USB Device

NOTE NOTE This enables selection of the next or previous


track.
l Digital audio players that support the mass l Depending on audio data in the USB device,
storage class specifications can be connec- track information may not be displayed cor-
ted. rectly.
Fast Forward or Rewind
l For details regarding the types of USB devi- l Depending on the status of the vehicle and
Hold down the 3 key or the 4 key.
ces that can be connected and the types of device, the iPod/iPhone may not play back
files that can be played back in vehicles with after starting the engine.
a Bluetooth® 2.0 interface, refer to “Types l Data containing copyright information may Fast forward/rewind is possible.
of connectable devices and supported file not play back.
specifications” on page 7-70. l This product can play back MP3, WMA, and Switch Playback Mode
l Regarding how to connect USB devices, re- AAC format audio files.
7 fer to “How to connect a USB memory de- l Depending on the type of USB device, usage Repeat playback, random playback, and scan
vice” on page 7-68. may not be possible, or functions that can be playback are possible.
l When connecting a USB device, use a con- used may be restricted.
nection cable. Failure to use a connection ca- l The recommended file system for USB
Repeat Playback (RPT)
ble when connecting may place undue load memory is FAT32.
on, or damage the USB connector. l The maximum supported capacity for USB Press the 1RPT key.
l Set up the device in order that no unsafe ac- memory is 32GB.
tions, such as plugging in the connection ca- l Operate the USB device containing recorded Repeat playback of the track currently being
ble are taken while driving. audio files while connected to this product.
played.
l When inserting and removing the USB de-
vice, for safety’s sake first stop the vehicle. Play Back of Audio Files on a
l Do not insert other than audio devices into
USB Device NOTE
the USB port. Damage to the device or
equipment may result. l Pressing again will cancel.
l Depending on the status of the USB device, Press the MEDIA key to set l Selecting a file will cancel this.
it may take some time until the device is rec-
ognized, or playback starts. USB as the source. The selected source is in- Folder Repeat Playback
l Depending on USB devices, buttons on the dicated on the display.
product will not operate while the USB de- Hold down the 1RPT key.
vice is connected.
Select the Track (File)
l USB device specifications and settings may
Repeat playback of the tracks within the fold-
mean that connection is not possible, or re-
sult in differences in operation or display. Press the key or key to select the er currently being played.
track.

7-32 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Listen to Audio Files on a USB Device

NOTE Scan Playback (SCAN) 3. Turn the /SEL key to select the file.
4. Press the /SEL key.
l Pressing again will cancel. Press the PTY/SCAN key.
l Even if the file is selected, folder repeat This plays the selected file (track).
playback will not be cancelled. Play the first 10 seconds of each of the tracks
on the whole USB device in order.
Folder Random Playback NOTE
(RDM) NOTE l While the folder is selected, press the 6
key to cancel track search mode.
Press the 2RDM key. l Press this button again during playback if
you wish to hear that track, and that track
l If there is no operation for 10 seconds after
selecting the folder, then track search mode
Play tracks in the folder currently being will play normally. will be cancelled.
played in a random order. l Select the folder, and hold down the /SEL 7
Folder Scan Playback key to start playback from the first track in
that folder.
NOTE Hold down the PTY/SCAN key.
l While the file is selected, press the 6 key
l Pressing again will cancel. to return to the previous operation.
Play the first 10 seconds of the first track in l While the file is selected, hold down the 6
l Even if the file is selected, folder random
each folder on the USB device in order.
playback will not be cancelled. key to cancel track search mode.
l If there is no operation for five seconds after
selecting the file, that file is played back.
All Folder Random Playback NOTE l Operations such as selecting a track will
Hold down the 2RDM key. l Press this button again during playback if cancel track search mode.
you wish to hear that track, and that track
will play normally.
Play the tracks in all folders in a random or-
der.
Search Tracks
NOTE Search folders and files, and select a track.
l Pressing again will cancel. 1. Turn the /SEL key to select the folder.
l Even if the file is selected, all folder random 2. Press the /SEL key.
playback will not be cancelled.
Files within the selected folder are dis-
played.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-33


To play iPod/USB memory device tracks via voice operation (vehicles with Bluetooth® 2.0 interface)

To play iPod/USB memory Preparation for voice operation NOTE


device tracks via voice To use the voice operation, press the
E00748800033
l If you say “Artist <name>,” you can skip
step 3.
operation (vehicles with SPEECH button (A) first.
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface) 3. After the voice guide says “What Artist
E00748700032 would you like to play?,” say the artist
name.
Desired tracks on the iPod/USB memory de-
4. If there is only one match, the system
vice which is connected to the USB input ter-
proceeds to step 6.
minal can be selected and played via voice
5. If there are two or more matches, the
operation.
7 For information concerning the voice recog-
voice guide will say “More than one
match was found, would you like to play
nition function or speaker registration func-
<artist name>?” If you say “Yes,” the
tion, refer to “Bluetooth® 2.0 interface” on system proceeds to step 6.
page 7-48. If you say “No,” the next matching artist
The following explains how to prepare for is uttered by the system.
voice operation and play the tracks. To search by artist name
E00748900034
NOTE
1. Say “Play” on the main menu.
l If you say “No” to three or all artist names
uttered by the system, the voice guide will
NOTE say “Artist not found, please try again” and
the system returns to step 2.
l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface starts recogniz-
ing the connected device. l Search time is dependant on the number of
songs on your connected device. Devices
If the connected device cannot be recognized
containing a large number of songs may take
or a connection error occurs, the Bluetooth® longer to return search results.
2.0 interface starts an appropriate voice
guide. Follow the voice guide.
6. After the voice guide says “Playing <ar-
tist name>,” the system creates a playlist
2. After the voice guide says “Would you
index for the artist.
like to play by Artist, Album, Playlist or
Genre?,” say “Artist”.

7-34 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


To play iPod/USB memory device tracks via voice operation (vehicles with Bluetooth® 2.0 interface)

NOTE 3. After the voice guide says “What Album 7. The system exits the voice recognition
would you like to play?” say the album mode and starts playback.
l If the confirmation function is active, the title.
voice guide confirms if the artist name is
correct. If the artist name is correct, say
4. If there is only one match, the system To search by playlist
“Yes”. If not, say “No”. After the voice proceeds to step 6. E00749100033
guide says “Artist not found, please try 5. If there are two or more matches, the 1. Say “Play” on the main menu.
again,” the system returns to step 2. voice guide will say “More than one
match was found, would you like to play
<album title>?” If you say “Yes,” the NOTE
7. The system exits the voice recognition
mode and starts playback. system proceeds to step 6. l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface starts recogniz-
If you say “No,” the next matching al- ing the connected device.

To search by album title


bum is uttered by the system. If the connected device cannot be recognized 7
or a connection error occurs, the Bluetooth®
E00749000032 2.0 interface starts an appropriate voice
1. Say “Play” on the main menu. NOTE guide. Follow the voice guide.
l If you say “No” to three or all album titles
uttered by the system, the voice guide will
NOTE say “Album not found, please try again” and
2. After the voice guide says “Would you
like to play by Artist, Album, Playlist or
l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface starts recogniz- the system returns to step 2.
Genre?,” say “Playlist”.
ing the connected device.
If the connected device cannot be recognized
6. After the voice guide says “Playing <al-
or a connection error occurs, the Bluetooth®
bum title>,” the system creates a playlist NOTE
2.0 interface starts an appropriate voice
guide. Follow the voice guide. index for the album title. l If you say “Playlist <playlist>,” you can skip
step 3.
If the device has no playlist, the voice guide
2. After the voice guide says “Would you NOTE will say “There are no playlists stored on de-
like to play by Artist, Album, Playlist or vice” and the system returns to step 2.
l If the confirmation function is active, the
Genre?,” say “Album”. voice guide confirms if the album title is
correct. If the album title is correct, say 3. After the voice guide says “What Play-
“Yes”. If not, say “No”. After the voice
NOTE guide says “Album not found, please try
list would you like to play?,” say the
again,” the system returns to step 2.
playlist name.
l If you say “Album <title>,” you can skip
4. If there is only one match, the system
step 3.
proceeds to step 6.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-35


Listen to Bluetooth Audio*
5. If there are two or more matches, the To search by genre If you say “No,” the next matching
voice guide will say “More than one E00749200034
genre is uttered by the system.
match was found, would you like to play 1. Say “Play” on the main menu.
<playlist>?” If you say “Yes,” the sys- NOTE
tem proceeds to step 6.
If you say “No,” the next matching play- NOTE l If you say “No” to three or all genres uttered
by the system, the voice guide will say
list name is uttered by the system. l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface starts recogniz- “Genre not found, please try again” and the
ing the connected device.
system returns to step 2.
If the connected device cannot be recognized
NOTE or a connection error occurs, the Bluetooth®
l If you say “No” to three or all playlist names 2.0 interface starts an appropriate voice 6. After the voice guide says “Playing
7 uttered by the system, the voice guide will
say “Playlist not found, please try again” and
guide. Follow the voice guide. <genre>,” the system creates an index
for the genre.
the system returns to step 2.
2. After the voice guide says “Would you
like to play by Artist, Album, Playlist or NOTE
6. After the voice guide says “Playing Genre?,” say “Genre”.
<playlist>,” the system creates an index l If the confirmation function is active, the
voice guide confirms if the genre is correct.
for the playlist.
NOTE If the genre is correct, say “Yes”. If not, say
“No”. After the voice guide says “Genre not
NOTE l If you say “Genre <type>,” you can skip found, please try again,” the system returns
step 3. to step 2. Refer to “Confirmation function
l If the confirmation function is active, the setting” on page 7-51.
voice guide confirms if the playlist name is
3. After the voice guide says “What Genre
correct. If the playlist name is correct, say
“Yes”. If not, say “No”. After the voice would you like to play?,” say the music 7. The system exits the voice recognition
guide says “Playlist not found, please try type. mode and starts playback.
again,” the system returns to step 2. Refer to 4. If there is only one match, the system
“Confirmation function setting” on page proceeds to step 6.
7-51. 5. If there are two or more matches, the Listen to Bluetooth Audio*
voice guide will say “More than one E00736700080

7. The system exits the voice recognition match was found, would you like to play This product can play back tracks on com-
mode and starts playback. <genre>?” If you say “Yes,” the system mercially-available Bluetooth-capable audio
proceeds to step 6. devices.

7-36 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Listen to Bluetooth Audio*

CAUTION NOTE 2. Press the 5 key. Bluetooth Audio


playback starts.
l Never hold these devices in your hand to op- l Depending on the status of the vehicle and
erate while driving, as this is dangerous. device, the iPod/iPhone may not play back
l Do not leave the Bluetooth audio device un- after starting the engine. NOTE
attended in the vehicle.
l Hold down the 5 key to pause.
l Depending on how the devices are handled,
Connect a Bluetooth-capable
audio files being damaged or lost, therefore l Press the 6 key to stop.
it is recommended that data be backed up. Audio Device
Regarding how to connect your Bluetooth de-
Select the Track (File)
NOTE vice, refer to “Connecting the Bluetooth® 2.0 Press the key or key to select the track.
l Depending on the type of Bluetooth-capable interface and Bluetooth device” on page 7
audio devices, usage may not be possible, or 7-53. This enables selection of the next or previous
functions that can be used may be restricted. Operation methods below describe situations track.
l Confirm together with the user manuals for once connection has been completed.
the commercially- available Bluetooth-capa-
ble audio devices. Fast Forward or Rewind
l Depending on the type of Bluetooth-capable NOTE
audio devices, volume levels may differ. Hold down the key or the key.
There is the danger of loud volumes, so prior l If the iPod/iPhone is connected via Blue-
tooth as a Bluetooth- capable audio device,
to use, it is recommended that you turn the
then do not connect the iPod/iPhone using
Fast forward/rewind is possible.
volume down.
an iPod cable. Connection using both meth-
→ “Adjust Volume” on page 7-21
ods will result in erroneous operation. Switch Playback Mode
l Depending on the status of the Bluetooth au-
dio device, it may take some time until the
Repeat playback, random playback, and scan
device is recognized, or playback starts. Play Bluetooth Audio playback are possible.
l Bluetooth audio device specifications and
settings may mean that connection is not 1. Press the MEDIA key to set Bluetooth
possible, or result in differences in operation Audio as the source.
Repeat Playback (RPT)
or display. Press the 1RPT key.
l Depending on audio data in the Bluetooth
The selected source is indicated on the
audio device, track information may not be
displayed correctly. display. Repeat playback of the track currently being
played.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-37


Use AUX*

NOTE Use AUX* CAUTION


l Each time the 1RPT key is pressed, this E00736900079
l Even if not inserted, the product will switch
switches in the order Repeat OFF, 1 track re- By connecting external input cables and to AUX, therefore take care with volume
peat, All track repeat, and Repeat OFF. levels when not inserted.
AUX devices to this product, you can play
back tracks on these devices through the
Random Playback (RDM) product. NOTE
Press the 2RDM key.
Hold down the MEDIA key. l Depending on the audio device to be con-
nected, noise may be emitted.
Play the tracks in the Bluetooth Audio device Switch to the AUX mode, and “AUX” is dis-
l For power, use the battery power source in-
in a random order. played. cluded in the audio device to be connected.
7 Using the connected audio device while
charging through the cigarette lighter socket
NOTE Auxiliary Audio connecter (RCA)
in the vehicle may lead to noise being emit-
l Pressing again will cancel. ted through the speakers.
l If no audio devices are connected, then do
not select the external sound input mode. If
Scan Playback (SCAN) external sound input mode is selected while
no audio devices are connected, then sound
Press the PTY/SCAN key. may be emitted through the speakers.

Play the first 10 seconds of each of the tracks


on the whole Bluetooth Audio device in or-
der.
Auxiliary Audio connector (RCA)
NOTE A- Left audio input connector (white)
B- Right audio input connector (red)
l Press this button again during playback if
you wish to hear that track, and that track
will play normally. CAUTION
l Connect an audio device with external sound
input mode cancelled, or with the sound
turned down.

7-38 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Display Indicator

Display Indicator
E00738100059

This explains content of the display indicator.

Change the Display Mode CAUTION NOTE


E00738500040
You can change the content of the display in- l The operation of changing display contents l Up to 11 characters may be displayed at one
may impede safe driving, therefore check time. To display 12 or more characters, press
dicator. safety before operation. the PAGE key, and subsequent characters
Press the DISP key to switch the display con- will be displayed.
tent.
During DAB Reception*
Each time the DISP key is pressed, the dis-
play content changes. This switches in the order “Service name”,
“Ensemble name”, and “CH no. (CH ID)”.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-39


Audio Quality and Volume Balance Adjustment

NOTE [DISP] Each time the key is pressed, this During Bluetooth® 2.0 Audio
switches in the order “Album name”, “Track
l If the text information for the service name name”, “Artist name”, “Genre name”*, and Playback*
and ensemble name cannot be obtained, then
“Operating status”. E00739000013
nothing is displayed. Operating details are the same as in “During
iPod Playback” on page 7-40.
*: Displayed when playing back audio files
During CD-DA playback
on a USB device (vehicles with a Bluetooth®
This switches in the order “Disc title”, 2.0 interface).
Audio Quality and Volume
“Track title”, and “Operating status”. Balance Adjustment
NOTE E00738200021

NOTE
7 l During display of the ID3tag, hold down the Change audio quality settings.
l If there is no text information to display, DISP key to switch to the folder title dis-
then “NO TITLE” is displayed. play. Adjust Audio Quality and Vol-
l The genre name display may not be possible.
ume Balance
During MP3/WMA/AAC Play-
back During iPod Playback 1. Press the /SEL key to select settings
items.
This switches in the order “Folder title”, E00738900015
This switches in the order “Albums”, “Track Each time the /SEL key is pressed,
“File title”, and “Operating status”.
name”, “Artist name”, “Genre name”*, and this switches in the order BASS, TRE-
“Operating status”. BLE, FADER, BALANCE, SCV, and
NOTE Cancel.
2. Turn the /SEL key to adjust.
l If there is no text information to display,
NOTE
then “NO TITLE” is displayed.
l If there is no text information to display, Ad- Turn counter- Turn clockwise
Display the ID3tag then “NO TITLE” is displayed. just- clockwise
l Displayed genre name in equipment by type
ment
Hold down the DISP key. (vehicles with a Bluetooth® 2.0 interface).
items
l The genre name display may not be possible.
This switches the ID3tag display. BASS -6 to 0 0 to +6
(low low-pass (high low-pass
volume) volume)

7-40 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


System Settings

Ad- Turn counter- Turn clockwise 2. Press the /SEL key to select settings Settings Settings val- Settings con-
just- clockwise items. name ue tent
ment DAB Band BAND III Set used
items Each time the /SEL key is pressed,
settings broadcast
this switches in the order Gracenote
TRE- -6 to 0 0 to +6 DB*, PHONE settings, Adjust time, and band to 174
BLE (Low high-pass (High high-pass Cancel. to 239 MHz.
volume) volume) 3. Turn the /SEL key to set. L-BAND Set used
FAD- CENTER to FRONT 11 to 4. Press the /SEL key to determine. broadcast
ER REAR 11 CENTER band to 1452
(emphasise (emphasise This completes settings, and displays the to 1490 MHz.
REAR) FRONT) next settings item.
BOTH Set used
7
BAL- LEFT 11 to CENTER to broadcast
ANC CENTER RIGHT 11 *: Displayed when playing back audio band to Band
E (emphasise (emphasise files (vehicles with a Bluetooth® 2.0 in- III and L-
LEFT) RIGHT) terface). Band.
SCV OFF, LOW MID, HIGH
(Low vehicle (High vehicle DAB Setting* RDS Setting
compensated vol- compensated vol-
ume effect) ume effect)
Change DAB settings Change RDS settings
System Settings (“Set value” bold typeface indicates factory (“Set value” bold typeface indicates factory
default settings.) default settings.)
E00738300107

Change system settings such as product time. Settings Settings val- Settings con-
1. Press the MENU key. name ue tent
DAB-DAB OFF If low recep-
Link settings tion sensitivi-
ON ty, switch to
another serv-
ice.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-41


System Settings

Settings Settings val- Settings con- Settings Settings val- Settings con- Settings Settings val- Settings con-
name ue tent name ue tent name ue tent
AF AF ON Automatical- TP-S TP-S ON Automatical- PTY ENGLISH Set the dis-
ly track the ly search for play language
same station traffic mes- for the pro-
as the pro- sages (TP sta- gram content
gram being tions). search (PTY
received. search) to
TP-S OFF Do not auto-
English.
AF OFF Do not auto- matically
matically search for FRANCAIS Set the dis-
7 track the traffic mes- play language
same station sages (TP sta- for the pro-
as the pro- tions). gram content
gram being PI-S search (PTY
PI-S ON Search for the
received. search) to
same station
REG French.
REG ON Do not auto- or local sta-
matically tion for that DEUTSCH Set the dis-
track the lo- registered in play language
cal station for the preset for the pro-
the program channel. gram content
being re- search (PTY
PI-S OFF Do not search
ceived. search) to
for the same
REG OFF Automatical- German.
station or lo-
ly track the cal station for SVENSK Set the dis-
local station that regis- play language
for the pro- tered in the for the pro-
gram being preset chan- gram content
received. nel. search (PTY
search) to
Swedish.

7-42 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


System Settings

Settings Settings val- Settings con- Time Setting NOTE


name ue tent
Turning the RDS setting CT setting “CT l While connected, mobile phone (receiving
PTY ESPANOL Set the dis- calls, etc.) operations may not function cor-
OFF” enables manual setting of the time. rectly.
play language 1. Select “YES” at the “Adjust time”
for the pro- l Depending on the distance between the
screen, and press the /SEL key. product and the mobile phone, the condi-
gram content
tions within the vehicle, and types of screen-
search (PTY The hour can be adjusted. Press the ing, connection may not be possible. In these
search) to /SEL key again to adjust the minutes. cases, situate the mobile phone as close as
Spanish. 2. Turn the /SEL key to adjust the time. possible to the product.
ITALIANO Set the dis- 3. Press the /SEL key. l Even though a Bluetooth-capable mobile
phone, characteristics and specifications
play language may mean that correct operation may not be 7
for the pro- This completes the adjustment. possible.
gram content l For safety’s sake, do not operate the mobile
search (PTY NOTE phone while driving. When operating the
search) to mobile phone, first stop the vehicle in a safe
Italian. l In order to finish adjusting the time, hold location.

CT
down the /SEL key until the seconds are l Even though a Bluetooth-capable mobile
CT ON Update the reset to “00”. phone, phone specifications and settings
time if time may result in differences in display, or pre-
data is re- vent correct operation.
PHONE Settings l Some models may not be confirmed as con-
ceived.
nected, or may not connect.
CT OFF Do not up- Change the mobile phone voice cut- in set-
date the time tings and the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface lan-
Supported profiles
even if time guage.
data is re- Depending on the vehicle, PHONE settings
Hands-free HFP(v1.5)
ceived. may not be possible.
Phone book trans- OPP(v1.1),
*: It is necessary to press the [TP] key and fer PBAP(v1.0)
NOTE
turn traffic message standby mode
“ON”. l Cancel functions such as the mobile phone
“dial lock”, and connect while on the stand-
by screen.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-43


System Settings

Vehicles without a Bluetooth® Vehicles with a Bluetooth® 2.0 Settings name


Settings
Settings con-
2.0 Interface Interface value tent
HFM voice lan- PORTU- Change the
A hands-free kit (available separately) is re- (“Set value” bold typeface indicates factory guage settings GUESE hands free mod-
quired. default settings.) ule voice lan-
(“Set value” bold typeface indicates factory RUSSI- guage.
default settings.) Settings Settings con- AN
Settings name
value tent
Settings value Settings content PHONE IN set- PHONE During mobile NOTE
Do not use mobile phone tings IN-R phone voice
PHONE OFF l Depending on the vehicle model, this may
voice cut-in. cut-in, output
7 sound from the
not display.
PHONE During mobile phone voice
right front
MUTE cut-in, mute the audio.
speaker.
Gracenote DB (Vehicles with a
During mobile phone voice
PHONE During mobile
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface)
PHONE ATT cut-in, output audio from
IN-L phone voice The version number can be confirmed.
all speakers.
cut-in, output 1. Select “Gracenote DB” and press the
During mobile phone voice sound from the /SEL key.
PHONE IN-L cut-in, output sound from left front 2. Turn the /SEL key and select “DB
the left front speaker. speaker. Version”.
During mobile phone voice HFM voice lan- ENG- Change the 3. Press the /SEL key.
PHONE IN-R cut-in, output sound from guage settings LISH hands free mod- The DB Version is displayed.
the right front speaker. ule voice lan-
FRENCH guage.
During mobile phone voice
cut-in, output sound from GER-
PHONE IN-LR MAN
the left and right front
speakers. SPANISH
ITALIAN
DUTCH

7-44 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting
E00738400081

Please check these items if a message appears on the display, or if you think something is not working properly.
If This Message Appears...
A message is displayed on this product according to the situation.

Mode Message Cause Response


CD CHECK DISC The disc is inserted upside down. Insert with the label side up.
The disc has condensation on it. Wait a while before inserting again.
DISC ERROR The disc is damaged. Clean the read surface of the disc. 7
The disc is dirty.
INTERNAL E The drive has malfunctioned for some reason. Check that there is no problem with the disc, and insert
the disc again. If the problem persists, consult a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
HEAT ERROR The temperature inside the product is high. Remove the disc, and wait for the internal temperature
to return to normal.
USB FILE ERROR Files that cannot be played are selected. Select files that can be played.
→ “Audio Files (MP3/WMA/AAC)” on page 7-16
USB BUS PWR There is high or low electrical current or voltage. Turn the power OFF and wait a short while. If the
problem persists, consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
Authorized Service Point.
LSI ERROR There is an internal malfunction for some reason.
UNSUPPORTED Unsupported audio files have been played. Confirm audio files that can be played.
FORMAT → “Audio Files (MP3/WMA/AAC)” on page 7-16
UNSUPPORTED An unsupported USB device has been connected. Please connect a USB memory device.
DEVICE

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-45


Troubleshooting

Mode Message Cause Response


iPod NO SONG An iPod/iPhone not containing any tracks has been Connect an iPod/iPhone containing tracks.
connected.
VER ERROR This iPod/iPhone software version is not supported. Please change to a supported software version.
Other ERROR DC An abnormal direct voltage has been sent to the speak- Turn the power OFF and wait a short while. If the
ers. problem persists, consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
Authorized Service Point.
If You Think Something Is Not Working Properly...
Here is a list of symptoms, causes and responses if you think something is not working properly.
7
Symptoms Cause Response
There is no sound or quiet The volume is turned to its minimum. Adjust the volume.
sound → “Adjust Volume” on page 7-21
The balance or fader is turned to one side. Adjust the balance or fader.
→ “Adjust Audio Quality and Volume Balance” on
page 7-40
The disc cannot be inserted. A disc is already in the product. Eject the disc.
→ “Insert/Eject Discs” on page 7-21
There is no disc in the product, but the product says it is Press the eject button once.
loading. → “Insert/Eject Discs” on page 7-21
The disc cannot be played. The disc is inserted upside down. Insert with the label side up.
The disc has condensation on it. Wait a while before inserting.
The disc is dirty. Clean the read surface of the disc.
The sound skips in the The disc is damaged or dirty. Check the disc.
same place.

7-46 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Antenna

Symptoms Cause Response


There is no sound, even if Damage to or dirt on the disc means that its data cannot Check the disc. Additionally, if using CD-R/RW discs,
the disc is inserted. be read. their characteristics may render them unable to be
played.

Antenna NOTE Refer to “To play iPod/USB memory device


tracks via voice operation ” on page 7-34.
E00710500543
l Be sure to remove the roof antenna in the Refer to “Listen to Bluetooth Audio*” on
following cases:
page 7-36.
To remove • When using an automatic car wash.
Refer to “Use AUX*” on page 7-38.
• When placing a car cover over the vehi-
cle.
7
Turn the pole (A) anticlockwise. Bluetooth®
is a registered trademark of
• When driving into a structure that has a
low ceiling. BLUETOOTH SIG, INC.

Link System End User Licence


Link System* Agreement
E00764501514
E00764600013

The Link System takes overall control of the You have acquired a device that includes
devices connected via the USB input terminal software licensed by MITSUBISHI
or the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface allowing the MOTORS CORPORATION from JOHN-
connected devices to be operated by using the SON CONTROLS Inc (the automotive expe-
switches in the vehicle or voice commands. rience business unit), and their subsequent 3rd
See the following section for details on how party suppliers. For a complete list of these
To install to operate. 3rd party products and their end user licence
agreements, please go to the following web-
Screw the pole (A) clockwise into the base Refer to “Bluetooth® 2.0 interface” on page site.
(B) until it is securely retained. 7-48. http://www.jciblueconnect.com/faq/fulldi-
Refer to “USB input terminal” on page sclosure.pdf
7-68.
Refer to “Listen to Audio Files on a USB De-
vice” on page 7-31.
OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-47
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

Bluetooth® 2.0 interface* WARNING NOTE


E00726002257 l Although the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface al- l Some Bluetooth® devices are not compatible
lows you to make hands-free calls, if you with the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface allows for mak- choose to use the cellular phone while
ing/receiving hands-free calls in the vehicle l For details on the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface,
driving, you must not allow yourself to be you can see to access via the MITSUBISHI
using a Bluetooth® compatible cellular phone distracted from the safe operation of your MOTORS website.
based on the wireless communication tech- vehicle. Anything, including cellular Please read and agree the “Warning about
nology commonly known as Bluetooth®. It phone usage, that distracts you from the Links to the Web Sites of Other Companies”
safe operation of your vehicle increases because it connects other than MITSUBISHI
also allows the user to play music, saved in a your risk of an accident. MOTORS website.
Bluetooth® music player, from the vehicle’s l Refer to and comply with all state and lo- http://www.mitsubishi-motors.com/en/prod-
speakers.
7 The system is equipped with a voice recogni-
cal laws in your area regarding cellular
phone usage while driving.
ucts/index.html
l Software updates by cellular phone/digital
tion function, which allows you to make audio device manufacturers may change/
hands-free calls by simple switch operations alter device connectivity.
and voice command operations using a de-
NOTE
fined voice tree. l If the ignition switch or the operation mode Steering control switch and microphone
is left in ACC, the accessory power will au-
® p. 7-49
tomatically turn off after a certain period of
The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface can be used Voice recognition function ® p. 7-50
time and you will no longer be able to use
when the ignition switch or the operation the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. The accessory Useful voice commands ® p. 7-50
mode is in ON or ACC. power comes on again if the ignition switch Speaker enrollment function ® p. 7-52
or the engine switch is operated. Connecting the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface and
Before you can use the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter- Refer to “ACC power auto-cutout function” Bluetooth® device ® p. 7-53
face, you must pair the Bluetooth® device on page 6-13. Operating a music player connected via Blue-
and Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. Refer to “Con- l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface cannot be used tooth® ® p. 7-59
if the Bluetooth® device has a flat battery or How to make or receive hands-free calls
necting the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface and
the device power is turned off. ® p. 7-59
Bluetooth® device” on page 7-53.
l Hands-free calls will not be possible if your
Phone book function ® p. 7-61
phone does not have service available.
Bluetooth®
is a registered trademark of l If you place the Bluetooth® device in the
BLUETOOTH SIG, INC. luggage compartment, you may not be able
to use the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.

7-48 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

Steering control switch and mi- SPEECH button HANG-UP button


crophone l Press this button to change to voice rec- l Press this button when an incoming call
E00727201406 ognition mode. is received to refuse the call.
While the system is in voice recognition l Press this button during a call to end the
mode, “Listening” will appear on the au- current call.
dio display. When another call is on hold, you will
l If you press the button briefly while in switch to that call.
voice recognition mode, it will interrupt l If this button is pressed in the voice rec-
prompting and allow voice command in- ognition mode, the voice recognition
put. mode will be deactivated.
Pressing the button longer will deacti-
vate the voice recognition mode.
7
NOTE
l Pressing this button briefly during a call
will enable voice recognition and allow l When you press the SPEECH button to enter
voice recognition mode with a cellular
voice command input.
phone paired to the system, current informa-
tion on the cellular phone, such as “remain-
PICK-UP button ing battery life,” “signal strength” or “roam-
l Press this button when an incoming call ing,” will be displayed on the audio dis-
is received to answer the telephone. play.*
1- Volume up button *: Some cellular phones will not send this
l When another call is received during a information to the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
2- Volume down button call, press this button to put the first call-
3- SPEECH button er on hold and talk to the new caller.
l Call waiting and three-way calls can be used
4- PICK-UP button by the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface, only if it is
• In such circumstances, you can press possible to use those services with your cel-
5- HANG-UP button the button briefly to switch between lular phone.
6- Microphone callers. You will switch to the first
Volume up button caller and the other caller will be put Microphone
on hold.
Press this button to increase the volume. • To establish a three-way call in such Your voice will be recognized by a micro-
situations, press the SPEECH button phone in the overhead console, allowing you
Volume down button to enter voice recognition mode and to make hands-free calls with voice com-
then say “Join calls”. mands.
Press this button to decrease the volume.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-49


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

NOTE NOTE NOTE


l If a cellular phone is within close proximity l Some voice commands have alternative l Changing the language deletes the mobile
of the microphone, it may distort the sound commands. phone book imported to the Bluetooth® 2.0
quality. In this case, place the cellular phone l Depending on the selected language, some interface. If you wish to use it, you will have
as far as possible from the microphone. functions may not be available. to import it again.

Voice recognition function Selecting the Language 6. When the voice guide says “English
E00727301670 1. Press the SPEECH button. (French, Spanish, Italian, German,
The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface is equipped 2. Say “Setup”. Dutch, Portuguese or Russian) selected,”
with a voice recognition function. 3. Say “Language.” the language change process will be
7 Simply say voice commands and you can 4. The voice guide will say “Select a lan- completed and the system will return to
perform various operations and make or re- guage: English, French, Spanish, Italian, the main menu.
ceive hands-free calls. German, Dutch, Portuguese or Russian”
Say the desired language. (Example: Say Useful voice commands
With the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface, voice rec- “English.”) E00760000019
ognition is possible for English, French, 5. The voice guide will say “English Help function
Spanish, Italian, German, Dutch, Portuguese (French, Spanish, Italian, German, E00760100010
and Russian. The factory setting is “English” Dutch, Portuguese or Russian) selected. The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface is equipped
or “Russian.” Is this correct?” Say “Yes.” with a help function.
Answer “No” to return to Step 4. If you say “Help” when the system is waiting
NOTE for a voice command input, the system will

l If the voice command that you say differs NOTE tell you a list of the commands that can be
from the predefined command or cannot be
used under the circumstances.
l The voice guide will repeat the same mes-
recognised due to ambient noise or some sage twice. The first message is in the cur-
other reason, the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface rent language, and the second message is in
Cancelling
E00760201034
will ask you for the voice command again up the selected language.
There are two cancel functions.
to 3 times. l If many entries are registered in the vehicle
If you are at the main menu, say “Cancel” to
l For best performance and further reduction phone book, changing the language will take
of ambient noise, close the vehicle windows, longer. exit from the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
lower the blower speed and refrain from If you are anywhere else within the system,
conversation with your passengers while en- say “Cancel” to return to the main menu.
gaging the voice recognition function.

7-50 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

NOTE Security function 6. For confirmation purposes, the voice


E00760500043 guide will say “Password <4-digit pass-
l You can return to the previous menu by say- It is possible to use a password as a security word>. Is this correct?” Answer “Yes.”
ing “Go Back.” (if so equipped)
function by setting a password of your choice Answer “No” to return to the password
for the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. input in Step 5.
Confirmation function setting When the security function is turned on, it is 7. When the registration of the password is
E00760400013 necessary to make a voice input of a 4-digit completed, the voice guide will say
The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface is equipped password in order to use all functions of the “Password is enabled” and the system
with a confirmation function. Bluetooth® 2.0 interface, except for recep- will return to the main menu.
With the confirmation function activated, you tion.
are given more opportunities than normal to NOTE
confirm a command when making various Setting the password 7
settings to Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. This al- l Password will be required to access the sys-
Use the following procedure to turn on the tem after the next ignition cycle.
lows you to decrease the possibility that a security function by setting a password. l It is required for a little time after engine
setting is accidentally changed. 1. Press the SPEECH button. stop that the entered password is actually re-
The confirmation function can be turned on 2. Say “Setup”. corded in the system.
or off by following the steps below. 3. Say “Password.” If the ignition switch or the operation mode
1. Press the SPEECH button. is made to ACC or ON or the engine is star-
4. The voice guide will say “Password is
2. Say “Setup”. ted immediately after engine stop, there is a
disabled. Would you like to enable it?” case when the entered password is not recor-
3. Say “Confirmation prompts”. Answer “Yes.” ded in the system. At this time, please try to
4. The voice guide will say “Confirmation Answer “No” to cancel the setting of the enter the password again.
prompts are <on/off>. Would you like to password and return to the main menu.
turn confirmation prompts <off/on>”. 5. The voice guide will say “Please say a 4- Entering the password
Answer “Yes” to change the setting or digit password. Remember this pass-
answer “No” to keep the current setting. If a password has been set and the security
word. It will be required to use this sys-
5. The voice guide will say “Confirmation function is enabled, the voice guide will say
tem”.
prompts are <off/on>” and then the sys- “Hands-free system is locked. State the pass-
Say a 4-digit number which you want to
tem will return to the main menu. word to continue” when the SPEECH button
set as a password.
is pressed to enter voice recognition mode.
Say the 4-digit password number to enter the
password.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-51


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*
If the entered password is wrong, the voice 5. When the disabling of the password is “P” (PARK) position (A/T or CVT), and
guide will say “<4- digit password>, Incor- completed, the voice guide will say pull the parking brake lever.
rect password. Please try again”. Enter the “Password is disabled” and the system
correct password. will return to the main menu. NOTE
Speaker enrollment function l Speaker enrollment is not possible unless the
NOTE vehicle is parked. Make sure you park the
E00727400238 vehicle in a safe area before attempting
l You can re-enter the password as many
The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface can use the
times as you want. speaker enrollment.
l If you have forgotten your password, say speaker enrollment function to create a voice
“Cancel” to quit the voice input mode and model for one person per language. 2. Press the SPEECH button.
then check with a MITSUBISHI MOTORS This makes it easier for the Bluetooth® 2.0
7 Authorized Service Point. interface to recognise voice commands said
3. Say “Voice training”.
4. The voice guide will say “This operation
by you. must be performed in a quiet environ-
Disabling the password You can turn a voice model registered with ment while the vehicle is stopped. See
Use the following procedure to turn off the the speaker enrollment function on and off the owner’s manual for the list of re-
security function by disabling the password. whenever you want. quired training phrases. Press and re-
lease the SPEECH button when you are
Speaker enrollment
NOTE E00727500301
ready to begin. Press the HANG-UP but-
It takes about 2 to 3 minutes to complete the ton to cancel at any time”.
l System must be unlocked to disable the
Press the SPEECH button to start the
password. speaker enrollment process.
To ensure the best results, run through the speaker enrollment process.

1. Press the SPEECH button. process while in the driver’s seat, in an envi-
2. Say “Setup”. ronment that is as quiet as possible (when NOTE
3. Say “Password.” there is no rain or strong winds and the vehi-
l If you do not start the speaker enrollment
4. The voice guide will say “Password is cle windows are closed). Please turn off your process within 3 minutes of pressing the
enabled. Would you like to disable it?” phone while in speaker enrollment to prevent SPEECH button, the speaker enrollment
Answer “Yes.” interruption of the process. function will time out.
Use the following procedure for speaker en- The voice guide will say “Speaker Enroll-
Answer “No” to cancel the disabling of ment has timed out”. The system will then
the password and return to the main rollment.
beep and the voice recognition mode will be
menu. 1. Stop your vehicle in a safe area, put the
deactivated.
gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) posi-
tion (M/T), or the selector lever in the
7-52 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*
5. The voice guide will prompt for phrase Enabling and disabling the Connecting the Bluetooth® 2.0
1. Repeat the corresponding phrase lis-
ted in table “Enrollment commands” on
voice model and retraining interface and Bluetooth® de-
page 7-68.
E00727600100
You can turn a voice model registered with
vice
The system will register your voice and the speaker enrollment function on and off E00760601634

then move on to the registration of the Before you can make or receive hands-free
whenever you want.
next command. Continue the process un- You can also retrain the system. calls or play music using the Bluetooth® 2.0
til all phrases have been registered. Use the following procedure to perform these interface function, you must pair the Blue-
actions. tooth® device and Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
NOTE 1. Press the SPEECH button.
l To repeat the most recent voice training 2. Say “Voice training”. NOTE 7
command, press and release the SPEECH 3. If you have completed a speaker enroll-
button. ment process once already, the voice l Pairing is required only when the device is
used for the first time. Once the device has
l If you press the HANG-UP button anytime guide will say either “Enrollment is ena- been paired with the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter-
during the process, the system will beep and bled. Would you like to disable or re- face, you only need to bring the device into
stop the speaker enrollment process. train?” or “Enrollment is disabled. the vehicle next time and the device will au-
Would you like to enable or retrain?” tomatically connect to the Bluetooth® 2.0 in-
6. When all enrollment commands have 4. When enrollment is “enabled”, the voice terface (if supported by the device). The de-
been read out, the voice guide will say model is on; when enrollment is “disa- vice must have Bluetooth® turned ON to
“Speaker enrollment is complete”. bled”, the voice model is off. Say the connect.
The system will then end the speaker en- command that fits your needs.
rollment process and return to the main Say “Retrain” to start the speaker enroll- Up to 7 Bluetooth® devices can be paired
menu. ment process and recreate a new voice with the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
model. (Refer to “Speaker enrollment”
If multiple paired Bluetooth® devices are
on page 7-52.)
NOTE available in the vehicle, the cellular phone or
music player most recently connected is auto-
l Completing the speaker enrollment process
will turn on the voice model automatically. matically connected to the Bluetooth® 2.0 in-
l The commands “Help” and “Cancel” will terface.
not work in this mode.
You can also change a Bluetooth® device to
be connected.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-53


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*
To pair NOTE NOTE
To pair a Bluetooth® device with the Blue- l If 7 devices have already been paired, the l The pairing code entered here is only used
tooth® 2.0 interface, use either one of the fol- voice guide will say “Maximum devices for the Bluetooth® connection certification.
lowing 2 methods (Type 1 or Type 2). paired” and then the system will end the It is any 4-digit number the user would like
pairing process. To register a new device, to select.
delete one device and then repeat the pairing Remember the pairing code as it needs to be
Pairing procedure- Type 1*
process. keyed into the Bluetooth® device later in the
1. Stop your vehicle in a safe area, put the (Refer to “Selecting a device: Deleting a de- pairing process.
gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) posi- vice” on page 7-56.) Depending on the connection settings of the
tion (M/T) or the selector lever in the Bluetooth® device, this code may have to be
“P” (PARK) position (A/T or CVT) and 6. The voice guide will say “Please say a 4- entered each time you connect the Blue-
7 pull the parking brake lever. digit pairing code.” Say a 4-digit num- tooth® device to the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter-
ber. face. For the default connection settings, re-
fer to the instructions for the device.
NOTE When the confirmation function is on,
the system will confirm whether the
l You cannot pair Bluetooth® devices with the number said is acceptable. Answer 7. The voice guide will say “Start pairing
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface unless the vehicle is “Yes.” procedure on the device. See the device
parked. Before pairing a Bluetooth® device manual for instructions.” Enter in the
Answer “No” to return to pairing code
with the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface, confirm Bluetooth® device the 4-digit number
selection.
that the vehicle is parked in a safe location.
you have registered in Step 6.

2. Press the SPEECH button. NOTE


3. Say “Setup”.
NOTE
l Some Bluetooth® devices require a specific
4. Say “Pairing options.” pairing code. Please refer to the device man- l According to the corresponding device to
5. The voice guide will say “Select one of ual for pairing code requirements. Bluetooth®, it might take a few minutes to
the following: pair, edit, delete, or list.” pair the Bluetooth® device with the Blue-
Say “Pair.” tooth® 2.0 interface.
l If the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface cannot recog-
nize the Bluetooth® device, the voice guide
will say “Pairing has timed out” and the
pairing process will be cancelled.
Confirm that the device you are pairing sup-
ports Bluetooth®, and try pairing it again.

7-54 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

NOTE NOTE manual for instructions.” and then will


say “The pairing code is <pairing
l If you enter the wrong number, the voice l You cannot pair any Bluetooth® device with code>.”
guide will say “Pairing failed” and the pair- the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface unless the vehi-
ing process will be cancelled. cle is parked. Before pairing a Bluetooth®
Confirm the number is right, and try pairing
device with the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface, NOTE
it again.
confirm that the vehicle is parked in a safe l Some Bluetooth® devices require a specific
location. pairing code. Please refer to the device man-
8. The voice guide will say “Please say the ual for pairing code requirements and read
name of the device after the beep.” You 2. Press the SPEECH button. the next section “If your device requires a
can assign a desired name for the Blue- specific pairing code” on page 7-53.
3. Say “Pair Device.”
tooth® device and register it as a device l The pairing code entered here is only used
tag. Say the name you want to register for the Bluetooth® connection certification. 7
after the beep. NOTE Depending on the connection settings of the
Bluetooth® device, this code may have to be
l The following procedure ( to ) can also entered each time you connect the Blue-
be used instead of saying “Pair Device.” Re-
NOTE place this step 3 with the following proce-
tooth® device to the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter-
face. For the default connection settings, re-
l When the confirmation function is on, after dure if you prefer.
fer to the instructions for the device.
repeating the device tag you have said, the Say “Setup.”
voice guide will ask “Is this correct?” An- Say “Pairing Options.”
swer “Yes.” The voice guide will say “Select one of 5. Enter in the Bluetooth® device the 4-dig-
To change the device tag, answer “No” and the following: pair, edit, delete, or list.” it number that has been read out in Step
then say the device tag again. Say “Pair.” 4.
l If 7 devices have already been paired, the
9. The voice guide will say “Pairing com- voice guide will say “Maximum devices
plete,” and the pairing process will end.
paired” and then the system will end the NOTE
pairing process. To register a new device,
delete one device and then repeat the pairing l Depending on the Bluetooth® device, it may
Pairing procedure- Type 2* process.
take a few minutes to pair it with the Blue-
1. Stop your vehicle in a safe area, put the (Refer to “Selecting a device: Deleting a de- tooth® 2.0 interface.
gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) posi- vice” on page 7-56.)
tion (M/T), or the selector lever in the
“P” (PARK) position (A/T or CVT), and 4. The voice guide will say “Start pairing
pull the parking brake lever. procedure on the device. See the device

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-55


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

NOTE 7. The voice guide will say “Pairing Com- 8. The voice guide will say “Do you want
plete. Would you like to import the con- to pair a device now?” Answer “Yes,”
l If the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface cannot recog- tacts from your mobile device now?” the system will proceed to Step 3 in the
nize the Bluetooth® device, the voice guide Answer “Yes,” and the voice guide will pairing process. Refer to the “Pairing
will say “Pairing has timed out” and the say “Please wait while the contacts are procedure- Type 2.”
pairing process will be cancelled.
Confirm that the device you are pairing sup-
imported. This may take several mi-
ports Bluetooth®, and try pairing it again.
nutes.” Answer “No” to end the pairing Selecting a device
process.
l If you enter the wrong number, the voice E00760700032
guide will say “Pairing failed” and the pair- If multiple paired Bluetooth® devices are
ing process will be cancelled. If your device requires a specif- available in the vehicle, the cellular phone or
Confirm the number is right, and try pairing ic pairing code music player most recently connected is auto-
7 it again.
If your device requires a specific pairing matically connected to the Bluetooth® 2.0 in-
If your device requires a specific pairing
code, you need to set the pairing code. Refer code, you need to set the pairing code. Fol- terface.
to the device manual for pairing code re- low the procedures below. You can connect to the other cellular phone
quirements and read the next section “If 1. Press the SPEECH button. or music player by following setting change
your device requires a specific pairing code” 2. Say “Setup.” procedures.
on page 7-53. 3. Say “Pairing Options.”
4. Say “Set Code.” To select a cellular phone
6. The voice guide will say “Please say the 5. The voice guide will say “Do you want 1. Press the SPEECH button.
name of the device after the beep.” You the pairing code to be random or fixed?” 2. Say “Setup”.
can assign a desired name for the Blue- Say “Fixed.” 3. Say “Select phone.”
tooth® device and register it as a device 6. The voice guide will say “Please say a 4- 4. After the voice guide says “Please say,”
tag. Say the name you want to register digit pairing code.” Say a 4-digit num- the numbers of the cellular phones and
after the beep. ber. device tags of corresponding cellular
7. The voice guide will say “Pairing code phones will be read out in order, starting
set to <pairing code>.” with the cellular phone that has been
NOTE When the confirmation function is on, most recently connected.
l When the confirmation function is on, after the system will confirm whether the Say the number of the cellular phone
repeating the device tag you have said, the number said is acceptable. Answer that you want to connect to.
voice guide will ask “Is this correct?” An-
“Yes.” When the confirmation function is on,
swer “Yes.”
To change the device tag, answer “No” and
Answer “No” to return to Step 6. the system will ask you again whether
then say the device tag again. the phone that you want to connect to is

7-56 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*
correct. Answer “Yes” to continue and When the confirmation function is on, 4. The voice guide will say “Select one of
connect to the cellular phone. the system will ask you again whether the following: pair, edit, delete, or list.”
Answer “No,” and the voice guide will the music player that you want to con- Say “Delete.”
say “Please say.” nect to is correct. Answer “Yes” to con- 5. After the voice guide says “Please say,”
Say the number of the phone that you tinue and connect to the music player. the numbers of the devices and device
want to connect to. Answer “No,” and the voice guide will tags of corresponding devices will be
say “Please say.” read out in order, starting with the de-
NOTE Say the number of the music player that vice that has been most recently connec-
you want to connect to. ted. After it completes reading all pairs,
l You can connect to a phone at any time by the voice guide will say “or all.”
pressing the SPEECH button and saying the
NOTE Say the number of the device that you
number, even before all of the paired num-
bers and device tags of corresponding cellu-
want to delete from the system. 7
lar phones are read out by the system. l You can connect to a music player at any If you want to delete all paired phones
time by pressing the SPEECH button and
from the system, say “All.”
saying the number, even before all of the
paired numbers and device tags of corre-
6. For confirmation purposes, the voice
5. The selected phone will be connected to
sponding music players are read out by the guide will say “Deleting <device tag>
the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. The voice <number>. Is this correct?” or “Deleting
system.
guide will say “<device tag> selected” all devices. Is this correct?”
and then the system will return to the Answer “Yes” to delete the phone(s).
main menu. 5. The selected music player will be con-
Answer “No” to return to Step 4.
nected to the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
7. The voice guide will say “Deleted,” and
To select a music player The voice guide will say “<device tag>
then the system will end the device dele-
1. Press the SPEECH button. selected” and then the system will return
tion process.
2. Say “Setup”. to the main menu.
3. Say “Select music player.”
4. After the voice guide says “Please say,”
Deleting a device NOTE
the numbers of the music players and de- Use the following procedure to delete a l If the device deletion process fails for some
vice tags of corresponding music players paired Bluetooth® device from the Blue- reason, the voice guide will say “Delete
will be read out in order, starting with failed” and then the system will cancel delet-
tooth® 2.0 interface.
ing the device.
the music player that has been most re- 1. Press the SPEECH button.
cently connected. 2. Say “Setup”.
Say the number of the music player that 3. Say “Pairing options.”
you want to connect to.
OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-57
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

To check a paired Bluetooth® NOTE 5. The voice guide will say “Please say,”
and read out the numbers of the Blue-
device l If you press and release the SPEECH button tooth® devices and device tags of corre-
E00760800017 and say “Continue” or “Previous” while the
list is being read, the system will advance or sponding devices in order, starting with
You can check a paired Bluetooth® device by
rewind the list. the Bluetooth® that has been most re-
following the steps below.
Say “Continue” to proceed to the device cently connected.
1. Press the SPEECH button.
with the next highest number or “Previous” After all paired device tags have been
2. Say “Setup”. to return to the phone with the previous read, the voice guide will say “Which
3. Say “Pairing options.” number.
device, please?” Say the number of the
4. The voice guide will say “Select one of l You can change the device tag by pressing
device tag you want to change.
the following: pair, edit, delete, or list.” and releasing the SPEECH button and then
saying “Edit” while the list is being read.
7 Say “List.”
5. The voice guide will read out device tags l You can change the phone to be connected NOTE
by pressing and releasing the SPEECH but-
of corresponding devices in order, start-
ton and then saying “Select phone” while the l You can press and release the SPEECH but-
ing with the Bluetooth® device that has list is being read. ton while the list is being read, and immedi-
been connected most recently. l You can change the music player to be con- ately say the number of the device tag you
6. After the device tags of all paired Blue- nected by pressing and releasing the want to change.
tooth® devices have been read, the sys- SPEECH button and then saying “Select mu-
tem will say “End of list, would you like sic player” while the list is being read. 6. The voice guide will say “New name,
to start from the beginning?” please.” Say the name you want to regis-
To hear the list again from the begin- Changing a device tag ter as a new device tag.
ning , answer “Yes.” When you are E00760900018 When the confirmation function is on,
done, answer “No” to return to the main You can change the device tag of a paired the voice guide will say “<New device
menu. cellular phone or music player. tag>. Is this correct?” Answer “Yes.”
Follow the steps below to change a device Answer “No,” to say the new device tag
tag. you want to register again.
1. Press the SPEECH button. 7. The device tag is changed.
2. Say “Setup”. When the change is complete, the voice
3. Say “Pairing options.” guide will say “New name saved” and
4. The voice guide will say “Select one of then the system will return to the main
the following: pair, edit, delete, or list.” menu.
Say “Edit.”

7-58 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

Operating a music player con- “SEND function” on page 7-61 4. The voice guide will say “Dialing <num-
“Receiving calls” on page 7-61 ber recognised>.”
nected via Bluetooth® “MUTE function” on page 7-61 The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface will then
E00761001172
“Switching between hands-free mode and make the call.
For the operation of a music player connected
private mode” on page 7-61 When the confirmation function is on,
via Bluetooth®, refer to the following sec-
the system will confirm again the tele-
tions.
NOTE phone number. To continue with that
number, answer “Yes.”
For vehicles equipped with the l The hands-free calls might not be operated To change the telephone number, answer
LW/MW/FM radio/CD player correctly when it makes calling or receiving
by operating the cellular phone directly.
“No.” The system will say “Number
Refer to “Listen to Bluetooth Audio*” on please” then say the telephone number
page 7-36. again. 7
To make a call
For vehicles equipped with the
NOTE
E00761200047

MITSUBISHI Multi-Communi- You can make a call in the following 3 ways


cation System (MMCS) using the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface: l In the case of English, the system will recog-
Making a call by saying a telephone number, nise both “zero” and “oh” (Letter “o”) for
Refer to the separate owner’s manual. the number “0.”
making a call using the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter-
l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface supports num-
For vehicles equipped with the face’s phone book, and making a call by re- bers (0 to 9) and characters (+, # and *).
DISPLAY AUDIO dialing.
l The maximum supported telephone number
length is as follows:
Refer to the separate owner’s manual. Making a call by using the telephone num- • International telephone number: + and tel-
ber ephone numbers (to 18 digits).
How to make or receive hands- • Except for international telephone num-
You can make a call by saying the telephone
free calls number.
ber: telephone numbers (to 19 digits).
E00761100059
1. Press the SPEECH button.
You can make or receive hands-free calls us- Making a call using a phone book
2. Say “Dial.”
ing a Bluetooth® compatible cellular phone 3. After the voice guide says “Number You can make calls using the vehicle phone
connected to the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. please,” say the telephone number. book or mobile phone book of the Blue-
You can also use the phone books in the tooth® 2.0 interface.
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface to make calls with- For details on the phone books, refer to
out dialling telephone numbers. “Phone book function” on page 7-61.
“To make a call” on page 7-59
OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-59
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*
1. Press the SPEECH button. NOTE NOTE
2. Say “Call.”
l If you say “No” to all names read by the sys- l If the name you selected has matching data
tem, the voice guide will say “Name not in the mobile phone book but no telephone
NOTE found, returning to main menu” and the sys- number is registered under the selected loca-
tem will return to the main menu. tion, the voice guide will say “{home/work/
l If you say “Call” when the vehicle phone
mobile/other} not found for <name>. Would
book and the mobile phone book are empty,
you like to try again?”
the voice guide will say “The vehicle phone 5. If only one telephone number is regis- Answer “Yes,” and the system will return to
book is empty. Would you like to add a new tered under the name you just said, the Step 3.
entry now?” voice guide proceeds to Step 6. Answer “No,” and the call will be cancelled.
Answer “Yes,” and the voice guide will say
“Entering the phone book - new entry
If two or more telephone numbers are Start over again from Step 1.
7 menu.” You can now create data in the vehi- registered that match the name you just
said, the voice guide will say “Would
cle phone book. 6. The voice guide will say “Calling
Answer “No,” to return to the main menu. you like to call <name> at [home], <name> <location>” and then the sys-
[work], [mobile], or [other]?” Select the tem will dial the telephone number.
3. After the voice guide says “Name location to call.
please,” say the name you want to call, NOTE
from those registered in the phone book. NOTE
4. If there is only one match, the system l When the confirmation function is on, the
proceeds to Step 5.
l If the name you selected has matching data system will ask if the name and location of
in the vehicle phone book but no telephone the receiver are correct.
If there are two or more matches, the number is registered under the selected loca- If the name is correct, answer “Yes.”
voice guide will say “More than one tion, the voice guide will say “{home/work/ If you want to change the name or location
match was found, would you like to call mobile/other} not found for <name>. Would to call, answer “No.” The system will return
<returned name>.” If that person is the you like to add location or try again?” to Step 3.
one you want to call, answer “Yes.” Say “Try again,” and the system will return
to Step 3.
Answer “No,” and the name of the next Redialing
Say “Add location” and you can register an
matching person will be uttered by the additional telephone number under the selec- You can redial the last number called, based
voice guide. ted location. on the history of dialed calls in the paired cel-
lular phone.
Use the following procedure to redial.
1. Press the SPEECH button.
2. Say “Redial.”

7-60 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

SEND function MUTE function These phone books are used to register tele-
E00761300035 E00760300054 phone numbers and to make calls to desired
During a call, press the SPEECH button to At any time during a call, you can mute the numbers via the voice recognition function.
enter voice recognition mode, then say vehicle microphone.
“<numbers> SEND” to generate DTMF Pressing the SPEECH button and then saying NOTE
tones. “Mute” during a call will turn ON the MUTE
For example, if during a call you need to sim- function and mute the microphone. l Disconnecting the battery cable will not de-
lete information registered in the phone
ulate the press of a phone button as a re- Saying “Mute off” in the same way will turn
book.
sponse to an automated system, press the off the MUTE function and cancel the mute
SPEECH button and speak “1 2 3 4 pound on the microphone.
SEND” and the 1234# will be sent on your Vehicle phone book
cellular phone. Switching between hands-free E00763801318 7
mode and private mode This phone book is used when making calls
Receiving calls E00761400036
with the voice recognition function.
E00761600025 The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface can switch be- Up to 32 names can be registered in the vehi-
If an incoming phone call is received while tween Hands-free mode (Hands-free calls) cle phone book per language.
the ignition switch or the operation mode is and private mode (calls using cellular phone). Also, each entry has 4 locations associated
in ON or ACC, the audio system will be au- If you press the SPEECH button and say with: home, work, mobile and other. You can
tomatically turned on and switched to the in- “Transfer call” during a Hands-free call, you register one telephone number for each loca-
coming call, even when the audio system was can stop the Hands-free mode and talk in pri- tion.
originally off. vate mode.
The voice guide announcement for the in- To return to Hands-free mode, press the You can register a desired name as a name
coming call will be output from the front pas- SPEECH button again and say “Transfer for any phone book entry registered in the ve-
senger’s seat speaker. call”. hicle phone book.
If the CD player or radio was playing when Names and telephone numbers can be
the incoming call was received, the audio Phone book function changed later on.
system will mute the sound from the CD E00763700020

player or radio and output only the incoming The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface has 2 types of The vehicle phone book can be used with all
call. unique phone books that are different from paired cellular phones.
To receive the call, press the PICK-UP but- the phone book stored in the cellular phone.
ton on the steering wheel control switch. They are the vehicle phone book and the mo-
When the call is over, the audio system will bile phone book.
return to its previous state.
OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-61
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

To register a telephone number in the ve- which you want to register a telephone To add another telephone number for a
hicle phone book number. new location for the current entry, an-
swer “Yes.” The system will return to
E00769700048
You can register a telephone number in the NOTE location selection in Step 5.
vehicle phone book in the following 2 ways: Answer “No” to end the registration
Reading out a telephone number, and select- l When the confirmation function is on, the process and return to the main menu.
voice guide will say “<Location>. Is this
ing and transferring 1 phone book entry from correct?” Answer “Yes.”
the phone book of the cellular phone. If a telephone number has been registered NOTE
for the selected location, the voice guide will
say “The current number is <telephone num- l When the confirmation function is on, after
To register by reading out a telephone repeating the telephone number you have
ber>, number please.”
number read, the voice guide will ask “Is this cor-
7 E00769800049
If you do not want to change the telephone
rect?” Answer “Yes.”
number, say “cancel” or the original number
1. Press the SPEECH button. Answer “No” to return to telephone number
to keep it registered.
2. Say “Phone book.” registration in step 6.
3. The voice guide will say “Select one of
6. The voice guide will say “Number
the following: new entry, edit number, To select and transfer one phone book en-
please.” Say the telephone number to
edit name, list names, delete, erase all, or try from the phone book of the cellular
register it.
import contact.” Say “New entry.” phone
4. The voice guide will say “Name please.”
Say your preferred name to register it. NOTE E00769900040
You can select 1 phone book entry from the
l In the case of English, the system will recog- phone book of the cellular phone and register
NOTE nise both “zero” and “oh” (Letter “o”) for it in the vehicle phone book.
the number “0.”
l If the maximum number of entries are al-
ready registered, the voice guide will say NOTE
“The phone book is full. Would you like to 7. The voice guide will repeat the tele-
delete a name?” Say “Yes” if you want to phone number you have just read, and l Transfer is not permitted unless the vehicle
is parked. Before transferring, make sure
delete a registered name. then register the number.
Say “No,” to return to the main menu. that the vehicle is parked in a safe location.
When the telephone number has been
registered, the voice guide will say
5. When the name has been registered, the “Number saved. Would you like to add
voice guide will say “home, work, mo- another number for this entry?”
bile, or other?” Say the location for
7-62 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

NOTE NOTE NOTE


l All or part of data may not be transferred, l If the maximum number of entries are al- l Pressing the HANG-UP button or pressing
even when the cellular phone supports Blue- ready registered, the voice guide will say and holding the SPEECH button will cancel
tooth®, depending on the compatibility of “The phone book is full. Would you like to the registration.
the device. delete a name?” Say “Yes” if you want to
l The maximum supported telephone number delete a registered name.
Say “No,” to return to the main menu. 7. When the reception is complete, the
length is 19 digits. Any telephone number of
20 digits or more will be truncated to the voice guide will say “<Number of tele-
first 19 digits. phone numbers that had been registered
5. After the voice guide says “Ready to re- in the import source> numbers have
l If telephone numbers contain characters oth-
ceive a contact from the phone. Only a
er than 0 to 9, *, # or +, these characters are been imported. What name would you
home, a work, and a mobile number can
l
deleted before the transfer.
For the connection settings on the cellular be imported,” the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter-
like to use for these numbers?” 7
Say the name you want to register for
phone side, refer to the instructions for the face will receive the phone book data this phone book entry.
cellular phone. from the Bluetooth® compatible cellular
phone.
1. Press the SPEECH button. 6. Operate the Bluetooth® compatible cel-
NOTE
2. Say “Phone book.” lular phone to set it up so that the phone l If the entered name is already used for other
3. The voice guide will say “Select one of book entry you want to register in the phone book entry or similar to a name used
the following: new entry, edit number, for other phone book entry, that name cannot
vehicle phone book can be transferred to be registered.
edit name, list names, delete, erase all, or the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
import contact.” Say “Import contact.”
4. The voice guide will say “Would you 8. The voice guide will say “Adding
like to import a single entry or all con- NOTE <name>.”
tacts?” Say “Single entry.” l If the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface cannot recog- When the confirmation function is on,
The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface will be- nise the Bluetooth® compatible cellular the system will ask if the name is cor-
come ready to receive transferred phone phone or the connection takes too much rect. Answer “Yes.”
book data. time, the voice guide will say “Import con- Answer “No,” and the voice guide will
tact has timed out” and then the system will say “Name please.” Register a different
cancel the registration. In such case, start name.
over again from Step 1. 9. The voice guide will say “Numbers
saved.”

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-63


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*
10. The voice guide will say “Would you or say list names.” Say the name of the 7. The voice guide will repeat the tele-
like to import another contact?” phone book entry you want to edit. phone number.
Answer “Yes” if you want to continue When the confirmation function is on,
with the registration. You can continue NOTE the system will ask if the number is cor-
to register a new phone book entry from rect. Answer “Yes.”
Step 5. l Say “List names,” and the names registered Answer “No” to return to Step 3.
in the phone book will be read out in order.
Answer “No,” to return to the main 8. Once the telephone number is registered,
Refer to “Vehicle phone book: Listening to
menu. the list of registered names” on page 7-65.
the voice guide will say “Number saved”
and then the system will return to the
To change the content registered in the ve- main menu.
5. The voice guide will say “Home, work,
hicle phone book
7 E00739800079
mobile or other?” Select and say the lo-
cation where the telephone number you NOTE
You can change or delete a name or tele- want to change or add is registered.
phone number registered in the vehicle phone
l If the location where a telephone number
When the confirmation function is on, was already registered has been overwritten
book. the system will check the target name with a new number, the voice guide will say
You can also listen to the list of names regis- and location again. Answer “Yes” if you “Number changed” and then the system will
tered in the vehicle phone book. return to the main menu.
want to continue with the editing.
Answer “No” to return to Step 3.
NOTE 6. The voice guide will say “Number Editing a name
please.” Say the telephone number you
l The system must have at least one entry. want to register.
E00770100042
1. Press the SPEECH button.
2. Say “Phone book.”
Editing a telephone number NOTE 3. The voice guide will say “Select one of
E00770000041 the following: new entry, edit number,
1. Press the SPEECH button. l If the telephone number is already registered
edit name, list names, delete, erase all, or
in the selected location, the voice guide will
2. Say “Phone book.” say “The current number is <current num- import contact.” Say “Edit name.”
3. The voice guide will say “Select one of ber>. New number, please.” Say a new tele- 4. The voice guide will say “Please say the
the following: new entry, edit number, phone number to change the current number. name of the entry you would like to edit,
edit name, list names, delete, erase all, or or say list names.” Say the name you
import contact.” Say “Edit number.” want to edit.
4. The voice guide will say “Please say the
name of the entry you would like to edit,
7-64 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

NOTE 5. When the voice guide is done reading lete, or say list names.” Say the name of
the list, it will say “End of list, would the phone book entry in which the tele-
l Say “List names,” and the names registered you like to start from the beginning?” phone number you want to delete is reg-
in the phone book will be read out in order.
When you want to check the list again istered.
Refer to “Vehicle phone book: Listening to
the list of registered names” on page 7-65. from the beginning, answer “Yes.”
When you are done, answer “No” to re- NOTE
turn to the previous or main menu.
5. The voice guide will say “Changing l Say “List names,” and the names registered
<name>.” in the phone book will be read out in order.
When the confirmation function is on, NOTE Refer to “Vehicle phone book: Listening to
the system will ask if the name is cor- the list of registered names” on page 7-65.
l You can call, edit or delete a name that is
rect. Answer “Yes” if you want to con-
tinue with the editing based on this in-
being read out.
Press the SPEECH button and say “Call” to 5. If only one telephone number is regis-
7
formation. call the name, “Edit name” to edit it, or “De- tered in the selected phone book entry,
Answer “No” to return to Step 4. lete” to delete it.
the voice guide will say “Deleting
The system will beep and then execute your
6. The voice guide will say “Name please.” command. <name> <location>.”
Say the new name you want to register. If multiple telephone numbers are regis-
l If you press the SPEECH button and say
7. The registered name will be changed. “Continue” or “Previous” while the list is tered in the selected phone book entry,
When the change is complete, the sys- being read, the system will advance or re- the voice guide will say “Would you like
tem will return to the main menu. wind the list. Say “Continue” to proceed to to delete [home], [work], [mobile], [oth-
the next entry or “Previous” to return to the er], or all?”
previous entry. Select the location to delete, and the
Listening to the list of registered names
voice guide will say “Deleting <name>
E00739900067
1. Press the SPEECH button. Deleting a telephone number <location>.”
2. Say “Phone book.” E00740000068

3. The voice guide will say “Select one of 1. Press the SPEECH button. NOTE
the following: new entry, edit number, 2. Say “Phone book.”
edit name, list names, delete, erase all, or 3. The voice guide will say “Select one of l To delete the telephone numbers from all lo-
cations, say “All.”
import contact.” Say “List names.” the following: new entry, edit number,
4. Bluetooth® 2.0 interface will read out edit name, list names, delete, erase all, or
the entries in the phone book in order. import contact.” Say “Delete.”
4. The voice guide will say “Please say the
name of the entry you would like to de-
OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-65
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*
6. The system will ask if you really want to 4. For confirmation purposes, the voice The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface automatically
delete the selected telephone number(s) guide will ask “Are you sure you want to converts from text to voice the names regis-
to go ahead with the deletion, answer erase everything from your hands-free tered in the transferred phone book entries,
“Yes.” system phone book?” Answer “Yes.” and creates names.
Answer “No,” the system will cancel de- Answer “No” to cancel the deletion of
leting the telephone number(s) and then all registered information in the phone
return to Step 4. book and return to the main menu.
NOTE
7. When the deletion of the telephone num- 5. The voice guide will say “You are about l Only the mobile phone book transferred
ber is completed, the voice guide will to delete everything from your hands- from the connected cellular phone can be
used with that cellular phone.
say “<name> <location> deleted” and free system phone book. Do you want to
then the system will return to the main continue?” Answer “Yes” to continue. l You cannot change the names and telephone
numbers in the phone book entries registered
7 menu. Answer “No” to cancel the deletion of in the mobile phone book. You cannot select
If all locations are deleted, the system all registered information in the phone and delete specific phone book entries, ei-
will say “<name> and all locations de- book and return to the main menu. ther.
leted” and the name will be removed 6. The voice guide will say “Please wait, To change or delete any of the above,
from the phone book. If numbers still re- erasing the handsfree system phone change the applicable information in the
main under the entry, the name will re- book” and then the system will delete all source phone book of the cellular phone and
then transfer the phone book again.
tain the other associated numbers. data in the phone book.
When the deletion is complete, the voice
guide will say “Hands-free system phone To import a devices phone book
Erasing the phone book
book erased” and then the system will Follow the steps below to transfer to the mo-
E00740100069
return to the main menu. bile phone book the phone book stored in the
You can delete all registered information
cellular phone.
from the vehicle phone book.
1. Press the SPEECH button. Mobile phone book
2. Say “Phone book.” E00763900077 NOTE
3. The voice guide will say “Select one of All entries in the phone book stored in the
cellular phone can be transferred in a batch l Transfer should be completed while the ve-
the following: new entry, edit number, hicle is parked.
edit name, list names, delete, erase all, or and registered in the mobile phone book. Before transferring, make sure that the vehi-
import contact.” Say “Erase all.” Up to 7 mobile phone books, each containing cle is parked in a safe location.
up to 1,000 names, can be registered.

7-66 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*

NOTE swer “Yes,” transferring to the mobile


phone book the phone book stored in the
l The already stored phone book in the mobile cellular phone will start.
phone book is overwritten by the stored
Answer “No,” to return to the main
phone book in the cellular phone.
menu.
l All or part of data may not be transferred,
even when the cellular phone supports Blue-
tooth®, depending on the compatibility of NOTE
the device.
l Only a home, a work, and a mobile number l The transfer may take some time to com-
can be imported. plete depending on the number of contacts.
l The maximum supported telephone number l If the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface could not be
connected to the Bluetooth® compatible cel-
length is 19 digits. Any telephone number of
20 digits or more will be truncated to the lular phone, the voice guide will say “Un-
7
first 19 digits. able to transfer contact list from phone” and
l If telephone numbers contain characters oth- then the system will return to the main
er than 0 to 9, *, # or +, these characters are menu.
deleted before the transfer. l If you press the HANG-UP button or press
l For the connection settings on the cellular and hold the SPEECH button during the data
phone side, refer to the instructions for the transfer, the transfer will be cancelled and
cellular phone. the system will return to the main menu.
l If an error occurs during the data transfer, all
transfer will be cancelled and the voice
1. Press the SPEECH button. guide will say “Unable to complete the
2. Say “Phone book.” phone book import” and then the system will
3. The voice guide will say “Select one of return to the main menu.
the following: new entry, edit number, l If there are no contacts in the phone book,
edit name, list names, delete, erase all, or the voice guide will say “There are no con-
import contact.” Say “Import contact.” tacts on the connected phone.”
4. The voice guide will say “Would you
like to import a single entry or all con- 6. When the transfer is complete, the voice
tacts?” Say “All contacts.” guide will say “Import complete” and
5. The voice guide will say “Importing the then the system will return to the main
contact list from the mobile phone book. menu.
This may take several minutes to com-
plete. Would you like to continue?” An-
OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-67
USB input terminal*

Enrollment commands
E00732400193

Phrase English French Spanish Italian German Dutch Portuguese Russian


1 123456789 123456789 123456789 123456789 123456789 123456789 123456789 123456789
2 888 555 1212 888 555 1212 888 555 1212 888 555 1212 888 555 1212 888 555 1212 888 555 1212 888 555 1212
3 Call Appeler Llamar Chiama Anrufen Bellen Ligar Вызов
4 Dial Composer Marcar Componi Wählen Nummer keuze Marcar Набор
5 Setup Configurer Configuración Configura Einrichtung Setup Configurar Настройка
7 6 Cancel Annuler Cancelar Annulla Abbrechen Annuleren Cancelar Отмена
7 Continue Continuer Continuar Continua Weiter Doorgaan Continuar Продолжить
8 Help Aide Ayuda Aiuto Hilfe Help Ajuda Справка

USB input terminal* *: “iPod” is a registered trademark of Apple 2. Open the USB input terminal cover (A)
Inc. in the United States and other countries. in the floor console box.
E00761901432

You can connect your USB memory device How to connect a USB memory
or iPod* to play music files stored in the device
USB memory device or iPod. E00762000390
This section explains how to connect and re- 1. Park your vehicle in a safe place and
move a USB memory device or iPod. turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK”
See the following section for details on how position or put the operation mode in
to play music files. OFF.
Refer to “Listen to an iPod” on page 7-29.
Refer to “Listen to Audio Files on a USB De-
vice” on page 7-31.
Refer to “To play iPod/USB memory device
tracks via voice operation” on page 7-34.

7-68 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


USB input terminal*
3. Connect a commercially available USB CAUTION 2. Open the USB input terminal cover (A)
connector cable (C) to the USB memory in the floor console box.
device (B). l Keep the lid of the floor console box closed
while driving the vehicle. A lid or the con-
tents of the glove box could otherwise cause
injuries.

NOTE
l Do not connect the USB memory device to
the USB input terminal directly.
The USB memory device may be damaged.
l When closing the floor console box, be care- 7
ful not to trap the USB connector cable.

5. To remove the USB connector cable, 3. Connect the Dock connector (C) to the
4. Connect the USB connector cable (C) to turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” iPod (B).
the USB input terminal (D). position or put the operation mode in
OFF first and perform the installation
steps in reverse.

How to connect an iPod


E00762100043
1. Park your vehicle in a safe place and
turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK”
position or put the operation mode in
OFF.

NOTE
l Use a genuine Dock connector from Apple
Inc.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-69


USB input terminal*
4. Connect the Dock connector (C) to the Types of connectable devices For vehicles equipped with the
USB input terminal (D). and supported file specifica- Bluetooth® 2.0 interface
tions E00770400029

E00762201038 For details about the types of connectable de-


Except for vehicles equipped vices and supported file specifications, refer
to the following sections.
with the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter-
face Device types
E00770300028 E00770500020

For details about the types of connectable de- Devices of the following types can be con-
nected.
7 vices and supported file specifications, refer
to the following pages and manuals. Model name Condition
For vehicles equipped with the Storage capacity of
CAUTION USB memory device
256 Mbytes or more
LW/MW/FM radio/CD player
l Keep the lid of the floor console box closed Refer to “Listen to an iPod” on page 7-29, Models other than Digital audio player
while driving the vehicle. A lid or the con-
tents of the floor console box could other- “Listen to Audio Files on a USB Device” on USB memory devi- supporting mass stor-
wise cause injuries. page 7-31 and “Audio Files (MP3/WMA/ ces and iPods age class
AAC)” on page 7-16.
For connectable device types for “iPod*,”
NOTE For vehicles equipped with the DISPLAY “iPod classic*,” “iPod nano*,” “iPod touch*”
AUDIO and “iPhone*,” access the MITSUBISHI
l When closing the floor console box, be care- MOTORS website.
ful not to trap the connector cable. Refer to the separate owner’s manual. Please read and agree to the “Warning about
Links to the Web Sites of Other Companies”.
5. To remove the Dock connector, turn the For vehicles equipped with the
The websites mentioned above may connect
ignition switch to the “LOCK” position MITSUBISHI Multi-Communication Sys-
you to websites other than the MITSUBISHI
or put the operation mode in OFF first tem (MMCS)
MOTORS website.
and perform the installation steps in re- Refer to the separate owner’s manual. http://www.mitsubishi-motors.com/en/prod-
verse. ucts/index.html

7-70 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Sun visors
*: “iPod,” “iPod classic,” “iPod nano,” “iPod File specifications Sun visors
touch” and “iPhone” are registered trade-
E00770600021 E00711201283
marks of Apple Inc. in the United States and You can play music files of the following
other countries. specifications that are saved in a USB memo-
ry device or other device supporting mass
NOTE storage class. When you connect your iPod,
playable file specifications depend on the
l Depending on the type of the USB memory connected iPod.
device or other device connected, the con-
nected device may not function properly or
the available functions may be limited. Item Condition
l It is recommended to use an iPod with firm- MP3, WMA, AAC,
ware updated to the latest version. File format
WAV
7
l You can charge your iPod by connecting it
1- To eliminate front glare
to the USB input terminal when the ignition Maximum number of
switch or the operation mode is in ON or levels (including the Level 8 2- To eliminate side glare
ACC. root)
l Do not keep your USB memory device or Vanity mirror
iPod in your vehicle. Number of folders 700
l It is recommended that you back up files in
Number of files 65,535
case of data damage. Type 1
l Do not connect to the USB input terminal
any device (hard disk, card reader, memory A vanity mirror is fitted to the back of the
reader, etc.) other than the connectable devi- sun visor.
ces specified in the previous section.
The device and/or data may be damaged. If
any of these devices was connected by mis-
take, remove it after turning the ignition
switch to the “LOCK” position or putting
the operation mode in OFF.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-71


Ashtray*
Operating the lid of the vanity mirror will au- Type 2 Type 2

tomatically turn on the mirror lamp (A).


A vanity mirror is fitted to the back of the
sun visor.

7 Ashtray*
E00711401009

CAUTION CAUTION
l If the lid of vanity mirror with lamp is kept Card holder l Put out matches and cigarettes before they
open for prolonged periods of time, the vehi- are placed in the ashtray.
cle’s battery will be discharged. Cards can be slipped into the holder (B) on l Don’t put papers and other things that burn
the sun visor. into your ashtrays. If you do, cigarettes or
other smoking materials could set them on
fire, causing damage.
Type 1
l Always close the ashtray. If left open, other
cigarette butts in the ashtray may be rekin-
dled.

7-72 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Cigarette lighter*
To use the ashtray, open the lid. CAUTION NOTE
l The moveable ashtray secure holder should l Do not leave the cigarette lighter removed
never be used as a cup holder. from its socket, because the socket might be-
Drinks could be spilled over the cigarette come clogged by foreign material and be
lighter by the vibration and jolts while driv- short-circuited.
ing, causing an electric shock.

CAUTION
Cigarette lighter* l Do not touch the heating element or the cig-
E00711501417 arette lighter housing, hold the knob only to
The cigarette lighter can be used while the ig- prevent burns.
nition switch or the operation mode is in ON l Do not allow children to operate or play with 7
the cigarette lighter as burns may occur.
Moveable ashtray secure hold- or ACC.
l Something is wrong with the cigarette light-
er er if it does not pop back out within approxi-
mately 30 seconds of being pushed in.
The moveable ashtray can be fitted at the in- Pull it out and have the problem corrected at
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
dicated position. ice Point.
l Do not use any electric appliance that is not
approved by MITSUBISHI MOTORS. Do-
ing so could damage the socket. If you used
the cigarette lighter after damaging the sock-
et, the cigarette lighter might pop out or fail
to come out after being pushed in.
l When the cigarette lighter socket is used as a
1- Push all the way in. power source for an electric appliance, be
sure that the electric appliance operates at
The cigarette lighter will automatically return 12 V and has an electric capacity of 120 W
to its original position with a “click” when or less. In addition, long use of the electric
appliance without running the engine may
ready. Pull it out for use. run down the battery.
After use, insert the cigarette lighter to its
original position in the socket.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-73


Accessory socket

Accessory socket The accessory socket can be used while the Interior lamps
ignition switch or the operation mode is in
E00711601346 E00712001174
ON or ACC.
CAUTION
Floor console*
l Be sure to use a “plug-in” type accessory op-
erating at 12 V and at 120 W or less.
When using more than one socket at the
same time, make sure that the electrical ac-
cessories are 12 V accessories and that the
total power consumption does not exceed
120 W.
7 l Long use of the electric appliance without
running the engine may run down the bat-
tery. 1- Luggage room lamp
l When the accessory socket is not in use, be 2- Room lamp (rear)*
sure to close the lid or install the cap, be- Floor console box 3- Map & room lamps (front)
cause the socket might become clogged by
Sunshade illumination dimming control
foreign material and be short-circuited.
switch*

To use a plug-in type accessory, open the lid


or remove the cap, and insert the plug in the NOTE
accessory socket. l If you leave the lamps on without running
the engine, you will run down the battery.
Before you leave the vehicle, make sure that
NOTE the lamps are turned off.
l Accessory sockets in 2 locations can be used
at the same time.

7-74 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Interior lamps

Map & room lamps (front) • If the vehicle is equipped with the Map lamps
E00717300638
keyless operation system, when the E00765200029
keyless operation function is used to Regardless of the position of the room lamp
Room lamp lock the vehicle. switch, when the lens is pressed, the lamp on
the side that was pressed will illuminate.
NOTE Press the lens again to turn off the lamp.

l When the key was used to start the engine, if


the key is removed while the doors and tail-
gate are closed, the lamp is illuminated and
after about 15 seconds it goes off.
l When the keyless operation function was
used to start the engine, if the operation 7
mode is put in OFF while the doors and tail-
gate are closed, the lamp illuminates and af-
ter about 15 seconds it goes off.
1- (DOOR) l The time until the lamp goes off can be ad-
justed. For details, please consult a
The lamp illuminates when a door or the MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
tailgate is opened. It goes off about 15 ice Point.
seconds after the door or tailgate is Room lamp (rear)*
closed. 2-
E00712300460

However, the lamp goes off immediately The lamp stays off regardless of whether
in the following cases: the doors and tailgate are open or closed.
• When the ignition switch is turned
to the “ON” position or the opera-
tion mode is put in ON.
• When the central door lock function
is used to lock the vehicle.
• When the remote control switch of
the keyless entry system or the key-
less operation system is used to lock
the vehicle.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-75


Interior lamps
1- ( ) NOTE Sunshade illumination dim-
The lamp illuminates regardless of ming control switch*
whether the doors and tailgate are open l When the keyless operation function was
used to start the engine, if the operation E00765000030
or closed.
mode is put in OFF while the doors and tail-
2- (•) gate are closed, the lamp illuminates and af-
The lamp illuminates when a door or the ter about 15 seconds it goes off.
tailgate is opened. It goes off about 15 l The time until the lamp goes off can be ad-
seconds after the door or tailgate is justed. For details, please consult a
closed. MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
However, the lamp goes off immediately ice Point.
in the following cases:
7 • When the ignition switch is turned 3- ( )
to the “ON” position or the opera- The lamp goes off regardless of whether
tion mode is put in ON. the doors and tailgate are open or closed.
• When the central door lock function
is used to lock the vehicle. Luggage room lamp The brightness of the sunshade illumination
• When the remote control switch of E00712700624
can be adjusted to 3 different levels when the
the keyless entry system or the key- ignition switch or the operation mode is in
less operation system is used to lock ON or ACC.
the vehicle. Each time you press the switch, the bright-
• If the vehicle is equipped with the ness switches in sequence from high → mid-
keyless operation system, when the dle → low → off → high.
keyless operation function is used to
lock the vehicle.
NOTE
NOTE l The brightness can be adjusted even when
the ignition switch is in the “LOCK” posi-
l When the key was used to start the engine, if tion or the operation mode is in OFF, provi-
the key is removed while the doors and tail- ded that the sunshade illumination is turned
gate are closed, the lamp is illuminated and on.
after about 15 seconds it goes off.
The lamp illuminates when the tailgate is
opened, and goes out when the tailgate is
closed.

7-76 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Interior lamps

Sunshade illumination* l For vehicles equipped with the keyless NOTE


E00765100060
operation system, the operation mode is
put in OFF while the engine is running l The sunshade illumination does not turn on
if the sunshade illumination dimming con-
and the doors and the tailgate are closed.
trol switch is off.
l The time until the sunshade illumination
NOTE goes off can be adjusted. If it is adjusted, the
time until the room & map lamps go off is
l The time until the sunshade illumination also adjusted automatically at the same time.
goes off can be adjusted. If it is adjusted, the For details, consult a MITSUBISHI
time until the room & map lamps go off is MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
also adjusted automatically at the same time.
For details, consult a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service Point. Interior lamp*1 auto-cutout 7
function
The sunshade illumination also turns on
The sunshade illumination turns on when the E00712901359
when a door or the tailgate is opened, and *1Interior lamps, including the room and
ignition switch or the operation mode is in
goes off 15 seconds after the door or the tail- map lamps
ON or ACC.
gate is closed, even when the engine switch is l If any of the interior lamps are left
in the “LOCK” position or the operation switched on with the ignition switch is in
NOTE mode is in OFF. the “LOCK” position or the operation
However, the sunshade illumination immedi- mode is in OFF, it goes off automatical-
l The sunshade illumination does not turn on
if the sunshade illumination dimming con- ately goes off in the following cases: ly after approximately 30 minutes.
trol switch is off. l When the central door lock function is l The lamps will illuminate again after
Refer to “Sunshade illumination dimming used to lock the vehicle. they automatically go off if the ignition
control switch” on page 7-76. l When the remote control switch of the switch or the engine switch is operated,
keyless entry system or the keyless oper- or if the keyless entry system or keyless
When the sunshade illumination is turned on, ation system is used to lock the vehicle. operation system is operated.
it will go off about 15 seconds after the fol- l If the vehicle is equipped with the key-
lowing operation is performed. less operation system, when the keyless
l When the key was used to start the en- operation function is used to lock the ve-
gine, the key is removed while the doors hicle.
and tailgate are closed.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-77


Storage spaces

NOTE NOTE
l The interior lamp auto cut-out function can l When the lamps are illuminated with the
be deactivated. The time until the lamps au- lamp switch in the “ ”, “ ”, or “AU-
tomatically go off can be adjusted. For de- TO” position (vehicles with automatic lamp
tails and support, consult your nearest control), the glove box lamp illuminates.
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point.
To use the warming and cooling
function*
Storage spaces The glove box can be used to keep its con-
E00713101664
1- Luggage floor boxes tents (e.g. drink bottles) warm or cool with
7 CAUTION
2- Floor console box
3- Glove box
the warm or cold air from the air condition-
ing.
l Never leave lighters, cans of carbonated 1. Turn the dial in the glove box to the
drink, and spectacles in the cabin when park- Glove box “ ” position.
ing the vehicle in hot sunshine. The cabin E00726200200 Turn the dial to the “ ” position when
will become extremely hot, so lighters and To open, pull the lever (A). not using the warming and cooling func-
other flammable items may catch fire and
unopened drink cans (including soft drink or tion.
beer cans) may rupture. Also, spectacles
with plastic lenses or materials could deform
or crack.
l Keep the lids of storage spaces closed while
driving the vehicle. A lid or the contents of a
storage space could otherwise cause injuries.

NOTE
l When leaving your vehicle, do not leave val-
uables in the storage spaces.

2. Turn the air conditioning temperature


control dial (A) to the desired tempera-
ture.
7-78 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5
Storage spaces
3. Turn the air conditioning blower speed NOTE NOTE
selection dial (B) to the desired air flow.
l The glove box has the same temperature as l There is a limit to the size of pens that can
the air that comes out of the air conditioning be stored in the holder. Forcibly inserting
Manual air conditioning
ventilators, so it is not possible to greatly large pens could damage the holder.
heat or cool the contents.
For efficient warming or cooling, select the Card holder
“ ” mode.
Refer to “Mode selection dial” on page 7-03. There is a card holder inside the glove box.
l When placing drinks in the glove box, read
the precautions on the container first. LHD
l Do not place in the glove box chocolate,
sweets, or other items which are susceptible
to temperature changes or which may rot.
7

Automatic air conditioning Pen holder


There is a pen holder inside the glove box.

RHD

For detailed information on how to use


the air conditioning, refer to “Heater/Air
conditioning” on page 7-03.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-79


Storage spaces

Floor console box The floor console box can also be used as an Upper box
armrest.
E00723300978
To open the upper box, lift the right release
lever (A) and raise the lid.
Type 1 1 2

To open the console box, lift the release lever


(A) and raise the lid.

7
1- Upper box
2- Lower box
Lower box
NOTE To open the lower box, lift the left release
l The Auxiliary Audio connector (RCA) is lo- lever (B) and raise the lid.
Type 2 cated in the floor console box (if so equip-
ped). For details, refer to “Use AUX*” on
Upper and lower boxes are located inside the
page 7-38.
floor console box.

7-80 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Cup holder
Tissue holder Cup holder Refer to “Armrest” on page 4-06.
The tissue holder (C) is located on the under- E00714500945

side of the floor console box lid.


CAUTION
Type 1 Type 2 l Do not drink beverages while driving. This
is distracting and could cause an accident.

For the front seat


The cup holders are located in front of the
floor console box.
7

Bottle holder
Luggage floor box* E00718200328

E00718701809 CAUTION
The box for storing articles is located inside
the luggage compartment. l Do not drink beverages while driving. This
is distracting and could cause an accident.
To use the box, raise the luggage floor board.
l Drinks could be spilled by the vibration and
jolts while driving. If the spilt drink is very
hot, you could be burnt.

For the rear seat*


E00716901575
In order to use the cup holder, allow the arm-
rest (A) to drop down.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-81


Rear shelf panel*
There are bottle holders located on the front To install 2. Hang the strap (C) of the rear shelf panel
doors. on the hook (D).
1. Insert the concave portion (A) on the un-
derside of the rear shelf panel into the
inside protruding portion (B) of the tail-
gate.

NOTE To remove
l Tightly close the cap on drink bottles before Follow this procedure in reverse to remove.
storing them.
l Some bottles may be too big or the wrong
shape to fit in the holder. CAUTION
l Lightly push the rear shelf panel to make
sure that the concave portion (A) is set firm-
Rear shelf panel* ly in the protruding portion (B) of the tail-
E00715400114 gate. If the rear shelf panel is not securely
locked in place, it could unhook while driv-
CAUTION ing and cause injuries.
l Do not place luggage or other items on the
rear shelf panel. Any items on the rear shelf
panel would obstruct your rearward view,
and they could fly forward and cause inju-
ries or other mishap in the event of hard
braking.

7-82 For pleasant driving OGAE15E5


Assist grips

Assist grips Coat hook* Luggage hooks


E00732800256 E00725600597 E00715700537

The assist grips (located above the doors on There is a coat hook on the rear seat assist There are 4 hooks located on the side walls of
the headliner) are not designed to support grip of the driver’s side. the luggage compartment.
body weight. They are intended for use only Use the hooks on the floor for securing the
while seated in the vehicle. luggage.

WARNING
l Do not put a hanger or any heavy or poin-
CAUTION ted object on the coat hook. If the curtain CAUTION
l Do not use the assist grips when getting into airbag was activated, any such item could
l Do not pile up the luggage beyond the seat-
or out of the vehicle. The assist grips could be propelled away with great force and back height. Also, firmly secure the luggage.
detach causing you to fall. could prevent the curtain airbag from in- Otherwise, serious accidents could result due
flating correctly. Hang clothes directly on to hindered rearward view or flying objects
the coat hook (without using a hanger). during sudden braking.
Make sure there are no heavy or sharp
objects in the pockets of clothes that you
hang on the coat hook.

OGAE15E5 For pleasant driving 7-83


OGAE15E5
For emergencies

If the vehicle breaks down.................................................................. 8-02


Emergency starting............................................................................. 8-02
Engine overheating............................................................................. 8-04
Tool and jack.......................................................................................8-06
Tyre repair kit*....................................................................................8-07
How to change a tyre.......................................................................... 8-13
Towing................................................................................................ 8-20
Operation under adverse driving conditions....................................... 8-24
8

OGAE15E5
If the vehicle breaks down

If the vehicle breaks down WARNING 4. Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK”
position or put the operation mode in
E00800101108
l To start the engine using jumper cables OFF.
If the vehicle breaks down on the road, move connected to another vehicle, perform the
correct procedures according to the in-
it to the shoulder and turn on the hazard
warning flashers and set up a warning trian-
struction below. Incorrect procedures WARNING
could result in a fire or explosion or dam-
gle, flashing lamp, etc. age to the vehicles. l Perform step 4 on both vehicles before-
Refer to “Hazard warning flasher switch” on hand.
Make sure that the cables or your clothes
page 5-55.
CAUTION cannot be caught by the fan or drive belt.
Personal injury could result.
If the engine stops/fails l Do not attempt to start the engine by pulling
or pushing the vehicle.
Vehicle operation and control are affected if It could damage your vehicle. 5. Make sure battery electrolyte is at the
8 the engine stops. l Always wear protective eye goggles when proper level.
Before moving the vehicle to a safe area, be working near the battery. Refer to “Battery” on page 10-09.
aware of the following: l Keep the battery out of the reach of children.
l The brake booster becomes inoperative WARNING
and the pedal effort will increase. Press 1. Get the vehicles close enough so the
down the brake pedal harder than usual. l If electrolyte fluid is not visible, or ap-
jumper cables can reach, but be sure the pears to be frozen, Do Not Attempt Jump
l Since the power steering system is no vehicles aren’t touching each other. Starting!
longer operative, the steering wheel feels A battery might rupture or explode if the
heavy when turning it. temperature is below the freezing point or
CAUTION if it is not filled to the proper level.

Emergency starting l Check the other vehicle. It must have a 12-


volt battery.
6. Connect one end of one jumper cable to
E00800504161 If the other system isn’t 12-volt, shorting can
damage both vehicles.
the positive (+) terminal of the dis-
If the engine cannot be started because the charged battery (A), and the other end to
battery is weak or dead, the battery from an- the positive (+) terminal of the booster
other vehicle can be used with jumper cables 2. Turn off all lamps, heater and other elec- battery (B).
to start the engine. trical loads.
3. Set the parking brake firmly on each ve-
hicle. Put an A/T, CVT in “P” (PARK)
or a M/T in “N” (Neutral).
8-02 For emergencies OGAE15E5
Emergency starting
Petrol-powered vehicles Diesel-powered vehicles WARNING
1600 models 1600 models
l Make sure you observe the following or-
der when connecting the cables:

l Make sure you make connection to the


correct designated location (as shown in
the illustration). If the connection is made
directly to the negative (-) side of the bat-
tery, flammable gases generated from the
battery might catch fire and explode.
l When connecting the jumper cables, do
not allow the positive (+) cable and nega-
tive (-) terminal to make contact. Other-
1800 models, 2000 models wise sparks might cause explosion of the
battery.
8
2200 models

CAUTION
l Take care not to get the jumper cable caught
in the cooling fan or other rotating part in
the engine compartment.
l Use the proper cables suitable for the battery
size to prevent overheating of the cables.
l Check the jumper cables for damage and
corrosion before use.

7. Connect one end of the other jumper ca- 8. Start the engine in the vehicle which has
ble to the negative (-) terminal of the the booster battery, let the engine idle a
booster battery, and the other end to the few minutes, then start the engine in the
engine block of the vehicle with the dis- vehicle with the discharged battery.
charged battery at the point farthest from
the battery.

OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-03


Engine overheating

CAUTION WARNING 2. Check whether steam is coming from the


engine compartment.
l Keep the engine of the vehicle giving assis- l Electrolyte is corrosive diluted sulphuric
tance running. acid.
[If steam does not come from the engine
If electrolyte (battery acid) comes into
contact with your hands, eyes, clothes and compartment]
NOTE the painted surface of your vehicle, it With the engine still running, raise the
should be thoroughly flushed with water. bonnet to ventilate the engine compart-
l For vehicles equipped with the Auto Stop & If electrolyte gets in your eyes, flush them ment.
Go (AS&G) system, press the “Auto Stop &
with water immediately and thoroughly,
Go (AS&G) OFF” switch to deactivate the
and get prompt medical attention.
Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system and pre- NOTE
vent the engine from automatically stopping
before the battery is sufficiently charged.
NOTE l For vehicles equipped with the Auto Stop &
Refer to “To deactivate” on page 6-22. Go (AS&G) system, press the “Auto Stop &
8 l If the vehicle is put in motion without fully Go (AS&G) OFF” switch to deactivate the
Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system before
charging the battery, it might cause the loss
9. After the engine is started, disconnect of smooth engine operation and the anti-lock stopping the vehicle.
the cables in the reverse order and keep brake warning lamp to illuminate. Refer to “To deactivate” on page 6-22.
the engine running for several minutes. Refer to “Anti-lock brake system (ABS)” on
page 6-48. [If steam is coming from the engine
WARNING compartment]
Engine overheating Stop the engine, and when the steam
l If the battery has to be charged while fit- stops, raise the bonnet to ventilate the
ted in the vehicle, disconnect the vehicle E00800604016
side negative (-) terminal connected to the engine compartment. Restart the engine.
battery. When the engine is overheating, the informa-
l Keep sparks, cigarettes and flames away tion screen in the multi-information display
from the battery because the battery may will be interrupted and the engine coolant
WARNING
produce an explosion. temperature warning display will appear. Al- l Do not open the bonnet while steam is
l Use adequate ventilation when charging so “ ” will blink. coming from the engine compartment. It
or using the battery in an enclosed space. could cause steam or hot water to spurt
l Remove all the caps before charging the
If this occurs, take the following corrective
out, causing burns. Hot water could spurt
battery. out even when there is no steam coming
measures: out, and some parts will be very hot. Be
1. Stop the vehicle in a safe place. very careful when opening the bonnet.

8-04 For emergencies OGAE15E5


Engine overheating

WARNING 3. Confirm that the cooling fans are turn- 4. When the bar graph in the engine cool-
ing. If the fans are not turning, stop the ant temperature warning display in the
l Be careful of hot steam, which could cause engine immediately and have it checked. multi-information display drops, stop the
the cap on the engine reserve tank to blow
engine.
off.
l Do not attempt to remove the radiator
cap while the engine is hot.
Type 1
Type 1

Except for diesel-powered vehicles 1600 models


Type 2
Type 2

8
A- Cooling fans
B- Caution label 5. Check the coolant level in the reserve
*: Front of the vehicle tank (C).

Diesel-powered 1600 models WARNING Except for diesel-powered vehicles 1600 models
l Be careful not to get your hands or clothes
caught in the cooling fan.
FULL

LOW

OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-05


Tool and jack

Diesel-powered 1600 models 7. Examine the radiator hoses for coolant Vehicles with tyre repair kit

leakage and the drive belt for looseness


or damage.
FULL
If there is anything wrong with the cool-
ing system or drive belt, we recommend
you to have it checked and repaired.
LOW
Tool and jack
E00800901500

1- Tools
Storage 2- Jack
WARNING
8 l If there is none, make sure that the engine The tools and jack are stowed in the luggage Tools
has cooled down before removing the ra- compartment. E00801900627
diator cap (D), because hot steam or boil- The storage location of the tools and jack
ing water otherwise will gush from the should be remembered in case of an emer-
filler port and may scald you. gency.

6. Fill the reserve tank with coolant as nee- Vehicles with spare wheel
ded. (Refer to the “Maintenance” sec-
tion.)

CAUTION
l Do not add coolant while the engine is hot.
Suddenly adding cold coolant could damage 1- Wheel nut wrench
the engine. Wait for the engine to cool 2- Jack bar
down, then add coolant a little at a time. 3- Towing hook
1- Tools
2- Jack

8-06 For emergencies OGAE15E5


Tyre repair kit*

Jack Vehicles with tyre repair kit Tyre repair kit storage
E00802000524
The jack is used only for the purpose of The tyre repair kit is stowed in the luggage
changing a tyre when a tyre is punctured. compartment.

NOTE
l The jack is maintenance-free.
l The jack is in conformity with EC law as ap-
proximated by the Machinery Directive
2006/42/EC.
l The EC declarations of conformity are at-
tached to the section “Declaration of Con-
Tyre repair kit*
formity” in the end of this owner’s manual.
• The business name, full address of the
E00804501054
8
This kit enables emergency repair of a small
manufacturer and of his authorized repre- puncture in the tread area of a tyre that has
sentative and the designation of the jack
are described in the EC declaration of
run over a nail, screw, or similar object.
conformity.
WARNING
Removing and storing the jack l The tyre repair kit may not permanently
Before removing the jack, lift up the luggage seal a punctured tyre.
floor board. l Use only the MITSUBISHI genuine tire
repair kit. Sealant in other repair kits
may not sufficiently seal the tire puncture.
Vehicles with spare wheel

1- Tyre compressor
2- Tyre sealant bottle
3- Valve insert (spare)

OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-07


Tyre repair kit*
4- Valve remover NOTE NOTE
5- Filler hose
6- Speed restriction sticker • The tyre has completely slipped over the
wheel rim and has come off the wheel.
• The wheel is damaged.
How to use the tyre repair kit
l Use the tyre sealant only at ambient temper-
atures of -30 °C to + 60 °C.
CAUTION l Effect an emergency repair without pulling
out the object (nail, screw, etc.) that is stuck
l The tyre sealant can cause health damage if in the tyre.
swallowed. If you accidentally swallow it,
drink as much water as possible and imme- l Do not use the tyre sealant if the tyre has
been damaged by being driven when insuffi-
diately consult a doctor.
ciently inflated (e.g. bumps, cuts, cracks etc.
l If the tyre sealant gets in your eyes or on
on the tyre).
your skin, rinse with lots of water. If you
8 still sense an abnormality, consult a doctor. • More than one tyre is punctured. l Wipe tyre sealant off the paintwork immedi-
ately with a damp cloth.
l Consult a doctor immediately if any allergic • The puncture hole has a length or width of
reactions occur. 4 mm or more. l Immediately wash clothes contaminated
• The tyre is punctured in the side wall (A), with tyre sealant.
l Do not allow children to touch the tyre seal-
ant. not in the tread (B).
l Do not breathe in the vapours of tyre sealant. Before repairing a tyre, first stop your vehicle
in a safe, flat location.
1. Park the vehicle on level and stable
NOTE ground.
l The tyre sealant cannot be used in any of the 2. Set the parking brake firmly.
situations listed below. If any of these situa- 3. On vehicles with M/T, stop the engine
tions occurs, please contact a MITSUBISHI and move the gearshift lever to the “R”
MOTORS Authorized Service Point or an- (Reverse) position.
other specialist.
On vehicles with A/T or CVT, move the
• The tyre sealant’s expiry date has passed.
(The expiry date is shown on the bottle la-
selector lever to the “P” (PARK) posi-
bel.) tion and stop the engine.
• The vehicle has been driven with the tyre
almost completely flat.

8-08 For emergencies OGAE15E5


Tyre repair kit*
4. Turn on the hazard warning flashers and NOTE
set up a warning triangle, flashing signal
lamp, etc., at an adequate distance from l In cold conditions (when the ambient tem-
perature is 0 °C or lower), thickening of the
the vehicle, and have all your passengers
tyre sealant can make the tyre sealant hard to
leave the vehicle. squeeze out of the bottle. Warm the bottle
5. Take out the tyre sealant bottle and the inside the vehicle.
compressor.
6. Take the valve cap (C) off the tyre valve
9. Take the cap (G) off the type sealant
(D), then press the valve remover (E)
bottle (H). Do not remove the seal (I).
onto the valve as illustrated. Allow all of
Screw the filler hose (J) onto the bottle
the air in the tyre to escape.
(H). As you screw the filler hose onto
CAUTION the bottle, the seal will break, allowing

l If there is any air left in the tyre when you


the sealant to be used. 8
remove the valve insert, the valve insert may
fly out and injure you. Make sure the tyre
contains no air before removing the valve in-
sert.

8. Shake the tyre sealant bottle well.

7. Remove the valve insert (F) by turning it


anticlockwise using the valve remover
(E). Put the removed valve insert in a
clean place so it does not get dirty. CAUTION
l If you shake the bottle after screwing on the
hose, sealant may spray out of the hose.

10. Press the hose onto the valve (D). Hold-


ing the sealant bottle upside-down,
OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-09
Tyre repair kit*
squeeze it again and again to inject all of 12. After injecting the sealant, securely fit
the sealant into the tyre. the valve remover (E) into the end of the
filler hose (J) to prevent sealant from
leaking from the empty bottle.

NOTE
8 l When removing and screwing in the valve
insert using the valve remover, turn the
NOTE valve remover by hand. Using a tool to turn
the valve remover could damage it.
l When injecting the sealant, position the 13. Pull out the compressor hose (K) from
valve away from the bottom, i.e., away from
the side of the tyre compressor, and then
the point where the tyre touches the ground.
If the valve is near the point where the tyre securely attach the hose to the tyre valve
touches the ground, the sealant may not go (D).
into the tyre easily.

11. After injecting the sealant, pull the hose


off the valve, remove any residual seal-
ant from the valve, rim and/or tyre. Fit
the valve insert (F) into the valve (D),
and screw the valve insert securely into
place using the valve remover (E).

8-10 For emergencies OGAE15E5


Tyre repair kit*
14. Place the compressor (L) with its air CAUTION CAUTION
pressure gauge (M) on top.
Pull out the compressor’s power cord l The supplied compressor is designed only l The surface of the compressor will get hot
for inflation of passenger vehicle tyres. while the compressor is running. Do not
(N), insert the plug on the cord into the
accessory socket or cigarette lighter l The compressor is designed to run on a vehi- keep the compressor running continuously
cle’s 12 V power supply. Do not connect it for more than 10 minutes. After using the
socket (O), and then turn the ignition to any other power source. compressor, wait for the compressor to cool
switch to “ACC” position or put the op- l The compressor is not waterproof. If you use before using it again.
eration mode in ACC. Refer to “Ciga- it in rain, make sure water does not get on it. l If the compressor becomes sluggish or hot
rette lighter” on page 7-73 and “Acces- l Any sand or dust sucked into the compressor while operating, it is overheating. Immedi-
sory socket” on page 7-74. could make the compressor break down. Do ately place the switch in the OFF position
not place the compressor directly on any and let the compressor cool down for at least
Turn ON the compressor switch (P) and
sandy or dusty surface when using it. 30 minutes.
inflate the tyre to the specified pressure.
l Do not disassemble or modify the compres-
(Refer to “Tyre inflation pressures” on sor. Also, do not subject the air pressure
page 10-13.) gauge to shock. It could malfunction. NOTE 8
l If the tyre pressure does not rise to the speci-
15. Check and adjust the tyre pressure with fied level within 10 minutes, the tyre may be
reference to the air pressure gauge on the so severely damaged that the tyre sealant
compressor. If you overinflate the tyre, cannot be used to effect an emergency re-
pair. Please contact a MITSUBISHI
release air by loosening the hose’s end
MOTORS Authorized Service Point or an-
fitting. other specialist in this event.
If there is a gap between the tyre and
wheel because the tyre has moved in-
ward from the wheel rim, press the pe- 16. Turn OFF the compressor switch, then
riphery of the tyre towards the wheel to pull the power cord plug out of the sock-
close the gap before running the com- et.
pressor. (With no gaps, the tyre pressure
will rise.)

CAUTION
l Be careful not to get your fingers trapped be-
tween the tyre and wheel as the tyre inflates.

OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-11


Tyre repair kit*

NOTE CAUTION 19. After driving for 10 minutes or 5 km


(3 miles), check the tyre pressure using
l Simply putting sealant and air into the tyre l Do not affix the sticker anywhere except the the air pressure gauge on the compres-
using the tyre repair kit does not seal the specified position on the pad of the steering
sor.
puncture hole. Air will leak through the wheel. Affixing the sticker in an incorrect
puncture hole until the emergency repair position could prevent the SRS airbag from If the tyre pressure is not sufficient, in-
procedure is completed (through step 19 of working normally. flate the tyre to the specified pressure
these instructions). l Be sure to check the tyre pressure for confir- again and drive the vehicle carefully
mation that the emergency repair procedure without exceeding a speed of 80 km/h
is complete. (50 mph).
17. Affix the speed restriction sticker (Q) to
the steering wheel at the position shown
in the illustration. Then immediately 18. When you have inflated the tyre to the CAUTION
drive with great care to a MITSUBISHI specified pressure, stow the compressor,
bottle, and other items in the vehicle and l If the tyre pressure is lower than the mini-
8 MOTORS Authorized Service Point or
another specialist and have tyre repair/ promptly start driving the vehicle so that
mum permitted pressure (1.3 bar
{130 kPa}), the tyre cannot successfully be
replacement performed. the tyre sealant can spread evenly in the repaired with the tyre sealant. Do not drive
tyre. Drive with great care. Do not ex- the vehicle any further. Contact a
ceed a speed of 80 km/h (50 mph). Ob- MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
serve local speed limits. ice Point or another specialist.

CAUTION 20. After driving for 10 minutes or 5 km


(3 miles), check the tyre pressure using
l If you sense any abnormality while driving, the air pressure gauge on the compres-
stop the vehicle and contact a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service Point or an- sor. If the tyre pressure has apparently
other specialist. Otherwise the tyre pressure not dropped, the emergency repair pro-
may drop before the emergency repair pro- cedure is complete. You must still not
cedure is completed, rendering the vehicle exceed a speed of 80 km/h (50 mph).
unsafe. Observe local speed limits.

NOTE
l Driving faster than 80 km/h (50 mph) can
make the vehicle vibrate.

8-12 For emergencies OGAE15E5


How to change a tyre

NOTE NOTE 3. On vehicles with M/T, stop the engine


and move the gearshift lever to the “R”
l If the tyre pressure has dropped below the lA tyre in which puncture sealant has been (Reverse) position.
specified level when you check it at the end used should ideally be replaced with a new
On vehicles with A/T or CVT, move the
of the repair procedure, do not drive the ve- one. If you wish to have such a tyre properly
hicle any further. Contact a MITSUBISHI repaired for reuse, please contact a selector lever to the “P” (PARK) posi-
MOTORS Authorized Service Point or an- MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv- tion and stop the engine.
other specialist. ice Point or another specialist. Note that a 4. Turn on the hazard warning flashers and
l In cold conditions (when the ambient tem- proper repair is impossible following an set up a warning triangle, flashing signal
perature is 0 °C or lower), the time and driv- emergency repair if the puncture hole cannot lamp, etc., at an adequate distance from
ing distance necessary until completion of be located. the vehicle, and have all your passengers
the repair can be longer than in warmer con- l Wipe away any sealant that gets on the
leave the vehicle.
ditions, meaning that the tyre pressure can wheel. Provided the valve is replaced with a
drop below the specified level even when new one, the wheel can be reused.
you have inflated the tyre a second time and l The manufacturer is unable to guarantee that NOTE 8
subsequently driven the vehicle. If this hap- all tyre punctures can be repaired with the
pens, inflate the tyre to the specified pres- tyre repair kit, in particular cuts or perfora- l The warning triangle and flashing signal
sure once more, drive for about 10 minutes tions with a diameter of more than 4 mm or lamp do not come with your vehicle. It is
or 5 km (3 miles), then check the tyre pres- away from the tyre’s tread. The manufactur- recommended that you keep one in the vehi-
sure again. If the tyre pressure has again er is not liable for damage sustained through cle for use if needed.
dropped below the specified level, stop driv- improper use of the tyre repair kit.
ing the vehicle and contact a MITSUBISHI l The manufacturer is not liable for damage 5. To prevent the vehicle from rolling
MOTORS Authorized Service Point or an- sustained through re-use of any tyre in
when it is raised on the jack, place
other specialist. which tyre sealant has been used.
chocks or blocks (A) in front of and be-
l Please give the empty sealant bottle to your
hind the tyre that is diagonally opposite
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point when you purchase new sealant or How to change a tyre from the tyre (B) you are changing.
dispose of the sealant bottle according to na- E00801202943
tional regulations for the disposal of chemi-
cal waste. Before changing a tyre, first stop your vehi-
cle in a safe, flat location.
1. Park the vehicle on level and stable
ground, free of loose pebbles, etc.
2. Set the parking brake firmly.

OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-13


How to change a tyre

Spare wheel information* Temporary spare wheel (spare


E00803601843
wheel with a speed limit label)*
Check the air pressure of the spare tyre fre- The T155/90D16 size spare wheel is stored
quently and make sure it is ready for emer- beneath the luggage floor board of the lug-
gency use at any time. gage compartment. It is designed to save
space in the luggage compartment and its
Maintaining the spare wheel at the highest light weight makes it easy to handle in the
specified air pressure will ensure that it can event of a flat tyre.
always be used under any conditions (city/
high-speed driving, varying load weight,
etc.). CAUTION
WARNING The spare wheel is stored beneath the lug- l The temporary spare wheel is for temporary
gage floor board of the luggage compartment. use only and should be removed as soon as
8 l Be sure to apply chocks or blocks to the
correct tyre when jacking up the vehicle. the original wheel can be repaired or re-
If the vehicle moves while jacked up, the placed. (For vehicles that are equipped with
jack could slip out of position, leading to CAUTION a tyre pressure monitoring system, while the
an accident. temporary spare wheel is being used, the
l The pressure should be periodically checked
and maintained at the specified pressure tyre pressure monitoring system will not
while the tyre is stowed. function properly.)
NOTE Driving with an insufficient tyre pressure l The vehicle must not be driven at speeds in
can lead to an accident. If you have no excess of 80 km/h (50 mph) while using the
l The chocks shown in the illustration do not choice but to drive with an insufficient tyre temporary spare wheel.
come with your vehicle. It is recommended
that you keep one in the vehicle for use if pressure, keep your speed down and inflate l The T155/90D16 size spare wheel is not as
the tyre to the correct pressure as soon as good as a standard wheel in controllability
needed. and stability. When the temporary spare
possible. (Refer to “Tyre inflation pressures”
l If chocks or blocks are not available, use
on page 10-13.) wheel is used, avoid quick starts, sudden
stones or any other objects that are large braking and sharp steering.
enough to hold the wheel in position. l When the tread wear indicators appear, the
tyre must be replaced. The tyre size of the 215/65R16 size tempo-
Refer to “Wheel condition” on page 10-14. rary spare tyre is different from that of the
6. Get the jack bar and wheel nut wrench standard tyre. When the temporary spare
ready. tyre is used, avoid quick starts, sudden brak-
ing and sharp steering.
Refer to “Tool and jack” on page 8-06.

8-14 For emergencies OGAE15E5


How to change a tyre

CAUTION CAUTION NOTE


l The temporary spare wheel is specifically l Upon installation of the T155/90D16 size l Put the spare wheel under the vehicle body
designed for your vehicle and it should not spare wheel, the ground clearance is reduced near the jack. This makes it safer if the jack
be used on any other vehicle. as the tyre is smaller in diameter than the slips out of position.
When you purchase a 215/65R16 size spare standard tyre.
wheel, be sure to purchase the type designed When passing over the projections on the
specially for your vehicle from your road, take care not to damage the vehicle’s
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv- undercarriage.
ice Point. l Do not install more than one temporary
l Do not use tyre chains with your temporary spare wheel at the same time.
spare wheel. Because of the smaller tyre
size, a tyre chain will not fit properly. This
could cause damage to the wheel and result To remove the spare wheel
in loss of the chain.
If a front tyre becomes flat when using tyre 1. Lift up the luggage floor board.
E00803301169
8
chains, first replace a rear wheel with the 2. To remove the spare wheel, remove the
temporary spare wheel and then use the re- installation clamp (A) by turning it anti- To change a tyre
moved rear wheel to replace the flat front
clockwise. E00803202295
wheel so that you can continue to use the
chains. 1. If a wheel cover is installed, first remove
the cover. (Refer to “Wheel covers”.)
Then loosen the wheel nuts a quarter
turn with the wheel nut wrench. Do not
remove the wheel nuts yet.

OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-15


How to change a tyre
2. Place the jack under one of the jacking 3. Rotate the jack by hand until the flange Slowly rotate the wheel nut wrench until
points (A) shown in the illustration. Use portion (B) fits in the groove (C) at the the tyre is raised slightly off the ground
the jacking point closest to the tyre you top of the jack. surface.
wish to change.

8
4. Check that the flange portion at the jack- WARNING
WARNING ing point fits in the groove at the top of
the jack. l Stop jacking up the vehicle as soon as the
l Set the jack only at the positions shown tyre is raised off the ground. It is danger-
Insert the jack bar (D) into the wheel nut
here. If the jack is set at a wrong position, ous to raise the vehicle any higher.
wrench (E).
it could dent your vehicle or the jack l Do not get under your vehicle while using
might fall over and cause personal injury. Then put the end of the jack bar into the the jack.
l Do not use the jack on a tilted or soft sur- shaft’s jack end, as shown in the illustra- l Do not bump the raised vehicle or leave it
face. tion. sitting on the jack for a long time. Both
Otherwise, the jack might slip and cause are very dangerous.
personal injury. Always use the jack on a l Do not use a jack except the one that
flat, hard surface. came with your vehicle.
Before setting the jack, make sure there l The jack should not be used for any pur-
are no sand or pebbles under the jack pose other than to change a tyre.
base. l No one should be in your vehicle when us-
ing the jack.
l Do not start or run the engine while your
vehicle is on the jack.

8-16 For emergencies OGAE15E5


How to change a tyre

WARNING WARNING touches the wheel hole seats (B) enough


to keep the tyre from wobbling.
l Do not turn the raised wheel. The tyres l Be sure to position the tyres the correct
still on the ground could turn and make way when putting them on the vehicle.
your vehicle fall off the jack. The valves should be on the outer side of
the vehicle. If the valve (I) cannot be seen,
the tyre has been mounted the wrong way
5. Remove the wheel nuts with the wheel around.
nut wrench, then take the wheel off. If tyres are mounted the wrong way
around it could have a negative effect on
the vehicle and cause an accident.
CAUTION
l Handle the wheel carefully when changing
the tyre, to avoid scratching the wheel sur-
face.
8
[Vehicle with the flange nuts]
6. Clean out any mud, etc. on the hub sur- • Aluminium wheel
face (F), hub bolts (G) or in the installa- Initially tighten the wheel nuts until
tion holes (H) in the wheel, and then the wheel nut flange area (C) touch-
mount the spare tyre. es the wheel enough to keep the tyre
from wobbling.

7. Turn the wheel nuts clockwise by hand


to initially tighten them.

[Vehicle with the tapered nuts]


Initially tighten the wheel nuts until the
tapered part (A) of the nuts lightly

• Steel wheel

OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-17


How to change a tyre
Initially tighten the wheel nuts until 8. Lower the vehicle slowly by rotating the (Achieved by applying force of 350 to
the tapered area (A) of the nuts wheel nut wrench anticlockwise until the 420 N at end of wheel nut wrench sup-
lightly touches the wheel hole seat tyre touches the ground. plied with vehicle)
area (B) enough to keep the tyre
from wobbling.

8
9. Tighten the nuts in the order shown in CAUTION
the illustration until each nut has been
tightened to the torque listed here. l Never use your foot or a pipe extension for
CAUTION extra force in the wheel nut wrench. If you
do so, you will tighten the nut too much.
l Never apply oil to either the wheel bolts or Tightening torque 88 to 108 Nm
the nuts, or they will tighten too much.
10. If the vehicle has a wheel cover, install
it.
NOTE Refer to “Wheel covers” on page 8-19.
l Flange nuts can be temporarily used on the 11. Lower and remove the jack, then store
steel wheel, but return to the original wheel the jack, flat tyre, and chocks. Have your
and tyre as soon as possible.
damaged tyre repaired as soon as possi-
l If all 4 aluminium wheels are changed to
ble.
steel wheels, e.g. when fitting winter tyres,
use tapered nuts. 12. Check your tyre inflation pressure at the
next gasstation. The correct tyre pres-
sures are shown on the driver’s door la-
bel. See the illustration.

8-18 For emergencies OGAE15E5


How to change a tyre
2. Store the flat tyre or the spare wheel un- Wheel covers*
der the luggage floor board. To store the E00801300692
flat tyre or spare wheel, fit the installa-
tion clamp (A) by turning it clockwise. To remove
Wrap the tip of the jack bar with a cloth, in-
sert it deeply into the notch provided in the
wheel cover, and pry the cover away from the
wheel. Using the same procedure at the other
wheel cover notches, work the wheel cover
away from the wheel to remove it complete-
ly.
CAUTION
l The temporary spare wheel is to be used on-
ly temporarily when the standard wheel is
8
damaged. Repair the damaged tyre as soon
as possible and use it to replace the tempora-
ry spare tyre.
l After changing the tyre and driving the vehi- NOTE
cle about 1,000 km (620 miles), retighten the
wheel nuts to make sure that they have not l On vehicles with a T155/90D16 size spare
come loose. wheel, the clamp cannot be used for a nor-
mal size tyre.
l If the steering wheel vibrates when driving
after changing the tyre, we recommend you
to have the tyres checked for balance. 3. Have your damaged tyre repaired as
l Do not mix one type of tyre with another or soon as possible.
use a different size from the one listed. This CAUTION
would cause early wear and poor handling.
To store the tools and jack l Removing the cover with your hands may
cause injury to the fingers.
E00803800154
To store the flat tyre or spare Reverse the removing procedure when stor-
wheel ing the jack, jack bar and wheel nut wrench. NOTE
E00803401274 Refer to “Tool and jack” on page 8-06.
1. Lift up the luggage floor board. l The wheel cover is made of plastic. Pry it
loose carefully.

OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-19


Towing
To install NOTE Towing
1. Make sure the tabs (A) of the back of the l Full wheel covers have a symbol mark (E) E00801505064

wheel cover are not broken and correctly provided on the reverse side to show the air
fitted on the rings (B). If in doubt, do not valve location.
Before installing the wheel cover to the
If your vehicle needs to be tow-
install the wheel cover and consult a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized wheel, make sure that the opening with the ed
symbol mark is correctly aligned with the air
Service Point. valve. If you need to tow your vehicle, we recom-
mend that you contact a MITSUBISHI
3. Push the underside (F) of the wheel cov- MOTORS Authorized Service Point or tow
er into the wheel. truck company.
4. Gently push both sides (G) of the wheel
cover and hold them in place with both In the following cases, transport the vehicle
8 knees. using a tow truck.
5. Gently tap around the circumference of l The engine runs but the vehicle does not
the wheel cover at the top (H), then push move or abnormal noise is produced.
the wheel cover into place. l Inspection of the vehicle’s underside re-
veals that oil or some other fluid is leak-
ing.
2. Align the air valve (C) of the tyre with
the notch (D) in the wheel cover. If a wheel gets stuck in a ditch, do not try to
tow the vehicle.
Please contact your MITSUBISHI MOTORS
Authorized Service Point or a commercial
tow truck service for assistance.

Only when you cannot receive a towing serv-


ice from a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
ized Service Point or commercial tow truck
service, tow your vehicle carefully in accord-
ance with the instructions given in “Emer-
gency towing” in this part.

8-20 For emergencies OGAE15E5


Towing
The regulations concerning towing may dif- Towing the vehicle by a tow
fer from country to country. It is recommen- truck
ded that you obey the regulations of the area
where you are driving your vehicle.
CAUTION
l This vehicle must not be towed by a tow
truck using sling lift type equipment (Type
A) as illustrated. Using a sling lift will dam-
age the bumper and front end.
l Do not tow 2WD vehicles with CVT with
Do not tow 4WD vehicles, or 2WD vehicles the driving wheels on the ground (Type B)
with CVT, with this style. as illustrated.
This could result in the driving system dam-
age.
l Do not tow 4WD vehicles with the front or 8
rear wheels on the ground (Type B or Type
C) as illustrated. This could result in driving
Do not tow 4WD vehicles with this style. system damage or the vehicle may jump at
the carriage.
If you tow 4WD vehicles, use Type D or E
equipment.
l On 2WD vehicles, if the transmission is mal-
functioning or damaged, transport the vehi-
cle with the driving wheels on a carriage
(Type C, D or E) as illustrated.
l 4WD vehicles cannot be towed with only the
front or rear tyres on the ground even if they
are in “2WD” drive mode.

OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-21


Towing

CAUTION Turn the ignition switch to the “ACC” posi-


tion or put the operation mode in ACC and
l [For 2WD vehicles equipped with the Active secure the steering wheel in a straight-ahead
Stability Control (ASC)]
position with a rope or tiedown strap. Never
If the vehicle is towed with the ignition
switch in the “ON” position or the operation place the ignition switch in the “LOCK” po-
mode in ON and only the front wheels or on- sition or put the operation mode in OFF when
ly the rear wheels raised off the ground towing.
(Type B or C), the ASC may operate, result-
ing in an accident. Towing with front wheels off
When towing the vehicle with the rear the ground (Type C)
wheels raised, turn the ignition switch to the
“ACC” position or put the operation mode in Release the parking brake.
ACC. Place the gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) NOTE
When towing the vehicle with the front position (M/T) or the selector lever in the
8 wheels raised, keep the ignition switch or the “N” (NEUTRAL) position (CVT).
l Do not use the tie-down hooks (B) for tow-
ing. These hooks are provided only for the
operation mode as follows. purpose of transporting the vehicle itself.
[Except for vehicles equipped with keyless Using any part other than the designated
operation system]
Emergency towing towing hook (A) could result in damage to
The ignition switch is in the “LOCK” or the vehicle body.
“ACC” position. If towing service is not available in an emer-
gency, your vehicle may be temporarily tow- l Using a wire rope or metal chain can result
[Vehicles equipped with keyless operation in damage to the vehicle body. It is best to
system] ed by a rope secured to the towing hook. use a non-metallic rope. If you use a wire
The operation mode is in OFF or ACC. If your vehicle is to be towed by another ve- rope or metal chain, wrap it with cloth at any
hicle or if your vehicle tows another vehicle, point where it touches the vehicle body.
Towing with rear wheels off the pay careful attention to the following points: l Take care that the tow rope is kept as hori-
ground (Type B) zontal as possible. An angled tow rope can
If your vehicle is to be towed by damage the vehicle body.
Place the gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) another vehicle
position. 2. Keep the engine running.
1. The front towing hook (A) is located as
If the engine is not running, perform the
shown in the illustration. Secure the tow
following operation to unlock the steer-
rope to the front towing hook.
ing wheel.
[Except for vehicles with keyless opera-
tion system]

8-22 For emergencies OGAE15E5


Towing
Turn the ignition switch to the “ACC” or 3. Place the gearshift lever in the “N” CAUTION
“ON” position (M/T) or “ON” position (Neutral) position (M/T), or the selector
(A/T or CVT). lever in the “N” (NEUTRAL) position l When the vehicle equipped with A/T or
CVT is to be towed by another vehicle with
[For vehicles with the keyless operation (A/T or CVT).
the all wheels on the ground, make sure that
system] 4. Turn on the hazard warning lamps if re- the towing speed and distance given below
Put the operation mode in ACC or ON quired by law. (Follow the local driving are never exceeded, causing damage to the
(M/T) or ON (A/T or CVT). laws and regulations.) transmission.
5. During towing make sure that close con-
tact is maintained between the drivers of Towing speed: 40 km/h (25 mph)
NOTE Towing distance: 40 km (25 miles)
both vehicles, and that the vehicles trav-
l For vehicles equipped with the Auto Stop & el at low speed.
Go (AS&G) system, press the “Auto Stop & For the towing speed and the towing dis-
Go (AS&G) OFF” switch to deactivate the tance, follow the local driving laws and reg-
Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system before CAUTION ulations.
8
stopping the vehicle.
Refer to “To deactivate” on page 6-22. l The person in the vehicle being towed must
If your vehicle tows another ve-
pay attention to the brake lamps of the tow-
ing vehicle and make sure the rope never be- hicle
comes slack.
WARNING 1. Take out the towing hook, wheel nut
l Avoid sudden braking, sudden acceleration
wrench and jack bar.
l When the engine is not running, the brake and sharp turning; such operation could
booster and power steering system do not cause damage to the towing hooks or the tow Refer to “Tools, jack and tyre repair kit”
operate. This means higher brake depres- rope. on page 8-06.
sion force and higher steering effort are People in the vicinity could be injured as a
required. Therefore, vehicle operation is result.
more difficult than usual. l When towing or being towed down a long
slope, the brakes may overheat reducing the
effectiveness. In this situation, have your ve-
CAUTION hicle transported by a tow truck.
l Do not leave the ignition switch in the
“LOCK” position or the operation mode in
OFF. The steering wheel will lock, causing
loss of control.

OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-23


Operation under adverse driving conditions
2. Cover the end of the jack bar (C) with 5. When finished towing, remove the tow- Operation under adverse
cloth and use it to remove the lid from ing hook, and stow it in the specified lo-
the rear bumper. cation. driving conditions
Refer to “Tools, jack and tyre repair kit” E00801702531

on page 8-06.
When installing the bumper lid, align the On a flooded road
hook with the cut out area on the vehi-
cle, and firmly insert. l Avoid flooded roads. Water could enter
the brake discs, resulting in temporarily
NOTE ineffective brakes. In such cases, lightly
depress the brake pedal to see if the
l Do not tow a vehicle heavier than your own
brakes operate properly. If they do not,
vehicle.
lightly depress the pedal several times
8 while driving in order to dry the brake
pads.
3. Use the wheel nut wrench (D) to firmly
attach the towing hook.
l When driving in rain or on a road with
many puddles a layer of water may form
between the tyres and the road surface.
This reduces a tyre’s frictional resistance
on the road, resulting in loss of steering
stability and braking capability.

To cope with this, observe the following


items:

(a) Drive your vehicle at slow


speed.
(b) Do not drive on worn tyres.
4. Always attach the tow rope to the towing (c) Always maintain the specified
hook. Otherwise, the instructions are the tyre inflation pressures.
same as for “When being towed by an-
other vehicle”.

8-24 For emergencies OGAE15E5


Operation under adverse driving conditions

On a snow-covered or frozen CAUTION


road l Do not press the accelerator pedal rapidly. If
the wheels break free of the ice, the vehicle
l The use of snow tyres or tyre chains is could suddenly start moving and possibly
recommended for driving on snow and cause an accident.
ice.
Refer to the “Snow tyres” and “Tyre On a bumpy or rutted road
chains” sections.
l Avoid high-speed driving, sudden accel- l Drive as slow as possible when driving
eration, sudden braking, and sharp turns. on bumpy or rutted roads.
l Depressing the brake pedal during travel
on snowy or icy roads may cause tyre
slippage and skidding. Tyres may slip if
CAUTION
the ability of the tyres to grip the road l The impact on tyres and/or wheels when 8
surface lessens. This may make it more driving on a bumpy or rutted road can dam-
difficult to stop the vehicle with normal age the tyre and/or wheel.
braking operations. For vehicles with an
anti-lock brake system (ABS), firmly de-
press and hold down the brake pedal.
l Allow extra distance between your vehi-
cle and the vehicle in front of you, and
avoid sudden braking.
l Accumulation of ice on the braking sys-
tem can cause the wheels to lock. Pull
away from a standstill slowly after con-
firming safety around the vehicle.

OGAE15E5 For emergencies 8-25


OGAE15E5
Vehicle care

Vehicle care precautions..................................................................... 9-02


Cleaning the interior of your vehicle.................................................. 9-02
Cleaning the exterior of your vehicle..................................................9-03

OGAE15E5
Vehicle care precautions

Vehicle care precautions Cleaning the interior of your NOTE


E00900100548
vehicle l Do not use cleaners, conditioners, and pro-
In order to maintain the value of your vehi- tectants containing silicons or wax.
E00900200220
Such products, when applied to the instru-
cle, it is necessary to perform regular mainte-
After cleaning the interior of your vehicle ment panels or other parts, may cause reflec-
nance using the proper procedures. tions on the windscreen and obscure vision.
with water, cleaner or similar, wipe and dry
Always maintain your vehicle in compliance Also, if such products get on the switches of
in a shady, well-ventilated area.
with environmental pollution control regula- the electrical accessories, it may lead to fail-
tions. ure of these accessories.
Carefully select the materials used for wash- CAUTION
ing, etc., to be sure that they do not contain l Do not use organic substances (solvents, Upholstery
corrosives. benzine, kerosene, alcohol, petrol, etc.) or
E00900500076
If in doubt, we recommend you to consult a alkaline or acidic solutions.
1. To maintain the value of your new vehi-
specialist for selection of these materials. These chemicals can cause discolouring,
staining or cracking of the surface. cle, handle the upholstery carefully and
9 If you use cleaners or polishing agents, make keep the interior clean.
CAUTION sure their ingredients do not include the sub- Use a vacuum cleaner and brush to clean
stances mentioned above. the seats. If stained, vinyl and synthetic
l Cleaning products can be dangerous. Always
follow the instructions of the cleaning prod- leather should be cleaned with an appro-
uct supplier. Plastic, vinyl leather, fabric priate cleaner. Cloth fabrics can be
l To avoid damage, never use the following to cleaned with either upholstery cleaner or
clean your vehicle: and flocked parts a 3% aqueous solution of neutral deter-
• Petrol E00900300319
gent in lukewarm water.
• Paint Thinner 1. Gently wipe off with a sponge, gauze or 2. Clean the carpeting with a vacuum
• Benzine other soft cloth soaked with a 3% aque- cleaner and remove any stains with car-
• Kerosene ous solution of neutral detergent. pet cleaner. Oil and grease can be re-
• Turpentine 2. Dip cloth in fresh water and wring it out moved by lightly dabbing with a clean
• Naphtha well. Using this cloth, wipe off the deter- colourfast cloth and stain remover.
• Lacquer Thinner gent thoroughly.
• Carbon Tetrachloride
• Nail Polish Remover
• Acetone

9-02 Vehicle care OGAE15E5


Cleaning the exterior of your vehicle

Genuine leather* Cleaning the exterior of Use a mild car washing soap if necessary.
Rinse thoroughly and wipe dry with a soft
E00900600804
1. Gently wipe off with gauze or other soft
your vehicle cloth. After washing the vehicle, carefully
cloth soaked with a 5 % aqueous solu- E00900700108 clean the joints and flanges of the doors, bon-
tion of neutral detergent. If the following is left on your vehicle, it may net and other sections where dirt is likely to
2. Dip cloth in fresh water and wring it out cause corrosion, discolouration and stains, remain.
well. Using this cloth, wipe off the deter- wash the vehicle as soon as possible.
gent thoroughly. l Seawater, road deicing products. CAUTION
3. Apply leather protecting agent to the l Soot and dust, iron powder from facto-
genuine leather surface. l When washing the under side of your vehi-
ries, chemical substance (acids, alkalis, cle or wheel, be careful not to injure your
coal-tar, etc.). hands.
NOTE l Droppings from birds, carcasses of in- l If your vehicle has rain sensor wipers, place
sects, tree sap, etc. the wiper switch lever in the “OFF” position
l If genuine leather is wet with water or is to deactivate the rain sensor before washing
washed in water, wipe off water as quickly the vehicle. Otherwise, the wipers will oper-
as possible with a dry, soft cloth. If left Washing ate in the presence of water spray on the 9
damp, mildew may grow. E00900902276 windscreen and may get damaged as a result.
l The genuine leather surface may be dam- Chemicals contained in the dirt and dust l Refrain from excessively using a car wash as
aged if a nylon brush or synthetic fibre is picked up from the road surface can damage its brushes may scratch the paint surface,
rubbed hard against it. causing it to lose its gloss. Scratches will be
the paint coat and body of your vehicle if left
l Organic solvents such as benzine, kerosene,
in prolonged contact. especially visible on darker coloured vehi-
alcohol and petrol, acid or alkaline solvents cles.
may discolour the genuine leather surface. Frequent washing and waxing is the best way
l Never spray or splash water on the electrical
Be sure to use neutral detergents. to protect your vehicle from this damage. components in the engine compartment. Do-
l Remove dirty patches or oil substances This will also be effective in protecting it ing so could have an adverse effect on the
quickly as they can stain genuine leather. from environmental elements such as rain, engine startability.
l The genuine leather surface may harden and snow, salt air, etc. Exercise caution also when washing the un-
shrink if it is exposed to direct sun for long derbody; be careful not to spray water into
Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight.
hours. When your vehicle is parked, place it the engine compartment.
in the shade as much as possible. Park the vehicle in the shade and spray it
with water to remove dust. Next, using an l Some types of hot water washing equipment
l When the temperature of the vehicle interior apply high pressure and heat to the vehicle.
rises in summer, vinyl products left on the ample amount of clean water and a car wash- They may cause heat distortion and damage
genuine leather seat may deteriorate and ing brush or sponge, wash the vehicle from to the vehicle resin parts and may result in
stick to the seat. top to bottom. flooding of the vehicle interior.

OGAE15E5 Vehicle care 9-03


Cleaning the exterior of your vehicle

CAUTION During cold weather CAUTION


Therefore; Salt and other chemicals spread on the roads l Waxes containing high abrasive compounds
• Maintain a distance of approx. 70 cm or in some areas in winter can have a harmful should not be used. Such waxes remove rust
more between the vehicle body and the effect on the vehicle body. You should there- and stains effectively from the paintwork but
washing nozzle. fore wash the vehicle as often as possible in they are harmful to the lustre on the painted
• When washing around the door glass, accordance with our care-instructions. It is surface and the plated surface.
hold the nozzle at a distance of more than Further, they are harmful to glossy surfaces
70 cm and at right angles to the glass sur-
recommended to have a preservative applied such as grille, garnish, mouldings, etc.
and the underfloor protection checked before
face. l Do not use petrol or paint thinners to remove
l After washing the vehicle, drive the vehicle and after the cold weather season. road tar or other contamination to the pain-
slowly while lightly depressing the brake After washing your vehicle, wipe off all wa- ted surface.
pedal several times in order to dry out the terdrops from the rubber parts around the l Do not apply wax to sections that have a
brakes. doors to prevent the doors from freezing. black mat paint coating, as doing so could
Leaving the brakes wet could result in re- cause uneven discolouration, spots or stains.
duced braking performance. Also, there is a If wax gets on such areas, wipe it off using
possibility that they could freeze up or be- NOTE lukewarm water and a soft cloth.
9 come inoperative due to rust, rendering the
vehicle unable to move. l To prevent freezing of the weatherstripping

l When using an automatic car wash, pay at-


on the doors, bonnet, etc., they should be Polishing
treated with silicone spray.
tention to the following items, referring to E00901100066
the operation manual or consulting a car The vehicle should only be polished if the
wash operator. If the following procedure is Waxing paintwork has become stained or lost its lus-
not followed, it could result in damage to tre. Do not polish parts with a mat coating
E00901000863
your vehicle.
Waxing the vehicle will help prevent the ad- and the plastic bumpers. Doing so could
• The outside mirrors are retracted.
herence of dust and road chemicals to the cause stains or damage the finish.
• The antenna is removed.
paintwork. Apply a wax solution after wash-
• The wiper arms are secured in place with
ing the vehicle, or at least once every three Damaged paint
tape.
• If your vehicle is equipped with a rear months to assist displacing of water. E00901200201

spoiler or roof rails, consult a car wash Do not wax your vehicle in direct sunlight. Small cracks and scratches in the paint coat
operator before using the car wash. You should wax after the surfaces have should be touched up as soon as possible
• If your vehicle has rain sensor wipers, cooled. with MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE
place the wiper switch lever in the “OFF” touch-up paint to prevent corrosion.
position to deactivate the rain sensor.

9-04 Vehicle care OGAE15E5


Cleaning the exterior of your vehicle
Check body areas facing the road or the tyres Chrome parts Window glass
carefully for damage to the paint caused by E00901400098 E00901600117
gravels, etc. The paint code number for your In order to prevent spots and corrosion of The window glass can normally be cleaned
vehicle can be found on the vehicle informa- chrome parts, wash with water, dry thorough- using only a sponge and water.
tion code plate in the engine compartment. ly, and apply a special protective coating. Glass cleaner can be used to remove oil,
This should be done more frequently in win- grease, dead insects, etc. After washing the
Cleaning plastic parts ter. glass, wipe dry with a clean, dry, soft cloth.
E00901300707
Never use a cloth that is used for cleaning a
Use a sponge or chamois leather.
Aluminium wheels* painted surface to clean a window. Wax from
If a car wax adheres on a grey or black rough
E00901500347 the painted surface could get on the glass and
surface of the bumper, moulding or lamps,
1. Remove dirt using a sponge while sprin- lower glass transparency and visibility.
the surface becomes white. In such a case,
kling water on the vehicle.
wipe it off using lukewarm water and soft
2. Use neutral detergent on any dirt that
cloth or chamois leather. NOTE
cannot be removed easily with water.
Rinse off the neutral detergent after l To clean the inside of the rear window, al-
9
CAUTION washing the vehicle. ways use a soft cloth and wipe the window
glass along the demister heater element so as
3. Dry the vehicle thoroughly using a cha-
l Do not use a scrubbing brush or other hard not to cause damage.
tools as they may damage the plastic part mois leather or a soft cloth.
surface.
l Do not use wax containing compound (pol- Wiper blades
ishing powder) which may damage the plas-
CAUTION
E00901700062
tic part surface. l Do not use a brush or other hard implement Use a soft cloth and glass cleaner to remove
l Do not bring the plastic parts into contact on the wheels. grease, dead insects, etc., from the wiper
with petrol, light oil, brake fluids, engine Doing so could scratch the wheels.
blades. Replace the wiper blades when they
oils, greases, paint thinners, and sulphuric l Do not use any cleaner that contains an abra-
acid (battery electrolyte) which may crack, sive substance or is acidic or alkaline. Doing
no longer wipe properly. (Refer to page
stain or discolour the plastic parts. so could cause the coating on the wheels to 10-17.)
If they touch the plastic parts, wipe them off peel or become discoloured or stained.
with soft cloth, chamois or the like and an l Do not directly apply hot water using a
aqueous solution of neutral detergent then steam cleaner or by any other means.
immediately rinse the affected parts with l Contact with seawater and road deicer can
water. cause corrosion. Rinse off such substances
as soon as possible.

OGAE15E5 Vehicle care 9-05


Cleaning the exterior of your vehicle

Engine compartment
E00902100308
Clean the engine compartment at the begin-
ning and end of winter. Pay particular atten-
tion to flanges, crevices and peripheral parts
where dust containing road chemicals and
other corrosive materials might collect.
If salt and other chemicals are used on the
roads in your area, clean the engine compart-
ment at least every three months.
Never spray or splash water on the electrical
components in the engine compartment, as
this may cause damage.
Do not bring the nearby parts, the plastic
9 parts and so on into contact with sulphuric
acid (battery electrolyte) which may crack,
stain or discolour them.
If they are in contact, wipe off with soft
cloth, chamois or the like and an aqueous sol-
ution of neutral detergent then immediately
rinse the affected parts with plenty of water.

9-06 Vehicle care OGAE15E5


Maintenance

Service precautions........................................................................... 10-02


Catalytic converter............................................................................ 10-02
Bonnet............................................................................................... 10-03
Engine oil.......................................................................................... 10-05
Engine coolant...................................................................................10-07
Washer fluid......................................................................................10-08
Brake fluid/Clutch fluid*.................................................................. 10-09
Battery...............................................................................................10-09
Tyres..................................................................................................10-13
Wiper blade rubber replacement....................................................... 10-17
General maintenance.........................................................................10-19
For cold and snowy weather............................................................. 10-19
Fusible links...................................................................................... 10-19 10
Fuses..................................................................................................10-20
Replacement of lamp bulbs...............................................................10-26

OGAE15E5
Service precautions

Service precautions In the event a malfunction or a problem is WARNING


discovered, we recommend you to have it
E01000102074
checked and repaired. This section contains l If it is necessary to do work in the engine
Adequate care of your vehicle at regular in- compartment with the engine running, be
information on inspection maintenance pro-
especially careful that your clothing, hair,
tervals serves to preserve the value and ap- cedures that you can do yourself. Follow the etc., does not become caught by the fan,
pearance as long as possible. instructions and cautions for each of the vari- drive belts, or other moving parts.
Maintenance items as described in this own- ous procedures. l The fan may turn on automatically even if
er’s manual can be performed by the owner. the engine is not running. Turn the igni-
We recommend you to have the periodic in- tion switch to the “LOCK” position or put
spection and maintenance performed by a the operation mode in OFF to be safe
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service while you work in the engine compart-
ment.
Point or another specialist.
l Do not smoke, cause sparks or allow open
flames around fuel or battery. The fumes
are flammable.
l Be extremely cautious when working
around the battery. It contains poisonous
and corrosive sulphuric acid.
10 l Do not get under your vehicle with just
the body jack supporting it. Always use
A- Cooling fans automotive jack stands.
B- Caution label l Improper handling of components and
materials used in the vehicle can endanger
your personal safety. We recommend you
*: Front of the vehicle
to consult a specialist for necessary infor-
mation.
WARNING
l When checking or servicing the inside of Catalytic converter
the engine compartment, make sure the
E01000202642
engine is switched off and has had a
chance to cool down. The exhaust gas scavenging devices used
with the catalytic converter are extremely ef-
ficient for the reduction of noxious gases.
The catalytic converter is installed in the ex-
haust system.
10-02 Maintenance OGAE15E5
Bonnet
It is important to keep the engine properly LHD
tuned to ensure proper catalyst operation and
prevent possible catalyst damage.

WARNING
l As with any vehicle, do not park or oper-
ate this vehicle in areas where combusti-
ble materials such as dry grass or leaves
can come in contact with a hot exhaust
since a fire could occur.
l Paint should not be applied to the catalyt-
ic converter. RHD NOTE
l Only open the bonnet when the wipers are in
the parked position. In any other position,
NOTE the wipers could damage the paint or bonnet.
l Use fuel of the type recommended in “Fuel
selection” on page 2-02.
3. Support the bonnet by inserting the sup- 10
port bar in its slot.
Bonnet
E01000304201

2. Raise the bonnet while pressing the safe-


To open ty lock.
1. Pull the release lever towards you to un-
lock the bonnet.

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-03


Bonnet

CAUTION CAUTION NOTE


l Note that the support bar may disengage the l Be careful that hands or fingers are not trap- l For vehicles equipped with the security
bonnet if the open bonnet is lifted by a ped when closing the bonnet. alarm system, if you drive with the bonnet
strong wind. l Before driving, make sure that the bonnet is left open, warning display is displayed on
l After inserting the support bar into the slot, securely locked. An incompletely locked the information screen in the multi-informa-
make sure the bar supports the bonnet se- bonnet can suddenly open while driving. tion display.
curely from falling down on to your head or This can be extremely dangerous.
body. Type 1

To close NOTE
l If this does not close the bonnet, release it
1. Unlatch the support bar and clip it in its from a slightly higher position.
holder. l Do not press down the bonnet hard with a
2. Slowly lower the bonnet to a position hand as it may damage the bonnet.
about 20 cm above the closed position, Type 2
then let it drop.
10 3. Make sure the bonnet is securely locked
by softly lifting the centre of the bonnet.

10-04 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Engine oil

Engine oil Diesel-powered vehicles 1. Park the car on a horizontal surface.


2. Switch off the engine.
E01000404387
1600 models 3. Wait a few minutes.
MAX. MIN. 4. Remove the dipstick and wipe it with a
To check and refill engine oil clean cloth.
5. Reinsert the dipstick as far as it goes.
6. Remove the dipstick and read the oil lev-
Petrol-powered vehicles el, which should always be within the
1600 models range indicated.
7. If the oil level is below the specified
limit, remove the cap located on the cyl-
MAX. MIN. inder head cover and add enough oil to
raise the level to within the specified
2200 models range. Do not overfill to avoid engine
damage. Be sure to use the specified en-
gine oil and do not mix various types of
MAX. MIN. oil. 10
8. After adding oil, close the cap securely.
9. Confirm the oil level by repeating step 4
1800, 2000 models to 6.

MAX. MIN. CAUTION


l In diesel-powered vehicles, when burning
away and removing soot accumulated in the
The engine oil used has a significant effect DPF, fuel can mix with the engine oil and an
on the engine’s performance, service life and increase in the engine oil level may occur.
startability. Be sure to use oil of the recom- This does not indicate an abnormality.
mended quality and appropriate viscosity. However, if the engine oil level is at or over
All engines consume a certain amount of oil the “X” mark (B) on the engine oil dipstick
(A), change the engine oil.
during normal operation. Therefore, it is im-
portant to check the oil level at regular inter-
valk thes or before starting a long trip.

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-05


Engine oil

Recommended engine oil vis- NOTE


cosity l Use of additives is not recommended since
they may reduce the effectiveness of addi-
tives already included in the engine oil. It
Petrol-powered vehicles may result in failure of the mechanical as-
sembly.

Diesel-powered vehicles

NOTE
l The engine oil will deteriorate rapidly if the
vehicle is subjected to severe conditions, re-
quiring earlier oil replacement.
Please refer to the maintenance schedule.
10 l For information on how to dispose of used
engine oil, refer to page 2-06.
l Select engine oil of the proper SAE vis-
cosity number according to the atmos-
pheric temperature.
SAE 0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-30, and 5W-40 1600 models
engine oils can only be used if they meet
ACEA A3/B3, A3/B4 or A5/B5 and API l Use the following engine oil.
• Recommended engine oil:
SM (or higher) specifications.
“TOTAL QUARTZ INEO FIRST
l Use engine oil conforming to the follow- 0W-30”
ing classification:
“TOTAL ACTIVA INEO ECS
• API classification: “For service SM”
5W-30”
or higher
• ILSAC certificated oil 2200 models
• ACEA classification:
“For service A1/B1, A3/B3, A3/B4, or l Select engine oil of the proper SAE vis-
A5/B5” cosity number according to the atmos-
pheric temperature.

10-06 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Engine coolant
l Use engine oil conforming to the follow- The coolant level in this tank should be kept To add coolant
ing classification: between the “LOW” and “FULL” marks
• ACEA classification: when measured while the engine is cold. The cooling system is a closed system and
“For service C1, C2, C3 or C4” normally the loss of coolant should be very
• JASO classification: Except for diesel-powered vehicles 1600 models slight. A noticeable drop in the coolant level
“For service DL-1” could indicate leakage. If this occurs, we rec-
ommend you to have the system checked as
If those classifications are not available, soon as possible.
FULL
contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au- If the level should drop below the “LOW”
thorized Service Point. level on the reserve tank, open the lid and
LOW add coolant.
NOTE Also, if the reserve tank is completely empty,
remove the radiator cap (B) and add coolant
l Use of additives is not recommended since until the level reaches the filler neck.
they may reduce the effectiveness of addi-
tives already included in the engine oil. It
may result in failure of the mechanical as- WARNING
sembly.
l Do not open the radiator cap (B) while the
10
engine is hot. The coolant system is under
Engine coolant Diesel-powered vehicles 1600 models
pressure and any hot coolant escaping
could cause severe burns.
E01000503437

Anti-freeze
To check the coolant level FULL The engine coolant contains an ethylene gly-
A transparent coolant reserve tank (A) is lo- col anti-corrosion agent. Some parts of the
cated in the engine compartment. engine are cast aluminium alloy, and periodic
LOW
changing of the engine coolant is necessary
to prevent corrosion of these parts.

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-07


Washer fluid
Except for diesel-powered 1600 Because of the necessity of this anti-corro- During cold weather
models sion agent, the coolant must not be replaced
with plain water even in summer. The re- If the temperatures in your area drop below
Use “MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE
quired concentration of anti-freeze differs de- freezing, there is the danger that the coolant
SUPER LONG LIFE COOLANT PREMI-
pending on the expected ambient tempera- in the engine or radiator could freeze and
UM” or equivalent*.
ture. cause severe damage to the engine and/or ra-
*: similar high quality ethylene glycol based
diator. Add a sufficient amount of anti-freeze
non-silicate, non-amine, non-nitrate and non-
Above -35 °C: 50 % concentration of anti- to the coolant to prevent it from freezing.
borate coolant with long life hybrid organic
freeze The concentration should be checked before
acid technology.
Below -35 °C: 60 % concentration of anti- the start of cold weather and anti-freeze add-
freeze ed to the system if necessary.
MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE Coolant
has excellent protection against corrosion and
rust formation of all metals including alumi- CAUTION Washer fluid
nium and can avoid blockages in the radiator, l Do not use alcohol or methanol anti-freeze
E01000702227

heater, cylinder head, engine block, etc. or any engine coolants mixed with alcohol Open the washer fluid reservoir cap and
or methanol anti-freeze. The use of an im- check the level of washer fluid with the dip-
10 Diesel-powered 1600 models proper anti-freeze can cause corrosion of the stick.
aluminium components.
Use “ALTECO Freecor DSC, BASF Glysan- If the level is low, replenish the container
l Do not use water to adjust the concentration
with washer fluid.
tin Alu Protect Premium/G30 or G33, or Bru- of coolant.
garolas Bradol 497”. l Concentrations exceeding 60 % will result in
a reduction of both the anti-freeze and cool-
This coolant has excellent protection against ing performance thus adversely affecting the
engine.
corrosion and rust formation of all metals in-
cluding aluminium and can avoid clogs in the l Do not top up with water only.
Water by itself reduces the rust-protective
radiator, heater, cylinder head, engine block, and anti-freeze qualities of the coolant and FULL EMPTY
etc. has a lower boiling point. It can also cause
Because of the necessity of this anti-corro- damage to the cooling system if it should
sion agent, the coolant must not be replaced freeze. Do not use tapwater, as it can cause
with plain water even in summer. corrosion and rust formation.

10-08 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Brake fluid/Clutch fluid*

NOTE The fluid level is monitored by a float. When CAUTION


the fluid level falls below the “MIN” mark,
l The washer fluid container serves the wind- the brake fluid warning lamp lights up. l Use only the specified brake fluid.
screen, rear window and headlamps (if so Do not mix or add different brands of brake
The fluid level falls slightly with wear of the
equipped). fluid to prevent chemical reactions.
brake pads, but this does not indicate any ab- Do not let any petroleum-based fluid touch,
normality. mix with, or get into the brake fluid.
During cold weather This will damage the seals.
The fluid in the master cylinder should be l Keep the reservoir tank cap closed to pre-
To ensure proper operation of the washers at vent the brake fluid from deteriorating ex-
checked when doing other work under the
low temperatures, use a fluid containing an cept maintenance.
bonnet. The brake system should also be
anti-freezing agent. l Clean the filler cap before removing and
checked for leakage at the same time.
close the cap securely after maintenance.
If the fluid level falls markedly in a short
Brake fluid/Clutch fluid* length of time, it indicates leaks from the
E01000800631 brake system. Battery
The brake fluid and the clutch fluid share the If this occurs, we recommend you to have the E01001203574

reservoir tank. vehicle checked.


The condition of the battery is very important
Fluid type for quick starting and to keep the vehicle’s 10
To check the fluid level electrical system working properly. Regular
The fluid level must be between the “MAX” Use brake fluid conforming to DOT3 or inspection and care are especially important
and “MIN” marks on the reservoir. DOT4 from a sealed container. The brake in cold weather.
fluid is hygroscopic. Too much moisture in
the brake fluid will adversely affect the brake Type 1 Type 2
system, reducing the performance.

CAUTION
l Take care in handling brake fluid as it is
harmful to the eyes, may irritate your skin
and also damage painted surfaces.

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-09


Battery

NOTE Diesel-powered 1600 models NOTE


l After replacing the battery, the electronic l Except for diesel-powered 1600 models, to
control system data for the automatic trans- replenish with the distilled water, remove
mission, etc., will be erased. As a result, the upper cover and duct.
shift shocks may occur. Refer to “Removing and installing the upper
Shift shocks will become smoother after sev- cover and duct” on page 10-10.
eral changes in speed.

Removing and installing the


Checking battery electrolyte
upper cover and duct
level (Type 1 only) E01010700112

Except for diesel-powered vehicles 1600 models The electrolyte level must be between the
specified limit on the outside of the battery. WARNING
Replenish with distilled water as necessary. l Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK”
The inside of the battery is divided into sev- position or put the operation mode in
eral compartments; remove the cap from each OFF.
10 compartment and fill to the upper mark. Do Make sure that your clothes cannot be
not top up beyond the upper mark because caught by the fan or drive belt. Personal
spillage during driving could cause damage. injury could result.
Check the electrolyte level at least once every
4 weeks, depending on the operating condi-
tions.
If the battery is not used, it will discharge by
itself with time.
Check it once every 4 weeks and charge with
low current as necessary.

10-10 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Battery
To remove To install
1. Remove the clips (A), and then remove 1. Install the air duct (A), and then tighten
the upper cover (B). the clips (B).

NOTE
l Attach the moulding with the wide part to-
wards the front of the vehicle.

2. Turn the upper cover over. Squeeze the 4. Install the clips (E).
head of the moulding clip (C) with pliers 10
and remove the moulding.

2. Remove the clips (C), and then remove


the air duct (D).

3. Install the upper cover, and then attach


the moulding (D).

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-11


Battery

During cold weather NOTE WARNING


E01010900068
The capacity of the battery is reduced at low Petrol-powered vehicles l The battery electrolyte is extremely caus-
tic. Do not allow it to come in contact with
temperatures. This is an inevitable result of your eyes, skin, clothing, or the painted
its chemical and physical properties. surfaces of the vehicle.
This is why a very cold battery, particularly Spilt electrolyte should be flushed imme-
one that is not fully charged, will only deliver diately with ample amounts of water.
a fraction of the starter current which is nor- Irritation to eyes or skin from contact
mally available. with electrolyte requires immediate medi-
cal attention.
We recommend you to have the battery
checked before the start of cold weather and,
l Ventilate when charging or using the bat-
tery in an enclosed space.
if necessary, have it charged or replaced.
This does not only ensure reliable starting,
but a battery which is kept fully charged also Diesel-powered vehicles CAUTION
has a longer life.
l Keep it out of reach of children.
l Never disconnect the battery with the igni-
10 Disconnection and connection tion switch or the operation mode in ON.
E01011001223
Doing so could damage electric components.
To disconnect the battery cable, stop the en-
l Never short-circuit the battery. This could
gine, first disconnect the negative (-) terminal cause it to overheat and be damaged.
and then the positive (+) terminal. When con- l If the battery is to be quick-charged, first
necting the battery, first connect the positive disconnect the battery cables.
(+) terminal and then the negative (-) termi- l In order to prevent a short circuit, be sure to
nal. disconnect the negative (-) terminal first.
WARNING l Always wear protective eye goggles when
working near the battery.
NOTE l Keep sparks, cigarettes, and flames away
from the battery because the battery
l Open the terminal cover (A) before discon- could explode.
necting or connecting the positive (+) termi-
nal of the battery.
l Loosen the nut (B), and then disconnect the
battery cable from the positive (+) terminal.

10-12 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Tyres

CAUTION NOTE Tyres


l Do not bring the nearby parts, the plastic l Keep the terminals clean. After the battery is E01001300255

parts and so on into contact with sulphuric connected, apply terminal protection grease.
acid (battery electrolyte) which may crack, To clean the terminals, use lukewarm water. WARNING
stain or discolour them. l Check to see if the battery is securely instal-
l Driving with tyres that are worn, dam-
If they are in contact, wipe off with soft led and cannot be moved during travel. Also aged or improperly inflated can lead to a
cloth, chamois or the like and an aqueous check each terminal for tightness. loss of control or blow out of the tyres
solution of neutral detergent then immedi- l When the vehicle is to be left unused for a which can result in a collision with serious
ately rinse the affected parts with plenty of long period of time, remove the battery and or fatal injury.
water. store it in a place where the battery fluid will
not freeze. The battery should be stored only
in a fully charged condition.

Tyre inflation pressures


E01001404108

At trailer towing
Item Tyre size Front Rear 10
Front Rear
2.4 bar (35 psi) [240 kPa]*, 2.4 bar (35 psi) [240 kPa]*,
215/65R16 98H
2.6 bar (38 psi) [260 kPa] 2.6 bar (38 psi) [260 kPa]
215/70R16 100H 2.6 bar (38 psi) [260 kPa] 2.6 bar (38 psi) [260 kPa]
215/60R17 96H 2.2 bar (32 psi) [220 kPa] 2.2 bar (32 psi) [220 kPa]
Normal tyre
225/55R18 98V
2.2 bar (32 psi) [220 kPa] 2.2 bar (32 psi) [220 kPa]
225/55R18 98H
2.2 bar (32 psi) [220 kPa], 2.2 bar (32 psi) [220 kPa],
P225/55R18 97H
2.3 bar (33 psi) [230 kPa]* 2.3 bar (33 psi) [230 kPa]*
T155/90D16 4.2 bar (60 psi) [420 kPa] —
Temporary spare tyre
215/65R16 2.4 bar (35 psi) [240 kPa] —
*: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-13


Tyres
Check the tyre inflation pressure of all the tyres while they are cold; if insufficient or excessive, adjust to the specified value.
After the tyre inflation pressure has been adjusted, check the tyres for damage and air leaks. Be sure to put caps on the valves.

Wheel condition Tread wear indicators will appear on the sur- Replacing tyres and wheels
E01001800885
face of the tyre as the tyre wears, thereby in- E01007201514
dicating that the tyre no longer meets the
minimum requirement for use. When these
wear indicators appear, the tyres must be re- CAUTION
placed with new ones. l Avoid using different size tyres from the one
On 4-wheel drive vehicles, when replacement listed and the combined use of different
of any of the tyres is necessary, replace all of types of tyres, as this can affect driving safe-
ty.
them.
Refer to “Tyres and wheels” on page
11-13.
CAUTION l Even if a wheel has the same rim size and
offset as the specified type of wheel, its
l Always use tyres of the same size, same shape may prevent it from being fitted cor-
type, and same brand, and which have no
10 1- Location of the tread wear indicator
wear differences.
rectly. We recommend you to consult a spe-
cialist before using wheels that you have.
2- Tread wear indicator
Using tyres of different size, type, brands or
l As your vehicle is equipped with a tyre pres-
degree of wear, will increase the differential sure monitoring system, only MITSUBISHI
Check the tyres for cuts, cracks and other oil temperature, resulting in possible damage MOTORS genuine wheels should be used.
damage. Replace the tyres if there are deep to the driving system. Further, the drive train Use of another type of wheel risks air leaks
cuts or cracks. Also check each tyre for will be subjected to excessive loading, possi- and sensor damage, as it will not be possible
pieces of metal or pebbles. bly leading to oil leakage, component seiz- to install the tyre inflation pressure sensors
The use of worn tyres can be very dangerous ure, or other serious faults. properly.
because of the greater chance of skidding or Refer to “Tyre pressure monitoring system
hydroplaning. The tread depth of the tyres (TPMS)*” on page 6-59.
must exceed 1.6 mm in order for the tyres to
meet the minimum requirement for use.

10-14 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Tyres

Tyre rotation When rotating tyres, check for uneven wear CAUTION
E01001901317
and damage. Abnormal wear is usually
Tyre wear varies with vehicle conditions, caused by incorrect tyre pressure, improper l A temporary spare tyre can be fitted tempo-
rarily in place of a tyre that has been re-
road surface conditions and individual driv- wheel alignment, out of balance wheel, or se-
moved during the tyre rotation. However, it
er’s driving habits. To equalize the wear and vere braking. We recommend you to have it must not be included in the regular tyre rota-
help extend tyre life, it is recommended to ro- checked to determine the cause of irregular tion sequence.
tate the tyres immediately after discovery of tread wear. l If the tyres have arrows (A) indicating the
abnormal wear, or whenever the wear differ- correct direction of rotation, swap the front
ence between the front and rear tyres is rec- and rear tyres on the left-hand side of the ve-
Spare tyre used
hicle and the front and rear tyres on the
ognizable. right-hand side of the vehicle separately.
Keep each tyre on its original side of the ve-
Front hicle. When fitting the tyres, make sure the
arrows point in the direction in which the
wheels will turn when the vehicle moves
forward. Any tyre whose arrow points in the
Spare tyre not used wrong direction will not perform to its full
potential.
10
Front

Front

Tyres that have arrows showing rotation direction

Front

*- If the spare tyre wheel differs from the


standard tyre wheel, do not perform tyre rota-
tion using a spare wheel.

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-15


Tyres

CAUTION NOTE Tyre size Wheel size


Max. chain
height [mm]
l Avoid the combined use of different types of l The laws and regulations concerning snow
tyres. tyres (driving speed, required use, type, etc.) 215/70R16
Using different types of tyres can affect ve- vary. Find out and follow the laws and regu- 16 x 6 1/2 J
215/65R16
hicle performance and safety. lations in the area you intend to drive. 9 mm
l If flange nuts are used on your vehicle, 215/60R17 17 x 6 1/2 J
change to tapered nuts when steel wheels are
Snow tyres used.
225/55R18* 18 x 7 J
E01002001852 *: Except for vehicles for Russia, Kazakh-
The use of snow tyres is recommended for stan and Ukraine
driving on snow and ice. To preserve driving Tyre chains
stability, mount snow tyres of the same size E01002103121

and tread pattern on all 4 wheels. If tyre chains have to be used, ensure that CAUTION
A snow tyre that is worn down more than they are fitted only on the drive wheels
(front) in accordance with the manufacturer’s l For vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Uk-
50% is no longer appropriate to use. raine that are equipped with the 18 inch tyre,
Snow tyres which do not meet specifications instructions. chains cannot be used. There is an insuffi-
must not be used. On 4WD vehicles in which the driving power cient gap between the chains and the body,
10 is distributed preferentially to the front so the vehicle could be damaged.
wheels, ensure that the tyre chains are fitted
CAUTION on the front. When driving with tyre chains on the tyres,
l Observe permissible maximum speed for Use only tyre chains which are designed for do not drive faster than 50 km/h (30 mph).
your snow tyres and the legal speed limit. use with the tyres mounted on the vehicle: When you reach roads that are not covered in
l As your vehicle is equipped with a tyre pres- use of the incorrect size or type of chain snow, immediately remove the tyre chains.
sure monitoring system, only MITSUBISHI could result in damage to the vehicle body.
MOTORS genuine wheels should be used.
Contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
Use of another type of wheel risks air leaks
ized Service Point before putting on tyre CAUTION
and sensor damage, as it will not be possible
to install the tyre inflation pressure sensors chains. The max. chain height is as follows. l Practice fitting the chains before you need
properly. them. Don’t expect help from other people
Refer to “Tyre pressure monitoring system in the cold.
(TPMS)*” on page 6-59. l Choose a clear straight stretch of road where
you can pull over and still be seen while you
are fitting the chains.

10-16 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Wiper blade rubber replacement

CAUTION NOTE NOTE


l Do not fit chains before you need them. This l The laws and regulations concerning the use l Do not let the wiper arm drop onto the wind-
will wear out your tyres and the road sur- of tyre chains vary. Always follow local screen. This could damage the glass.
face. laws and regulations.
l After driving around 100-300 metres, stop In most countries, it is prohibited by law to
3. Attach the retainers (C) to a new wiper
and retighten the chains. use tyre chains on roads without snow.
l Drive cautiously and do not exceed 50 km/h blade.
(30 mph). Refer to the illustration to ensure that the
Remember that preventing accidents is not Wiper blade rubber retainers are correctly aligned as you at-
the purpose of tyre chains. tach them.
l When tyre chains are installed, take care that replacement
they do not damage the disc wheel or body. E01002600327

l Do not install a tyre chain on an emergency


wheel which is compact in size. If one of the
front wheels has punctured, replace it with Windscreen wiper blades
one of the rear wheels and install the tempo-
rary spare wheel in that place before fitting a 1. Lift the wiper arm off the windscreen.
tyre chain. 2. Pull the wiper blade until its stopper (A)
l An aluminium wheel can be damaged by a disengages from the hook (B). Pull the 10
tyre chain while driving. When fitting a tyre wiper blade further to remove it.
chain on an aluminium wheel, take care that
any part of the chain and fitting cannot be
brought into contact with the wheel.
l Remove the wheel covers before installing a
tyre chain, otherwise they may be damaged
by the tyre chain. (See page 8-19.)
l When installing or removing the tyre chain,
take care that hands and other parts of your
body are not injured by the sharp edges of
the vehicle body. 4. Insert the wiper blade into the arm, start-
ing with the opposite end of the blade
from the stopper. Make sure the hook
(B) is fitted correctly in the grooves in
the blade.

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-17


Wiper blade rubber replacement

NOTE Refer to the illustration to ensure that the


retainers are correctly aligned as you in-
l If a retainer is not supplied with the new sert them into the groove.
wiper blade, use the retainer from the old
blade.

5. Push the wiper blade until the hook (B)


engages securely with the stopper (A).

NOTE
l Do not allow the wiper arm to fall onto the
window glass; it could damage the glass.

4. Firmly insert the retainer (C) into the


10 groove (D) in the wiper blade.

Rear window wiper blades NOTE


1. Lift the wiper arm off the window glass. l If a retainer is not supplied with the new
wiper blade, use the retainer from the old
2. Pull the wiper blade downward to disen- blade.
gage it from the stopper (A) at the end of
the wiper arm. Pull the wiper blade fur-
ther to remove it.
3. Slide a new wiper blade through the
hook (B) on the wiper arm.

10-18 Maintenance OGAE15E5


General maintenance

General maintenance If the fuses and bulbs are all OK, we recom- Weatherstripping
mend you to have your vehicle checked and
E01002700520
repaired. To prevent freezing of the weatherstripping
on the doors, bonnet, etc., they should be
Fuel, engine coolant, oil and ex- Meter, gauge and indicator/ treated with silicone grease.
haust gas leakage warning lamps operation
Additional equipment
Look under the body of your vehicle to check Start the engine and check the operation of
for fuel, engine coolant, oil and exhaust gas all instruments, gauges and indication and It is a good idea to carry a shovel or a short-
leaks. warning lamps. handled spade in the vehicle during the win-
If there is anything wrong, we recommend ter so that you can clear away snow if you get
you to have your vehicle inspected. stranded. A small hand-brush for sweeping
WARNING snow off the vehicle and a plastic scraper for
l If you see a suspicious fuel leak or if you Hinges and latches lubrication the windscreen and rear window are also use-
smell fuel, do not operate the vehicle; call ful.
your MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
Check all latches and hinges, and, if necessa-
ized Service Point for assistance.
ry, have them lubricated. Fusible links 10
Exterior and interior lamp op- For cold and snowy weather
E01002900564

eration E01002800361
The fusible links will melt to prevent a fire if
a large current attempts to flow through cer-
Operate the combination lamp switch to tain electrical systems.
check that all lamps are functioning properly. Ventilation slots In case of a melted fusible link, we recom-
If the lamps do not illuminate, the probable mend you to have your vehicle inspected.
cause is a blown fuse or defective lamp bulb. The ventilation slots in front of the wind- For the fusible links, please refer to “Fuse
Check the fuses first. If there is no blown screen should be kept clear of leaves or load capacity” on page 10-22.
fuse, check the lamp bulbs. brushed clear after heavy snowfall, so that
For information regarding the inspection and the operation of the heating and ventilation
replacement of the fuses and the lamp bulbs, systems will not be impaired.
refer to “Fuses” on page 10-20 and “Re-
placement of lamp bulbs” on page 10-26.

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-19


Fuses

WARNING Passenger compartment (LHD 1. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screw-
vehicles) driver into the notch of the fuse lid and
l Fusible links must not be replaced by any pry gently to remove it.
other device. Failing to fit the correct fusi- The fuse blocks in the passenger compart-
ble link may result in fire in the vehicle, ment are located behind the fuse lid in front
property destruction and serious or fatal of the driver’s seat at the position shown in
injuries at any time. the illustration.

Fuses
E01003002250

Fuse block location


To prevent damage to the electrical system
due to shortcircuiting or overloading, each in-
2. To put back the fuse lid, line up the fuse
dividual circuit is provided with a fuse.
lid hook (A) with the clamp (B) on the
10 There are fuse blocks in the passenger com-
instrument panel and push the lid back
partment and in the engine compartment. A- Main fuse block
in.
B- Sub fuse block

10-20 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Fuses
Passenger compartment (RHD 2. Move the rod (A) on the left side of the 4. Remove the glove box fastener, and then
vehicles) glove box to the left side of the box. remove the glove box.
The fuse boxes in the passenger compartment
are located behind the glove box at the posi-
tion shown in the illustration.

3. While pressing the side of the glove box, Sub fuse block
unhook the left and right hooks (B) and
lower the glove box. 1. Remove the cover from the bottom of
A- Main fuse block the glove box. 10
B- Sub fuse block

Main fuse block


1. Open the glove box.

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-21


Fuses
Engine compartment Passenger compartment fuse lo- Passenger compartment fuse location (RHD)

In the engine compartment, the fuse block is


cation table
Main fuse block
located as shown in the illustration. NOTE
l Spare fuses are provided on the lid of the
fuse block in the engine compartment. Al-
ways use a fuse of the same capacity for re-
placement.

Passenger compartment fuse location (LHD)

Main fuse block Sub fuse block Sub fuse block

1- Push the knob.


2- Remove the cover.
10
Fuse load capacity
E01007701870
The fuse capacity and the names of electrical
systems protected by the fuses are indicated Ca-
Sym- Electrical sys-
on the inside of the fuse lid (LHD vehicles), No. paci-
bol tem
the inside of the glove box (RHD vehicles) ties
and inside of the fuse block cover (inside of
1 Heater 30 A*
the engine compartment).
Stop lamps
2 15 A
(Brake lamps)
3 Rear fog lamp 10 A
*: Fusible link

10-22 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Fuses

Ca- Ca- l The table above shows the main equip-


Sym- Electrical sys- Sym- Electrical sys- ment corresponding to each fuse.
No. paci- No. paci-
bol tem bol tem
ties ties
Engine compartment fuse loca-
4
Windscreen
30 A 16
Outside rear-
10 A tion table
wipers view mirrors
Engine compartment fuse location
5 Option 10 A 4-wheel drive
17 10 A
system
6 Door locks 20 A
Reversing lamps
18 7.5 A
7 Radio 15 A (Backup lamps)
Control unit re- Accessory sock-
8 7.5 A 19 15 A
lay et
Interior lamps Electric window
9 15 A 20 30 A*
(Room lamps) control
Rear window
10
Hazard warning
flasher
15 A 21
demister
30 A* 10
Behind of the fuse block cover

Rear window Heated door


11 15 A 22 7.5 A
wiper mirror

12 Instruments 7.5 A Passenger’s


23 25 (20) A
power seat
Cigarette lighter/
Driver’s power
13 Accessory sock- 15 A 24 25 (20) A
seat
et
25 Heated seat 30 A Ca-
14 Ignition switch 10 A Sym- Electrical sys-
*: Fusible link No. paci-
15 Sunroof 20 A bol tem
ties
*: l Some fuses may not be installed on your
Fusible link vehicle, depending on the vehicle model 1 Front fog lamps 15 A
or specifications. *: Fusible link

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-23


Fuses

Ca- Ca- Ca-


Sym- Electrical sys- Sym- Electrical sys- Sym- Electrical sys-
No. paci- No. paci- No. paci-
bol tem bol tem bol tem
ties ties ties
2 Engine 7.5 A Headlamp high- ENG/POWER 20 A
15 10 A
beam (right) 22
Automatic trans- Fuel line heater 25 A
3 20 A Head-
mission
lamp 23 Fuel pump 15 A
4 Horn 10 A Dis-
16 low 20 A
charge
5 Alternator 7.5 A
beam 24 Starter 30 A*
(left)
25 — — —
Headlamp wash- Head-
6 20 A
er Anti-lock brake
lamp 26 40 A*
Dis- system
7 Air conditioning 10 A 17 low 20 A
charge
beam Anti-lock brake
ETV/Oil cooler 27 30 A*
(right) system
10 8
fan
15 A Head- Air conditioning
(Twin Clutch
SST) lamp 28 condenser fan 30 A*
Halo-
18 low 10 A motor
9 Security horn 20 A gen
beam Radiator fan mo-
(left) 29 40 A*
10 Wiper de-icer 15 A tor
Head- 30 IOD IOD 30 A
11 — — — lamp
Halo- Audio system
12 Electric tailgate 30 A 19 low 10 A 31 30 A
gen amp
beam
Daytime running (right)
13 10 A 32 Diesel 30 A
lamps
20 ENG/POWER 10 A 33 — Spare fuse 10 A
Headlamp high-
14 10 A
beam (left) 21 Ignition coil 10 A 34 — Spare fuse 15 A
*: Fusible link *: *:
Fusible link Fusible link

10-24 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Fuses

Ca- Capacity Colour


Sym- Electrical sys-
No. paci-
bol tem Green (fuse type)/Pink
ties 30 A
(fusible link type)
35 — Spare fuse 20 A
40 A Green (fusible link type)
*: Fusible link
Fuse replacement
l Some fuses may not be installed on your E01007800630
vehicle, depending on the vehicle model 1. Before replacing a fuse, always turn off
or specifications. the electrical circuit concerned and turn
l The table above shows the main equip- the ignition switch to the “LOCK” posi- B- Fuse is OK
ment corresponding to each fuse. tion or put the operation mode in OFF. C- Blown fuse
2. Remove the fuse puller (A) from the in-
The fuse box does not contain spare 7.5 A, side of the fuse box in the engine com- NOTE
25 A or 30 A fuses. If one of these fuses partment.
burns out, substitute with the following fuse. l If any system does not function but the fuse
corresponding to that system is normal, there
7.5 A: 10 A spare fuse
25 A: 20 A spare fuse
may be a fault in the system elsewhere. We
recommend you to have your vehicle
10
30 A: 30 A audio system amp fuse checked.
When using a substitute fuse, replace with a
fuse of the correct capacity as soon as possi-
4. Use the fuse puller to insert a new fuse
ble.
with the same capacity. Make sure you
Identification of fuse insert the fuse into the same location in
the fuse block.
Capacity Colour
7.5 A Brown
3. Referring to the fuse load capacity table,
10 A Red check the fuse pertaining to the problem.
15 A Blue
20 A Yellow
25 A Natural (White)

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-25


Replacement of lamp bulbs

CAUTION Outside
E01003304231
l Bulbs are extremely hot immediately after
being turned off.
When replacing a bulb, wait for it to cool Front
sufficiently before touching it. You could
otherwise be burnt.

NOTE
l If you are unsure of how to carry out the
work as required, we recommend you to
CAUTION consult a specialist.
l Be careful not to scratch the vehicle body
l If the newly inserted fuse blows again after a when removing a lamp or lens.
short time, we recommend you to have the
electrical system checked to find the cause l When it rains or when the vehicle has been
washed, the inside of the lens sometimes be- 1- Front turn-signal lamps: 21 W
and rectify it. comes foggy. This is the same phenomenon (WY21W)
10 l Never use a fuse with a larger capacity than
specified or a substitute (such as a cable or
as when window glass mists up on a humid 2- Headlamps, high-beam: 60 W (HB3)
day, and does not indicate a functional prob-
foil). Doing so could cause the circuit wires 3- Type 1
lem.
to overheat and create a fire. When the lamp is switched on, the heat will Front fog lamps: 35 W (H8)
remove the fog. However, if water gathers Daytime running lamps (type 1)*1:
inside the lamp, we recommend you to have 13 W (P13W)
Replacement of lamp bulbs the lamp checked. Type 2
E01003100488
Front fog lamps: 55 W (H11)
Before replacing a bulb, ensure the lamp is Bulb capacity 4- Daytime running lamps (type 2)*1
off. Do not touch the glass part of the new E01003200290 Position lamps (type 2)*1
bulb with your bare fingers; the skin oil left When replacing a bulb, use a new bulb with 5- Headlamps, low beam
on the glass will evaporate when the bulb the same wattage and colour. Halogen: 55 W (H11)
gets hot and the vapour will condense on the High intensity discharge*2: 35 W
reflector and dim the surface. 6- Position lamps (type 1)*1: 5 W (W5W)
7- Side turn-signal lamps (on fender)*1,*2:
5W

10-26 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Replacement of lamp bulbs
8- Side turn-signal lamps (on outside rear- NOTE NOTE
view mirror)*1
l For the side turn-signal lamp (on fender), it l An LED, not a bulb, is used in the stop
*1: if so equipped is not possible to repair or replace just the lamp/tail lamp and high-mounted stop lamp.
bulb. Contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
*2: Have the lamps bulbs replaced at a Contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author- ized Service Point when there is a need for
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author- ized Service Point when there is a need for repair or replacement.
ized Service Point. repair or replacement.

Codes in parentheses indicate bulb Inside


types. Rear E01003402094

WARNING
l Always consult a specialist when repair-
ing or replacing the bulbs of high intensi-
ty discharge headlamps.
This is because the power circuit, bulbs
and electrodes generate a high voltage
that could cause an electric shock.
10

NOTE 9- High-mounted stop lamp


1- Room lamp (rear)*: 8 W
l An LED, not a bulb, is used in the side turn- 10- Licence plate lamps: 5 W (W5W)
2- Vanity mirror lamps*: 2 W or 3 W
signal lamp (on outside rear-view mirror, 11- Rear fog lamp: 21 W (W21W)
daytime running lamp (type 2), and position
3- Room lamp (front) & map lamps: 8 W
12- Reversing lamps: 16 W (W16W)
lamp (type 2)). 4- Luggage room lamp: 5 W
13- Rear turn-signal lamps: 21 W (W21W)
Contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author- 5- Glove box lamp: 1.4 W
14- Stop and tail lamps
ized Service Point when there is a need for
repair or replacement. *: if so equipped
Codes in parentheses indicate bulb types.

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-27


Replacement of lamp bulbs

Headlamps (low beam, except 4. Turn the cap (D) anticlockwise to re-
for vehicles with high intensity move it.
discharge headlamps)
E01009301522
1. When replacing the bulb on the left side
of the vehicle in the case of diesel-pow-
ered vehicles, remove the bolt (A) hold-
ing down the relay box and move the re-
lay box towards the rear of the vehicle.

*: Front of the vehicle

3. When replacing the bulb on the right


side of the vehicle in the case of diesel- *: Front of the vehicle
powered vehicles, remove the clips (C)
10 by prying with a straight blade (or mi- 5. Turn the bulb (E) anticlockwise to re-
nus) screwdriver, and remove the side move it.
cover.

*: Front of the vehicle

2. When replacing the bulb on the right


side of the vehicle in the case of diesel-
powered vehicles (1600 models only),
remove the bolts (B), and then move the
reserve tank.

*: Front of the vehicle


*: Front of the vehicle
10-28 Maintenance OGAE15E5
Replacement of lamp bulbs
6. While holding down the tab (F), pull out Headlamps (High-beam)
the socket (G). E01009400135
1. When replacing the bulb on the left side
of the vehicle in the case of diesel-pow-
ered vehicles, remove the bolt (A) hold-
ing down the relay box and move the re-
lay box towards the rear of the vehicle.

Headlamps (low beam, for ve-


hicles with high intensity dis-
charge headlamps)
7. To install the bulb, perform the removal E01010100132

steps in reverse. Do not attempt to disassemble or repair head-


lamps, and do not attempt to replace their 10
bulbs.
CAUTION *: Front of the vehicle
l Handle halogen lamp bulbs with care. The
WARNING
gas inside halogen lamp bulbs is highly pres-
surized, so dropping, knocking, or scratching l A high voltage is present in the power cir-
a halogen lamp bulb can cause it to shatter. cuit and in the bulbs and bulb terminals.
l Never hold the halogen lamp bulb with a To avoid the risk of an electric shock, con-
bare hand, dirty glove, etc. tact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
The oil from your hand could cause the bulb ized Service Point whenever repair or re-
to break the next time the headlamps are op- placement is necessary.
erated.
If the glass surface is dirty, it must be
cleaned with alcohol, paint thinner, etc., and
refit it after drying it thoroughly.

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-29


Replacement of lamp bulbs
2. Turn the cap (B) anticlockwise to re- 4. While holding down the tab (D), pull out
move it. the socket (E).

Position lamps (type 1)*


E01003702316
*: Front of the vehicle 1. When replacing the bulb on the left side
5. To install the bulb, perform the removal of the vehicle in the case of diesel-pow-
3. Turn the bulb (C) anticlockwise to re- steps in reverse. ered vehicles, remove the bolt (A) hold-
move it. ing down the relay box and move the re-
10
CAUTION lay box towards the rear of the vehicle.

l Handle halogen lamp bulbs with care. The


gas inside halogen lamp bulbs is highly pres-
surized, so dropping, knocking, or scratching
a halogen lamp bulb can cause it to shatter.
l Never hold the halogen lamp bulb with a
bare hand, dirty glove, etc.
The oil from your hand could cause the bulb
to break the next time the headlamps are op-
erated.
If the glass surface is dirty, it must be
*: Front of the vehicle cleaned with alcohol, paint thinner, etc., and
refit it after drying it thoroughly.
*: Front of the vehicle

10-30 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Replacement of lamp bulbs
2. When replacing the bulb on the right 4. Pull the bulb out of the socket. 2. Remove the entire socket and bulb as-
side of the vehicle in the case of diesel- sembly (A) by turning it anticlockwise.
powered vehicles, remove the clips (B)
by prying with a straight blade (or mi-
nus) screwdriver, and remove the side
cover.

5. To install the bulb, perform the removal *: Front of the vehicle


steps in reverse.
3. Remove the bulb by pulling it out.
Front turn-signal lamps 10
*: Front of the vehicle E01003800922
To remove
3. Turn the socket (C) anticlockwise to re- 1. Remove the upper cover.
move it. For information regarding how to re-
move the upper cover, refer to “Remov-
ing and installing the upper cover and
duct” on page 10-10.

To install
1. To install the bulb, perform the removal
steps in reverse.

*: Front of the vehicle

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-31


Replacement of lamp bulbs
2. Install the upper cover. Front fog lamps*
For information regarding how to install E01004002941
the upper cover, refer to “Removing and 1. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screw-
installing the upper cover and duct” on driver with a cloth over its tip into the
page 10-10. fog lamp cover (A) and pry gently to re-
move it.
Side turn-signal lamps (on
fender)* Type 1
E01003900516

NOTE
NOTE
l For the side turn-signal lamps (on fender), it
is not possible to repair or replace just the l Except for vehicles equipped with daytime
bulb. running lamps, when unfastening the screws,
Contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author- be careful not to move the beam position ad-
ized Service Point when there is a need for justment screw (C).
10 repair or replacement.

Side turn-signal lamps (on out- Type 2


side rear-view mirror)*
E01003900529

NOTE
l An LED, not a bulb, is used in the side turn-
signal lamps (on outside rear-view mirror).
Contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
ized Service Point when there is a need for
repair or replacement.

2. Remove the screws (B), and remove the


lamp unit.

10-32 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Replacement of lamp bulbs
3. While holding down the tab (D), pull out CAUTION Daytime running lamps (type
the socket (E). 2)*/Position lamps (type 2)*
l Handle halogen lamp bulbs with care. The
gas inside halogen lamp bulbs is highly pres- E01012000021

surized, so dropping, knocking, or scratching


a halogen lamp bulb can cause it to shatter.
NOTE
l Never hold the halogen lamp bulb with a
bare hand, dirty glove, etc. l An LED, not a bulb, is used in the daytime
The oil from your hand could cause the bulb running lamp (type 2) / position lamp (type
to break the next time the fog lamps are op- 2). Contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au-
erated. thorized Service Point when there is a need
If the glass surface is dirty, it must be for repair or replacement.
cleaned with alcohol, paint thinner, etc., and
refit it after drying it thoroughly.
Daytime running lamps (type
4. Turn the bulb (F) anticlockwise to re- 1)*
move it. E01011201137
1. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screw-
driver with a cloth over its tip into the 10
daytime running lamp cover (A) and pry
gently to remove it.

5. To install the bulb, perform the removal


steps in reverse.

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-33


Replacement of lamp bulbs
2. Remove the screws (B), and then re- 4. While holding down the tab (D), pull out 2. Remove the socket (B) and bulb assem-
move the lamp unit. the socket (E). bly by turning it anticlockwise.

3. Turn the bulb (C) anticlockwise to re- 5. To install the bulb, perform the removal 3. Remove the bulb by pulling it out.
move it. steps in reverse.
10 Rear fog lamp
E01004101596
1. When removing the lamp unit (A), push
it towards the left side of the vehicle
body.

4. To install the bulb, perform the removal


steps in reverse.

10-34 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Replacement of lamp bulbs

NOTE Rear combination lamps NOTE


E01004201366
l If the wiring harness is pulled off the 2 har- 1. Remove the screws (A) that hold the l An LED, not a bulb, is used in the stop
ness guides on the lamp unit while replacing lamp/tail lamp.
the bulb, make sure to secure the wiring har- lamp unit and remove the lamp unit. Contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
ness to the harness guides. ized Service Point when there is a need for
l When installing the lamp unit, first insert the repair or replacement.
tab (C) into the groove (D) on the body, and
then push on the lamp unit to fit it into place.
3. Pull the bulb out of the socket.

2. Turn the socket and bulb assembly anti-


clockwise to remove it.
10

4. To install the bulb, perform the removal


steps in reverse.

NOTE
l When mounting the lamp unit, align the
groove (D) on the lamp unit with the clip on
the body and the pin (E) on the unit with the
hole in the body.
B- Stop and tail lamp (LED) - cannot be
replaced
C- Rear turn-signal lamp

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-35


Replacement of lamp bulbs

NOTE 5. To install the bulb, perform the removal


steps in reverse.
l Wrap a piece of cloth around the tip of the
screwdriver in order to avoid scratching the
cover. NOTE
l When installing the lid, align the tab on the
3. Remove the socket and bulb assembly lid with the hole on the vehicle side.
by turning it anticlockwise.

Reversing lamps
E01004401430
1. Open the tailgate.
2. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screw-
driver into the notch of the cover and pry
gently to remove the cover.
10

4. Remove the bulb by pulling it out.

10-36 Maintenance OGAE15E5


Replacement of lamp bulbs

Licence plate lamps 3. Remove the bulb by pulling it out. High-mounted stop lamp
E01004602093 E01004500593
1. When removing the lamp unit (A), push
it towards the left side of the vehicle NOTE
body.
l An LED, not a bulb, is used in the high-
mounted stop lamp.
Contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
ized Service Point when there is a need for
repair or replacement.

4. To install the bulb, perform the removal


steps in reverse.

NOTE 10
2. Remove the socket (B) and bulb assem-
bly by turning it anticlockwise. l When installing the lamp, insert tab (C) first
then align and insert tab (D).

OGAE15E5 Maintenance 10-37


OGAE15E5
Specifications

Vehicle labeling................................................................................ 11-02


Vehicle dimensions........................................................................... 11-05
Vehicle performance......................................................................... 11-07
Vehicle weight.................................................................................. 11-08
Engine specifications........................................................................ 11-11
Electrical system............................................................................... 11-12
Tyres and wheels...............................................................................11-13
Fuel consumption..............................................................................11-13
Refill capacities.................................................................................11-16

11

OGAE15E5
Vehicle labeling

Vehicle labeling Vehicle information code la- Please use this number when ordering re-
bel* placement parts.
E01100104747

The vehicle information code label is located


Vehicle identification number as shown in the illustration.
The vehicle identification number is stamped
on the bulkhead as shown in the illustration.

1- Model code
2- Engine model code
3- Exterior code
4- Transmission model code
The label shows model code, engine model,
5- Body colour code,
11 transmission model and body colour code,
Interior code,
etc.
Option code
6- Chassis number
7- Maximum gross vehicle weight
8- Gross combination weight
9- Maximum axle weight (Front)
10- Maximum axle weight (Rear)

11-02 Specifications OGAE15E5


Vehicle labeling

Vehicle information code Please use this number when ordering re- Vehicle identification number
plate* placement parts. plate (RHD vehicles only)
The vehicle information code plate is riveted The vehicle identification number is stamped
as shown in the illustration. on the plate riveted to the left front corner of
the vehicle body. It is visible from outside of
the vehicle through the windscreen.

1- Model code
2- Engine model code
3- Transmission model code
4- Body colour code
The plate shows model code, engine model, 5- Interior code
6- Option code
transmission model and body colour code, 11
etc. 7- Exterior code Engine number
The engine number is stamped on the engine
cylinder block as shown in the illustrations.

OGAE15E5 Specifications 11-03


Vehicle labeling
Petrol-powered vehicles Diesel-powered vehicles
1600 models 1600 models

*: Front of the vehicle

1800 models, 2000 models


*: Front of the vehicle

2200 models

11

*: Front of the vehicle

*: Front of the vehicle

11-04 Specifications OGAE15E5


Vehicle dimensions

Vehicle dimensions
E01100204474

Except for vehicles equipped with wheel lip molding

Vehicles equipped with wheel lip molding

11

NOTE
l The overall width varies depending on whether the vehicle is equipped with wheel lip moldings.
To determine whether your vehicle is equipped with wheel lip moldings, refer to “Exterior” on page 1-12.

OGAE15E5 Specifications 11-05


Vehicle dimensions
Item Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan Except for vehicles for Russia,
and Ukraine Kazakhstan and Ukraine
Vehicles with Vehicles with
Vehicles with Vehicles with
16 or 17 inch 16 or 17 inch
18 inch tyre 18 inch tyre
tyre tyre
1 Front track 1,525 mm 1,545 mm
Without wheel lip molding 1,770 mm —
2 Overall width
With wheel lip molding — 1,810 mm
3 Front overhang 870 mm
4 Wheel base 2,670 mm
5 Rear Overhang 755 mm
6 Overall length 4,295 mm
180 mm,
Petrol-powered vehicles 195 mm 215 mm 190 mm
Ground clearance (unla- 190 mm*
11 7
den) 170 mm,
Diesel-powered vehicles — — 180 mm
180 mm*
1,615 mm,
8 Without roof rails 1,615 mm 1,630 mm 1,625 mm
1,625 mm*
Overall height (unladen)
1,625 mm,
9 With roof rails 1,625 mm 1,640 mm 1,635 mm
1,635 mm*
10 Rear track 1,530 mm 1,525 mm 1,530 mm 1,545 mm
Body 5.63 m
Minimum turning radius
Wheel 5.3 m
*: 215/70R16 size tyre

11-06 Specifications OGAE15E5


Vehicle performance

Vehicle performance
E01100303902

Petrol-powered vehicles
1600 models 183 km/h (114 mph)
1800 models 189 km/h (116 mph)
Maximum speed
2WD 194 km/h (121 mph)
2000 models
4WD 191 km/h (119 mph)
Diesel-powered vehicles
2WD 182 km/h (113 mph)
1600 models
Maximum speed 4WD 180 km/h (112 mph)
2200 models 190 km/h (118 mph)

11

OGAE15E5 Specifications 11-07


Vehicle weight

Vehicle weight
E01100407581

Petrol-powered vehicles
1600 models 1800 models
M/T CVT
Item
INTENSE
INFORM INVITE INVITE INTENSE
INSTYLE
Without optional 1,260 kg,
1,260 kg 1,285 kg 1,385 kg 1,390 kg
parts 1,300 kg*1
Kerb weight
With full optional 1,290 kg,
1,290 kg 1,346 kg 1,398 kg 1,452 kg
parts 1,315 kg*1
Maximum gross vehicle weight 1,870 kg, 1,825 kg*2 1,970 kg, 2,035 kg*2

Maximum axle Front 930 kg 1,030 kg


11 weight Rear 1,000 kg, 1,070 kg*2 1,000 kg, 1,085 kg*2

Maximum towable With brake 1,200 kg 1,300 kg


weight Without brake 665 kg, 670 kg*1 715 kg
Maximum trailer-nose weight 60 kg 65 kg
Maximum roof load 80 kg
Seating capacity 5 persons
*1: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine
*2: In case of trailer towing

11-08 Specifications OGAE15E5


Vehicle weight

NOTE
l Trailer specifications indicate the manufacturer’s recommendation.

2000 models
2WD 4WD
Item
M/T CVT
INTENSE INVITE INTENSE
Without optional parts 1,360 kg 1,450 kg 1,455 kg
Kerb weight
With full optional parts 1,413 kg 1,463 kg 1,517 kg
Maximum gross vehicle weight 1,970 kg, 2,035 kg*
Front 1,030 kg
Maximum axle weight
Rear 1,000 kg, 1,085 kg*
With brake 1,300 kg
Maximum towable weight 11
Without brake 715 kg 745 kg
Maximum trailer-nose weight 65 kg
Maximum roof load 80 kg
Seating capacity 5 persons
*: In case of trailer towing

NOTE
l Trailer specifications indicate the manufacturer’s recommendation.

OGAE15E5 Specifications 11-09


Vehicle weight

Diesel-powered vehicles
1600 models 2200 models
2WD 4WD 4WD
Item M/T A/T
INFORM IN- INTENSE IN- INFORM IN- INTENSE IN- INFORM IN- INTENSE IN-
VITE STYLE VITE STYLE VITE STYLE
Without option-
1,355 kg 1,380 kg 1,420 kg 1,445 kg 1,520 kg 1,540 kg
al parts
Kerb weight
With full option-
1,377 kg 1,441 kg 1,442 kg 1,506 kg 1,542 kg 1,601 kg
al parts
Maximum gross vehicle weight 1,980 kg, 2,050 kg* 2,060 kg, 2,130 kg*

Maximum axle Front 1,120 kg


weight Rear 1,000 kg, 1,090 kg*
11 Maximum towa- With brake 1,400 kg
ble weight Without brake 695 kg 745 kg 750 kg
Maximum trailer-nose weight 70 kg
Maximum roof load 80 kg
Seating capacity 5 persons
*: In case of trailer towing

NOTE
l Trailer specifications indicate the manufacturer’s recommendation.

11-10 Specifications OGAE15E5


Engine specifications

Engine specifications
E01100604335

Petrol-powered vehicles
Item 1600 models 1800 models 2000 models
Engine model 4A92 4B10 4B11
No. of cylinders 4 in line 4 in line 4 in line
Total displacement 1,590 cc 1,798 cc 1,998 cc
Bore 75.0 mm 86.0 mm 86.0 mm
Stroke 90.0 mm 77.4 mm 86.0 mm
Camshaft Double overhead Double overhead Double overhead
Mixture preparation Electronic injection Electronic injection Electronic injection
86 kW/6,000 r/min,
Maximum output (EEC net) 86 kW/6,100 r/min*1 103 kW/6,000 r/min 110 kW/6,000 r/min
85 kW/6,000 r/min*2 11
Maximum torque (EEC net) 154 N•m/4,000 r/min 177 N•m/4,200 r/min 197 N•m/4,200 r/min
*1: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine
*2: Vehicles for Belgium and Norway
Diesel-powered vehicles
Item 1600 models 2200 models
Engine model 9HD 4N14
No. of cylinders 4 in line 4 in line
Total displacement 1,560 cc 2,268 cc

OGAE15E5 Specifications 11-11


Electrical system

Item 1600 models 2200 models


Bore 75.0 mm 86.0 mm
Stroke 88.3 mm 97.6 mm
Camshaft Single overhead Double overhead
Mixture preparation Electronic direct injection Electronic direct injection
Maximum output (EEC net) 84 kW/3,600 r/min 110 kW/3,500 r/min
Maximum torque (EEC net) 270 N•m/1,750 r/min 360 N•m/1,500 to 2,750 r/min

Electrical system
E01100804122

Petrol-powered vehicles Diesel-powered vehicles


Item 1800 models,
1600 models 1600 models 2200 models
2000 models
11 Voltage 12 V
Type1 Type (JIS) 75D23L, Q-85*1 75D23L T-105 95D31L
Battery
Capacity (5HR) 52Ah, 55Ah*1 52 Ah 73Ah 64 Ah
Type2 Type (BCI) BCI Group No.35 (530CCA/118RC) —
Alternator capacity 95 A, 85 A*2 105 A 150 A 130 A
NGK DILFR5A11
FR6EI
Spark plug type LZFR5BI-11*2 —
DENSO — K20PSR-B8
*1: Vehicles equipped with Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system
*2: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine

11-12 Specifications OGAE15E5


Tyres and wheels

NOTE
l For vehicles equipped with the Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system, contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Point when replacing the battery.

Tyres and wheels


E01100904543

Tyre 215/65R16 98H 215/70R16 100H 215/60R17 96H 225/55R18 98V 225/55R18 98H P225/55R18 97H
Size 16x6 1/2J 17x6 1/2 J 18x7J
Wheel
Offset 46 mm 38 mm 38 mm, 46 mm*
*: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine

NOTE
l Contact your MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Point for details on the combination used on your vehicle.
11

Fuel consumption
E01101101903

Petrol-powered vehicles

OGAE15E5 Specifications 11-13


Fuel consumption

Urban condi- Extra-urban


Combined
tions conditions
Item
Fuel consump- Fuel consump- Fuel consump-
CO2 (g/km)
tion (L/100 km) tion (L/100 km) tion (L/100 km)
INFORM 135 5,8 7,4 4,9
INVITE 135, 141* 5.8, 6.1* 7.4, 8.0* 4.9, 5.0*
Without AS&G
INTENSE IN- 136 5.9 7.4 5.0
1600 models STYLE 131 5.7 6.9 4.9
INFORM IN-
VITE
With AS&G 132 5.7 7.0 5.0
INTENSE IN-
STYLE
1800 models 175 7.4 9,4 6,2
2WD 181 7,7 10.1 6,3
2000 models
4WD 183 7.7 9.4 6.7
11
*:
Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine
AS&G: Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system

NOTE
l The results given do not express or imply any guarantee of the fuel consumption of the particular vehicle.
The vehicle itself has not been tested and there are inevitably differences between individual vehicles of the same model. In addition, this vehicle may incor-
porate particular modifications. Furthermore, the driver’s style and road and traffic conditions, as well as the extent to which the vehicle has been driven and
the standard of maintenance, will all affect its fuel consumption.

Diesel-powered vehicles

11-14 Specifications OGAE15E5


Fuel consumption

Urban condi- Extra-urban


Combined
tions conditions
Item
Fuel consump- Fuel consump- Fuel consump-
CO2 (g/km)
tion (L/100 km) tion (L/100 km) tion (L/100 km)
2WD 119 4.6 5.2 4.2
1600 models
4WD 132 5.0 5.6 4.7
INFORM INVITE 152 5.8 7.2 5.0
2200 models
INTENSE INSTYLE 152 5.8 7.1 5.0

NOTE
l The results given do not express or imply any guarantee of the fuel consumption of the particular vehicle.
The vehicle itself has not been tested and there are inevitably differences between individual vehicles of the same model. In addition, this vehicle may incor-
porate particular modifications. Furthermore, the driver’s style and road and traffic conditions, as well as the extent to which the vehicle has been driven and
the standard of maintenance, will all affect its fuel consumption.

11

OGAE15E5 Specifications 11-15


Refill capacities

Refill capacities
E01101306434

Petrol-powered vehicles
1600 models
LHD RHD

11 1800 models, 2000 models

11-16 Specifications OGAE15E5


Refill capacities

Diesel-powered vehicles
1600 models
LHD RHD

2200 models

LHD RHD
11

OGAE15E5 Specifications 11-17


Refill capacities

No. Item Quantity Lubricants


Oil pan 4.0 litres
1600 models
Oil filter 0.2 litre
Petrol-powered Oil pan 4.0 litres
1800 models
vehicles Oil filter 0.3 litre
Oil pan 4.0 litres
1 Engine oil 2000 models Refer to page 10-05.
Oil filter 0.3 litre
3.25 litres*1
1600 models
Diesel-powered 3.75 litres*2
vehicles Oil pan 7.1 litres
2200 models
Oil filter 0.3 litre
*1: Oil capacity without replacement of the oil filter cartridge
*2: Oil capacity with replacement of the oil filter cartridge
11
No. Item Quantity Lubricants
Brake fluid
2 As required Brake fluid DOT 3 or DOT 4
Clutch fluid
3 Washer fluid 4.5 litres —
Engine coolant (pet- 6.0 litres [includes MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE SUPER
4 rol-powered vehi- 1600 models 0.65 litre in the re- LONG LIFE COOLANT PREMIUM or equiva-
cles) serve tank] lent*
*: similar high quality ethylene glycol based non-silicate, non-amine, non-nitrate and non-borate coolant with long life hybrid organic acid tech-

nology

11-18 Specifications OGAE15E5


Refill capacities

No. Item Quantity Lubricants


Engine coolant (pet- 7.5 litres [includes MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE SUPER
1800 models,
rol-powered vehi- 0.65 litre in the re- LONG LIFE COOLANT PREMIUM or equiva-
2000 models
cles) serve tank] lent*
7.4 litres [includes ALTECO Freecor DSC, BASF Glysantin Alu
4 1600 models 0.62 litre in the re- Protect Premium/G30 or G33, or Brugarolas Bra-
Engine coolant (die- serve tank] dol 497
sel-powered vehicles) 7.5 litres [includes MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE SUPER
2200 models 0.65 litre in the re- LONG LIFE COOLANT PREMIUM or equiva-
serve tank] lent*
5 Automatic transmission fluid 8.2 litres MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE ATF-J3
6 CVT fluid 6.9 litres MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE CVTF-J4
*:similar high quality ethylene glycol based non-silicate, non-amine, non-nitrate and non-borate coolant with long life hybrid organic acid tech-
nology

CAUTION
11
l For the automatic transmission fluid, use only the MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE ATF and for the CVT fluid, use only the MITSUBISHI MOTORS
GENUINE CVTF. Use of a different fluid could damage the transmission.

No. Item Quantity Lubricants


1600 models 2.0 litres
5 M/T
2000 models 2.5 litres MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE NEW MUL-
7 Manual transmission oil TI GEAR OIL
1600 mod- 2WD 2.6 litres API classification GL-3, SAE 75W-80
6 M/T
els 4WD 2.7 litres
MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE Super Hy-
8 Transfer oil 0.5 litre
poid Gear Oil API classification GL-5 SAE 80

OGAE15E5 Specifications 11-19


Refill capacities

No. Item Quantity Lubricants


MITSUBISHI MOTORS GENUINE Super Hy-
9 Rear differential oil 0.4 litre
poid Gear Oil API classification GL-5 SAE 80
480 - 520
10 Refrigerant (air conditioning) HFC-134a
g

11

11-20 Specifications OGAE15E5


Alphabetical index
Caution for installing the child re-
4 B straint on vehicles with a front
passenger airbag.................................. 4-15,4-27
4-wheel drive operation.....................................6-41 Battery............................................................. 10-09 Child-protection rear doors............................... 3-30
Charge warning lamp.................................... 5-46 Cigarette lighter.................................................7-73
A Discharged battery (Emergency starting)..... 8-02 Cleaning
Disposal information for used batteries........ 2-06
Accessory (Installation).....................................2-04 Exterior of your vehicle................................ 9-03
Specification............................................... 11-12
Interior of your vehicle................................. 9-02
Accessory socket............................................... 7-74 Bluetooth® 2.0 interface................................... 7-48
Clutch
Active stability control (ASC)...........................6-51 Bonnet............................................................. 10-03
Fluid............................................................ 10-09
Additional equipment......................................10-19 Bottle holder......................................................7-81 Coat hook.......................................................... 7-83
Air conditioning................................................ 7-03 Brake assist system............................................6-47 Combination headlamps and dipper switch...... 5-48
Important operation tips for the air Brake Coolant (engine)....................................10-07,11-16
conditioning................................................. 7-11 Anti-lock brake............................................. 6-48 Cruise control.................................................... 6-54
Air purifier.........................................................7-12 Braking..........................................................6-44
Cup holder......................................................... 7-81
Airbag................................................................4-24 Fluid..................................................10-09,11-16
Parking brake................................................ 6-06
Antenna............................................................. 7-47
Bulb capacity...................................................10-26 D
Anti-lock brake system (ABS).......................... 6-48
Daytime running lamps (type 1)........................5-51
Display.......................................................... 6-49 C
Warning lamp................................................6-49 Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-26
Ashtray.............................................................. 7-72 Capacities........................................................ 11-16 Replacement................................................10-33
Daytime running lamps (type 2)........................5-51
Assist grips........................................................ 7-83 Card holder................................................7-72,7-79
Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-26
Audio Cargo loads........................................................6-71
Replacement................................................10-33
CD player...................................................... 7-12 Catalytic converter.......................................... 10-02 Demister (rear window).................................... 5-63
LW/MW/FM radio........................................7-12 Cautions on handling of 4-wheel Diesel particulate filter (DPF)........................... 6-17
Troubleshooting............................................ 7-45 drive vehicles................................................... 6-43
Auto Stop & Go (AS&G) system......................6-19 Digital clock
CD player.......................................................... 7-12
Automatic transmission Time Setting..................................................7-43
Central door locks............................................. 3-26 Dimensions......................................................11-05
Fluid............................................................ 11-16
Selector lever operation........................ 6-26,6-32 Charge warning lamp........................................ 5-46 Dipper (High/Low beam change)......................5-52
Selector lever position.......................... 6-28,6-34 Chassis number............................................... 11-02 Doors
Sports mode.......................................... 6-29,6-36 Check engine warning lamp..............................5-45 Central door locks......................................... 3-26
Child restraint....................................................4-15 Child-protection............................................ 3-30
Dead Lock System........................................ 3-27

OGAE15E5 Alphabetical index 12- 1


Alphabetical index
Lock and unlock............................................3-25 Washer fluid..................................... 10-08,11-16 Head restraints...................................................4-07
Driving, alcohol and drugs................................ 6-03 For cold and snowy weather............................10-19 Headlamp levelling switch................................ 5-54
Front fog lamps Headlamp washer switch...................................5-62
E Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-26 Headlamps
Replacement................................................10-32
Economical driving........................................... 6-02 Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-26
Switch........................................................... 5-56
Electric power steering system (EPS)............... 6-50 Front room lamp Headlamp flasher.......................................... 5-52
Replacement..................................... 10-28,10-29
Electric window control.................................... 3-39 Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27 Switch........................................................... 5-48
Electrical system............................................. 11-12 Front seat........................................................... 4-03 Heated mirror.................................................... 6-12
Electronic immobilizer (Anti-theft Front turn-signal lamps Heated seats.......................................................4-06
starting system)................................................ 3-03 Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-26 Heater................................................................ 7-03
Electronically controlled 4WD system............. 6-39 Replacement................................................10-31
Fuel consumption............................................ 11-13 High-mounted stop lamp
Emergency starting............................................8-02
Fuel Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27
Emergency stop signal system.......................... 6-48 Replacement................................................10-37
Filling the fuel tank....................................... 2-03 Hill start assist................................................... 6-45
Engine specifications.......................................11-11
Fuel selection................................................ 2-02
Engine switch.................................................... 3-13 Modification/alterations to the Hinges and latches lubrication........................ 10-19
Engine electrical or fuel systems............................. 2-05 Horn switch....................................................... 5-63
Coolant..............................................10-07,11-16 Tank capacity................................................ 2-03
Number....................................................... 11-03 Fuses................................................................10-20 I
Oil............................................................... 10-05 Fusible links.................................................... 10-19
Oil and filter................................................ 11-16 If the vehicle breaks down................................ 8-02
Overheating...................................................8-04 G Ignition switch...................................................6-12
Specifications.............................................. 11-11 Indication lamps................................................ 5-44
Used engine oils safety instructions General maintenance....................................... 10-19
and disposal information............................. 2-06 Information screen display................................ 5-46
General vehicle data........................................ 11-05
Exterior and interior lamp operation............... 10-19 Inside rear-view mirror......................................6-08
Genuine parts.....................................................2-05
Inside tailgate release........................................ 3-31
F Glove box lamp
Inspection and maintenance following
Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27 rough road operation........................................6-43
Fluid capacities and lubricants........................ 11-16
Instruments........................................................ 5-02
Fluid H
Interior lamps.................................................... 7-74
Automatic transmission fluid...................... 11-16
Brake fluid........................................ 10-09,11-16 Hazard warning flasher switch..........................5-55
Clutch fluid................................................. 10-09 Hazard warning indication lamps......................5-44
Engine coolant.................................. 10-07,11-16
12- 2 Alphabetical index OGAE15E5
Alphabetical index
Map lamps......................................................... 7-75
J Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27 R
Mirror
Jack....................................................................8-07 Rear combination lamps
Inside rear-view mirror................................. 6-08
Storage.......................................................... 8-06 Outside rear-view mirrors............................. 6-10 Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27
Jump starting (Emergency starting).................. 8-02 Modification/alterations to the electri- Replacement................................................10-35
cal or fuel systems............................................2-05 Rear differential oil......................................... 11-16
K Multi-information display................................. 5-03 Rear fog lamp
Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27
Key slot............................................................. 3-20
O Replacement..................................... 10-34,10-35
Keyless entry system.................................3-04,3-22 Switch........................................................... 5-56
Keyless operation system.................................. 3-08 Oil Rear room lamp
Keys...................................................................3-02 Engine oil.................................................... 10-05 Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27
Manual transmission oil.............................. 11-16 Rear shelf panel.................................................7-82
L Rear differential oil..................................... 11-16
Transfer oil..................................................11-16
Rear turn-signal lamps
Operation mode................................................. 3-14 Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27
Labeling...........................................................11-02 Replacement................................................10-35
Lamp monitor buzzer........................................ 5-51 Operation under adverse driving conditions..... 8-24 Rear window demister switch........................... 5-63
Leakage (Fuel, engine coolant, oil Outside rear-view mirrors................................. 6-10 Rear-view camera..............................................6-68
and exhaust gas).............................................10-19 Overheating....................................................... 8-04 Rear-view mirror
Licence plate lamps Inside.............................................................6-08
Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27 P Outside.......................................................... 6-10
Replacement................................................10-37 Refill capacities............................................... 11-16
Parking.............................................................. 6-07
Link System.......................................................7-47 Replacement of lamp bulbs............................. 10-26
Parking brake................................................ 6-06
Lubricants........................................................11-16 Reversing lamps
Position lamps
Luggage hooks.................................................. 7-83 Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27
Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-26
Luggage room lamp.......................................... 7-76 Replacement................................................10-30 Replacement................................................10-35
Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27 Precautions to observe when using Reversing sensor system................................... 6-64
LW/MW/FM radio............................................ 7-12 wipers and washers.......................................... 5-62 Roof carrier precaution......................................6-72
Pregnant women restraint..................................4-14 Room lamp (front).............................................7-75
M Puncture (tyre changing)................................... 8-13 Room lamp (rear).............................................. 7-75
Making a luggage compartment........................4-08 Running-in recommendations........................... 6-04
Manual transmission......................................... 6-23

OGAE15E5 Alphabetical index 12- 3


Alphabetical index
Stop lamps Size (tyre and wheel).................................. 11-13
S Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-26 Snow tyres...................................................10-16
Storage spaces................................................... 7-78 Tread wear indicators..................................10-14
Safe driving techniques..................................... 6-03 Tyre chains..................................................10-16
Sun visors.......................................................... 7-71
Seat belt............................................................. 4-09
Adjustable seat belt anchor........................... 4-11
Sunshade............................................................3-41 U
Sunshade illumination....................................... 7-77
Child restraint................................................4-15 USB input terminal............................................7-68
Force limiter..................................................4-15 Supplemental restraint system...........................4-24
Inspection...................................................... 4-24 Servicing....................................................... 4-36 How to connect an iPod................................ 7-69
Pregnant women restraint............................. 4-14 USB input terminal device
Pretensioner...................................................4-14 T How to connect a USB memory device........ 7-68
Seat Used engine oils safety instructions
Adjustment.................................................... 4-03 Tachometer........................................................5-02 and disposal information..................................2-06
Front seat.......................................................4-03 Tail lamps
Head restraints.............................................. 4-07 V
Heated seats.................................................. 4-06 Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27
Making a luggage compartment....................4-08 Replacement................................................10-35 Vanity mirror lamp
Rear seat........................................................4-06 Tailgate..............................................................3-30
Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-27
Security alarm system....................................... 3-32 Tank capacity.................................................... 2-03 Vehicle care precautions................................... 9-02
Service precaution........................................... 10-02 Time Setting...................................................... 7-43 Vehicle dimensions......................................... 11-05
Side turn-signal lamps Tools..................................................................8-06 Vehicle identification number plate................ 11-03
Bulb capacity.............................................. 10-26 Storage.......................................................... 8-06 Vehicle information code plate....................... 11-03
Replacement................................................10-32 Towing.............................................................. 8-20
Vehicle labeling...............................................11-02
Snow tyres....................................................... 10-16 Trailer towing....................................................6-72
Vehicle performance....................................... 11-07
Spare wheel....................................................... 8-14 Transfer oil...................................................... 11-16
Vehicle weight.................................................11-08
Spark plug....................................................... 11-12 Transmission
Ventilators......................................................... 7-02
Specifications.................................................. 11-02 Automatic transmission........................ 6-26,6-32
Manual transmission..................................... 6-23
Starting.............................................................. 6-14
Turbocharger operation..................................... 6-18
W
Starting and stopping the engine....................... 3-17
Steering Turn-signal indication lamps.............................5-44 Warning lamps.................................................. 5-45
Steering wheel height and reach adjustment.6-08 Turn/Lane-change signals................................. 5-55 Washer
Steering wheel lock.............................. 3-17,6-13 Tyres................................................................10-13 Fluid..................................................10-08,11-16
Stop and tail lamps How to change a tyre.................................... 8-13 Switch................................................... 5-61,5-62
Replacement................................................10-35 Inflation pressures....................................... 10-13 Washing.............................................................9-03
Rotation.......................................................10-15
12- 4 Alphabetical index OGAE15E5
Alphabetical index
Waxing.............................................................. 9-04
Weatherstripping............................................. 10-19
Weight............................................................. 11-08
Wheel
Covers........................................................... 8-19
Specification............................................... 11-13
Wiper
Rear window................................................. 5-61
Windscreen................................................... 5-57
Wiper blades............................................... 10-17

OGAE15E5 Alphabetical index 12- 5


OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 1
13- 2 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 3
13- 4 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 5
13- 6 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 7
13- 8 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 9
13- 10 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 11
13- 12 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 13
13- 14 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 15
13- 16 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 17
13- 18 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 19
13- 20 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 21
13- 22 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 23
13- 24 Declaration of Conformity OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5 Declaration of Conformity 13- 25
OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5
OGAE15E5
Foreword Throughout this owner’s manual the words WARNING and CAUTION
appear.
Information for station service
E09200106344 E09300104149
Thank you for selecting an ASX as your new vehicle. These serve as reminders to be especially careful. Failure to follow instruc-
tions could result in personal injury or damage to your vehicle. 58 litres*1
2WD models
This owner’s manual will add to your understanding and full enjoyment of Petrol-powered vehicles 63 litres*2
the many fine features of this vehicle. WARNING Capacity
4WD models 60 litres
It contains information prepared to acquaint you with the proper way to oper-
ate and maintain your vehicle for the utmost in driving pleasure. indicates a strong possibility of severe personal injury or death if in- Diesel-powered vehicles 60 litres
structions are not followed. Petrol-powered vehicles
Fuel
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Europe B.V. reserves the right to make changes in Unleaded petrol octane number (EN228)
design and specifications and/or to make additions to or improvements in CAUTION 1600 models, 1800 models: 95 RON or higher
this product without obligation to install them on products previously manu- Fuel requirements 2000 models: 90 RON or higher
factured. means hazards or unsafe practices that could cause minor personal in- Diesel-powered vehicles
It is an absolute requirement for the driver to strictly observe all laws and jury or damage to your vehicle. Cetane number (EN590): 51 or higher
regulations concerning vehicles. You will see another important symbol: Refer to the “General information” section for the fuel selection.

This owner’s manual has been written in compliance with such laws and reg- NOTE: gives helpful information. Engine oil Refer to the “Maintenance” section for the selection of engine oil.
ulations, but some of the contents may become contradictory with later *: indicates optional equipment. Tyre inflation pressure Refer to the “Maintenance” section for the tyre inflation pressure.
amendment of the laws and regulations. It may differ according to the sales classification; refer *1: For vehicles with vehicle identification numbers that begin with “4”
to the sales catalogue.
*2: For vehicles with vehicle identification numbers that begin with “J”
Please leave this owner’s manual in this vehicle at time of resale. The next
owner will appreciate having access to the information contained in this Abbreviations used in this owner’s manual:
LHD: Left-Hand Drive
owner’s manual.
RHD: Right-Hand Drive CAUTION
Repairs to your vehicle: M/T: Manual Transmission l Diesel-powered vehicles are designed to use only diesel fuel that meets the EN 590 standard.
Vehicles in the warranty period: A/T: Automatic Transmission Use of any other type of diesel fuel can adversely affect the engine.
All warranty repairs must be carried out by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Au- CVT: Continuously Variable Transmission
The symbol used on the vehicles:
thorized Service Point. NOTE
Vehicles outside the warranty period: : See owner’s manual l For the location of the vehicle identification number, refer to “Vehicle identification number” on page 11-02.
Where the vehicle is repaired is at the discretion of the owner.

© 2015 Mitsubishi Motors Corporation


OGAE15E5
BLO-15-000456
15
ASX - ENGLISH - OGAE15E5
ASX
OWNER’S MANUAL

ASX - ENGLISH - OGAE15E5

You might also like